You can not select more than 25 topics Topics must start with a letter or number, can include dashes ('-') and can be up to 35 characters long.

25797 lines
686KB

  1. @chapter Filtering Introduction
  2. @c man begin FILTERING INTRODUCTION
  3. Filtering in FFmpeg is enabled through the libavfilter library.
  4. In libavfilter, a filter can have multiple inputs and multiple
  5. outputs.
  6. To illustrate the sorts of things that are possible, we consider the
  7. following filtergraph.
  8. @verbatim
  9. [main]
  10. input --> split ---------------------> overlay --> output
  11. | ^
  12. |[tmp] [flip]|
  13. +-----> crop --> vflip -------+
  14. @end verbatim
  15. This filtergraph splits the input stream in two streams, then sends one
  16. stream through the crop filter and the vflip filter, before merging it
  17. back with the other stream by overlaying it on top. You can use the
  18. following command to achieve this:
  19. @example
  20. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "split [main][tmp]; [tmp] crop=iw:ih/2:0:0, vflip [flip]; [main][flip] overlay=0:H/2" OUTPUT
  21. @end example
  22. The result will be that the top half of the video is mirrored
  23. onto the bottom half of the output video.
  24. Filters in the same linear chain are separated by commas, and distinct
  25. linear chains of filters are separated by semicolons. In our example,
  26. @var{crop,vflip} are in one linear chain, @var{split} and
  27. @var{overlay} are separately in another. The points where the linear
  28. chains join are labelled by names enclosed in square brackets. In the
  29. example, the split filter generates two outputs that are associated to
  30. the labels @var{[main]} and @var{[tmp]}.
  31. The stream sent to the second output of @var{split}, labelled as
  32. @var{[tmp]}, is processed through the @var{crop} filter, which crops
  33. away the lower half part of the video, and then vertically flipped. The
  34. @var{overlay} filter takes in input the first unchanged output of the
  35. split filter (which was labelled as @var{[main]}), and overlay on its
  36. lower half the output generated by the @var{crop,vflip} filterchain.
  37. Some filters take in input a list of parameters: they are specified
  38. after the filter name and an equal sign, and are separated from each other
  39. by a colon.
  40. There exist so-called @var{source filters} that do not have an
  41. audio/video input, and @var{sink filters} that will not have audio/video
  42. output.
  43. @c man end FILTERING INTRODUCTION
  44. @chapter graph2dot
  45. @c man begin GRAPH2DOT
  46. The @file{graph2dot} program included in the FFmpeg @file{tools}
  47. directory can be used to parse a filtergraph description and issue a
  48. corresponding textual representation in the dot language.
  49. Invoke the command:
  50. @example
  51. graph2dot -h
  52. @end example
  53. to see how to use @file{graph2dot}.
  54. You can then pass the dot description to the @file{dot} program (from
  55. the graphviz suite of programs) and obtain a graphical representation
  56. of the filtergraph.
  57. For example the sequence of commands:
  58. @example
  59. echo @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} | \
  60. tools/graph2dot -o graph.tmp && \
  61. dot -Tpng graph.tmp -o graph.png && \
  62. display graph.png
  63. @end example
  64. can be used to create and display an image representing the graph
  65. described by the @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string. Note that this string must be
  66. a complete self-contained graph, with its inputs and outputs explicitly defined.
  67. For example if your command line is of the form:
  68. @example
  69. ffmpeg -i infile -vf scale=640:360 outfile
  70. @end example
  71. your @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string will need to be of the form:
  72. @example
  73. nullsrc,scale=640:360,nullsink
  74. @end example
  75. you may also need to set the @var{nullsrc} parameters and add a @var{format}
  76. filter in order to simulate a specific input file.
  77. @c man end GRAPH2DOT
  78. @chapter Filtergraph description
  79. @c man begin FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
  80. A filtergraph is a directed graph of connected filters. It can contain
  81. cycles, and there can be multiple links between a pair of
  82. filters. Each link has one input pad on one side connecting it to one
  83. filter from which it takes its input, and one output pad on the other
  84. side connecting it to one filter accepting its output.
  85. Each filter in a filtergraph is an instance of a filter class
  86. registered in the application, which defines the features and the
  87. number of input and output pads of the filter.
  88. A filter with no input pads is called a "source", and a filter with no
  89. output pads is called a "sink".
  90. @anchor{Filtergraph syntax}
  91. @section Filtergraph syntax
  92. A filtergraph has a textual representation, which is recognized by the
  93. @option{-filter}/@option{-vf}/@option{-af} and
  94. @option{-filter_complex} options in @command{ffmpeg} and
  95. @option{-vf}/@option{-af} in @command{ffplay}, and by the
  96. @code{avfilter_graph_parse_ptr()} function defined in
  97. @file{libavfilter/avfilter.h}.
  98. A filterchain consists of a sequence of connected filters, each one
  99. connected to the previous one in the sequence. A filterchain is
  100. represented by a list of ","-separated filter descriptions.
  101. A filtergraph consists of a sequence of filterchains. A sequence of
  102. filterchains is represented by a list of ";"-separated filterchain
  103. descriptions.
  104. A filter is represented by a string of the form:
  105. [@var{in_link_1}]...[@var{in_link_N}]@var{filter_name}@@@var{id}=@var{arguments}[@var{out_link_1}]...[@var{out_link_M}]
  106. @var{filter_name} is the name of the filter class of which the
  107. described filter is an instance of, and has to be the name of one of
  108. the filter classes registered in the program optionally followed by "@@@var{id}".
  109. The name of the filter class is optionally followed by a string
  110. "=@var{arguments}".
  111. @var{arguments} is a string which contains the parameters used to
  112. initialize the filter instance. It may have one of two forms:
  113. @itemize
  114. @item
  115. A ':'-separated list of @var{key=value} pairs.
  116. @item
  117. A ':'-separated list of @var{value}. In this case, the keys are assumed to be
  118. the option names in the order they are declared. E.g. the @code{fade} filter
  119. declares three options in this order -- @option{type}, @option{start_frame} and
  120. @option{nb_frames}. Then the parameter list @var{in:0:30} means that the value
  121. @var{in} is assigned to the option @option{type}, @var{0} to
  122. @option{start_frame} and @var{30} to @option{nb_frames}.
  123. @item
  124. A ':'-separated list of mixed direct @var{value} and long @var{key=value}
  125. pairs. The direct @var{value} must precede the @var{key=value} pairs, and
  126. follow the same constraints order of the previous point. The following
  127. @var{key=value} pairs can be set in any preferred order.
  128. @end itemize
  129. If the option value itself is a list of items (e.g. the @code{format} filter
  130. takes a list of pixel formats), the items in the list are usually separated by
  131. @samp{|}.
  132. The list of arguments can be quoted using the character @samp{'} as initial
  133. and ending mark, and the character @samp{\} for escaping the characters
  134. within the quoted text; otherwise the argument string is considered
  135. terminated when the next special character (belonging to the set
  136. @samp{[]=;,}) is encountered.
  137. The name and arguments of the filter are optionally preceded and
  138. followed by a list of link labels.
  139. A link label allows one to name a link and associate it to a filter output
  140. or input pad. The preceding labels @var{in_link_1}
  141. ... @var{in_link_N}, are associated to the filter input pads,
  142. the following labels @var{out_link_1} ... @var{out_link_M}, are
  143. associated to the output pads.
  144. When two link labels with the same name are found in the
  145. filtergraph, a link between the corresponding input and output pad is
  146. created.
  147. If an output pad is not labelled, it is linked by default to the first
  148. unlabelled input pad of the next filter in the filterchain.
  149. For example in the filterchain
  150. @example
  151. nullsrc, split[L1], [L2]overlay, nullsink
  152. @end example
  153. the split filter instance has two output pads, and the overlay filter
  154. instance two input pads. The first output pad of split is labelled
  155. "L1", the first input pad of overlay is labelled "L2", and the second
  156. output pad of split is linked to the second input pad of overlay,
  157. which are both unlabelled.
  158. In a filter description, if the input label of the first filter is not
  159. specified, "in" is assumed; if the output label of the last filter is not
  160. specified, "out" is assumed.
  161. In a complete filterchain all the unlabelled filter input and output
  162. pads must be connected. A filtergraph is considered valid if all the
  163. filter input and output pads of all the filterchains are connected.
  164. Libavfilter will automatically insert @ref{scale} filters where format
  165. conversion is required. It is possible to specify swscale flags
  166. for those automatically inserted scalers by prepending
  167. @code{sws_flags=@var{flags};}
  168. to the filtergraph description.
  169. Here is a BNF description of the filtergraph syntax:
  170. @example
  171. @var{NAME} ::= sequence of alphanumeric characters and '_'
  172. @var{FILTER_NAME} ::= @var{NAME}["@@"@var{NAME}]
  173. @var{LINKLABEL} ::= "[" @var{NAME} "]"
  174. @var{LINKLABELS} ::= @var{LINKLABEL} [@var{LINKLABELS}]
  175. @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS} ::= sequence of chars (possibly quoted)
  176. @var{FILTER} ::= [@var{LINKLABELS}] @var{FILTER_NAME} ["=" @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS}] [@var{LINKLABELS}]
  177. @var{FILTERCHAIN} ::= @var{FILTER} [,@var{FILTERCHAIN}]
  178. @var{FILTERGRAPH} ::= [sws_flags=@var{flags};] @var{FILTERCHAIN} [;@var{FILTERGRAPH}]
  179. @end example
  180. @anchor{filtergraph escaping}
  181. @section Notes on filtergraph escaping
  182. Filtergraph description composition entails several levels of
  183. escaping. See @ref{quoting_and_escaping,,the "Quoting and escaping"
  184. section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils} for more
  185. information about the employed escaping procedure.
  186. A first level escaping affects the content of each filter option
  187. value, which may contain the special character @code{:} used to
  188. separate values, or one of the escaping characters @code{\'}.
  189. A second level escaping affects the whole filter description, which
  190. may contain the escaping characters @code{\'} or the special
  191. characters @code{[],;} used by the filtergraph description.
  192. Finally, when you specify a filtergraph on a shell commandline, you
  193. need to perform a third level escaping for the shell special
  194. characters contained within it.
  195. For example, consider the following string to be embedded in
  196. the @ref{drawtext} filter description @option{text} value:
  197. @example
  198. this is a 'string': may contain one, or more, special characters
  199. @end example
  200. This string contains the @code{'} special escaping character, and the
  201. @code{:} special character, so it needs to be escaped in this way:
  202. @example
  203. text=this is a \'string\'\: may contain one, or more, special characters
  204. @end example
  205. A second level of escaping is required when embedding the filter
  206. description in a filtergraph description, in order to escape all the
  207. filtergraph special characters. Thus the example above becomes:
  208. @example
  209. drawtext=text=this is a \\\'string\\\'\\: may contain one\, or more\, special characters
  210. @end example
  211. (note that in addition to the @code{\'} escaping special characters,
  212. also @code{,} needs to be escaped).
  213. Finally an additional level of escaping is needed when writing the
  214. filtergraph description in a shell command, which depends on the
  215. escaping rules of the adopted shell. For example, assuming that
  216. @code{\} is special and needs to be escaped with another @code{\}, the
  217. previous string will finally result in:
  218. @example
  219. -vf "drawtext=text=this is a \\\\\\'string\\\\\\'\\\\: may contain one\\, or more\\, special characters"
  220. @end example
  221. @chapter Timeline editing
  222. Some filters support a generic @option{enable} option. For the filters
  223. supporting timeline editing, this option can be set to an expression which is
  224. evaluated before sending a frame to the filter. If the evaluation is non-zero,
  225. the filter will be enabled, otherwise the frame will be sent unchanged to the
  226. next filter in the filtergraph.
  227. The expression accepts the following values:
  228. @table @samp
  229. @item t
  230. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  231. @item n
  232. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0
  233. @item pos
  234. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  235. @item w
  236. @item h
  237. width and height of the input frame if video
  238. @end table
  239. Additionally, these filters support an @option{enable} command that can be used
  240. to re-define the expression.
  241. Like any other filtering option, the @option{enable} option follows the same
  242. rules.
  243. For example, to enable a blur filter (@ref{smartblur}) from 10 seconds to 3
  244. minutes, and a @ref{curves} filter starting at 3 seconds:
  245. @example
  246. smartblur = enable='between(t,10,3*60)',
  247. curves = enable='gte(t,3)' : preset=cross_process
  248. @end example
  249. See @code{ffmpeg -filters} to view which filters have timeline support.
  250. @c man end FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
  251. @anchor{commands}
  252. @chapter Changing options at runtime with a command
  253. Some options can be changed during the operation of the filter using
  254. a command. These options are marked 'T' on the output of
  255. @command{ffmpeg} @option{-h filter=<name of filter>}.
  256. The name of the command is the name of the option and the argument is
  257. the new value.
  258. @anchor{framesync}
  259. @chapter Options for filters with several inputs (framesync)
  260. @c man begin OPTIONS FOR FILTERS WITH SEVERAL INPUTS
  261. Some filters with several inputs support a common set of options.
  262. These options can only be set by name, not with the short notation.
  263. @table @option
  264. @item eof_action
  265. The action to take when EOF is encountered on the secondary input; it accepts
  266. one of the following values:
  267. @table @option
  268. @item repeat
  269. Repeat the last frame (the default).
  270. @item endall
  271. End both streams.
  272. @item pass
  273. Pass the main input through.
  274. @end table
  275. @item shortest
  276. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  277. terminates. Default value is 0.
  278. @item repeatlast
  279. If set to 1, force the filter to extend the last frame of secondary streams
  280. until the end of the primary stream. A value of 0 disables this behavior.
  281. Default value is 1.
  282. @end table
  283. @c man end OPTIONS FOR FILTERS WITH SEVERAL INPUTS
  284. @chapter Audio Filters
  285. @c man begin AUDIO FILTERS
  286. When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
  287. existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
  288. The configure output will show the audio filters included in your
  289. build.
  290. Below is a description of the currently available audio filters.
  291. @section acompressor
  292. A compressor is mainly used to reduce the dynamic range of a signal.
  293. Especially modern music is mostly compressed at a high ratio to
  294. improve the overall loudness. It's done to get the highest attention
  295. of a listener, "fatten" the sound and bring more "power" to the track.
  296. If a signal is compressed too much it may sound dull or "dead"
  297. afterwards or it may start to "pump" (which could be a powerful effect
  298. but can also destroy a track completely).
  299. The right compression is the key to reach a professional sound and is
  300. the high art of mixing and mastering. Because of its complex settings
  301. it may take a long time to get the right feeling for this kind of effect.
  302. Compression is done by detecting the volume above a chosen level
  303. @code{threshold} and dividing it by the factor set with @code{ratio}.
  304. So if you set the threshold to -12dB and your signal reaches -6dB a ratio
  305. of 2:1 will result in a signal at -9dB. Because an exact manipulation of
  306. the signal would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be
  307. levelled over the time. This is done by setting "Attack" and "Release".
  308. @code{attack} determines how long the signal has to rise above the threshold
  309. before any reduction will occur and @code{release} sets the time the signal
  310. has to fall below the threshold to reduce the reduction again. Shorter signals
  311. than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
  312. The overall reduction of the signal can be made up afterwards with the
  313. @code{makeup} setting. So compressing the peaks of a signal about 6dB and
  314. raising the makeup to this level results in a signal twice as loud than the
  315. source. To gain a softer entry in the compression the @code{knee} flattens the
  316. hard edge at the threshold in the range of the chosen decibels.
  317. The filter accepts the following options:
  318. @table @option
  319. @item level_in
  320. Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  321. @item mode
  322. Set mode of compressor operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  323. Default is @code{downward}.
  324. @item threshold
  325. If a signal of stream rises above this level it will affect the gain
  326. reduction.
  327. By default it is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
  328. @item ratio
  329. Set a ratio by which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
  330. rose 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
  331. Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
  332. @item attack
  333. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  334. reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
  335. @item release
  336. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
  337. reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
  338. @item makeup
  339. Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
  340. Default is 1. Range is from 1 to 64.
  341. @item knee
  342. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  343. Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
  344. @item link
  345. Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of input stream
  346. or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of input stream affects the
  347. reduction. Default is @code{average}.
  348. @item detection
  349. Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
  350. of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mostly smoother.
  351. @item mix
  352. How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
  353. Range is between 0 and 1.
  354. @end table
  355. @subsection Commands
  356. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  357. @section acontrast
  358. Simple audio dynamic range compression/expansion filter.
  359. The filter accepts the following options:
  360. @table @option
  361. @item contrast
  362. Set contrast. Default is 33. Allowed range is between 0 and 100.
  363. @end table
  364. @section acopy
  365. Copy the input audio source unchanged to the output. This is mainly useful for
  366. testing purposes.
  367. @section acrossfade
  368. Apply cross fade from one input audio stream to another input audio stream.
  369. The cross fade is applied for specified duration near the end of first stream.
  370. The filter accepts the following options:
  371. @table @option
  372. @item nb_samples, ns
  373. Specify the number of samples for which the cross fade effect has to last.
  374. At the end of the cross fade effect the first input audio will be completely
  375. silent. Default is 44100.
  376. @item duration, d
  377. Specify the duration of the cross fade effect. See
  378. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  379. for the accepted syntax.
  380. By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
  381. If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
  382. @item overlap, o
  383. Should first stream end overlap with second stream start. Default is enabled.
  384. @item curve1
  385. Set curve for cross fade transition for first stream.
  386. @item curve2
  387. Set curve for cross fade transition for second stream.
  388. For description of available curve types see @ref{afade} filter description.
  389. @end table
  390. @subsection Examples
  391. @itemize
  392. @item
  393. Cross fade from one input to another:
  394. @example
  395. ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
  396. @end example
  397. @item
  398. Cross fade from one input to another but without overlapping:
  399. @example
  400. ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:o=0:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
  401. @end example
  402. @end itemize
  403. @section acrossover
  404. Split audio stream into several bands.
  405. This filter splits audio stream into two or more frequency ranges.
  406. Summing all streams back will give flat output.
  407. The filter accepts the following options:
  408. @table @option
  409. @item split
  410. Set split frequencies. Those must be positive and increasing.
  411. @item order
  412. Set filter order, can be @var{2nd}, @var{4th} or @var{8th}.
  413. Default is @var{4th}.
  414. @end table
  415. @section acrusher
  416. Reduce audio bit resolution.
  417. This filter is bit crusher with enhanced functionality. A bit crusher
  418. is used to audibly reduce number of bits an audio signal is sampled
  419. with. This doesn't change the bit depth at all, it just produces the
  420. effect. Material reduced in bit depth sounds more harsh and "digital".
  421. This filter is able to even round to continuous values instead of discrete
  422. bit depths.
  423. Additionally it has a D/C offset which results in different crushing of
  424. the lower and the upper half of the signal.
  425. An Anti-Aliasing setting is able to produce "softer" crushing sounds.
  426. Another feature of this filter is the logarithmic mode.
  427. This setting switches from linear distances between bits to logarithmic ones.
  428. The result is a much more "natural" sounding crusher which doesn't gate low
  429. signals for example. The human ear has a logarithmic perception,
  430. so this kind of crushing is much more pleasant.
  431. Logarithmic crushing is also able to get anti-aliased.
  432. The filter accepts the following options:
  433. @table @option
  434. @item level_in
  435. Set level in.
  436. @item level_out
  437. Set level out.
  438. @item bits
  439. Set bit reduction.
  440. @item mix
  441. Set mixing amount.
  442. @item mode
  443. Can be linear: @code{lin} or logarithmic: @code{log}.
  444. @item dc
  445. Set DC.
  446. @item aa
  447. Set anti-aliasing.
  448. @item samples
  449. Set sample reduction.
  450. @item lfo
  451. Enable LFO. By default disabled.
  452. @item lforange
  453. Set LFO range.
  454. @item lforate
  455. Set LFO rate.
  456. @end table
  457. @section acue
  458. Delay audio filtering until a given wallclock timestamp. See the @ref{cue}
  459. filter.
  460. @section adeclick
  461. Remove impulsive noise from input audio.
  462. Samples detected as impulsive noise are replaced by interpolated samples using
  463. autoregressive modelling.
  464. @table @option
  465. @item w
  466. Set window size, in milliseconds. Allowed range is from @code{10} to
  467. @code{100}. Default value is @code{55} milliseconds.
  468. This sets size of window which will be processed at once.
  469. @item o
  470. Set window overlap, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  471. @code{50} to @code{95}. Default value is @code{75} percent.
  472. Setting this to a very high value increases impulsive noise removal but makes
  473. whole process much slower.
  474. @item a
  475. Set autoregression order, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  476. @code{0} to @code{25}. Default value is @code{2} percent. This option also
  477. controls quality of interpolated samples using neighbour good samples.
  478. @item t
  479. Set threshold value. Allowed range is from @code{1} to @code{100}.
  480. Default value is @code{2}.
  481. This controls the strength of impulsive noise which is going to be removed.
  482. The lower value, the more samples will be detected as impulsive noise.
  483. @item b
  484. Set burst fusion, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is @code{0} to
  485. @code{10}. Default value is @code{2}.
  486. If any two samples detected as noise are spaced less than this value then any
  487. sample between those two samples will be also detected as noise.
  488. @item m
  489. Set overlap method.
  490. It accepts the following values:
  491. @table @option
  492. @item a
  493. Select overlap-add method. Even not interpolated samples are slightly
  494. changed with this method.
  495. @item s
  496. Select overlap-save method. Not interpolated samples remain unchanged.
  497. @end table
  498. Default value is @code{a}.
  499. @end table
  500. @section adeclip
  501. Remove clipped samples from input audio.
  502. Samples detected as clipped are replaced by interpolated samples using
  503. autoregressive modelling.
  504. @table @option
  505. @item w
  506. Set window size, in milliseconds. Allowed range is from @code{10} to @code{100}.
  507. Default value is @code{55} milliseconds.
  508. This sets size of window which will be processed at once.
  509. @item o
  510. Set window overlap, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from @code{50}
  511. to @code{95}. Default value is @code{75} percent.
  512. @item a
  513. Set autoregression order, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  514. @code{0} to @code{25}. Default value is @code{8} percent. This option also controls
  515. quality of interpolated samples using neighbour good samples.
  516. @item t
  517. Set threshold value. Allowed range is from @code{1} to @code{100}.
  518. Default value is @code{10}. Higher values make clip detection less aggressive.
  519. @item n
  520. Set size of histogram used to detect clips. Allowed range is from @code{100} to @code{9999}.
  521. Default value is @code{1000}. Higher values make clip detection less aggressive.
  522. @item m
  523. Set overlap method.
  524. It accepts the following values:
  525. @table @option
  526. @item a
  527. Select overlap-add method. Even not interpolated samples are slightly changed
  528. with this method.
  529. @item s
  530. Select overlap-save method. Not interpolated samples remain unchanged.
  531. @end table
  532. Default value is @code{a}.
  533. @end table
  534. @section adelay
  535. Delay one or more audio channels.
  536. Samples in delayed channel are filled with silence.
  537. The filter accepts the following option:
  538. @table @option
  539. @item delays
  540. Set list of delays in milliseconds for each channel separated by '|'.
  541. Unused delays will be silently ignored. If number of given delays is
  542. smaller than number of channels all remaining channels will not be delayed.
  543. If you want to delay exact number of samples, append 'S' to number.
  544. If you want instead to delay in seconds, append 's' to number.
  545. @item all
  546. Use last set delay for all remaining channels. By default is disabled.
  547. This option if enabled changes how option @code{delays} is interpreted.
  548. @end table
  549. @subsection Examples
  550. @itemize
  551. @item
  552. Delay first channel by 1.5 seconds, the third channel by 0.5 seconds and leave
  553. the second channel (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.
  554. @example
  555. adelay=1500|0|500
  556. @end example
  557. @item
  558. Delay second channel by 500 samples, the third channel by 700 samples and leave
  559. the first channel (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.
  560. @example
  561. adelay=0|500S|700S
  562. @end example
  563. @item
  564. Delay all channels by same number of samples:
  565. @example
  566. adelay=delays=64S:all=1
  567. @end example
  568. @end itemize
  569. @section aderivative, aintegral
  570. Compute derivative/integral of audio stream.
  571. Applying both filters one after another produces original audio.
  572. @section aecho
  573. Apply echoing to the input audio.
  574. Echoes are reflected sound and can occur naturally amongst mountains
  575. (and sometimes large buildings) when talking or shouting; digital echo
  576. effects emulate this behaviour and are often used to help fill out the
  577. sound of a single instrument or vocal. The time difference between the
  578. original signal and the reflection is the @code{delay}, and the
  579. loudness of the reflected signal is the @code{decay}.
  580. Multiple echoes can have different delays and decays.
  581. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  582. @table @option
  583. @item in_gain
  584. Set input gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.6}.
  585. @item out_gain
  586. Set output gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.3}.
  587. @item delays
  588. Set list of time intervals in milliseconds between original signal and reflections
  589. separated by '|'. Allowed range for each @code{delay} is @code{(0 - 90000.0]}.
  590. Default is @code{1000}.
  591. @item decays
  592. Set list of loudness of reflected signals separated by '|'.
  593. Allowed range for each @code{decay} is @code{(0 - 1.0]}.
  594. Default is @code{0.5}.
  595. @end table
  596. @subsection Examples
  597. @itemize
  598. @item
  599. Make it sound as if there are twice as many instruments as are actually playing:
  600. @example
  601. aecho=0.8:0.88:60:0.4
  602. @end example
  603. @item
  604. If delay is very short, then it sounds like a (metallic) robot playing music:
  605. @example
  606. aecho=0.8:0.88:6:0.4
  607. @end example
  608. @item
  609. A longer delay will sound like an open air concert in the mountains:
  610. @example
  611. aecho=0.8:0.9:1000:0.3
  612. @end example
  613. @item
  614. Same as above but with one more mountain:
  615. @example
  616. aecho=0.8:0.9:1000|1800:0.3|0.25
  617. @end example
  618. @end itemize
  619. @section aemphasis
  620. Audio emphasis filter creates or restores material directly taken from LPs or
  621. emphased CDs with different filter curves. E.g. to store music on vinyl the
  622. signal has to be altered by a filter first to even out the disadvantages of
  623. this recording medium.
  624. Once the material is played back the inverse filter has to be applied to
  625. restore the distortion of the frequency response.
  626. The filter accepts the following options:
  627. @table @option
  628. @item level_in
  629. Set input gain.
  630. @item level_out
  631. Set output gain.
  632. @item mode
  633. Set filter mode. For restoring material use @code{reproduction} mode, otherwise
  634. use @code{production} mode. Default is @code{reproduction} mode.
  635. @item type
  636. Set filter type. Selects medium. Can be one of the following:
  637. @table @option
  638. @item col
  639. select Columbia.
  640. @item emi
  641. select EMI.
  642. @item bsi
  643. select BSI (78RPM).
  644. @item riaa
  645. select RIAA.
  646. @item cd
  647. select Compact Disc (CD).
  648. @item 50fm
  649. select 50µs (FM).
  650. @item 75fm
  651. select 75µs (FM).
  652. @item 50kf
  653. select 50µs (FM-KF).
  654. @item 75kf
  655. select 75µs (FM-KF).
  656. @end table
  657. @end table
  658. @section aeval
  659. Modify an audio signal according to the specified expressions.
  660. This filter accepts one or more expressions (one for each channel),
  661. which are evaluated and used to modify a corresponding audio signal.
  662. It accepts the following parameters:
  663. @table @option
  664. @item exprs
  665. Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. If
  666. the number of input channels is greater than the number of
  667. expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
  668. output channels.
  669. @item channel_layout, c
  670. Set output channel layout. If not specified, the channel layout is
  671. specified by the number of expressions. If set to @samp{same}, it will
  672. use by default the same input channel layout.
  673. @end table
  674. Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants and functions:
  675. @table @option
  676. @item ch
  677. channel number of the current expression
  678. @item n
  679. number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
  680. @item s
  681. sample rate
  682. @item t
  683. time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds
  684. @item nb_in_channels
  685. @item nb_out_channels
  686. input and output number of channels
  687. @item val(CH)
  688. the value of input channel with number @var{CH}
  689. @end table
  690. Note: this filter is slow. For faster processing you should use a
  691. dedicated filter.
  692. @subsection Examples
  693. @itemize
  694. @item
  695. Half volume:
  696. @example
  697. aeval=val(ch)/2:c=same
  698. @end example
  699. @item
  700. Invert phase of the second channel:
  701. @example
  702. aeval=val(0)|-val(1)
  703. @end example
  704. @end itemize
  705. @anchor{afade}
  706. @section afade
  707. Apply fade-in/out effect to input audio.
  708. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  709. @table @option
  710. @item type, t
  711. Specify the effect type, can be either @code{in} for fade-in, or
  712. @code{out} for a fade-out effect. Default is @code{in}.
  713. @item start_sample, ss
  714. Specify the number of the start sample for starting to apply the fade
  715. effect. Default is 0.
  716. @item nb_samples, ns
  717. Specify the number of samples for which the fade effect has to last. At
  718. the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
  719. volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
  720. the output audio will be silence. Default is 44100.
  721. @item start_time, st
  722. Specify the start time of the fade effect. Default is 0.
  723. The value must be specified as a time duration; see
  724. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  725. for the accepted syntax.
  726. If set this option is used instead of @var{start_sample}.
  727. @item duration, d
  728. Specify the duration of the fade effect. See
  729. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  730. for the accepted syntax.
  731. At the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
  732. volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
  733. the output audio will be silence.
  734. By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
  735. If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
  736. @item curve
  737. Set curve for fade transition.
  738. It accepts the following values:
  739. @table @option
  740. @item tri
  741. select triangular, linear slope (default)
  742. @item qsin
  743. select quarter of sine wave
  744. @item hsin
  745. select half of sine wave
  746. @item esin
  747. select exponential sine wave
  748. @item log
  749. select logarithmic
  750. @item ipar
  751. select inverted parabola
  752. @item qua
  753. select quadratic
  754. @item cub
  755. select cubic
  756. @item squ
  757. select square root
  758. @item cbr
  759. select cubic root
  760. @item par
  761. select parabola
  762. @item exp
  763. select exponential
  764. @item iqsin
  765. select inverted quarter of sine wave
  766. @item ihsin
  767. select inverted half of sine wave
  768. @item dese
  769. select double-exponential seat
  770. @item desi
  771. select double-exponential sigmoid
  772. @item losi
  773. select logistic sigmoid
  774. @item nofade
  775. no fade applied
  776. @end table
  777. @end table
  778. @subsection Examples
  779. @itemize
  780. @item
  781. Fade in first 15 seconds of audio:
  782. @example
  783. afade=t=in:ss=0:d=15
  784. @end example
  785. @item
  786. Fade out last 25 seconds of a 900 seconds audio:
  787. @example
  788. afade=t=out:st=875:d=25
  789. @end example
  790. @end itemize
  791. @section afftdn
  792. Denoise audio samples with FFT.
  793. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  794. @table @option
  795. @item nr
  796. Set the noise reduction in dB, allowed range is 0.01 to 97.
  797. Default value is 12 dB.
  798. @item nf
  799. Set the noise floor in dB, allowed range is -80 to -20.
  800. Default value is -50 dB.
  801. @item nt
  802. Set the noise type.
  803. It accepts the following values:
  804. @table @option
  805. @item w
  806. Select white noise.
  807. @item v
  808. Select vinyl noise.
  809. @item s
  810. Select shellac noise.
  811. @item c
  812. Select custom noise, defined in @code{bn} option.
  813. Default value is white noise.
  814. @end table
  815. @item bn
  816. Set custom band noise for every one of 15 bands.
  817. Bands are separated by ' ' or '|'.
  818. @item rf
  819. Set the residual floor in dB, allowed range is -80 to -20.
  820. Default value is -38 dB.
  821. @item tn
  822. Enable noise tracking. By default is disabled.
  823. With this enabled, noise floor is automatically adjusted.
  824. @item tr
  825. Enable residual tracking. By default is disabled.
  826. @item om
  827. Set the output mode.
  828. It accepts the following values:
  829. @table @option
  830. @item i
  831. Pass input unchanged.
  832. @item o
  833. Pass noise filtered out.
  834. @item n
  835. Pass only noise.
  836. Default value is @var{o}.
  837. @end table
  838. @end table
  839. @subsection Commands
  840. This filter supports the following commands:
  841. @table @option
  842. @item sample_noise, sn
  843. Start or stop measuring noise profile.
  844. Syntax for the command is : "start" or "stop" string.
  845. After measuring noise profile is stopped it will be
  846. automatically applied in filtering.
  847. @item noise_reduction, nr
  848. Change noise reduction. Argument is single float number.
  849. Syntax for the command is : "@var{noise_reduction}"
  850. @item noise_floor, nf
  851. Change noise floor. Argument is single float number.
  852. Syntax for the command is : "@var{noise_floor}"
  853. @item output_mode, om
  854. Change output mode operation.
  855. Syntax for the command is : "i", "o" or "n" string.
  856. @end table
  857. @section afftfilt
  858. Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain.
  859. @table @option
  860. @item real
  861. Set frequency domain real expression for each separate channel separated
  862. by '|'. Default is "re".
  863. If the number of input channels is greater than the number of
  864. expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
  865. output channels.
  866. @item imag
  867. Set frequency domain imaginary expression for each separate channel
  868. separated by '|'. Default is "im".
  869. Each expression in @var{real} and @var{imag} can contain the following
  870. constants and functions:
  871. @table @option
  872. @item sr
  873. sample rate
  874. @item b
  875. current frequency bin number
  876. @item nb
  877. number of available bins
  878. @item ch
  879. channel number of the current expression
  880. @item chs
  881. number of channels
  882. @item pts
  883. current frame pts
  884. @item re
  885. current real part of frequency bin of current channel
  886. @item im
  887. current imaginary part of frequency bin of current channel
  888. @item real(b, ch)
  889. Return the value of real part of frequency bin at location (@var{bin},@var{channel})
  890. @item imag(b, ch)
  891. Return the value of imaginary part of frequency bin at location (@var{bin},@var{channel})
  892. @end table
  893. @item win_size
  894. Set window size. Allowed range is from 16 to 131072.
  895. Default is @code{4096}
  896. @item win_func
  897. Set window function. Default is @code{hann}.
  898. @item overlap
  899. Set window overlap. If set to 1, the recommended overlap for selected
  900. window function will be picked. Default is @code{0.75}.
  901. @end table
  902. @subsection Examples
  903. @itemize
  904. @item
  905. Leave almost only low frequencies in audio:
  906. @example
  907. afftfilt="'real=re * (1-clip((b/nb)*b,0,1))':imag='im * (1-clip((b/nb)*b,0,1))'"
  908. @end example
  909. @item
  910. Apply robotize effect:
  911. @example
  912. afftfilt="real='hypot(re,im)*sin(0)':imag='hypot(re,im)*cos(0)':win_size=512:overlap=0.75"
  913. @end example
  914. @item
  915. Apply whisper effect:
  916. @example
  917. afftfilt="real='hypot(re,im)*cos((random(0)*2-1)*2*3.14)':imag='hypot(re,im)*sin((random(1)*2-1)*2*3.14)':win_size=128:overlap=0.8"
  918. @end example
  919. @end itemize
  920. @anchor{afir}
  921. @section afir
  922. Apply an arbitrary Finite Impulse Response filter.
  923. This filter is designed for applying long FIR filters,
  924. up to 60 seconds long.
  925. It can be used as component for digital crossover filters,
  926. room equalization, cross talk cancellation, wavefield synthesis,
  927. auralization, ambiophonics, ambisonics and spatialization.
  928. This filter uses the streams higher than first one as FIR coefficients.
  929. If the non-first stream holds a single channel, it will be used
  930. for all input channels in the first stream, otherwise
  931. the number of channels in the non-first stream must be same as
  932. the number of channels in the first stream.
  933. It accepts the following parameters:
  934. @table @option
  935. @item dry
  936. Set dry gain. This sets input gain.
  937. @item wet
  938. Set wet gain. This sets final output gain.
  939. @item length
  940. Set Impulse Response filter length. Default is 1, which means whole IR is processed.
  941. @item gtype
  942. Enable applying gain measured from power of IR.
  943. Set which approach to use for auto gain measurement.
  944. @table @option
  945. @item none
  946. Do not apply any gain.
  947. @item peak
  948. select peak gain, very conservative approach. This is default value.
  949. @item dc
  950. select DC gain, limited application.
  951. @item gn
  952. select gain to noise approach, this is most popular one.
  953. @end table
  954. @item irgain
  955. Set gain to be applied to IR coefficients before filtering.
  956. Allowed range is 0 to 1. This gain is applied after any gain applied with @var{gtype} option.
  957. @item irfmt
  958. Set format of IR stream. Can be @code{mono} or @code{input}.
  959. Default is @code{input}.
  960. @item maxir
  961. Set max allowed Impulse Response filter duration in seconds. Default is 30 seconds.
  962. Allowed range is 0.1 to 60 seconds.
  963. @item response
  964. Show IR frequency response, magnitude(magenta), phase(green) and group delay(yellow) in additional video stream.
  965. By default it is disabled.
  966. @item channel
  967. Set for which IR channel to display frequency response. By default is first channel
  968. displayed. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  969. @item size
  970. Set video stream size. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  971. @item rate
  972. Set video stream frame rate. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  973. @item minp
  974. Set minimal partition size used for convolution. Default is @var{8192}.
  975. Allowed range is from @var{1} to @var{32768}.
  976. Lower values decreases latency at cost of higher CPU usage.
  977. @item maxp
  978. Set maximal partition size used for convolution. Default is @var{8192}.
  979. Allowed range is from @var{8} to @var{32768}.
  980. Lower values may increase CPU usage.
  981. @item nbirs
  982. Set number of input impulse responses streams which will be switchable at runtime.
  983. Allowed range is from @var{1} to @var{32}. Default is @var{1}.
  984. @item ir
  985. Set IR stream which will be used for convolution, starting from @var{0}, should always be
  986. lower than supplied value by @code{nbirs} option. Default is @var{0}.
  987. This option can be changed at runtime via @ref{commands}.
  988. @end table
  989. @subsection Examples
  990. @itemize
  991. @item
  992. Apply reverb to stream using mono IR file as second input, complete command using ffmpeg:
  993. @example
  994. ffmpeg -i input.wav -i middle_tunnel_1way_mono.wav -lavfi afir output.wav
  995. @end example
  996. @end itemize
  997. @anchor{aformat}
  998. @section aformat
  999. Set output format constraints for the input audio. The framework will
  1000. negotiate the most appropriate format to minimize conversions.
  1001. It accepts the following parameters:
  1002. @table @option
  1003. @item sample_fmts, f
  1004. A '|'-separated list of requested sample formats.
  1005. @item sample_rates, r
  1006. A '|'-separated list of requested sample rates.
  1007. @item channel_layouts, cl
  1008. A '|'-separated list of requested channel layouts.
  1009. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1010. for the required syntax.
  1011. @end table
  1012. If a parameter is omitted, all values are allowed.
  1013. Force the output to either unsigned 8-bit or signed 16-bit stereo
  1014. @example
  1015. aformat=sample_fmts=u8|s16:channel_layouts=stereo
  1016. @end example
  1017. @section agate
  1018. A gate is mainly used to reduce lower parts of a signal. This kind of signal
  1019. processing reduces disturbing noise between useful signals.
  1020. Gating is done by detecting the volume below a chosen level @var{threshold}
  1021. and dividing it by the factor set with @var{ratio}. The bottom of the noise
  1022. floor is set via @var{range}. Because an exact manipulation of the signal
  1023. would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be levelled over
  1024. time. This is done by setting @var{attack} and @var{release}.
  1025. @var{attack} determines how long the signal has to fall below the threshold
  1026. before any reduction will occur and @var{release} sets the time the signal
  1027. has to rise above the threshold to reduce the reduction again.
  1028. Shorter signals than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
  1029. @table @option
  1030. @item level_in
  1031. Set input level before filtering.
  1032. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  1033. @item mode
  1034. Set the mode of operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  1035. Default is @code{downward}. If set to @code{upward} mode, higher parts of signal
  1036. will be amplified, expanding dynamic range in upward direction.
  1037. Otherwise, in case of @code{downward} lower parts of signal will be reduced.
  1038. @item range
  1039. Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
  1040. Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1041. Setting this to 0 disables reduction and then filter behaves like expander.
  1042. @item threshold
  1043. If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
  1044. Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1045. @item ratio
  1046. Set a ratio by which the signal is reduced.
  1047. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
  1048. @item attack
  1049. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  1050. reduction stops.
  1051. Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  1052. @item release
  1053. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
  1054. reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
  1055. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  1056. @item makeup
  1057. Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
  1058. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  1059. @item knee
  1060. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  1061. Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
  1062. @item detection
  1063. Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
  1064. Default is @code{rms}. Can be @code{peak} or @code{rms}.
  1065. @item link
  1066. Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
  1067. the reduction.
  1068. Default is @code{average}. Can be @code{average} or @code{maximum}.
  1069. @end table
  1070. @section aiir
  1071. Apply an arbitrary Infinite Impulse Response filter.
  1072. It accepts the following parameters:
  1073. @table @option
  1074. @item zeros, z
  1075. Set numerator/zeros coefficients.
  1076. @item poles, p
  1077. Set denominator/poles coefficients.
  1078. @item gains, k
  1079. Set channels gains.
  1080. @item dry_gain
  1081. Set input gain.
  1082. @item wet_gain
  1083. Set output gain.
  1084. @item format, f
  1085. Set coefficients format.
  1086. @table @samp
  1087. @item tf
  1088. digital transfer function
  1089. @item zp
  1090. Z-plane zeros/poles, cartesian (default)
  1091. @item pr
  1092. Z-plane zeros/poles, polar radians
  1093. @item pd
  1094. Z-plane zeros/poles, polar degrees
  1095. @item sp
  1096. S-plane zeros/poles
  1097. @end table
  1098. @item process, r
  1099. Set kind of processing.
  1100. Can be @code{d} - direct or @code{s} - serial cascading. Default is @code{s}.
  1101. @item precision, e
  1102. Set filtering precision.
  1103. @table @samp
  1104. @item dbl
  1105. double-precision floating-point (default)
  1106. @item flt
  1107. single-precision floating-point
  1108. @item i32
  1109. 32-bit integers
  1110. @item i16
  1111. 16-bit integers
  1112. @end table
  1113. @item normalize, n
  1114. Normalize filter coefficients, by default is enabled.
  1115. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  1116. @item mix
  1117. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  1118. Range is between 0 and 1.
  1119. @item response
  1120. Show IR frequency response, magnitude(magenta), phase(green) and group delay(yellow) in additional video stream.
  1121. By default it is disabled.
  1122. @item channel
  1123. Set for which IR channel to display frequency response. By default is first channel
  1124. displayed. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  1125. @item size
  1126. Set video stream size. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  1127. @end table
  1128. Coefficients in @code{tf} format are separated by spaces and are in ascending
  1129. order.
  1130. Coefficients in @code{zp} format are separated by spaces and order of coefficients
  1131. doesn't matter. Coefficients in @code{zp} format are complex numbers with @var{i}
  1132. imaginary unit.
  1133. Different coefficients and gains can be provided for every channel, in such case
  1134. use '|' to separate coefficients or gains. Last provided coefficients will be
  1135. used for all remaining channels.
  1136. @subsection Examples
  1137. @itemize
  1138. @item
  1139. Apply 2 pole elliptic notch at around 5000Hz for 48000 Hz sample rate:
  1140. @example
  1141. aiir=k=1:z=7.957584807809675810E-1 -2.575128568908332300 3.674839853930788710 -2.57512875289799137 7.957586296317130880E-1:p=1 -2.86950072432325953 3.63022088054647218 -2.28075678147272232 6.361362326477423500E-1:f=tf:r=d
  1142. @end example
  1143. @item
  1144. Same as above but in @code{zp} format:
  1145. @example
  1146. aiir=k=0.79575848078096756:z=0.80918701+0.58773007i 0.80918701-0.58773007i 0.80884700+0.58784055i 0.80884700-0.58784055i:p=0.63892345+0.59951235i 0.63892345-0.59951235i 0.79582691+0.44198673i 0.79582691-0.44198673i:f=zp:r=s
  1147. @end example
  1148. @end itemize
  1149. @section alimiter
  1150. The limiter prevents an input signal from rising over a desired threshold.
  1151. This limiter uses lookahead technology to prevent your signal from distorting.
  1152. It means that there is a small delay after the signal is processed. Keep in mind
  1153. that the delay it produces is the attack time you set.
  1154. The filter accepts the following options:
  1155. @table @option
  1156. @item level_in
  1157. Set input gain. Default is 1.
  1158. @item level_out
  1159. Set output gain. Default is 1.
  1160. @item limit
  1161. Don't let signals above this level pass the limiter. Default is 1.
  1162. @item attack
  1163. The limiter will reach its attenuation level in this amount of time in
  1164. milliseconds. Default is 5 milliseconds.
  1165. @item release
  1166. Come back from limiting to attenuation 1.0 in this amount of milliseconds.
  1167. Default is 50 milliseconds.
  1168. @item asc
  1169. When gain reduction is always needed ASC takes care of releasing to an
  1170. average reduction level rather than reaching a reduction of 0 in the release
  1171. time.
  1172. @item asc_level
  1173. Select how much the release time is affected by ASC, 0 means nearly no changes
  1174. in release time while 1 produces higher release times.
  1175. @item level
  1176. Auto level output signal. Default is enabled.
  1177. This normalizes audio back to 0dB if enabled.
  1178. @end table
  1179. Depending on picked setting it is recommended to upsample input 2x or 4x times
  1180. with @ref{aresample} before applying this filter.
  1181. @section allpass
  1182. Apply a two-pole all-pass filter with central frequency (in Hz)
  1183. @var{frequency}, and filter-width @var{width}.
  1184. An all-pass filter changes the audio's frequency to phase relationship
  1185. without changing its frequency to amplitude relationship.
  1186. The filter accepts the following options:
  1187. @table @option
  1188. @item frequency, f
  1189. Set frequency in Hz.
  1190. @item width_type, t
  1191. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1192. @table @option
  1193. @item h
  1194. Hz
  1195. @item q
  1196. Q-Factor
  1197. @item o
  1198. octave
  1199. @item s
  1200. slope
  1201. @item k
  1202. kHz
  1203. @end table
  1204. @item width, w
  1205. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1206. @item mix, m
  1207. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  1208. Range is between 0 and 1.
  1209. @item channels, c
  1210. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  1211. @item normalize, n
  1212. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  1213. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  1214. @item order, o
  1215. Set the filter order, can be 1 or 2. Default is 2.
  1216. @end table
  1217. @subsection Commands
  1218. This filter supports the following commands:
  1219. @table @option
  1220. @item frequency, f
  1221. Change allpass frequency.
  1222. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  1223. @item width_type, t
  1224. Change allpass width_type.
  1225. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  1226. @item width, w
  1227. Change allpass width.
  1228. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  1229. @item mix, m
  1230. Change allpass mix.
  1231. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  1232. @end table
  1233. @section aloop
  1234. Loop audio samples.
  1235. The filter accepts the following options:
  1236. @table @option
  1237. @item loop
  1238. Set the number of loops. Setting this value to -1 will result in infinite loops.
  1239. Default is 0.
  1240. @item size
  1241. Set maximal number of samples. Default is 0.
  1242. @item start
  1243. Set first sample of loop. Default is 0.
  1244. @end table
  1245. @anchor{amerge}
  1246. @section amerge
  1247. Merge two or more audio streams into a single multi-channel stream.
  1248. The filter accepts the following options:
  1249. @table @option
  1250. @item inputs
  1251. Set the number of inputs. Default is 2.
  1252. @end table
  1253. If the channel layouts of the inputs are disjoint, and therefore compatible,
  1254. the channel layout of the output will be set accordingly and the channels
  1255. will be reordered as necessary. If the channel layouts of the inputs are not
  1256. disjoint, the output will have all the channels of the first input then all
  1257. the channels of the second input, in that order, and the channel layout of
  1258. the output will be the default value corresponding to the total number of
  1259. channels.
  1260. For example, if the first input is in 2.1 (FL+FR+LF) and the second input
  1261. is FC+BL+BR, then the output will be in 5.1, with the channels in the
  1262. following order: a1, a2, b1, a3, b2, b3 (a1 is the first channel of the
  1263. first input, b1 is the first channel of the second input).
  1264. On the other hand, if both input are in stereo, the output channels will be
  1265. in the default order: a1, a2, b1, b2, and the channel layout will be
  1266. arbitrarily set to 4.0, which may or may not be the expected value.
  1267. All inputs must have the same sample rate, and format.
  1268. If inputs do not have the same duration, the output will stop with the
  1269. shortest.
  1270. @subsection Examples
  1271. @itemize
  1272. @item
  1273. Merge two mono files into a stereo stream:
  1274. @example
  1275. amovie=left.wav [l] ; amovie=right.mp3 [r] ; [l] [r] amerge
  1276. @end example
  1277. @item
  1278. Multiple merges assuming 1 video stream and 6 audio streams in @file{input.mkv}:
  1279. @example
  1280. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -filter_complex "[0:1][0:2][0:3][0:4][0:5][0:6] amerge=inputs=6" -c:a pcm_s16le output.mkv
  1281. @end example
  1282. @end itemize
  1283. @section amix
  1284. Mixes multiple audio inputs into a single output.
  1285. Note that this filter only supports float samples (the @var{amerge}
  1286. and @var{pan} audio filters support many formats). If the @var{amix}
  1287. input has integer samples then @ref{aresample} will be automatically
  1288. inserted to perform the conversion to float samples.
  1289. For example
  1290. @example
  1291. ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex amix=inputs=3:duration=first:dropout_transition=3 OUTPUT
  1292. @end example
  1293. will mix 3 input audio streams to a single output with the same duration as the
  1294. first input and a dropout transition time of 3 seconds.
  1295. It accepts the following parameters:
  1296. @table @option
  1297. @item inputs
  1298. The number of inputs. If unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  1299. @item duration
  1300. How to determine the end-of-stream.
  1301. @table @option
  1302. @item longest
  1303. The duration of the longest input. (default)
  1304. @item shortest
  1305. The duration of the shortest input.
  1306. @item first
  1307. The duration of the first input.
  1308. @end table
  1309. @item dropout_transition
  1310. The transition time, in seconds, for volume renormalization when an input
  1311. stream ends. The default value is 2 seconds.
  1312. @item weights
  1313. Specify weight of each input audio stream as sequence.
  1314. Each weight is separated by space. By default all inputs have same weight.
  1315. @end table
  1316. @subsection Commands
  1317. This filter supports the following commands:
  1318. @table @option
  1319. @item weights
  1320. Syntax is same as option with same name.
  1321. @end table
  1322. @section amultiply
  1323. Multiply first audio stream with second audio stream and store result
  1324. in output audio stream. Multiplication is done by multiplying each
  1325. sample from first stream with sample at same position from second stream.
  1326. With this element-wise multiplication one can create amplitude fades and
  1327. amplitude modulations.
  1328. @section anequalizer
  1329. High-order parametric multiband equalizer for each channel.
  1330. It accepts the following parameters:
  1331. @table @option
  1332. @item params
  1333. This option string is in format:
  1334. "c@var{chn} f=@var{cf} w=@var{w} g=@var{g} t=@var{f} | ..."
  1335. Each equalizer band is separated by '|'.
  1336. @table @option
  1337. @item chn
  1338. Set channel number to which equalization will be applied.
  1339. If input doesn't have that channel the entry is ignored.
  1340. @item f
  1341. Set central frequency for band.
  1342. If input doesn't have that frequency the entry is ignored.
  1343. @item w
  1344. Set band width in hertz.
  1345. @item g
  1346. Set band gain in dB.
  1347. @item t
  1348. Set filter type for band, optional, can be:
  1349. @table @samp
  1350. @item 0
  1351. Butterworth, this is default.
  1352. @item 1
  1353. Chebyshev type 1.
  1354. @item 2
  1355. Chebyshev type 2.
  1356. @end table
  1357. @end table
  1358. @item curves
  1359. With this option activated frequency response of anequalizer is displayed
  1360. in video stream.
  1361. @item size
  1362. Set video stream size. Only useful if curves option is activated.
  1363. @item mgain
  1364. Set max gain that will be displayed. Only useful if curves option is activated.
  1365. Setting this to a reasonable value makes it possible to display gain which is derived from
  1366. neighbour bands which are too close to each other and thus produce higher gain
  1367. when both are activated.
  1368. @item fscale
  1369. Set frequency scale used to draw frequency response in video output.
  1370. Can be linear or logarithmic. Default is logarithmic.
  1371. @item colors
  1372. Set color for each channel curve which is going to be displayed in video stream.
  1373. This is list of color names separated by space or by '|'.
  1374. Unrecognised or missing colors will be replaced by white color.
  1375. @end table
  1376. @subsection Examples
  1377. @itemize
  1378. @item
  1379. Lower gain by 10 of central frequency 200Hz and width 100 Hz
  1380. for first 2 channels using Chebyshev type 1 filter:
  1381. @example
  1382. anequalizer=c0 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1|c1 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1
  1383. @end example
  1384. @end itemize
  1385. @subsection Commands
  1386. This filter supports the following commands:
  1387. @table @option
  1388. @item change
  1389. Alter existing filter parameters.
  1390. Syntax for the commands is : "@var{fN}|f=@var{freq}|w=@var{width}|g=@var{gain}"
  1391. @var{fN} is existing filter number, starting from 0, if no such filter is available
  1392. error is returned.
  1393. @var{freq} set new frequency parameter.
  1394. @var{width} set new width parameter in herz.
  1395. @var{gain} set new gain parameter in dB.
  1396. Full filter invocation with asendcmd may look like this:
  1397. asendcmd=c='4.0 anequalizer change 0|f=200|w=50|g=1',anequalizer=...
  1398. @end table
  1399. @section anlmdn
  1400. Reduce broadband noise in audio samples using Non-Local Means algorithm.
  1401. Each sample is adjusted by looking for other samples with similar contexts. This
  1402. context similarity is defined by comparing their surrounding patches of size
  1403. @option{p}. Patches are searched in an area of @option{r} around the sample.
  1404. The filter accepts the following options:
  1405. @table @option
  1406. @item s
  1407. Set denoising strength. Allowed range is from 0.00001 to 10. Default value is 0.00001.
  1408. @item p
  1409. Set patch radius duration. Allowed range is from 1 to 100 milliseconds.
  1410. Default value is 2 milliseconds.
  1411. @item r
  1412. Set research radius duration. Allowed range is from 2 to 300 milliseconds.
  1413. Default value is 6 milliseconds.
  1414. @item o
  1415. Set the output mode.
  1416. It accepts the following values:
  1417. @table @option
  1418. @item i
  1419. Pass input unchanged.
  1420. @item o
  1421. Pass noise filtered out.
  1422. @item n
  1423. Pass only noise.
  1424. Default value is @var{o}.
  1425. @end table
  1426. @item m
  1427. Set smooth factor. Default value is @var{11}. Allowed range is from @var{1} to @var{15}.
  1428. @end table
  1429. @subsection Commands
  1430. This filter supports the following commands:
  1431. @table @option
  1432. @item s
  1433. Change denoise strength. Argument is single float number.
  1434. Syntax for the command is : "@var{s}"
  1435. @item o
  1436. Change output mode.
  1437. Syntax for the command is : "i", "o" or "n" string.
  1438. @end table
  1439. @section anlms
  1440. Apply Normalized Least-Mean-Squares algorithm to the first audio stream using the second audio stream.
  1441. This adaptive filter is used to mimic a desired filter by finding the filter coefficients that
  1442. relate to producing the least mean square of the error signal (difference between the desired,
  1443. 2nd input audio stream and the actual signal, the 1st input audio stream).
  1444. A description of the accepted options follows.
  1445. @table @option
  1446. @item order
  1447. Set filter order.
  1448. @item mu
  1449. Set filter mu.
  1450. @item eps
  1451. Set the filter eps.
  1452. @item leakage
  1453. Set the filter leakage.
  1454. @item out_mode
  1455. It accepts the following values:
  1456. @table @option
  1457. @item i
  1458. Pass the 1st input.
  1459. @item d
  1460. Pass the 2nd input.
  1461. @item o
  1462. Pass filtered samples.
  1463. @item n
  1464. Pass difference between desired and filtered samples.
  1465. Default value is @var{o}.
  1466. @end table
  1467. @end table
  1468. @subsection Examples
  1469. @itemize
  1470. @item
  1471. One of many usages of this filter is noise reduction, input audio is filtered
  1472. with same samples that are delayed by fixed amount, one such example for stereo audio is:
  1473. @example
  1474. asplit[a][b],[a]adelay=32S|32S[a],[b][a]anlms=order=128:leakage=0.0005:mu=.5:out_mode=o
  1475. @end example
  1476. @end itemize
  1477. @subsection Commands
  1478. This filter supports the same commands as options, excluding option @code{order}.
  1479. @section anull
  1480. Pass the audio source unchanged to the output.
  1481. @section apad
  1482. Pad the end of an audio stream with silence.
  1483. This can be used together with @command{ffmpeg} @option{-shortest} to
  1484. extend audio streams to the same length as the video stream.
  1485. A description of the accepted options follows.
  1486. @table @option
  1487. @item packet_size
  1488. Set silence packet size. Default value is 4096.
  1489. @item pad_len
  1490. Set the number of samples of silence to add to the end. After the
  1491. value is reached, the stream is terminated. This option is mutually
  1492. exclusive with @option{whole_len}.
  1493. @item whole_len
  1494. Set the minimum total number of samples in the output audio stream. If
  1495. the value is longer than the input audio length, silence is added to
  1496. the end, until the value is reached. This option is mutually exclusive
  1497. with @option{pad_len}.
  1498. @item pad_dur
  1499. Specify the duration of samples of silence to add. See
  1500. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1501. for the accepted syntax. Used only if set to non-zero value.
  1502. @item whole_dur
  1503. Specify the minimum total duration in the output audio stream. See
  1504. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1505. for the accepted syntax. Used only if set to non-zero value. If the value is longer than
  1506. the input audio length, silence is added to the end, until the value is reached.
  1507. This option is mutually exclusive with @option{pad_dur}
  1508. @end table
  1509. If neither the @option{pad_len} nor the @option{whole_len} nor @option{pad_dur}
  1510. nor @option{whole_dur} option is set, the filter will add silence to the end of
  1511. the input stream indefinitely.
  1512. @subsection Examples
  1513. @itemize
  1514. @item
  1515. Add 1024 samples of silence to the end of the input:
  1516. @example
  1517. apad=pad_len=1024
  1518. @end example
  1519. @item
  1520. Make sure the audio output will contain at least 10000 samples, pad
  1521. the input with silence if required:
  1522. @example
  1523. apad=whole_len=10000
  1524. @end example
  1525. @item
  1526. Use @command{ffmpeg} to pad the audio input with silence, so that the
  1527. video stream will always result the shortest and will be converted
  1528. until the end in the output file when using the @option{shortest}
  1529. option:
  1530. @example
  1531. ffmpeg -i VIDEO -i AUDIO -filter_complex "[1:0]apad" -shortest OUTPUT
  1532. @end example
  1533. @end itemize
  1534. @section aphaser
  1535. Add a phasing effect to the input audio.
  1536. A phaser filter creates series of peaks and troughs in the frequency spectrum.
  1537. The position of the peaks and troughs are modulated so that they vary over time, creating a sweeping effect.
  1538. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  1539. @table @option
  1540. @item in_gain
  1541. Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
  1542. @item out_gain
  1543. Set output gain. Default is 0.74
  1544. @item delay
  1545. Set delay in milliseconds. Default is 3.0.
  1546. @item decay
  1547. Set decay. Default is 0.4.
  1548. @item speed
  1549. Set modulation speed in Hz. Default is 0.5.
  1550. @item type
  1551. Set modulation type. Default is triangular.
  1552. It accepts the following values:
  1553. @table @samp
  1554. @item triangular, t
  1555. @item sinusoidal, s
  1556. @end table
  1557. @end table
  1558. @section apulsator
  1559. Audio pulsator is something between an autopanner and a tremolo.
  1560. But it can produce funny stereo effects as well. Pulsator changes the volume
  1561. of the left and right channel based on a LFO (low frequency oscillator) with
  1562. different waveforms and shifted phases.
  1563. This filter have the ability to define an offset between left and right
  1564. channel. An offset of 0 means that both LFO shapes match each other.
  1565. The left and right channel are altered equally - a conventional tremolo.
  1566. An offset of 50% means that the shape of the right channel is exactly shifted
  1567. in phase (or moved backwards about half of the frequency) - pulsator acts as
  1568. an autopanner. At 1 both curves match again. Every setting in between moves the
  1569. phase shift gapless between all stages and produces some "bypassing" sounds with
  1570. sine and triangle waveforms. The more you set the offset near 1 (starting from
  1571. the 0.5) the faster the signal passes from the left to the right speaker.
  1572. The filter accepts the following options:
  1573. @table @option
  1574. @item level_in
  1575. Set input gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
  1576. @item level_out
  1577. Set output gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
  1578. @item mode
  1579. Set waveform shape the LFO will use. Can be one of: sine, triangle, square,
  1580. sawup or sawdown. Default is sine.
  1581. @item amount
  1582. Set modulation. Define how much of original signal is affected by the LFO.
  1583. @item offset_l
  1584. Set left channel offset. Default is 0. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
  1585. @item offset_r
  1586. Set right channel offset. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
  1587. @item width
  1588. Set pulse width. Default is 1. Allowed range is [0 - 2].
  1589. @item timing
  1590. Set possible timing mode. Can be one of: bpm, ms or hz. Default is hz.
  1591. @item bpm
  1592. Set bpm. Default is 120. Allowed range is [30 - 300]. Only used if timing
  1593. is set to bpm.
  1594. @item ms
  1595. Set ms. Default is 500. Allowed range is [10 - 2000]. Only used if timing
  1596. is set to ms.
  1597. @item hz
  1598. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 2. Allowed range is [0.01 - 100]. Only used
  1599. if timing is set to hz.
  1600. @end table
  1601. @anchor{aresample}
  1602. @section aresample
  1603. Resample the input audio to the specified parameters, using the
  1604. libswresample library. If none are specified then the filter will
  1605. automatically convert between its input and output.
  1606. This filter is also able to stretch/squeeze the audio data to make it match
  1607. the timestamps or to inject silence / cut out audio to make it match the
  1608. timestamps, do a combination of both or do neither.
  1609. The filter accepts the syntax
  1610. [@var{sample_rate}:]@var{resampler_options}, where @var{sample_rate}
  1611. expresses a sample rate and @var{resampler_options} is a list of
  1612. @var{key}=@var{value} pairs, separated by ":". See the
  1613. @ref{Resampler Options,,"Resampler Options" section in the
  1614. ffmpeg-resampler(1) manual,ffmpeg-resampler}
  1615. for the complete list of supported options.
  1616. @subsection Examples
  1617. @itemize
  1618. @item
  1619. Resample the input audio to 44100Hz:
  1620. @example
  1621. aresample=44100
  1622. @end example
  1623. @item
  1624. Stretch/squeeze samples to the given timestamps, with a maximum of 1000
  1625. samples per second compensation:
  1626. @example
  1627. aresample=async=1000
  1628. @end example
  1629. @end itemize
  1630. @section areverse
  1631. Reverse an audio clip.
  1632. Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming
  1633. is suggested.
  1634. @subsection Examples
  1635. @itemize
  1636. @item
  1637. Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.
  1638. @example
  1639. atrim=end=5,areverse
  1640. @end example
  1641. @end itemize
  1642. @section arnndn
  1643. Reduce noise from speech using Recurrent Neural Networks.
  1644. This filter accepts the following options:
  1645. @table @option
  1646. @item model, m
  1647. Set train model file to load. This option is always required.
  1648. @end table
  1649. @section asetnsamples
  1650. Set the number of samples per each output audio frame.
  1651. The last output packet may contain a different number of samples, as
  1652. the filter will flush all the remaining samples when the input audio
  1653. signals its end.
  1654. The filter accepts the following options:
  1655. @table @option
  1656. @item nb_out_samples, n
  1657. Set the number of frames per each output audio frame. The number is
  1658. intended as the number of samples @emph{per each channel}.
  1659. Default value is 1024.
  1660. @item pad, p
  1661. If set to 1, the filter will pad the last audio frame with zeroes, so
  1662. that the last frame will contain the same number of samples as the
  1663. previous ones. Default value is 1.
  1664. @end table
  1665. For example, to set the number of per-frame samples to 1234 and
  1666. disable padding for the last frame, use:
  1667. @example
  1668. asetnsamples=n=1234:p=0
  1669. @end example
  1670. @section asetrate
  1671. Set the sample rate without altering the PCM data.
  1672. This will result in a change of speed and pitch.
  1673. The filter accepts the following options:
  1674. @table @option
  1675. @item sample_rate, r
  1676. Set the output sample rate. Default is 44100 Hz.
  1677. @end table
  1678. @section ashowinfo
  1679. Show a line containing various information for each input audio frame.
  1680. The input audio is not modified.
  1681. The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
  1682. @var{key}:@var{value}.
  1683. The following values are shown in the output:
  1684. @table @option
  1685. @item n
  1686. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  1687. @item pts
  1688. The presentation timestamp of the input frame, in time base units; the time base
  1689. depends on the filter input pad, and is usually 1/@var{sample_rate}.
  1690. @item pts_time
  1691. The presentation timestamp of the input frame in seconds.
  1692. @item pos
  1693. position of the frame in the input stream, -1 if this information in
  1694. unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic audio)
  1695. @item fmt
  1696. The sample format.
  1697. @item chlayout
  1698. The channel layout.
  1699. @item rate
  1700. The sample rate for the audio frame.
  1701. @item nb_samples
  1702. The number of samples (per channel) in the frame.
  1703. @item checksum
  1704. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of the audio data. For planar
  1705. audio, the data is treated as if all the planes were concatenated.
  1706. @item plane_checksums
  1707. A list of Adler-32 checksums for each data plane.
  1708. @end table
  1709. @section asoftclip
  1710. Apply audio soft clipping.
  1711. Soft clipping is a type of distortion effect where the amplitude of a signal is saturated
  1712. along a smooth curve, rather than the abrupt shape of hard-clipping.
  1713. This filter accepts the following options:
  1714. @table @option
  1715. @item type
  1716. Set type of soft-clipping.
  1717. It accepts the following values:
  1718. @table @option
  1719. @item tanh
  1720. @item atan
  1721. @item cubic
  1722. @item exp
  1723. @item alg
  1724. @item quintic
  1725. @item sin
  1726. @end table
  1727. @item param
  1728. Set additional parameter which controls sigmoid function.
  1729. @end table
  1730. @subsection Commands
  1731. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  1732. @section asr
  1733. Automatic Speech Recognition
  1734. This filter uses PocketSphinx for speech recognition. To enable
  1735. compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  1736. @code{--enable-pocketsphinx}.
  1737. It accepts the following options:
  1738. @table @option
  1739. @item rate
  1740. Set sampling rate of input audio. Defaults is @code{16000}.
  1741. This need to match speech models, otherwise one will get poor results.
  1742. @item hmm
  1743. Set dictionary containing acoustic model files.
  1744. @item dict
  1745. Set pronunciation dictionary.
  1746. @item lm
  1747. Set language model file.
  1748. @item lmctl
  1749. Set language model set.
  1750. @item lmname
  1751. Set which language model to use.
  1752. @item logfn
  1753. Set output for log messages.
  1754. @end table
  1755. The filter exports recognized speech as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.asr.text}.
  1756. @anchor{astats}
  1757. @section astats
  1758. Display time domain statistical information about the audio channels.
  1759. Statistics are calculated and displayed for each audio channel and,
  1760. where applicable, an overall figure is also given.
  1761. It accepts the following option:
  1762. @table @option
  1763. @item length
  1764. Short window length in seconds, used for peak and trough RMS measurement.
  1765. Default is @code{0.05} (50 milliseconds). Allowed range is @code{[0.01 - 10]}.
  1766. @item metadata
  1767. Set metadata injection. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.astats.X},
  1768. where @code{X} is channel number starting from 1 or string @code{Overall}. Default is
  1769. disabled.
  1770. Available keys for each channel are:
  1771. DC_offset
  1772. Min_level
  1773. Max_level
  1774. Min_difference
  1775. Max_difference
  1776. Mean_difference
  1777. RMS_difference
  1778. Peak_level
  1779. RMS_peak
  1780. RMS_trough
  1781. Crest_factor
  1782. Flat_factor
  1783. Peak_count
  1784. Noise_floor
  1785. Noise_floor_count
  1786. Bit_depth
  1787. Dynamic_range
  1788. Zero_crossings
  1789. Zero_crossings_rate
  1790. Number_of_NaNs
  1791. Number_of_Infs
  1792. Number_of_denormals
  1793. and for Overall:
  1794. DC_offset
  1795. Min_level
  1796. Max_level
  1797. Min_difference
  1798. Max_difference
  1799. Mean_difference
  1800. RMS_difference
  1801. Peak_level
  1802. RMS_level
  1803. RMS_peak
  1804. RMS_trough
  1805. Flat_factor
  1806. Peak_count
  1807. Noise_floor
  1808. Noise_floor_count
  1809. Bit_depth
  1810. Number_of_samples
  1811. Number_of_NaNs
  1812. Number_of_Infs
  1813. Number_of_denormals
  1814. For example full key look like this @code{lavfi.astats.1.DC_offset} or
  1815. this @code{lavfi.astats.Overall.Peak_count}.
  1816. For description what each key means read below.
  1817. @item reset
  1818. Set number of frame after which stats are going to be recalculated.
  1819. Default is disabled.
  1820. @item measure_perchannel
  1821. Select the entries which need to be measured per channel. The metadata keys can
  1822. be used as flags, default is @option{all} which measures everything.
  1823. @option{none} disables all per channel measurement.
  1824. @item measure_overall
  1825. Select the entries which need to be measured overall. The metadata keys can
  1826. be used as flags, default is @option{all} which measures everything.
  1827. @option{none} disables all overall measurement.
  1828. @end table
  1829. A description of each shown parameter follows:
  1830. @table @option
  1831. @item DC offset
  1832. Mean amplitude displacement from zero.
  1833. @item Min level
  1834. Minimal sample level.
  1835. @item Max level
  1836. Maximal sample level.
  1837. @item Min difference
  1838. Minimal difference between two consecutive samples.
  1839. @item Max difference
  1840. Maximal difference between two consecutive samples.
  1841. @item Mean difference
  1842. Mean difference between two consecutive samples.
  1843. The average of each difference between two consecutive samples.
  1844. @item RMS difference
  1845. Root Mean Square difference between two consecutive samples.
  1846. @item Peak level dB
  1847. @item RMS level dB
  1848. Standard peak and RMS level measured in dBFS.
  1849. @item RMS peak dB
  1850. @item RMS trough dB
  1851. Peak and trough values for RMS level measured over a short window.
  1852. @item Crest factor
  1853. Standard ratio of peak to RMS level (note: not in dB).
  1854. @item Flat factor
  1855. Flatness (i.e. consecutive samples with the same value) of the signal at its peak levels
  1856. (i.e. either @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}).
  1857. @item Peak count
  1858. Number of occasions (not the number of samples) that the signal attained either
  1859. @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}.
  1860. @item Noise floor dB
  1861. Minimum local peak measured in dBFS over a short window.
  1862. @item Noise floor count
  1863. Number of occasions (not the number of samples) that the signal attained
  1864. @var{Noise floor}.
  1865. @item Bit depth
  1866. Overall bit depth of audio. Number of bits used for each sample.
  1867. @item Dynamic range
  1868. Measured dynamic range of audio in dB.
  1869. @item Zero crossings
  1870. Number of points where the waveform crosses the zero level axis.
  1871. @item Zero crossings rate
  1872. Rate of Zero crossings and number of audio samples.
  1873. @end table
  1874. @section asubboost
  1875. Boost subwoofer frequencies.
  1876. The filter accepts the following options:
  1877. @table @option
  1878. @item dry
  1879. Set dry gain, how much of original signal is kept. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1880. Default value is 0.5.
  1881. @item wet
  1882. Set wet gain, how much of filtered signal is kept. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1883. Default value is 0.8.
  1884. @item decay
  1885. Set delay line decay gain value. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1886. Default value is 0.7.
  1887. @item feedback
  1888. Set delay line feedback gain value. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1889. Default value is 0.5.
  1890. @item cutoff
  1891. Set cutoff frequency in herz. Allowed range is 50 to 900.
  1892. Default value is 100.
  1893. @item slope
  1894. Set slope amount for cutoff frequency. Allowed range is 0.0001 to 1.
  1895. Default value is 0.5.
  1896. @item delay
  1897. Set delay. Allowed range is from 1 to 100.
  1898. Default value is 20.
  1899. @end table
  1900. @subsection Commands
  1901. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  1902. @section atempo
  1903. Adjust audio tempo.
  1904. The filter accepts exactly one parameter, the audio tempo. If not
  1905. specified then the filter will assume nominal 1.0 tempo. Tempo must
  1906. be in the [0.5, 100.0] range.
  1907. Note that tempo greater than 2 will skip some samples rather than
  1908. blend them in. If for any reason this is a concern it is always
  1909. possible to daisy-chain several instances of atempo to achieve the
  1910. desired product tempo.
  1911. @subsection Examples
  1912. @itemize
  1913. @item
  1914. Slow down audio to 80% tempo:
  1915. @example
  1916. atempo=0.8
  1917. @end example
  1918. @item
  1919. To speed up audio to 300% tempo:
  1920. @example
  1921. atempo=3
  1922. @end example
  1923. @item
  1924. To speed up audio to 300% tempo by daisy-chaining two atempo instances:
  1925. @example
  1926. atempo=sqrt(3),atempo=sqrt(3)
  1927. @end example
  1928. @end itemize
  1929. @subsection Commands
  1930. This filter supports the following commands:
  1931. @table @option
  1932. @item tempo
  1933. Change filter tempo scale factor.
  1934. Syntax for the command is : "@var{tempo}"
  1935. @end table
  1936. @section atrim
  1937. Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
  1938. It accepts the following parameters:
  1939. @table @option
  1940. @item start
  1941. Timestamp (in seconds) of the start of the section to keep. I.e. the audio
  1942. sample with the timestamp @var{start} will be the first sample in the output.
  1943. @item end
  1944. Specify time of the first audio sample that will be dropped, i.e. the
  1945. audio sample immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be
  1946. the last sample in the output.
  1947. @item start_pts
  1948. Same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp in samples
  1949. instead of seconds.
  1950. @item end_pts
  1951. Same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp in samples instead
  1952. of seconds.
  1953. @item duration
  1954. The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
  1955. @item start_sample
  1956. The number of the first sample that should be output.
  1957. @item end_sample
  1958. The number of the first sample that should be dropped.
  1959. @end table
  1960. @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
  1961. duration specifications; see
  1962. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  1963. Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
  1964. option look at the frame timestamp, while the _sample options simply count the
  1965. samples that pass through the filter. So start/end_pts and start/end_sample will
  1966. give different results when the timestamps are wrong, inexact or do not start at
  1967. zero. Also note that this filter does not modify the timestamps. If you wish
  1968. to have the output timestamps start at zero, insert the asetpts filter after the
  1969. atrim filter.
  1970. If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
  1971. keep all samples that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
  1972. only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple atrim
  1973. filters.
  1974. The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
  1975. just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
  1976. Examples:
  1977. @itemize
  1978. @item
  1979. Drop everything except the second minute of input:
  1980. @example
  1981. ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=60:120
  1982. @end example
  1983. @item
  1984. Keep only the first 1000 samples:
  1985. @example
  1986. ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=end_sample=1000
  1987. @end example
  1988. @end itemize
  1989. @section axcorrelate
  1990. Calculate normalized cross-correlation between two input audio streams.
  1991. Resulted samples are always between -1 and 1 inclusive.
  1992. If result is 1 it means two input samples are highly correlated in that selected segment.
  1993. Result 0 means they are not correlated at all.
  1994. If result is -1 it means two input samples are out of phase, which means they cancel each
  1995. other.
  1996. The filter accepts the following options:
  1997. @table @option
  1998. @item size
  1999. Set size of segment over which cross-correlation is calculated.
  2000. Default is 256. Allowed range is from 2 to 131072.
  2001. @item algo
  2002. Set algorithm for cross-correlation. Can be @code{slow} or @code{fast}.
  2003. Default is @code{slow}. Fast algorithm assumes mean values over any given segment
  2004. are always zero and thus need much less calculations to make.
  2005. This is generally not true, but is valid for typical audio streams.
  2006. @end table
  2007. @subsection Examples
  2008. @itemize
  2009. @item
  2010. Calculate correlation between channels in stereo audio stream:
  2011. @example
  2012. ffmpeg -i stereo.wav -af channelsplit,axcorrelate=size=1024:algo=fast correlation.wav
  2013. @end example
  2014. @end itemize
  2015. @section bandpass
  2016. Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-pass filter with central
  2017. frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width width.
  2018. The @var{csg} option selects a constant skirt gain (peak gain = Q)
  2019. instead of the default: constant 0dB peak gain.
  2020. The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
  2021. The filter accepts the following options:
  2022. @table @option
  2023. @item frequency, f
  2024. Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
  2025. @item csg
  2026. Constant skirt gain if set to 1. Defaults to 0.
  2027. @item width_type, t
  2028. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2029. @table @option
  2030. @item h
  2031. Hz
  2032. @item q
  2033. Q-Factor
  2034. @item o
  2035. octave
  2036. @item s
  2037. slope
  2038. @item k
  2039. kHz
  2040. @end table
  2041. @item width, w
  2042. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  2043. @item mix, m
  2044. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2045. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2046. @item channels, c
  2047. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2048. @item normalize, n
  2049. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2050. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2051. @end table
  2052. @subsection Commands
  2053. This filter supports the following commands:
  2054. @table @option
  2055. @item frequency, f
  2056. Change bandpass frequency.
  2057. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2058. @item width_type, t
  2059. Change bandpass width_type.
  2060. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2061. @item width, w
  2062. Change bandpass width.
  2063. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2064. @item mix, m
  2065. Change bandpass mix.
  2066. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2067. @end table
  2068. @section bandreject
  2069. Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-reject filter with central
  2070. frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width @var{width}.
  2071. The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
  2072. The filter accepts the following options:
  2073. @table @option
  2074. @item frequency, f
  2075. Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
  2076. @item width_type, t
  2077. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2078. @table @option
  2079. @item h
  2080. Hz
  2081. @item q
  2082. Q-Factor
  2083. @item o
  2084. octave
  2085. @item s
  2086. slope
  2087. @item k
  2088. kHz
  2089. @end table
  2090. @item width, w
  2091. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  2092. @item mix, m
  2093. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2094. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2095. @item channels, c
  2096. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2097. @item normalize, n
  2098. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2099. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2100. @end table
  2101. @subsection Commands
  2102. This filter supports the following commands:
  2103. @table @option
  2104. @item frequency, f
  2105. Change bandreject frequency.
  2106. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2107. @item width_type, t
  2108. Change bandreject width_type.
  2109. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2110. @item width, w
  2111. Change bandreject width.
  2112. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2113. @item mix, m
  2114. Change bandreject mix.
  2115. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2116. @end table
  2117. @section bass, lowshelf
  2118. Boost or cut the bass (lower) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
  2119. shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
  2120. hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
  2121. The filter accepts the following options:
  2122. @table @option
  2123. @item gain, g
  2124. Give the gain at 0 Hz. Its useful range is about -20
  2125. (for a large cut) to +20 (for a large boost).
  2126. Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  2127. @item frequency, f
  2128. Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
  2129. to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
  2130. The default value is @code{100} Hz.
  2131. @item width_type, t
  2132. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2133. @table @option
  2134. @item h
  2135. Hz
  2136. @item q
  2137. Q-Factor
  2138. @item o
  2139. octave
  2140. @item s
  2141. slope
  2142. @item k
  2143. kHz
  2144. @end table
  2145. @item width, w
  2146. Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
  2147. @item mix, m
  2148. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2149. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2150. @item channels, c
  2151. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2152. @item normalize, n
  2153. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2154. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2155. @end table
  2156. @subsection Commands
  2157. This filter supports the following commands:
  2158. @table @option
  2159. @item frequency, f
  2160. Change bass frequency.
  2161. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2162. @item width_type, t
  2163. Change bass width_type.
  2164. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2165. @item width, w
  2166. Change bass width.
  2167. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2168. @item gain, g
  2169. Change bass gain.
  2170. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  2171. @item mix, m
  2172. Change bass mix.
  2173. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2174. @end table
  2175. @section biquad
  2176. Apply a biquad IIR filter with the given coefficients.
  2177. Where @var{b0}, @var{b1}, @var{b2} and @var{a0}, @var{a1}, @var{a2}
  2178. are the numerator and denominator coefficients respectively.
  2179. and @var{channels}, @var{c} specify which channels to filter, by default all
  2180. available are filtered.
  2181. @subsection Commands
  2182. This filter supports the following commands:
  2183. @table @option
  2184. @item a0
  2185. @item a1
  2186. @item a2
  2187. @item b0
  2188. @item b1
  2189. @item b2
  2190. Change biquad parameter.
  2191. Syntax for the command is : "@var{value}"
  2192. @item mix, m
  2193. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2194. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2195. @item channels, c
  2196. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2197. @item normalize, n
  2198. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2199. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2200. @end table
  2201. @section bs2b
  2202. Bauer stereo to binaural transformation, which improves headphone listening of
  2203. stereo audio records.
  2204. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  2205. @code{--enable-libbs2b}.
  2206. It accepts the following parameters:
  2207. @table @option
  2208. @item profile
  2209. Pre-defined crossfeed level.
  2210. @table @option
  2211. @item default
  2212. Default level (fcut=700, feed=50).
  2213. @item cmoy
  2214. Chu Moy circuit (fcut=700, feed=60).
  2215. @item jmeier
  2216. Jan Meier circuit (fcut=650, feed=95).
  2217. @end table
  2218. @item fcut
  2219. Cut frequency (in Hz).
  2220. @item feed
  2221. Feed level (in Hz).
  2222. @end table
  2223. @section channelmap
  2224. Remap input channels to new locations.
  2225. It accepts the following parameters:
  2226. @table @option
  2227. @item map
  2228. Map channels from input to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
  2229. mappings, each in the @code{@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}} or
  2230. @var{in_channel} form. @var{in_channel} can be either the name of the input
  2231. channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its index in the input channel layout.
  2232. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output channel or its index in the output
  2233. channel layout. If @var{out_channel} is not given then it is implicitly an
  2234. index, starting with zero and increasing by one for each mapping.
  2235. @item channel_layout
  2236. The channel layout of the output stream.
  2237. @end table
  2238. If no mapping is present, the filter will implicitly map input channels to
  2239. output channels, preserving indices.
  2240. @subsection Examples
  2241. @itemize
  2242. @item
  2243. For example, assuming a 5.1+downmix input MOV file,
  2244. @example
  2245. ffmpeg -i in.mov -filter 'channelmap=map=DL-FL|DR-FR' out.wav
  2246. @end example
  2247. will create an output WAV file tagged as stereo from the downmix channels of
  2248. the input.
  2249. @item
  2250. To fix a 5.1 WAV improperly encoded in AAC's native channel order
  2251. @example
  2252. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter 'channelmap=1|2|0|5|3|4:5.1' out.wav
  2253. @end example
  2254. @end itemize
  2255. @section channelsplit
  2256. Split each channel from an input audio stream into a separate output stream.
  2257. It accepts the following parameters:
  2258. @table @option
  2259. @item channel_layout
  2260. The channel layout of the input stream. The default is "stereo".
  2261. @item channels
  2262. A channel layout describing the channels to be extracted as separate output streams
  2263. or "all" to extract each input channel as a separate stream. The default is "all".
  2264. Choosing channels not present in channel layout in the input will result in an error.
  2265. @end table
  2266. @subsection Examples
  2267. @itemize
  2268. @item
  2269. For example, assuming a stereo input MP3 file,
  2270. @example
  2271. ffmpeg -i in.mp3 -filter_complex channelsplit out.mkv
  2272. @end example
  2273. will create an output Matroska file with two audio streams, one containing only
  2274. the left channel and the other the right channel.
  2275. @item
  2276. Split a 5.1 WAV file into per-channel files:
  2277. @example
  2278. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter_complex
  2279. 'channelsplit=channel_layout=5.1[FL][FR][FC][LFE][SL][SR]'
  2280. -map '[FL]' front_left.wav -map '[FR]' front_right.wav -map '[FC]'
  2281. front_center.wav -map '[LFE]' lfe.wav -map '[SL]' side_left.wav -map '[SR]'
  2282. side_right.wav
  2283. @end example
  2284. @item
  2285. Extract only LFE from a 5.1 WAV file:
  2286. @example
  2287. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter_complex 'channelsplit=channel_layout=5.1:channels=LFE[LFE]'
  2288. -map '[LFE]' lfe.wav
  2289. @end example
  2290. @end itemize
  2291. @section chorus
  2292. Add a chorus effect to the audio.
  2293. Can make a single vocal sound like a chorus, but can also be applied to instrumentation.
  2294. Chorus resembles an echo effect with a short delay, but whereas with echo the delay is
  2295. constant, with chorus, it is varied using using sinusoidal or triangular modulation.
  2296. The modulation depth defines the range the modulated delay is played before or after
  2297. the delay. Hence the delayed sound will sound slower or faster, that is the delayed
  2298. sound tuned around the original one, like in a chorus where some vocals are slightly
  2299. off key.
  2300. It accepts the following parameters:
  2301. @table @option
  2302. @item in_gain
  2303. Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
  2304. @item out_gain
  2305. Set output gain. Default is 0.4.
  2306. @item delays
  2307. Set delays. A typical delay is around 40ms to 60ms.
  2308. @item decays
  2309. Set decays.
  2310. @item speeds
  2311. Set speeds.
  2312. @item depths
  2313. Set depths.
  2314. @end table
  2315. @subsection Examples
  2316. @itemize
  2317. @item
  2318. A single delay:
  2319. @example
  2320. chorus=0.7:0.9:55:0.4:0.25:2
  2321. @end example
  2322. @item
  2323. Two delays:
  2324. @example
  2325. chorus=0.6:0.9:50|60:0.4|0.32:0.25|0.4:2|1.3
  2326. @end example
  2327. @item
  2328. Fuller sounding chorus with three delays:
  2329. @example
  2330. chorus=0.5:0.9:50|60|40:0.4|0.32|0.3:0.25|0.4|0.3:2|2.3|1.3
  2331. @end example
  2332. @end itemize
  2333. @section compand
  2334. Compress or expand the audio's dynamic range.
  2335. It accepts the following parameters:
  2336. @table @option
  2337. @item attacks
  2338. @item decays
  2339. A list of times in seconds for each channel over which the instantaneous level
  2340. of the input signal is averaged to determine its volume. @var{attacks} refers to
  2341. increase of volume and @var{decays} refers to decrease of volume. For most
  2342. situations, the attack time (response to the audio getting louder) should be
  2343. shorter than the decay time, because the human ear is more sensitive to sudden
  2344. loud audio than sudden soft audio. A typical value for attack is 0.3 seconds and
  2345. a typical value for decay is 0.8 seconds.
  2346. If specified number of attacks & decays is lower than number of channels, the last
  2347. set attack/decay will be used for all remaining channels.
  2348. @item points
  2349. A list of points for the transfer function, specified in dB relative to the
  2350. maximum possible signal amplitude. Each key points list must be defined using
  2351. the following syntax: @code{x0/y0|x1/y1|x2/y2|....} or
  2352. @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ....}
  2353. The input values must be in strictly increasing order but the transfer function
  2354. does not have to be monotonically rising. The point @code{0/0} is assumed but
  2355. may be overridden (by @code{0/out-dBn}). Typical values for the transfer
  2356. function are @code{-70/-70|-60/-20|1/0}.
  2357. @item soft-knee
  2358. Set the curve radius in dB for all joints. It defaults to 0.01.
  2359. @item gain
  2360. Set the additional gain in dB to be applied at all points on the transfer
  2361. function. This allows for easy adjustment of the overall gain.
  2362. It defaults to 0.
  2363. @item volume
  2364. Set an initial volume, in dB, to be assumed for each channel when filtering
  2365. starts. This permits the user to supply a nominal level initially, so that, for
  2366. example, a very large gain is not applied to initial signal levels before the
  2367. companding has begun to operate. A typical value for audio which is initially
  2368. quiet is -90 dB. It defaults to 0.
  2369. @item delay
  2370. Set a delay, in seconds. The input audio is analyzed immediately, but audio is
  2371. delayed before being fed to the volume adjuster. Specifying a delay
  2372. approximately equal to the attack/decay times allows the filter to effectively
  2373. operate in predictive rather than reactive mode. It defaults to 0.
  2374. @end table
  2375. @subsection Examples
  2376. @itemize
  2377. @item
  2378. Make music with both quiet and loud passages suitable for listening to in a
  2379. noisy environment:
  2380. @example
  2381. compand=.3|.3:1|1:-90/-60|-60/-40|-40/-30|-20/-20:6:0:-90:0.2
  2382. @end example
  2383. Another example for audio with whisper and explosion parts:
  2384. @example
  2385. compand=0|0:1|1:-90/-900|-70/-70|-30/-9|0/-3:6:0:0:0
  2386. @end example
  2387. @item
  2388. A noise gate for when the noise is at a lower level than the signal:
  2389. @example
  2390. compand=.1|.1:.2|.2:-900/-900|-50.1/-900|-50/-50:.01:0:-90:.1
  2391. @end example
  2392. @item
  2393. Here is another noise gate, this time for when the noise is at a higher level
  2394. than the signal (making it, in some ways, similar to squelch):
  2395. @example
  2396. compand=.1|.1:.1|.1:-45.1/-45.1|-45/-900|0/-900:.01:45:-90:.1
  2397. @end example
  2398. @item
  2399. 2:1 compression starting at -6dB:
  2400. @example
  2401. compand=points=-80/-80|-6/-6|0/-3.8|20/3.5
  2402. @end example
  2403. @item
  2404. 2:1 compression starting at -9dB:
  2405. @example
  2406. compand=points=-80/-80|-9/-9|0/-5.3|20/2.9
  2407. @end example
  2408. @item
  2409. 2:1 compression starting at -12dB:
  2410. @example
  2411. compand=points=-80/-80|-12/-12|0/-6.8|20/1.9
  2412. @end example
  2413. @item
  2414. 2:1 compression starting at -18dB:
  2415. @example
  2416. compand=points=-80/-80|-18/-18|0/-9.8|20/0.7
  2417. @end example
  2418. @item
  2419. 3:1 compression starting at -15dB:
  2420. @example
  2421. compand=points=-80/-80|-15/-15|0/-10.8|20/-5.2
  2422. @end example
  2423. @item
  2424. Compressor/Gate:
  2425. @example
  2426. compand=points=-80/-105|-62/-80|-15.4/-15.4|0/-12|20/-7.6
  2427. @end example
  2428. @item
  2429. Expander:
  2430. @example
  2431. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-169|-54/-80|-49.5/-64.6|-41.1/-41.1|-25.8/-15|-10.8/-4.5|0/0|20/8.3
  2432. @end example
  2433. @item
  2434. Hard limiter at -6dB:
  2435. @example
  2436. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-6/-6|20/-6
  2437. @end example
  2438. @item
  2439. Hard limiter at -12dB:
  2440. @example
  2441. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12/-12|20/-12
  2442. @end example
  2443. @item
  2444. Hard noise gate at -35 dB:
  2445. @example
  2446. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-115|-35.1/-80|-35/-35|20/20
  2447. @end example
  2448. @item
  2449. Soft limiter:
  2450. @example
  2451. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12.4/-12.4|-6/-8|0/-6.8|20/-2.8
  2452. @end example
  2453. @end itemize
  2454. @section compensationdelay
  2455. Compensation Delay Line is a metric based delay to compensate differing
  2456. positions of microphones or speakers.
  2457. For example, you have recorded guitar with two microphones placed in
  2458. different locations. Because the front of sound wave has fixed speed in
  2459. normal conditions, the phasing of microphones can vary and depends on
  2460. their location and interposition. The best sound mix can be achieved when
  2461. these microphones are in phase (synchronized). Note that a distance of
  2462. ~30 cm between microphones makes one microphone capture the signal in
  2463. antiphase to the other microphone. That makes the final mix sound moody.
  2464. This filter helps to solve phasing problems by adding different delays
  2465. to each microphone track and make them synchronized.
  2466. The best result can be reached when you take one track as base and
  2467. synchronize other tracks one by one with it.
  2468. Remember that synchronization/delay tolerance depends on sample rate, too.
  2469. Higher sample rates will give more tolerance.
  2470. The filter accepts the following parameters:
  2471. @table @option
  2472. @item mm
  2473. Set millimeters distance. This is compensation distance for fine tuning.
  2474. Default is 0.
  2475. @item cm
  2476. Set cm distance. This is compensation distance for tightening distance setup.
  2477. Default is 0.
  2478. @item m
  2479. Set meters distance. This is compensation distance for hard distance setup.
  2480. Default is 0.
  2481. @item dry
  2482. Set dry amount. Amount of unprocessed (dry) signal.
  2483. Default is 0.
  2484. @item wet
  2485. Set wet amount. Amount of processed (wet) signal.
  2486. Default is 1.
  2487. @item temp
  2488. Set temperature in degrees Celsius. This is the temperature of the environment.
  2489. Default is 20.
  2490. @end table
  2491. @section crossfeed
  2492. Apply headphone crossfeed filter.
  2493. Crossfeed is the process of blending the left and right channels of stereo
  2494. audio recording.
  2495. It is mainly used to reduce extreme stereo separation of low frequencies.
  2496. The intent is to produce more speaker like sound to the listener.
  2497. The filter accepts the following options:
  2498. @table @option
  2499. @item strength
  2500. Set strength of crossfeed. Default is 0.2. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2501. This sets gain of low shelf filter for side part of stereo image.
  2502. Default is -6dB. Max allowed is -30db when strength is set to 1.
  2503. @item range
  2504. Set soundstage wideness. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2505. This sets cut off frequency of low shelf filter. Default is cut off near
  2506. 1550 Hz. With range set to 1 cut off frequency is set to 2100 Hz.
  2507. @item slope
  2508. Set curve slope of low shelf filter. Default is 0.5.
  2509. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 1.
  2510. @item level_in
  2511. Set input gain. Default is 0.9.
  2512. @item level_out
  2513. Set output gain. Default is 1.
  2514. @end table
  2515. @subsection Commands
  2516. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  2517. @section crystalizer
  2518. Simple algorithm to expand audio dynamic range.
  2519. The filter accepts the following options:
  2520. @table @option
  2521. @item i
  2522. Sets the intensity of effect (default: 2.0). Must be in range between 0.0
  2523. (unchanged sound) to 10.0 (maximum effect).
  2524. @item c
  2525. Enable clipping. By default is enabled.
  2526. @end table
  2527. @subsection Commands
  2528. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  2529. @section dcshift
  2530. Apply a DC shift to the audio.
  2531. This can be useful to remove a DC offset (caused perhaps by a hardware problem
  2532. in the recording chain) from the audio. The effect of a DC offset is reduced
  2533. headroom and hence volume. The @ref{astats} filter can be used to determine if
  2534. a signal has a DC offset.
  2535. @table @option
  2536. @item shift
  2537. Set the DC shift, allowed range is [-1, 1]. It indicates the amount to shift
  2538. the audio.
  2539. @item limitergain
  2540. Optional. It should have a value much less than 1 (e.g. 0.05 or 0.02) and is
  2541. used to prevent clipping.
  2542. @end table
  2543. @section deesser
  2544. Apply de-essing to the audio samples.
  2545. @table @option
  2546. @item i
  2547. Set intensity for triggering de-essing. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2548. Default is 0.
  2549. @item m
  2550. Set amount of ducking on treble part of sound. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2551. Default is 0.5.
  2552. @item f
  2553. How much of original frequency content to keep when de-essing. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2554. Default is 0.5.
  2555. @item s
  2556. Set the output mode.
  2557. It accepts the following values:
  2558. @table @option
  2559. @item i
  2560. Pass input unchanged.
  2561. @item o
  2562. Pass ess filtered out.
  2563. @item e
  2564. Pass only ess.
  2565. Default value is @var{o}.
  2566. @end table
  2567. @end table
  2568. @section drmeter
  2569. Measure audio dynamic range.
  2570. DR values of 14 and higher is found in very dynamic material. DR of 8 to 13
  2571. is found in transition material. And anything less that 8 have very poor dynamics
  2572. and is very compressed.
  2573. The filter accepts the following options:
  2574. @table @option
  2575. @item length
  2576. Set window length in seconds used to split audio into segments of equal length.
  2577. Default is 3 seconds.
  2578. @end table
  2579. @section dynaudnorm
  2580. Dynamic Audio Normalizer.
  2581. This filter applies a certain amount of gain to the input audio in order
  2582. to bring its peak magnitude to a target level (e.g. 0 dBFS). However, in
  2583. contrast to more "simple" normalization algorithms, the Dynamic Audio
  2584. Normalizer *dynamically* re-adjusts the gain factor to the input audio.
  2585. This allows for applying extra gain to the "quiet" sections of the audio
  2586. while avoiding distortions or clipping the "loud" sections. In other words:
  2587. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer will "even out" the volume of quiet and loud
  2588. sections, in the sense that the volume of each section is brought to the
  2589. same target level. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer achieves
  2590. this goal *without* applying "dynamic range compressing". It will retain 100%
  2591. of the dynamic range *within* each section of the audio file.
  2592. @table @option
  2593. @item framelen, f
  2594. Set the frame length in milliseconds. In range from 10 to 8000 milliseconds.
  2595. Default is 500 milliseconds.
  2596. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer processes the input audio in small chunks,
  2597. referred to as frames. This is required, because a peak magnitude has no
  2598. meaning for just a single sample value. Instead, we need to determine the
  2599. peak magnitude for a contiguous sequence of sample values. While a "standard"
  2600. normalizer would simply use the peak magnitude of the complete file, the
  2601. Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the peak magnitude individually for each
  2602. frame. The length of a frame is specified in milliseconds. By default, the
  2603. Dynamic Audio Normalizer uses a frame length of 500 milliseconds, which has
  2604. been found to give good results with most files.
  2605. Note that the exact frame length, in number of samples, will be determined
  2606. automatically, based on the sampling rate of the individual input audio file.
  2607. @item gausssize, g
  2608. Set the Gaussian filter window size. In range from 3 to 301, must be odd
  2609. number. Default is 31.
  2610. Probably the most important parameter of the Dynamic Audio Normalizer is the
  2611. @code{window size} of the Gaussian smoothing filter. The filter's window size
  2612. is specified in frames, centered around the current frame. For the sake of
  2613. simplicity, this must be an odd number. Consequently, the default value of 31
  2614. takes into account the current frame, as well as the 15 preceding frames and
  2615. the 15 subsequent frames. Using a larger window results in a stronger
  2616. smoothing effect and thus in less gain variation, i.e. slower gain
  2617. adaptation. Conversely, using a smaller window results in a weaker smoothing
  2618. effect and thus in more gain variation, i.e. faster gain adaptation.
  2619. In other words, the more you increase this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
  2620. Normalizer will behave like a "traditional" normalization filter. On the
  2621. contrary, the more you decrease this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
  2622. Normalizer will behave like a dynamic range compressor.
  2623. @item peak, p
  2624. Set the target peak value. This specifies the highest permissible magnitude
  2625. level for the normalized audio input. This filter will try to approach the
  2626. target peak magnitude as closely as possible, but at the same time it also
  2627. makes sure that the normalized signal will never exceed the peak magnitude.
  2628. A frame's maximum local gain factor is imposed directly by the target peak
  2629. magnitude. The default value is 0.95 and thus leaves a headroom of 5%*.
  2630. It is not recommended to go above this value.
  2631. @item maxgain, m
  2632. Set the maximum gain factor. In range from 1.0 to 100.0. Default is 10.0.
  2633. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the maximum possible (local) gain
  2634. factor for each input frame, i.e. the maximum gain factor that does not
  2635. result in clipping or distortion. The maximum gain factor is determined by
  2636. the frame's highest magnitude sample. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer
  2637. additionally bounds the frame's maximum gain factor by a predetermined
  2638. (global) maximum gain factor. This is done in order to avoid excessive gain
  2639. factors in "silent" or almost silent frames. By default, the maximum gain
  2640. factor is 10.0, For most inputs the default value should be sufficient and
  2641. it usually is not recommended to increase this value. Though, for input
  2642. with an extremely low overall volume level, it may be necessary to allow even
  2643. higher gain factors. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does
  2644. not simply apply a "hard" threshold (i.e. cut off values above the threshold).
  2645. Instead, a "sigmoid" threshold function will be applied. This way, the
  2646. gain factors will smoothly approach the threshold value, but never exceed that
  2647. value.
  2648. @item targetrms, r
  2649. Set the target RMS. In range from 0.0 to 1.0. Default is 0.0 - disabled.
  2650. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer performs "peak" normalization.
  2651. This means that the maximum local gain factor for each frame is defined
  2652. (only) by the frame's highest magnitude sample. This way, the samples can
  2653. be amplified as much as possible without exceeding the maximum signal
  2654. level, i.e. without clipping. Optionally, however, the Dynamic Audio
  2655. Normalizer can also take into account the frame's root mean square,
  2656. abbreviated RMS. In electrical engineering, the RMS is commonly used to
  2657. determine the power of a time-varying signal. It is therefore considered
  2658. that the RMS is a better approximation of the "perceived loudness" than
  2659. just looking at the signal's peak magnitude. Consequently, by adjusting all
  2660. frames to a constant RMS value, a uniform "perceived loudness" can be
  2661. established. If a target RMS value has been specified, a frame's local gain
  2662. factor is defined as the factor that would result in exactly that RMS value.
  2663. Note, however, that the maximum local gain factor is still restricted by the
  2664. frame's highest magnitude sample, in order to prevent clipping.
  2665. @item coupling, n
  2666. Enable channels coupling. By default is enabled.
  2667. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will amplify all channels by the same
  2668. amount. This means the same gain factor will be applied to all channels, i.e.
  2669. the maximum possible gain factor is determined by the "loudest" channel.
  2670. However, in some recordings, it may happen that the volume of the different
  2671. channels is uneven, e.g. one channel may be "quieter" than the other one(s).
  2672. In this case, this option can be used to disable the channel coupling. This way,
  2673. the gain factor will be determined independently for each channel, depending
  2674. only on the individual channel's highest magnitude sample. This allows for
  2675. harmonizing the volume of the different channels.
  2676. @item correctdc, c
  2677. Enable DC bias correction. By default is disabled.
  2678. An audio signal (in the time domain) is a sequence of sample values.
  2679. In the Dynamic Audio Normalizer these sample values are represented in the
  2680. -1.0 to 1.0 range, regardless of the original input format. Normally, the
  2681. audio signal, or "waveform", should be centered around the zero point.
  2682. That means if we calculate the mean value of all samples in a file, or in a
  2683. single frame, then the result should be 0.0 or at least very close to that
  2684. value. If, however, there is a significant deviation of the mean value from
  2685. 0.0, in either positive or negative direction, this is referred to as a
  2686. DC bias or DC offset. Since a DC bias is clearly undesirable, the Dynamic
  2687. Audio Normalizer provides optional DC bias correction.
  2688. With DC bias correction enabled, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will determine
  2689. the mean value, or "DC correction" offset, of each input frame and subtract
  2690. that value from all of the frame's sample values which ensures those samples
  2691. are centered around 0.0 again. Also, in order to avoid "gaps" at the frame
  2692. boundaries, the DC correction offset values will be interpolated smoothly
  2693. between neighbouring frames.
  2694. @item altboundary, b
  2695. Enable alternative boundary mode. By default is disabled.
  2696. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer takes into account a certain neighbourhood
  2697. around each frame. This includes the preceding frames as well as the
  2698. subsequent frames. However, for the "boundary" frames, located at the very
  2699. beginning and at the very end of the audio file, not all neighbouring
  2700. frames are available. In particular, for the first few frames in the audio
  2701. file, the preceding frames are not known. And, similarly, for the last few
  2702. frames in the audio file, the subsequent frames are not known. Thus, the
  2703. question arises which gain factors should be assumed for the missing frames
  2704. in the "boundary" region. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer implements two modes
  2705. to deal with this situation. The default boundary mode assumes a gain factor
  2706. of exactly 1.0 for the missing frames, resulting in a smooth "fade in" and
  2707. "fade out" at the beginning and at the end of the input, respectively.
  2708. @item compress, s
  2709. Set the compress factor. In range from 0.0 to 30.0. Default is 0.0.
  2710. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not apply "traditional"
  2711. compression. This means that signal peaks will not be pruned and thus the
  2712. full dynamic range will be retained within each local neighbourhood. However,
  2713. in some cases it may be desirable to combine the Dynamic Audio Normalizer's
  2714. normalization algorithm with a more "traditional" compression.
  2715. For this purpose, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer provides an optional compression
  2716. (thresholding) function. If (and only if) the compression feature is enabled,
  2717. all input frames will be processed by a soft knee thresholding function prior
  2718. to the actual normalization process. Put simply, the thresholding function is
  2719. going to prune all samples whose magnitude exceeds a certain threshold value.
  2720. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not simply apply a fixed threshold
  2721. value. Instead, the threshold value will be adjusted for each individual
  2722. frame.
  2723. In general, smaller parameters result in stronger compression, and vice versa.
  2724. Values below 3.0 are not recommended, because audible distortion may appear.
  2725. @item threshold, t
  2726. Set the target threshold value. This specifies the lowest permissible
  2727. magnitude level for the audio input which will be normalized.
  2728. If input frame volume is above this value frame will be normalized.
  2729. Otherwise frame may not be normalized at all. The default value is set
  2730. to 0, which means all input frames will be normalized.
  2731. This option is mostly useful if digital noise is not wanted to be amplified.
  2732. @end table
  2733. @subsection Commands
  2734. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  2735. @section earwax
  2736. Make audio easier to listen to on headphones.
  2737. This filter adds `cues' to 44.1kHz stereo (i.e. audio CD format) audio
  2738. so that when listened to on headphones the stereo image is moved from
  2739. inside your head (standard for headphones) to outside and in front of
  2740. the listener (standard for speakers).
  2741. Ported from SoX.
  2742. @section equalizer
  2743. Apply a two-pole peaking equalisation (EQ) filter. With this
  2744. filter, the signal-level at and around a selected frequency can
  2745. be increased or decreased, whilst (unlike bandpass and bandreject
  2746. filters) that at all other frequencies is unchanged.
  2747. In order to produce complex equalisation curves, this filter can
  2748. be given several times, each with a different central frequency.
  2749. The filter accepts the following options:
  2750. @table @option
  2751. @item frequency, f
  2752. Set the filter's central frequency in Hz.
  2753. @item width_type, t
  2754. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2755. @table @option
  2756. @item h
  2757. Hz
  2758. @item q
  2759. Q-Factor
  2760. @item o
  2761. octave
  2762. @item s
  2763. slope
  2764. @item k
  2765. kHz
  2766. @end table
  2767. @item width, w
  2768. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  2769. @item gain, g
  2770. Set the required gain or attenuation in dB.
  2771. Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  2772. @item mix, m
  2773. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2774. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2775. @item channels, c
  2776. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2777. @item normalize, n
  2778. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2779. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2780. @end table
  2781. @subsection Examples
  2782. @itemize
  2783. @item
  2784. Attenuate 10 dB at 1000 Hz, with a bandwidth of 200 Hz:
  2785. @example
  2786. equalizer=f=1000:t=h:width=200:g=-10
  2787. @end example
  2788. @item
  2789. Apply 2 dB gain at 1000 Hz with Q 1 and attenuate 5 dB at 100 Hz with Q 2:
  2790. @example
  2791. equalizer=f=1000:t=q:w=1:g=2,equalizer=f=100:t=q:w=2:g=-5
  2792. @end example
  2793. @end itemize
  2794. @subsection Commands
  2795. This filter supports the following commands:
  2796. @table @option
  2797. @item frequency, f
  2798. Change equalizer frequency.
  2799. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2800. @item width_type, t
  2801. Change equalizer width_type.
  2802. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2803. @item width, w
  2804. Change equalizer width.
  2805. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2806. @item gain, g
  2807. Change equalizer gain.
  2808. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  2809. @item mix, m
  2810. Change equalizer mix.
  2811. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2812. @end table
  2813. @section extrastereo
  2814. Linearly increases the difference between left and right channels which
  2815. adds some sort of "live" effect to playback.
  2816. The filter accepts the following options:
  2817. @table @option
  2818. @item m
  2819. Sets the difference coefficient (default: 2.5). 0.0 means mono sound
  2820. (average of both channels), with 1.0 sound will be unchanged, with
  2821. -1.0 left and right channels will be swapped.
  2822. @item c
  2823. Enable clipping. By default is enabled.
  2824. @end table
  2825. @subsection Commands
  2826. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  2827. @section firequalizer
  2828. Apply FIR Equalization using arbitrary frequency response.
  2829. The filter accepts the following option:
  2830. @table @option
  2831. @item gain
  2832. Set gain curve equation (in dB). The expression can contain variables:
  2833. @table @option
  2834. @item f
  2835. the evaluated frequency
  2836. @item sr
  2837. sample rate
  2838. @item ch
  2839. channel number, set to 0 when multichannels evaluation is disabled
  2840. @item chid
  2841. channel id, see libavutil/channel_layout.h, set to the first channel id when
  2842. multichannels evaluation is disabled
  2843. @item chs
  2844. number of channels
  2845. @item chlayout
  2846. channel_layout, see libavutil/channel_layout.h
  2847. @end table
  2848. and functions:
  2849. @table @option
  2850. @item gain_interpolate(f)
  2851. interpolate gain on frequency f based on gain_entry
  2852. @item cubic_interpolate(f)
  2853. same as gain_interpolate, but smoother
  2854. @end table
  2855. This option is also available as command. Default is @code{gain_interpolate(f)}.
  2856. @item gain_entry
  2857. Set gain entry for gain_interpolate function. The expression can
  2858. contain functions:
  2859. @table @option
  2860. @item entry(f, g)
  2861. store gain entry at frequency f with value g
  2862. @end table
  2863. This option is also available as command.
  2864. @item delay
  2865. Set filter delay in seconds. Higher value means more accurate.
  2866. Default is @code{0.01}.
  2867. @item accuracy
  2868. Set filter accuracy in Hz. Lower value means more accurate.
  2869. Default is @code{5}.
  2870. @item wfunc
  2871. Set window function. Acceptable values are:
  2872. @table @option
  2873. @item rectangular
  2874. rectangular window, useful when gain curve is already smooth
  2875. @item hann
  2876. hann window (default)
  2877. @item hamming
  2878. hamming window
  2879. @item blackman
  2880. blackman window
  2881. @item nuttall3
  2882. 3-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
  2883. @item mnuttall3
  2884. minimum 3-terms discontinuous nuttall window
  2885. @item nuttall
  2886. 4-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
  2887. @item bnuttall
  2888. minimum 4-terms discontinuous nuttall (blackman-nuttall) window
  2889. @item bharris
  2890. blackman-harris window
  2891. @item tukey
  2892. tukey window
  2893. @end table
  2894. @item fixed
  2895. If enabled, use fixed number of audio samples. This improves speed when
  2896. filtering with large delay. Default is disabled.
  2897. @item multi
  2898. Enable multichannels evaluation on gain. Default is disabled.
  2899. @item zero_phase
  2900. Enable zero phase mode by subtracting timestamp to compensate delay.
  2901. Default is disabled.
  2902. @item scale
  2903. Set scale used by gain. Acceptable values are:
  2904. @table @option
  2905. @item linlin
  2906. linear frequency, linear gain
  2907. @item linlog
  2908. linear frequency, logarithmic (in dB) gain (default)
  2909. @item loglin
  2910. logarithmic (in octave scale where 20 Hz is 0) frequency, linear gain
  2911. @item loglog
  2912. logarithmic frequency, logarithmic gain
  2913. @end table
  2914. @item dumpfile
  2915. Set file for dumping, suitable for gnuplot.
  2916. @item dumpscale
  2917. Set scale for dumpfile. Acceptable values are same with scale option.
  2918. Default is linlog.
  2919. @item fft2
  2920. Enable 2-channel convolution using complex FFT. This improves speed significantly.
  2921. Default is disabled.
  2922. @item min_phase
  2923. Enable minimum phase impulse response. Default is disabled.
  2924. @end table
  2925. @subsection Examples
  2926. @itemize
  2927. @item
  2928. lowpass at 1000 Hz:
  2929. @example
  2930. firequalizer=gain='if(lt(f,1000), 0, -INF)'
  2931. @end example
  2932. @item
  2933. lowpass at 1000 Hz with gain_entry:
  2934. @example
  2935. firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(1000,0); entry(1001, -INF)'
  2936. @end example
  2937. @item
  2938. custom equalization:
  2939. @example
  2940. firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(100,0); entry(400, -4); entry(1000, -6); entry(2000, 0)'
  2941. @end example
  2942. @item
  2943. higher delay with zero phase to compensate delay:
  2944. @example
  2945. firequalizer=delay=0.1:fixed=on:zero_phase=on
  2946. @end example
  2947. @item
  2948. lowpass on left channel, highpass on right channel:
  2949. @example
  2950. firequalizer=gain='if(eq(chid,1), gain_interpolate(f), if(eq(chid,2), gain_interpolate(1e6+f), 0))'
  2951. :gain_entry='entry(1000, 0); entry(1001,-INF); entry(1e6+1000,0)':multi=on
  2952. @end example
  2953. @end itemize
  2954. @section flanger
  2955. Apply a flanging effect to the audio.
  2956. The filter accepts the following options:
  2957. @table @option
  2958. @item delay
  2959. Set base delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 30. Default value is 0.
  2960. @item depth
  2961. Set added sweep delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 10. Default value is 2.
  2962. @item regen
  2963. Set percentage regeneration (delayed signal feedback). Range from -95 to 95.
  2964. Default value is 0.
  2965. @item width
  2966. Set percentage of delayed signal mixed with original. Range from 0 to 100.
  2967. Default value is 71.
  2968. @item speed
  2969. Set sweeps per second (Hz). Range from 0.1 to 10. Default value is 0.5.
  2970. @item shape
  2971. Set swept wave shape, can be @var{triangular} or @var{sinusoidal}.
  2972. Default value is @var{sinusoidal}.
  2973. @item phase
  2974. Set swept wave percentage-shift for multi channel. Range from 0 to 100.
  2975. Default value is 25.
  2976. @item interp
  2977. Set delay-line interpolation, @var{linear} or @var{quadratic}.
  2978. Default is @var{linear}.
  2979. @end table
  2980. @section haas
  2981. Apply Haas effect to audio.
  2982. Note that this makes most sense to apply on mono signals.
  2983. With this filter applied to mono signals it give some directionality and
  2984. stretches its stereo image.
  2985. The filter accepts the following options:
  2986. @table @option
  2987. @item level_in
  2988. Set input level. By default is @var{1}, or 0dB
  2989. @item level_out
  2990. Set output level. By default is @var{1}, or 0dB.
  2991. @item side_gain
  2992. Set gain applied to side part of signal. By default is @var{1}.
  2993. @item middle_source
  2994. Set kind of middle source. Can be one of the following:
  2995. @table @samp
  2996. @item left
  2997. Pick left channel.
  2998. @item right
  2999. Pick right channel.
  3000. @item mid
  3001. Pick middle part signal of stereo image.
  3002. @item side
  3003. Pick side part signal of stereo image.
  3004. @end table
  3005. @item middle_phase
  3006. Change middle phase. By default is disabled.
  3007. @item left_delay
  3008. Set left channel delay. By default is @var{2.05} milliseconds.
  3009. @item left_balance
  3010. Set left channel balance. By default is @var{-1}.
  3011. @item left_gain
  3012. Set left channel gain. By default is @var{1}.
  3013. @item left_phase
  3014. Change left phase. By default is disabled.
  3015. @item right_delay
  3016. Set right channel delay. By defaults is @var{2.12} milliseconds.
  3017. @item right_balance
  3018. Set right channel balance. By default is @var{1}.
  3019. @item right_gain
  3020. Set right channel gain. By default is @var{1}.
  3021. @item right_phase
  3022. Change right phase. By default is enabled.
  3023. @end table
  3024. @section hdcd
  3025. Decodes High Definition Compatible Digital (HDCD) data. A 16-bit PCM stream with
  3026. embedded HDCD codes is expanded into a 20-bit PCM stream.
  3027. The filter supports the Peak Extend and Low-level Gain Adjustment features
  3028. of HDCD, and detects the Transient Filter flag.
  3029. @example
  3030. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.flac -af hdcd OUT24.flac
  3031. @end example
  3032. When using the filter with wav, note the default encoding for wav is 16-bit,
  3033. so the resulting 20-bit stream will be truncated back to 16-bit. Use something
  3034. like @command{-acodec pcm_s24le} after the filter to get 24-bit PCM output.
  3035. @example
  3036. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.wav -af hdcd OUT16.wav
  3037. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.wav -af hdcd -c:a pcm_s24le OUT24.wav
  3038. @end example
  3039. The filter accepts the following options:
  3040. @table @option
  3041. @item disable_autoconvert
  3042. Disable any automatic format conversion or resampling in the filter graph.
  3043. @item process_stereo
  3044. Process the stereo channels together. If target_gain does not match between
  3045. channels, consider it invalid and use the last valid target_gain.
  3046. @item cdt_ms
  3047. Set the code detect timer period in ms.
  3048. @item force_pe
  3049. Always extend peaks above -3dBFS even if PE isn't signaled.
  3050. @item analyze_mode
  3051. Replace audio with a solid tone and adjust the amplitude to signal some
  3052. specific aspect of the decoding process. The output file can be loaded in
  3053. an audio editor alongside the original to aid analysis.
  3054. @code{analyze_mode=pe:force_pe=true} can be used to see all samples above the PE level.
  3055. Modes are:
  3056. @table @samp
  3057. @item 0, off
  3058. Disabled
  3059. @item 1, lle
  3060. Gain adjustment level at each sample
  3061. @item 2, pe
  3062. Samples where peak extend occurs
  3063. @item 3, cdt
  3064. Samples where the code detect timer is active
  3065. @item 4, tgm
  3066. Samples where the target gain does not match between channels
  3067. @end table
  3068. @end table
  3069. @section headphone
  3070. Apply head-related transfer functions (HRTFs) to create virtual
  3071. loudspeakers around the user for binaural listening via headphones.
  3072. The HRIRs are provided via additional streams, for each channel
  3073. one stereo input stream is needed.
  3074. The filter accepts the following options:
  3075. @table @option
  3076. @item map
  3077. Set mapping of input streams for convolution.
  3078. The argument is a '|'-separated list of channel names in order as they
  3079. are given as additional stream inputs for filter.
  3080. This also specify number of input streams. Number of input streams
  3081. must be not less than number of channels in first stream plus one.
  3082. @item gain
  3083. Set gain applied to audio. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3084. @item type
  3085. Set processing type. Can be @var{time} or @var{freq}. @var{time} is
  3086. processing audio in time domain which is slow.
  3087. @var{freq} is processing audio in frequency domain which is fast.
  3088. Default is @var{freq}.
  3089. @item lfe
  3090. Set custom gain for LFE channels. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3091. @item size
  3092. Set size of frame in number of samples which will be processed at once.
  3093. Default value is @var{1024}. Allowed range is from 1024 to 96000.
  3094. @item hrir
  3095. Set format of hrir stream.
  3096. Default value is @var{stereo}. Alternative value is @var{multich}.
  3097. If value is set to @var{stereo}, number of additional streams should
  3098. be greater or equal to number of input channels in first input stream.
  3099. Also each additional stream should have stereo number of channels.
  3100. If value is set to @var{multich}, number of additional streams should
  3101. be exactly one. Also number of input channels of additional stream
  3102. should be equal or greater than twice number of channels of first input
  3103. stream.
  3104. @end table
  3105. @subsection Examples
  3106. @itemize
  3107. @item
  3108. Full example using wav files as coefficients with amovie filters for 7.1 downmix,
  3109. each amovie filter use stereo file with IR coefficients as input.
  3110. The files give coefficients for each position of virtual loudspeaker:
  3111. @example
  3112. ffmpeg -i input.wav
  3113. -filter_complex "amovie=azi_270_ele_0_DFC.wav[sr];amovie=azi_90_ele_0_DFC.wav[sl];amovie=azi_225_ele_0_DFC.wav[br];amovie=azi_135_ele_0_DFC.wav[bl];amovie=azi_0_ele_0_DFC.wav,asplit[fc][lfe];amovie=azi_35_ele_0_DFC.wav[fl];amovie=azi_325_ele_0_DFC.wav[fr];[0:a][fl][fr][fc][lfe][bl][br][sl][sr]headphone=FL|FR|FC|LFE|BL|BR|SL|SR"
  3114. output.wav
  3115. @end example
  3116. @item
  3117. Full example using wav files as coefficients with amovie filters for 7.1 downmix,
  3118. but now in @var{multich} @var{hrir} format.
  3119. @example
  3120. ffmpeg -i input.wav -filter_complex "amovie=minp.wav[hrirs];[0:a][hrirs]headphone=map=FL|FR|FC|LFE|BL|BR|SL|SR:hrir=multich"
  3121. output.wav
  3122. @end example
  3123. @end itemize
  3124. @section highpass
  3125. Apply a high-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
  3126. The filter can be either single-pole, or double-pole (the default).
  3127. The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
  3128. The filter accepts the following options:
  3129. @table @option
  3130. @item frequency, f
  3131. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 3000.
  3132. @item poles, p
  3133. Set number of poles. Default is 2.
  3134. @item width_type, t
  3135. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  3136. @table @option
  3137. @item h
  3138. Hz
  3139. @item q
  3140. Q-Factor
  3141. @item o
  3142. octave
  3143. @item s
  3144. slope
  3145. @item k
  3146. kHz
  3147. @end table
  3148. @item width, w
  3149. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  3150. Applies only to double-pole filter.
  3151. The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
  3152. @item mix, m
  3153. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  3154. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3155. @item channels, c
  3156. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  3157. @item normalize, n
  3158. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  3159. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  3160. @end table
  3161. @subsection Commands
  3162. This filter supports the following commands:
  3163. @table @option
  3164. @item frequency, f
  3165. Change highpass frequency.
  3166. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  3167. @item width_type, t
  3168. Change highpass width_type.
  3169. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  3170. @item width, w
  3171. Change highpass width.
  3172. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  3173. @item mix, m
  3174. Change highpass mix.
  3175. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  3176. @end table
  3177. @section join
  3178. Join multiple input streams into one multi-channel stream.
  3179. It accepts the following parameters:
  3180. @table @option
  3181. @item inputs
  3182. The number of input streams. It defaults to 2.
  3183. @item channel_layout
  3184. The desired output channel layout. It defaults to stereo.
  3185. @item map
  3186. Map channels from inputs to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
  3187. mappings, each in the @code{@var{input_idx}.@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}}
  3188. form. @var{input_idx} is the 0-based index of the input stream. @var{in_channel}
  3189. can be either the name of the input channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its
  3190. index in the specified input stream. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output
  3191. channel.
  3192. @end table
  3193. The filter will attempt to guess the mappings when they are not specified
  3194. explicitly. It does so by first trying to find an unused matching input channel
  3195. and if that fails it picks the first unused input channel.
  3196. Join 3 inputs (with properly set channel layouts):
  3197. @example
  3198. ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex join=inputs=3 OUTPUT
  3199. @end example
  3200. Build a 5.1 output from 6 single-channel streams:
  3201. @example
  3202. ffmpeg -i fl -i fr -i fc -i sl -i sr -i lfe -filter_complex
  3203. 'join=inputs=6:channel_layout=5.1:map=0.0-FL|1.0-FR|2.0-FC|3.0-SL|4.0-SR|5.0-LFE'
  3204. out
  3205. @end example
  3206. @section ladspa
  3207. Load a LADSPA (Linux Audio Developer's Simple Plugin API) plugin.
  3208. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3209. @code{--enable-ladspa}.
  3210. @table @option
  3211. @item file, f
  3212. Specifies the name of LADSPA plugin library to load. If the environment
  3213. variable @env{LADSPA_PATH} is defined, the LADSPA plugin is searched in
  3214. each one of the directories specified by the colon separated list in
  3215. @env{LADSPA_PATH}, otherwise in the standard LADSPA paths, which are in
  3216. this order: @file{HOME/.ladspa/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/ladspa/},
  3217. @file{/usr/lib/ladspa/}.
  3218. @item plugin, p
  3219. Specifies the plugin within the library. Some libraries contain only
  3220. one plugin, but others contain many of them. If this is not set filter
  3221. will list all available plugins within the specified library.
  3222. @item controls, c
  3223. Set the '|' separated list of controls which are zero or more floating point
  3224. values that determine the behavior of the loaded plugin (for example delay,
  3225. threshold or gain).
  3226. Controls need to be defined using the following syntax:
  3227. c0=@var{value0}|c1=@var{value1}|c2=@var{value2}|..., where
  3228. @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
  3229. Alternatively they can be also defined using the following syntax:
  3230. @var{value0}|@var{value1}|@var{value2}|..., where
  3231. @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
  3232. If @option{controls} is set to @code{help}, all available controls and
  3233. their valid ranges are printed.
  3234. @item sample_rate, s
  3235. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100. Only used if plugin have
  3236. zero inputs.
  3237. @item nb_samples, n
  3238. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default
  3239. is 1024. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3240. @item duration, d
  3241. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  3242. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3243. for the accepted syntax.
  3244. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified duration,
  3245. as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.
  3246. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  3247. supposed to be generated forever.
  3248. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3249. @item latency, l
  3250. Enable latency compensation, by default is disabled.
  3251. Only used if plugin have inputs.
  3252. @end table
  3253. @subsection Examples
  3254. @itemize
  3255. @item
  3256. List all available plugins within amp (LADSPA example plugin) library:
  3257. @example
  3258. ladspa=file=amp
  3259. @end example
  3260. @item
  3261. List all available controls and their valid ranges for @code{vcf_notch}
  3262. plugin from @code{VCF} library:
  3263. @example
  3264. ladspa=f=vcf:p=vcf_notch:c=help
  3265. @end example
  3266. @item
  3267. Simulate low quality audio equipment using @code{Computer Music Toolkit} (CMT)
  3268. plugin library:
  3269. @example
  3270. ladspa=file=cmt:plugin=lofi:controls=c0=22|c1=12|c2=12
  3271. @end example
  3272. @item
  3273. Add reverberation to the audio using TAP-plugins
  3274. (Tom's Audio Processing plugins):
  3275. @example
  3276. ladspa=file=tap_reverb:tap_reverb
  3277. @end example
  3278. @item
  3279. Generate white noise, with 0.2 amplitude:
  3280. @example
  3281. ladspa=file=cmt:noise_source_white:c=c0=.2
  3282. @end example
  3283. @item
  3284. Generate 20 bpm clicks using plugin @code{C* Click - Metronome} from the
  3285. @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3286. @example
  3287. ladspa=file=caps:Click:c=c1=20'
  3288. @end example
  3289. @item
  3290. Apply @code{C* Eq10X2 - Stereo 10-band equaliser} effect:
  3291. @example
  3292. ladspa=caps:Eq10X2:c=c0=-48|c9=-24|c3=12|c4=2
  3293. @end example
  3294. @item
  3295. Increase volume by 20dB using fast lookahead limiter from Steve Harris
  3296. @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
  3297. @example
  3298. ladspa=fast_lookahead_limiter_1913:fastLookaheadLimiter:20|0|2
  3299. @end example
  3300. @item
  3301. Attenuate low frequencies using Multiband EQ from Steve Harris
  3302. @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
  3303. @example
  3304. ladspa=mbeq_1197:mbeq:-24|-24|-24|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0
  3305. @end example
  3306. @item
  3307. Reduce stereo image using @code{Narrower} from the @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite}
  3308. (CAPS) library:
  3309. @example
  3310. ladspa=caps:Narrower
  3311. @end example
  3312. @item
  3313. Another white noise, now using @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3314. @example
  3315. ladspa=caps:White:.2
  3316. @end example
  3317. @item
  3318. Some fractal noise, using @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3319. @example
  3320. ladspa=caps:Fractal:c=c1=1
  3321. @end example
  3322. @item
  3323. Dynamic volume normalization using @code{VLevel} plugin:
  3324. @example
  3325. ladspa=vlevel-ladspa:vlevel_mono
  3326. @end example
  3327. @end itemize
  3328. @subsection Commands
  3329. This filter supports the following commands:
  3330. @table @option
  3331. @item cN
  3332. Modify the @var{N}-th control value.
  3333. If the specified value is not valid, it is ignored and prior one is kept.
  3334. @end table
  3335. @section loudnorm
  3336. EBU R128 loudness normalization. Includes both dynamic and linear normalization modes.
  3337. Support for both single pass (livestreams, files) and double pass (files) modes.
  3338. This algorithm can target IL, LRA, and maximum true peak. In dynamic mode, to accurately
  3339. detect true peaks, the audio stream will be upsampled to 192 kHz.
  3340. Use the @code{-ar} option or @code{aresample} filter to explicitly set an output sample rate.
  3341. The filter accepts the following options:
  3342. @table @option
  3343. @item I, i
  3344. Set integrated loudness target.
  3345. Range is -70.0 - -5.0. Default value is -24.0.
  3346. @item LRA, lra
  3347. Set loudness range target.
  3348. Range is 1.0 - 20.0. Default value is 7.0.
  3349. @item TP, tp
  3350. Set maximum true peak.
  3351. Range is -9.0 - +0.0. Default value is -2.0.
  3352. @item measured_I, measured_i
  3353. Measured IL of input file.
  3354. Range is -99.0 - +0.0.
  3355. @item measured_LRA, measured_lra
  3356. Measured LRA of input file.
  3357. Range is 0.0 - 99.0.
  3358. @item measured_TP, measured_tp
  3359. Measured true peak of input file.
  3360. Range is -99.0 - +99.0.
  3361. @item measured_thresh
  3362. Measured threshold of input file.
  3363. Range is -99.0 - +0.0.
  3364. @item offset
  3365. Set offset gain. Gain is applied before the true-peak limiter.
  3366. Range is -99.0 - +99.0. Default is +0.0.
  3367. @item linear
  3368. Normalize by linearly scaling the source audio.
  3369. @code{measured_I}, @code{measured_LRA}, @code{measured_TP},
  3370. and @code{measured_thresh} must all be specified. Target LRA shouldn't
  3371. be lower than source LRA and the change in integrated loudness shouldn't
  3372. result in a true peak which exceeds the target TP. If any of these
  3373. conditions aren't met, normalization mode will revert to @var{dynamic}.
  3374. Options are @code{true} or @code{false}. Default is @code{true}.
  3375. @item dual_mono
  3376. Treat mono input files as "dual-mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
  3377. on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
  3378. If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
  3379. Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
  3380. Options are true or false. Default is false.
  3381. @item print_format
  3382. Set print format for stats. Options are summary, json, or none.
  3383. Default value is none.
  3384. @end table
  3385. @section lowpass
  3386. Apply a low-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
  3387. The filter can be either single-pole or double-pole (the default).
  3388. The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
  3389. The filter accepts the following options:
  3390. @table @option
  3391. @item frequency, f
  3392. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 500.
  3393. @item poles, p
  3394. Set number of poles. Default is 2.
  3395. @item width_type, t
  3396. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  3397. @table @option
  3398. @item h
  3399. Hz
  3400. @item q
  3401. Q-Factor
  3402. @item o
  3403. octave
  3404. @item s
  3405. slope
  3406. @item k
  3407. kHz
  3408. @end table
  3409. @item width, w
  3410. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  3411. Applies only to double-pole filter.
  3412. The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
  3413. @item mix, m
  3414. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  3415. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3416. @item channels, c
  3417. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  3418. @item normalize, n
  3419. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  3420. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  3421. @end table
  3422. @subsection Examples
  3423. @itemize
  3424. @item
  3425. Lowpass only LFE channel, it LFE is not present it does nothing:
  3426. @example
  3427. lowpass=c=LFE
  3428. @end example
  3429. @end itemize
  3430. @subsection Commands
  3431. This filter supports the following commands:
  3432. @table @option
  3433. @item frequency, f
  3434. Change lowpass frequency.
  3435. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  3436. @item width_type, t
  3437. Change lowpass width_type.
  3438. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  3439. @item width, w
  3440. Change lowpass width.
  3441. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  3442. @item mix, m
  3443. Change lowpass mix.
  3444. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  3445. @end table
  3446. @section lv2
  3447. Load a LV2 (LADSPA Version 2) plugin.
  3448. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3449. @code{--enable-lv2}.
  3450. @table @option
  3451. @item plugin, p
  3452. Specifies the plugin URI. You may need to escape ':'.
  3453. @item controls, c
  3454. Set the '|' separated list of controls which are zero or more floating point
  3455. values that determine the behavior of the loaded plugin (for example delay,
  3456. threshold or gain).
  3457. If @option{controls} is set to @code{help}, all available controls and
  3458. their valid ranges are printed.
  3459. @item sample_rate, s
  3460. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100. Only used if plugin have
  3461. zero inputs.
  3462. @item nb_samples, n
  3463. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default
  3464. is 1024. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3465. @item duration, d
  3466. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  3467. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3468. for the accepted syntax.
  3469. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified duration,
  3470. as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.
  3471. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  3472. supposed to be generated forever.
  3473. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3474. @end table
  3475. @subsection Examples
  3476. @itemize
  3477. @item
  3478. Apply bass enhancer plugin from Calf:
  3479. @example
  3480. lv2=p=http\\\\://calf.sourceforge.net/plugins/BassEnhancer:c=amount=2
  3481. @end example
  3482. @item
  3483. Apply vinyl plugin from Calf:
  3484. @example
  3485. lv2=p=http\\\\://calf.sourceforge.net/plugins/Vinyl:c=drone=0.2|aging=0.5
  3486. @end example
  3487. @item
  3488. Apply bit crusher plugin from ArtyFX:
  3489. @example
  3490. lv2=p=http\\\\://www.openavproductions.com/artyfx#bitta:c=crush=0.3
  3491. @end example
  3492. @end itemize
  3493. @section mcompand
  3494. Multiband Compress or expand the audio's dynamic range.
  3495. The input audio is divided into bands using 4th order Linkwitz-Riley IIRs.
  3496. This is akin to the crossover of a loudspeaker, and results in flat frequency
  3497. response when absent compander action.
  3498. It accepts the following parameters:
  3499. @table @option
  3500. @item args
  3501. This option syntax is:
  3502. attack,decay,[attack,decay..] soft-knee points crossover_frequency [delay [initial_volume [gain]]] | attack,decay ...
  3503. For explanation of each item refer to compand filter documentation.
  3504. @end table
  3505. @anchor{pan}
  3506. @section pan
  3507. Mix channels with specific gain levels. The filter accepts the output
  3508. channel layout followed by a set of channels definitions.
  3509. This filter is also designed to efficiently remap the channels of an audio
  3510. stream.
  3511. The filter accepts parameters of the form:
  3512. "@var{l}|@var{outdef}|@var{outdef}|..."
  3513. @table @option
  3514. @item l
  3515. output channel layout or number of channels
  3516. @item outdef
  3517. output channel specification, of the form:
  3518. "@var{out_name}=[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}[(+-)[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}...]"
  3519. @item out_name
  3520. output channel to define, either a channel name (FL, FR, etc.) or a channel
  3521. number (c0, c1, etc.)
  3522. @item gain
  3523. multiplicative coefficient for the channel, 1 leaving the volume unchanged
  3524. @item in_name
  3525. input channel to use, see out_name for details; it is not possible to mix
  3526. named and numbered input channels
  3527. @end table
  3528. If the `=' in a channel specification is replaced by `<', then the gains for
  3529. that specification will be renormalized so that the total is 1, thus
  3530. avoiding clipping noise.
  3531. @subsection Mixing examples
  3532. For example, if you want to down-mix from stereo to mono, but with a bigger
  3533. factor for the left channel:
  3534. @example
  3535. pan=1c|c0=0.9*c0+0.1*c1
  3536. @end example
  3537. A customized down-mix to stereo that works automatically for 3-, 4-, 5- and
  3538. 7-channels surround:
  3539. @example
  3540. pan=stereo| FL < FL + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BL + 0.6*SL | FR < FR + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BR + 0.6*SR
  3541. @end example
  3542. Note that @command{ffmpeg} integrates a default down-mix (and up-mix) system
  3543. that should be preferred (see "-ac" option) unless you have very specific
  3544. needs.
  3545. @subsection Remapping examples
  3546. The channel remapping will be effective if, and only if:
  3547. @itemize
  3548. @item gain coefficients are zeroes or ones,
  3549. @item only one input per channel output,
  3550. @end itemize
  3551. If all these conditions are satisfied, the filter will notify the user ("Pure
  3552. channel mapping detected"), and use an optimized and lossless method to do the
  3553. remapping.
  3554. For example, if you have a 5.1 source and want a stereo audio stream by
  3555. dropping the extra channels:
  3556. @example
  3557. pan="stereo| c0=FL | c1=FR"
  3558. @end example
  3559. Given the same source, you can also switch front left and front right channels
  3560. and keep the input channel layout:
  3561. @example
  3562. pan="5.1| c0=c1 | c1=c0 | c2=c2 | c3=c3 | c4=c4 | c5=c5"
  3563. @end example
  3564. If the input is a stereo audio stream, you can mute the front left channel (and
  3565. still keep the stereo channel layout) with:
  3566. @example
  3567. pan="stereo|c1=c1"
  3568. @end example
  3569. Still with a stereo audio stream input, you can copy the right channel in both
  3570. front left and right:
  3571. @example
  3572. pan="stereo| c0=FR | c1=FR"
  3573. @end example
  3574. @section replaygain
  3575. ReplayGain scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream as an input and
  3576. outputs it unchanged.
  3577. At end of filtering it displays @code{track_gain} and @code{track_peak}.
  3578. @section resample
  3579. Convert the audio sample format, sample rate and channel layout. It is
  3580. not meant to be used directly.
  3581. @section rubberband
  3582. Apply time-stretching and pitch-shifting with librubberband.
  3583. To enable compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3584. @code{--enable-librubberband}.
  3585. The filter accepts the following options:
  3586. @table @option
  3587. @item tempo
  3588. Set tempo scale factor.
  3589. @item pitch
  3590. Set pitch scale factor.
  3591. @item transients
  3592. Set transients detector.
  3593. Possible values are:
  3594. @table @var
  3595. @item crisp
  3596. @item mixed
  3597. @item smooth
  3598. @end table
  3599. @item detector
  3600. Set detector.
  3601. Possible values are:
  3602. @table @var
  3603. @item compound
  3604. @item percussive
  3605. @item soft
  3606. @end table
  3607. @item phase
  3608. Set phase.
  3609. Possible values are:
  3610. @table @var
  3611. @item laminar
  3612. @item independent
  3613. @end table
  3614. @item window
  3615. Set processing window size.
  3616. Possible values are:
  3617. @table @var
  3618. @item standard
  3619. @item short
  3620. @item long
  3621. @end table
  3622. @item smoothing
  3623. Set smoothing.
  3624. Possible values are:
  3625. @table @var
  3626. @item off
  3627. @item on
  3628. @end table
  3629. @item formant
  3630. Enable formant preservation when shift pitching.
  3631. Possible values are:
  3632. @table @var
  3633. @item shifted
  3634. @item preserved
  3635. @end table
  3636. @item pitchq
  3637. Set pitch quality.
  3638. Possible values are:
  3639. @table @var
  3640. @item quality
  3641. @item speed
  3642. @item consistency
  3643. @end table
  3644. @item channels
  3645. Set channels.
  3646. Possible values are:
  3647. @table @var
  3648. @item apart
  3649. @item together
  3650. @end table
  3651. @end table
  3652. @subsection Commands
  3653. This filter supports the following commands:
  3654. @table @option
  3655. @item tempo
  3656. Change filter tempo scale factor.
  3657. Syntax for the command is : "@var{tempo}"
  3658. @item pitch
  3659. Change filter pitch scale factor.
  3660. Syntax for the command is : "@var{pitch}"
  3661. @end table
  3662. @section sidechaincompress
  3663. This filter acts like normal compressor but has the ability to compress
  3664. detected signal using second input signal.
  3665. It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
  3666. First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
  3667. The filtered signal then can be filtered with other filters in later stages of
  3668. processing. See @ref{pan} and @ref{amerge} filter.
  3669. The filter accepts the following options:
  3670. @table @option
  3671. @item level_in
  3672. Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  3673. @item mode
  3674. Set mode of compressor operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  3675. Default is @code{downward}.
  3676. @item threshold
  3677. If a signal of second stream raises above this level it will affect the gain
  3678. reduction of first stream.
  3679. By default is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
  3680. @item ratio
  3681. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
  3682. raised 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
  3683. Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
  3684. @item attack
  3685. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  3686. reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
  3687. @item release
  3688. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
  3689. reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
  3690. @item makeup
  3691. Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
  3692. Default is 1. Range is from 1 to 64.
  3693. @item knee
  3694. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  3695. Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
  3696. @item link
  3697. Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of side-chain stream
  3698. or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of side-chain stream affects the
  3699. reduction. Default is @code{average}.
  3700. @item detection
  3701. Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
  3702. of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mainly smoother.
  3703. @item level_sc
  3704. Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  3705. @item mix
  3706. How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
  3707. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3708. @end table
  3709. @subsection Commands
  3710. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  3711. @subsection Examples
  3712. @itemize
  3713. @item
  3714. Full ffmpeg example taking 2 audio inputs, 1st input to be compressed
  3715. depending on the signal of 2nd input and later compressed signal to be
  3716. merged with 2nd input:
  3717. @example
  3718. ffmpeg -i main.flac -i sidechain.flac -filter_complex "[1:a]asplit=2[sc][mix];[0:a][sc]sidechaincompress[compr];[compr][mix]amerge"
  3719. @end example
  3720. @end itemize
  3721. @section sidechaingate
  3722. A sidechain gate acts like a normal (wideband) gate but has the ability to
  3723. filter the detected signal before sending it to the gain reduction stage.
  3724. Normally a gate uses the full range signal to detect a level above the
  3725. threshold.
  3726. For example: If you cut all lower frequencies from your sidechain signal
  3727. the gate will decrease the volume of your track only if not enough highs
  3728. appear. With this technique you are able to reduce the resonation of a
  3729. natural drum or remove "rumbling" of muted strokes from a heavily distorted
  3730. guitar.
  3731. It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
  3732. First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
  3733. The filter accepts the following options:
  3734. @table @option
  3735. @item level_in
  3736. Set input level before filtering.
  3737. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3738. @item mode
  3739. Set the mode of operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  3740. Default is @code{downward}. If set to @code{upward} mode, higher parts of signal
  3741. will be amplified, expanding dynamic range in upward direction.
  3742. Otherwise, in case of @code{downward} lower parts of signal will be reduced.
  3743. @item range
  3744. Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
  3745. Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  3746. Setting this to 0 disables reduction and then filter behaves like expander.
  3747. @item threshold
  3748. If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
  3749. Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  3750. @item ratio
  3751. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced.
  3752. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
  3753. @item attack
  3754. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  3755. reduction stops.
  3756. Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  3757. @item release
  3758. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
  3759. reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
  3760. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  3761. @item makeup
  3762. Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
  3763. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  3764. @item knee
  3765. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  3766. Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
  3767. @item detection
  3768. Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
  3769. Default is rms. Can be peak or rms.
  3770. @item link
  3771. Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
  3772. the reduction.
  3773. Default is average. Can be average or maximum.
  3774. @item level_sc
  3775. Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3776. @end table
  3777. @section silencedetect
  3778. Detect silence in an audio stream.
  3779. This filter logs a message when it detects that the input audio volume is less
  3780. or equal to a noise tolerance value for a duration greater or equal to the
  3781. minimum detected noise duration.
  3782. The printed times and duration are expressed in seconds. The
  3783. @code{lavfi.silence_start} or @code{lavfi.silence_start.X} metadata key
  3784. is set on the first frame whose timestamp equals or exceeds the detection
  3785. duration and it contains the timestamp of the first frame of the silence.
  3786. The @code{lavfi.silence_duration} or @code{lavfi.silence_duration.X}
  3787. and @code{lavfi.silence_end} or @code{lavfi.silence_end.X} metadata
  3788. keys are set on the first frame after the silence. If @option{mono} is
  3789. enabled, and each channel is evaluated separately, the @code{.X}
  3790. suffixed keys are used, and @code{X} corresponds to the channel number.
  3791. The filter accepts the following options:
  3792. @table @option
  3793. @item noise, n
  3794. Set noise tolerance. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the
  3795. specified value) or amplitude ratio. Default is -60dB, or 0.001.
  3796. @item duration, d
  3797. Set silence duration until notification (default is 2 seconds). See
  3798. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3799. for the accepted syntax.
  3800. @item mono, m
  3801. Process each channel separately, instead of combined. By default is disabled.
  3802. @end table
  3803. @subsection Examples
  3804. @itemize
  3805. @item
  3806. Detect 5 seconds of silence with -50dB noise tolerance:
  3807. @example
  3808. silencedetect=n=-50dB:d=5
  3809. @end example
  3810. @item
  3811. Complete example with @command{ffmpeg} to detect silence with 0.0001 noise
  3812. tolerance in @file{silence.mp3}:
  3813. @example
  3814. ffmpeg -i silence.mp3 -af silencedetect=noise=0.0001 -f null -
  3815. @end example
  3816. @end itemize
  3817. @section silenceremove
  3818. Remove silence from the beginning, middle or end of the audio.
  3819. The filter accepts the following options:
  3820. @table @option
  3821. @item start_periods
  3822. This value is used to indicate if audio should be trimmed at beginning of
  3823. the audio. A value of zero indicates no silence should be trimmed from the
  3824. beginning. When specifying a non-zero value, it trims audio up until it
  3825. finds non-silence. Normally, when trimming silence from beginning of audio
  3826. the @var{start_periods} will be @code{1} but it can be increased to higher
  3827. values to trim all audio up to specific count of non-silence periods.
  3828. Default value is @code{0}.
  3829. @item start_duration
  3830. Specify the amount of time that non-silence must be detected before it stops
  3831. trimming audio. By increasing the duration, bursts of noises can be treated
  3832. as silence and trimmed off. Default value is @code{0}.
  3833. @item start_threshold
  3834. This indicates what sample value should be treated as silence. For digital
  3835. audio, a value of @code{0} may be fine but for audio recorded from analog,
  3836. you may wish to increase the value to account for background noise.
  3837. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
  3838. or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
  3839. @item start_silence
  3840. Specify max duration of silence at beginning that will be kept after
  3841. trimming. Default is 0, which is equal to trimming all samples detected
  3842. as silence.
  3843. @item start_mode
  3844. Specify mode of detection of silence end in start of multi-channel audio.
  3845. Can be @var{any} or @var{all}. Default is @var{any}.
  3846. With @var{any}, any sample that is detected as non-silence will cause
  3847. stopped trimming of silence.
  3848. With @var{all}, only if all channels are detected as non-silence will cause
  3849. stopped trimming of silence.
  3850. @item stop_periods
  3851. Set the count for trimming silence from the end of audio.
  3852. To remove silence from the middle of a file, specify a @var{stop_periods}
  3853. that is negative. This value is then treated as a positive value and is
  3854. used to indicate the effect should restart processing as specified by
  3855. @var{start_periods}, making it suitable for removing periods of silence
  3856. in the middle of the audio.
  3857. Default value is @code{0}.
  3858. @item stop_duration
  3859. Specify a duration of silence that must exist before audio is not copied any
  3860. more. By specifying a higher duration, silence that is wanted can be left in
  3861. the audio.
  3862. Default value is @code{0}.
  3863. @item stop_threshold
  3864. This is the same as @option{start_threshold} but for trimming silence from
  3865. the end of audio.
  3866. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
  3867. or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
  3868. @item stop_silence
  3869. Specify max duration of silence at end that will be kept after
  3870. trimming. Default is 0, which is equal to trimming all samples detected
  3871. as silence.
  3872. @item stop_mode
  3873. Specify mode of detection of silence start in end of multi-channel audio.
  3874. Can be @var{any} or @var{all}. Default is @var{any}.
  3875. With @var{any}, any sample that is detected as non-silence will cause
  3876. stopped trimming of silence.
  3877. With @var{all}, only if all channels are detected as non-silence will cause
  3878. stopped trimming of silence.
  3879. @item detection
  3880. Set how is silence detected. Can be @code{rms} or @code{peak}. Second is faster
  3881. and works better with digital silence which is exactly 0.
  3882. Default value is @code{rms}.
  3883. @item window
  3884. Set duration in number of seconds used to calculate size of window in number
  3885. of samples for detecting silence.
  3886. Default value is @code{0.02}. Allowed range is from @code{0} to @code{10}.
  3887. @end table
  3888. @subsection Examples
  3889. @itemize
  3890. @item
  3891. The following example shows how this filter can be used to start a recording
  3892. that does not contain the delay at the start which usually occurs between
  3893. pressing the record button and the start of the performance:
  3894. @example
  3895. silenceremove=start_periods=1:start_duration=5:start_threshold=0.02
  3896. @end example
  3897. @item
  3898. Trim all silence encountered from beginning to end where there is more than 1
  3899. second of silence in audio:
  3900. @example
  3901. silenceremove=stop_periods=-1:stop_duration=1:stop_threshold=-90dB
  3902. @end example
  3903. @item
  3904. Trim all digital silence samples, using peak detection, from beginning to end
  3905. where there is more than 0 samples of digital silence in audio and digital
  3906. silence is detected in all channels at same positions in stream:
  3907. @example
  3908. silenceremove=window=0:detection=peak:stop_mode=all:start_mode=all:stop_periods=-1:stop_threshold=0
  3909. @end example
  3910. @end itemize
  3911. @section sofalizer
  3912. SOFAlizer uses head-related transfer functions (HRTFs) to create virtual
  3913. loudspeakers around the user for binaural listening via headphones (audio
  3914. formats up to 9 channels supported).
  3915. The HRTFs are stored in SOFA files (see @url{http://www.sofacoustics.org/} for a database).
  3916. SOFAlizer is developed at the Acoustics Research Institute (ARI) of the
  3917. Austrian Academy of Sciences.
  3918. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3919. @code{--enable-libmysofa}.
  3920. The filter accepts the following options:
  3921. @table @option
  3922. @item sofa
  3923. Set the SOFA file used for rendering.
  3924. @item gain
  3925. Set gain applied to audio. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3926. @item rotation
  3927. Set rotation of virtual loudspeakers in deg. Default is 0.
  3928. @item elevation
  3929. Set elevation of virtual speakers in deg. Default is 0.
  3930. @item radius
  3931. Set distance in meters between loudspeakers and the listener with near-field
  3932. HRTFs. Default is 1.
  3933. @item type
  3934. Set processing type. Can be @var{time} or @var{freq}. @var{time} is
  3935. processing audio in time domain which is slow.
  3936. @var{freq} is processing audio in frequency domain which is fast.
  3937. Default is @var{freq}.
  3938. @item speakers
  3939. Set custom positions of virtual loudspeakers. Syntax for this option is:
  3940. <CH> <AZIM> <ELEV>[|<CH> <AZIM> <ELEV>|...].
  3941. Each virtual loudspeaker is described with short channel name following with
  3942. azimuth and elevation in degrees.
  3943. Each virtual loudspeaker description is separated by '|'.
  3944. For example to override front left and front right channel positions use:
  3945. 'speakers=FL 45 15|FR 345 15'.
  3946. Descriptions with unrecognised channel names are ignored.
  3947. @item lfegain
  3948. Set custom gain for LFE channels. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3949. @item framesize
  3950. Set custom frame size in number of samples. Default is 1024.
  3951. Allowed range is from 1024 to 96000. Only used if option @samp{type}
  3952. is set to @var{freq}.
  3953. @item normalize
  3954. Should all IRs be normalized upon importing SOFA file.
  3955. By default is enabled.
  3956. @item interpolate
  3957. Should nearest IRs be interpolated with neighbor IRs if exact position
  3958. does not match. By default is disabled.
  3959. @item minphase
  3960. Minphase all IRs upon loading of SOFA file. By default is disabled.
  3961. @item anglestep
  3962. Set neighbor search angle step. Only used if option @var{interpolate} is enabled.
  3963. @item radstep
  3964. Set neighbor search radius step. Only used if option @var{interpolate} is enabled.
  3965. @end table
  3966. @subsection Examples
  3967. @itemize
  3968. @item
  3969. Using ClubFritz6 sofa file:
  3970. @example
  3971. sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=1
  3972. @end example
  3973. @item
  3974. Using ClubFritz12 sofa file and bigger radius with small rotation:
  3975. @example
  3976. sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz12.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:rotation=5
  3977. @end example
  3978. @item
  3979. Similar as above but with custom speaker positions for front left, front right, back left and back right
  3980. and also with custom gain:
  3981. @example
  3982. "sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:speakers=FL 45|FR 315|BL 135|BR 225:gain=28"
  3983. @end example
  3984. @end itemize
  3985. @section stereotools
  3986. This filter has some handy utilities to manage stereo signals, for converting
  3987. M/S stereo recordings to L/R signal while having control over the parameters
  3988. or spreading the stereo image of master track.
  3989. The filter accepts the following options:
  3990. @table @option
  3991. @item level_in
  3992. Set input level before filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
  3993. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3994. @item level_out
  3995. Set output level after filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
  3996. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3997. @item balance_in
  3998. Set input balance between both channels. Default is 0.
  3999. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  4000. @item balance_out
  4001. Set output balance between both channels. Default is 0.
  4002. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  4003. @item softclip
  4004. Enable softclipping. Results in analog distortion instead of harsh digital 0dB
  4005. clipping. Disabled by default.
  4006. @item mutel
  4007. Mute the left channel. Disabled by default.
  4008. @item muter
  4009. Mute the right channel. Disabled by default.
  4010. @item phasel
  4011. Change the phase of the left channel. Disabled by default.
  4012. @item phaser
  4013. Change the phase of the right channel. Disabled by default.
  4014. @item mode
  4015. Set stereo mode. Available values are:
  4016. @table @samp
  4017. @item lr>lr
  4018. Left/Right to Left/Right, this is default.
  4019. @item lr>ms
  4020. Left/Right to Mid/Side.
  4021. @item ms>lr
  4022. Mid/Side to Left/Right.
  4023. @item lr>ll
  4024. Left/Right to Left/Left.
  4025. @item lr>rr
  4026. Left/Right to Right/Right.
  4027. @item lr>l+r
  4028. Left/Right to Left + Right.
  4029. @item lr>rl
  4030. Left/Right to Right/Left.
  4031. @item ms>ll
  4032. Mid/Side to Left/Left.
  4033. @item ms>rr
  4034. Mid/Side to Right/Right.
  4035. @end table
  4036. @item slev
  4037. Set level of side signal. Default is 1.
  4038. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  4039. @item sbal
  4040. Set balance of side signal. Default is 0.
  4041. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  4042. @item mlev
  4043. Set level of the middle signal. Default is 1.
  4044. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  4045. @item mpan
  4046. Set middle signal pan. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  4047. @item base
  4048. Set stereo base between mono and inversed channels. Default is 0.
  4049. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  4050. @item delay
  4051. Set delay in milliseconds how much to delay left from right channel and
  4052. vice versa. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -20 to 20.
  4053. @item sclevel
  4054. Set S/C level. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 100.
  4055. @item phase
  4056. Set the stereo phase in degrees. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 360.
  4057. @item bmode_in, bmode_out
  4058. Set balance mode for balance_in/balance_out option.
  4059. Can be one of the following:
  4060. @table @samp
  4061. @item balance
  4062. Classic balance mode. Attenuate one channel at time.
  4063. Gain is raised up to 1.
  4064. @item amplitude
  4065. Similar as classic mode above but gain is raised up to 2.
  4066. @item power
  4067. Equal power distribution, from -6dB to +6dB range.
  4068. @end table
  4069. @end table
  4070. @subsection Examples
  4071. @itemize
  4072. @item
  4073. Apply karaoke like effect:
  4074. @example
  4075. stereotools=mlev=0.015625
  4076. @end example
  4077. @item
  4078. Convert M/S signal to L/R:
  4079. @example
  4080. "stereotools=mode=ms>lr"
  4081. @end example
  4082. @end itemize
  4083. @section stereowiden
  4084. This filter enhance the stereo effect by suppressing signal common to both
  4085. channels and by delaying the signal of left into right and vice versa,
  4086. thereby widening the stereo effect.
  4087. The filter accepts the following options:
  4088. @table @option
  4089. @item delay
  4090. Time in milliseconds of the delay of left signal into right and vice versa.
  4091. Default is 20 milliseconds.
  4092. @item feedback
  4093. Amount of gain in delayed signal into right and vice versa. Gives a delay
  4094. effect of left signal in right output and vice versa which gives widening
  4095. effect. Default is 0.3.
  4096. @item crossfeed
  4097. Cross feed of left into right with inverted phase. This helps in suppressing
  4098. the mono. If the value is 1 it will cancel all the signal common to both
  4099. channels. Default is 0.3.
  4100. @item drymix
  4101. Set level of input signal of original channel. Default is 0.8.
  4102. @end table
  4103. @subsection Commands
  4104. This filter supports the all above options except @code{delay} as @ref{commands}.
  4105. @section superequalizer
  4106. Apply 18 band equalizer.
  4107. The filter accepts the following options:
  4108. @table @option
  4109. @item 1b
  4110. Set 65Hz band gain.
  4111. @item 2b
  4112. Set 92Hz band gain.
  4113. @item 3b
  4114. Set 131Hz band gain.
  4115. @item 4b
  4116. Set 185Hz band gain.
  4117. @item 5b
  4118. Set 262Hz band gain.
  4119. @item 6b
  4120. Set 370Hz band gain.
  4121. @item 7b
  4122. Set 523Hz band gain.
  4123. @item 8b
  4124. Set 740Hz band gain.
  4125. @item 9b
  4126. Set 1047Hz band gain.
  4127. @item 10b
  4128. Set 1480Hz band gain.
  4129. @item 11b
  4130. Set 2093Hz band gain.
  4131. @item 12b
  4132. Set 2960Hz band gain.
  4133. @item 13b
  4134. Set 4186Hz band gain.
  4135. @item 14b
  4136. Set 5920Hz band gain.
  4137. @item 15b
  4138. Set 8372Hz band gain.
  4139. @item 16b
  4140. Set 11840Hz band gain.
  4141. @item 17b
  4142. Set 16744Hz band gain.
  4143. @item 18b
  4144. Set 20000Hz band gain.
  4145. @end table
  4146. @section surround
  4147. Apply audio surround upmix filter.
  4148. This filter allows to produce multichannel output from audio stream.
  4149. The filter accepts the following options:
  4150. @table @option
  4151. @item chl_out
  4152. Set output channel layout. By default, this is @var{5.1}.
  4153. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4154. for the required syntax.
  4155. @item chl_in
  4156. Set input channel layout. By default, this is @var{stereo}.
  4157. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4158. for the required syntax.
  4159. @item level_in
  4160. Set input volume level. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4161. @item level_out
  4162. Set output volume level. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4163. @item lfe
  4164. Enable LFE channel output if output channel layout has it. By default, this is enabled.
  4165. @item lfe_low
  4166. Set LFE low cut off frequency. By default, this is @var{128} Hz.
  4167. @item lfe_high
  4168. Set LFE high cut off frequency. By default, this is @var{256} Hz.
  4169. @item lfe_mode
  4170. Set LFE mode, can be @var{add} or @var{sub}. Default is @var{add}.
  4171. In @var{add} mode, LFE channel is created from input audio and added to output.
  4172. In @var{sub} mode, LFE channel is created from input audio and added to output but
  4173. also all non-LFE output channels are subtracted with output LFE channel.
  4174. @item angle
  4175. Set angle of stereo surround transform, Allowed range is from @var{0} to @var{360}.
  4176. Default is @var{90}.
  4177. @item fc_in
  4178. Set front center input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4179. @item fc_out
  4180. Set front center output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4181. @item fl_in
  4182. Set front left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4183. @item fl_out
  4184. Set front left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4185. @item fr_in
  4186. Set front right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4187. @item fr_out
  4188. Set front right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4189. @item sl_in
  4190. Set side left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4191. @item sl_out
  4192. Set side left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4193. @item sr_in
  4194. Set side right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4195. @item sr_out
  4196. Set side right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4197. @item bl_in
  4198. Set back left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4199. @item bl_out
  4200. Set back left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4201. @item br_in
  4202. Set back right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4203. @item br_out
  4204. Set back right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4205. @item bc_in
  4206. Set back center input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4207. @item bc_out
  4208. Set back center output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4209. @item lfe_in
  4210. Set LFE input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4211. @item lfe_out
  4212. Set LFE output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4213. @item allx
  4214. Set spread usage of stereo image across X axis for all channels.
  4215. @item ally
  4216. Set spread usage of stereo image across Y axis for all channels.
  4217. @item fcx, flx, frx, blx, brx, slx, srx, bcx
  4218. Set spread usage of stereo image across X axis for each channel.
  4219. @item fcy, fly, fry, bly, bry, sly, sry, bcy
  4220. Set spread usage of stereo image across Y axis for each channel.
  4221. @item win_size
  4222. Set window size. Allowed range is from @var{1024} to @var{65536}. Default size is @var{4096}.
  4223. @item win_func
  4224. Set window function.
  4225. It accepts the following values:
  4226. @table @samp
  4227. @item rect
  4228. @item bartlett
  4229. @item hann, hanning
  4230. @item hamming
  4231. @item blackman
  4232. @item welch
  4233. @item flattop
  4234. @item bharris
  4235. @item bnuttall
  4236. @item bhann
  4237. @item sine
  4238. @item nuttall
  4239. @item lanczos
  4240. @item gauss
  4241. @item tukey
  4242. @item dolph
  4243. @item cauchy
  4244. @item parzen
  4245. @item poisson
  4246. @item bohman
  4247. @end table
  4248. Default is @code{hann}.
  4249. @item overlap
  4250. Set window overlap. If set to 1, the recommended overlap for selected
  4251. window function will be picked. Default is @code{0.5}.
  4252. @end table
  4253. @section treble, highshelf
  4254. Boost or cut treble (upper) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
  4255. shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
  4256. hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
  4257. The filter accepts the following options:
  4258. @table @option
  4259. @item gain, g
  4260. Give the gain at whichever is the lower of ~22 kHz and the
  4261. Nyquist frequency. Its useful range is about -20 (for a large cut)
  4262. to +20 (for a large boost). Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  4263. @item frequency, f
  4264. Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
  4265. to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
  4266. The default value is @code{3000} Hz.
  4267. @item width_type, t
  4268. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  4269. @table @option
  4270. @item h
  4271. Hz
  4272. @item q
  4273. Q-Factor
  4274. @item o
  4275. octave
  4276. @item s
  4277. slope
  4278. @item k
  4279. kHz
  4280. @end table
  4281. @item width, w
  4282. Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
  4283. @item mix, m
  4284. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  4285. Range is between 0 and 1.
  4286. @item channels, c
  4287. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  4288. @item normalize, n
  4289. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  4290. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  4291. @end table
  4292. @subsection Commands
  4293. This filter supports the following commands:
  4294. @table @option
  4295. @item frequency, f
  4296. Change treble frequency.
  4297. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  4298. @item width_type, t
  4299. Change treble width_type.
  4300. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  4301. @item width, w
  4302. Change treble width.
  4303. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  4304. @item gain, g
  4305. Change treble gain.
  4306. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  4307. @item mix, m
  4308. Change treble mix.
  4309. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  4310. @end table
  4311. @section tremolo
  4312. Sinusoidal amplitude modulation.
  4313. The filter accepts the following options:
  4314. @table @option
  4315. @item f
  4316. Modulation frequency in Hertz. Modulation frequencies in the subharmonic range
  4317. (20 Hz or lower) will result in a tremolo effect.
  4318. This filter may also be used as a ring modulator by specifying
  4319. a modulation frequency higher than 20 Hz.
  4320. Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
  4321. @item d
  4322. Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
  4323. Default value is 0.5.
  4324. @end table
  4325. @section vibrato
  4326. Sinusoidal phase modulation.
  4327. The filter accepts the following options:
  4328. @table @option
  4329. @item f
  4330. Modulation frequency in Hertz.
  4331. Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
  4332. @item d
  4333. Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
  4334. Default value is 0.5.
  4335. @end table
  4336. @section volume
  4337. Adjust the input audio volume.
  4338. It accepts the following parameters:
  4339. @table @option
  4340. @item volume
  4341. Set audio volume expression.
  4342. Output values are clipped to the maximum value.
  4343. The output audio volume is given by the relation:
  4344. @example
  4345. @var{output_volume} = @var{volume} * @var{input_volume}
  4346. @end example
  4347. The default value for @var{volume} is "1.0".
  4348. @item precision
  4349. This parameter represents the mathematical precision.
  4350. It determines which input sample formats will be allowed, which affects the
  4351. precision of the volume scaling.
  4352. @table @option
  4353. @item fixed
  4354. 8-bit fixed-point; this limits input sample format to U8, S16, and S32.
  4355. @item float
  4356. 32-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to FLT. (default)
  4357. @item double
  4358. 64-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to DBL.
  4359. @end table
  4360. @item replaygain
  4361. Choose the behaviour on encountering ReplayGain side data in input frames.
  4362. @table @option
  4363. @item drop
  4364. Remove ReplayGain side data, ignoring its contents (the default).
  4365. @item ignore
  4366. Ignore ReplayGain side data, but leave it in the frame.
  4367. @item track
  4368. Prefer the track gain, if present.
  4369. @item album
  4370. Prefer the album gain, if present.
  4371. @end table
  4372. @item replaygain_preamp
  4373. Pre-amplification gain in dB to apply to the selected replaygain gain.
  4374. Default value for @var{replaygain_preamp} is 0.0.
  4375. @item replaygain_noclip
  4376. Prevent clipping by limiting the gain applied.
  4377. Default value for @var{replaygain_noclip} is 1.
  4378. @item eval
  4379. Set when the volume expression is evaluated.
  4380. It accepts the following values:
  4381. @table @samp
  4382. @item once
  4383. only evaluate expression once during the filter initialization, or
  4384. when the @samp{volume} command is sent
  4385. @item frame
  4386. evaluate expression for each incoming frame
  4387. @end table
  4388. Default value is @samp{once}.
  4389. @end table
  4390. The volume expression can contain the following parameters.
  4391. @table @option
  4392. @item n
  4393. frame number (starting at zero)
  4394. @item nb_channels
  4395. number of channels
  4396. @item nb_consumed_samples
  4397. number of samples consumed by the filter
  4398. @item nb_samples
  4399. number of samples in the current frame
  4400. @item pos
  4401. original frame position in the file
  4402. @item pts
  4403. frame PTS
  4404. @item sample_rate
  4405. sample rate
  4406. @item startpts
  4407. PTS at start of stream
  4408. @item startt
  4409. time at start of stream
  4410. @item t
  4411. frame time
  4412. @item tb
  4413. timestamp timebase
  4414. @item volume
  4415. last set volume value
  4416. @end table
  4417. Note that when @option{eval} is set to @samp{once} only the
  4418. @var{sample_rate} and @var{tb} variables are available, all other
  4419. variables will evaluate to NAN.
  4420. @subsection Commands
  4421. This filter supports the following commands:
  4422. @table @option
  4423. @item volume
  4424. Modify the volume expression.
  4425. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  4426. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  4427. value.
  4428. @end table
  4429. @subsection Examples
  4430. @itemize
  4431. @item
  4432. Halve the input audio volume:
  4433. @example
  4434. volume=volume=0.5
  4435. volume=volume=1/2
  4436. volume=volume=-6.0206dB
  4437. @end example
  4438. In all the above example the named key for @option{volume} can be
  4439. omitted, for example like in:
  4440. @example
  4441. volume=0.5
  4442. @end example
  4443. @item
  4444. Increase input audio power by 6 decibels using fixed-point precision:
  4445. @example
  4446. volume=volume=6dB:precision=fixed
  4447. @end example
  4448. @item
  4449. Fade volume after time 10 with an annihilation period of 5 seconds:
  4450. @example
  4451. volume='if(lt(t,10),1,max(1-(t-10)/5,0))':eval=frame
  4452. @end example
  4453. @end itemize
  4454. @section volumedetect
  4455. Detect the volume of the input video.
  4456. The filter has no parameters. The input is not modified. Statistics about
  4457. the volume will be printed in the log when the input stream end is reached.
  4458. In particular it will show the mean volume (root mean square), maximum
  4459. volume (on a per-sample basis), and the beginning of a histogram of the
  4460. registered volume values (from the maximum value to a cumulated 1/1000 of
  4461. the samples).
  4462. All volumes are in decibels relative to the maximum PCM value.
  4463. @subsection Examples
  4464. Here is an excerpt of the output:
  4465. @example
  4466. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] mean_volume: -27 dB
  4467. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] max_volume: -4 dB
  4468. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_4db: 6
  4469. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_5db: 62
  4470. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_6db: 286
  4471. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_7db: 1042
  4472. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_8db: 2551
  4473. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_9db: 4609
  4474. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_10db: 8409
  4475. @end example
  4476. It means that:
  4477. @itemize
  4478. @item
  4479. The mean square energy is approximately -27 dB, or 10^-2.7.
  4480. @item
  4481. The largest sample is at -4 dB, or more precisely between -4 dB and -5 dB.
  4482. @item
  4483. There are 6 samples at -4 dB, 62 at -5 dB, 286 at -6 dB, etc.
  4484. @end itemize
  4485. In other words, raising the volume by +4 dB does not cause any clipping,
  4486. raising it by +5 dB causes clipping for 6 samples, etc.
  4487. @c man end AUDIO FILTERS
  4488. @chapter Audio Sources
  4489. @c man begin AUDIO SOURCES
  4490. Below is a description of the currently available audio sources.
  4491. @section abuffer
  4492. Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
  4493. This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
  4494. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/asrc_abuffer.h}.
  4495. It accepts the following parameters:
  4496. @table @option
  4497. @item time_base
  4498. The timebase which will be used for timestamps of submitted frames. It must be
  4499. either a floating-point number or in @var{numerator}/@var{denominator} form.
  4500. @item sample_rate
  4501. The sample rate of the incoming audio buffers.
  4502. @item sample_fmt
  4503. The sample format of the incoming audio buffers.
  4504. Either a sample format name or its corresponding integer representation from
  4505. the enum AVSampleFormat in @file{libavutil/samplefmt.h}
  4506. @item channel_layout
  4507. The channel layout of the incoming audio buffers.
  4508. Either a channel layout name from channel_layout_map in
  4509. @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} or its corresponding integer representation
  4510. from the AV_CH_LAYOUT_* macros in @file{libavutil/channel_layout.h}
  4511. @item channels
  4512. The number of channels of the incoming audio buffers.
  4513. If both @var{channels} and @var{channel_layout} are specified, then they
  4514. must be consistent.
  4515. @end table
  4516. @subsection Examples
  4517. @example
  4518. abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=s16p:channel_layout=stereo
  4519. @end example
  4520. will instruct the source to accept planar 16bit signed stereo at 44100Hz.
  4521. Since the sample format with name "s16p" corresponds to the number
  4522. 6 and the "stereo" channel layout corresponds to the value 0x3, this is
  4523. equivalent to:
  4524. @example
  4525. abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=6:channel_layout=0x3
  4526. @end example
  4527. @section aevalsrc
  4528. Generate an audio signal specified by an expression.
  4529. This source accepts in input one or more expressions (one for each
  4530. channel), which are evaluated and used to generate a corresponding
  4531. audio signal.
  4532. This source accepts the following options:
  4533. @table @option
  4534. @item exprs
  4535. Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. In case the
  4536. @option{channel_layout} option is not specified, the selected channel layout
  4537. depends on the number of provided expressions. Otherwise the last
  4538. specified expression is applied to the remaining output channels.
  4539. @item channel_layout, c
  4540. Set the channel layout. The number of channels in the specified layout
  4541. must be equal to the number of specified expressions.
  4542. @item duration, d
  4543. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  4544. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4545. for the accepted syntax.
  4546. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified
  4547. duration, as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a
  4548. complete frame.
  4549. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  4550. supposed to be generated forever.
  4551. @item nb_samples, n
  4552. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame,
  4553. default to 1024.
  4554. @item sample_rate, s
  4555. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100.
  4556. @end table
  4557. Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants:
  4558. @table @option
  4559. @item n
  4560. number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
  4561. @item t
  4562. time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds, starting from 0
  4563. @item s
  4564. sample rate
  4565. @end table
  4566. @subsection Examples
  4567. @itemize
  4568. @item
  4569. Generate silence:
  4570. @example
  4571. aevalsrc=0
  4572. @end example
  4573. @item
  4574. Generate a sin signal with frequency of 440 Hz, set sample rate to
  4575. 8000 Hz:
  4576. @example
  4577. aevalsrc="sin(440*2*PI*t):s=8000"
  4578. @end example
  4579. @item
  4580. Generate a two channels signal, specify the channel layout (Front
  4581. Center + Back Center) explicitly:
  4582. @example
  4583. aevalsrc="sin(420*2*PI*t)|cos(430*2*PI*t):c=FC|BC"
  4584. @end example
  4585. @item
  4586. Generate white noise:
  4587. @example
  4588. aevalsrc="-2+random(0)"
  4589. @end example
  4590. @item
  4591. Generate an amplitude modulated signal:
  4592. @example
  4593. aevalsrc="sin(10*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t)"
  4594. @end example
  4595. @item
  4596. Generate 2.5 Hz binaural beats on a 360 Hz carrier:
  4597. @example
  4598. aevalsrc="0.1*sin(2*PI*(360-2.5/2)*t) | 0.1*sin(2*PI*(360+2.5/2)*t)"
  4599. @end example
  4600. @end itemize
  4601. @section afirsrc
  4602. Generate a FIR coefficients using frequency sampling method.
  4603. The resulting stream can be used with @ref{afir} filter for filtering the audio signal.
  4604. The filter accepts the following options:
  4605. @table @option
  4606. @item taps, t
  4607. Set number of filter coefficents in output audio stream.
  4608. Default value is 1025.
  4609. @item frequency, f
  4610. Set frequency points from where magnitude and phase are set.
  4611. This must be in non decreasing order, and first element must be 0, while last element
  4612. must be 1. Elements are separated by white spaces.
  4613. @item magnitude, m
  4614. Set magnitude value for every frequency point set by @option{frequency}.
  4615. Number of values must be same as number of frequency points.
  4616. Values are separated by white spaces.
  4617. @item phase, p
  4618. Set phase value for every frequency point set by @option{frequency}.
  4619. Number of values must be same as number of frequency points.
  4620. Values are separated by white spaces.
  4621. @item sample_rate, r
  4622. Set sample rate, default is 44100.
  4623. @item nb_samples, n
  4624. Set number of samples per each frame. Default is 1024.
  4625. @item win_func, w
  4626. Set window function. Default is blackman.
  4627. @end table
  4628. @section anullsrc
  4629. The null audio source, return unprocessed audio frames. It is mainly useful
  4630. as a template and to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as
  4631. the source for filters which ignore the input data (for example the sox
  4632. synth filter).
  4633. This source accepts the following options:
  4634. @table @option
  4635. @item channel_layout, cl
  4636. Specifies the channel layout, and can be either an integer or a string
  4637. representing a channel layout. The default value of @var{channel_layout}
  4638. is "stereo".
  4639. Check the channel_layout_map definition in
  4640. @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} for the mapping between strings and
  4641. channel layout values.
  4642. @item sample_rate, r
  4643. Specifies the sample rate, and defaults to 44100.
  4644. @item nb_samples, n
  4645. Set the number of samples per requested frames.
  4646. @end table
  4647. @subsection Examples
  4648. @itemize
  4649. @item
  4650. Set the sample rate to 48000 Hz and the channel layout to AV_CH_LAYOUT_MONO.
  4651. @example
  4652. anullsrc=r=48000:cl=4
  4653. @end example
  4654. @item
  4655. Do the same operation with a more obvious syntax:
  4656. @example
  4657. anullsrc=r=48000:cl=mono
  4658. @end example
  4659. @end itemize
  4660. All the parameters need to be explicitly defined.
  4661. @section flite
  4662. Synthesize a voice utterance using the libflite library.
  4663. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  4664. @code{--enable-libflite}.
  4665. Note that versions of the flite library prior to 2.0 are not thread-safe.
  4666. The filter accepts the following options:
  4667. @table @option
  4668. @item list_voices
  4669. If set to 1, list the names of the available voices and exit
  4670. immediately. Default value is 0.
  4671. @item nb_samples, n
  4672. Set the maximum number of samples per frame. Default value is 512.
  4673. @item textfile
  4674. Set the filename containing the text to speak.
  4675. @item text
  4676. Set the text to speak.
  4677. @item voice, v
  4678. Set the voice to use for the speech synthesis. Default value is
  4679. @code{kal}. See also the @var{list_voices} option.
  4680. @end table
  4681. @subsection Examples
  4682. @itemize
  4683. @item
  4684. Read from file @file{speech.txt}, and synthesize the text using the
  4685. standard flite voice:
  4686. @example
  4687. flite=textfile=speech.txt
  4688. @end example
  4689. @item
  4690. Read the specified text selecting the @code{slt} voice:
  4691. @example
  4692. flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
  4693. @end example
  4694. @item
  4695. Input text to ffmpeg:
  4696. @example
  4697. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
  4698. @end example
  4699. @item
  4700. Make @file{ffplay} speak the specified text, using @code{flite} and
  4701. the @code{lavfi} device:
  4702. @example
  4703. ffplay -f lavfi flite=text='No more be grieved for which that thou hast done.'
  4704. @end example
  4705. @end itemize
  4706. For more information about libflite, check:
  4707. @url{http://www.festvox.org/flite/}
  4708. @section anoisesrc
  4709. Generate a noise audio signal.
  4710. The filter accepts the following options:
  4711. @table @option
  4712. @item sample_rate, r
  4713. Specify the sample rate. Default value is 48000 Hz.
  4714. @item amplitude, a
  4715. Specify the amplitude (0.0 - 1.0) of the generated audio stream. Default value
  4716. is 1.0.
  4717. @item duration, d
  4718. Specify the duration of the generated audio stream. Not specifying this option
  4719. results in noise with an infinite length.
  4720. @item color, colour, c
  4721. Specify the color of noise. Available noise colors are white, pink, brown,
  4722. blue, violet and velvet. Default color is white.
  4723. @item seed, s
  4724. Specify a value used to seed the PRNG.
  4725. @item nb_samples, n
  4726. Set the number of samples per each output frame, default is 1024.
  4727. @end table
  4728. @subsection Examples
  4729. @itemize
  4730. @item
  4731. Generate 60 seconds of pink noise, with a 44.1 kHz sampling rate and an amplitude of 0.5:
  4732. @example
  4733. anoisesrc=d=60:c=pink:r=44100:a=0.5
  4734. @end example
  4735. @end itemize
  4736. @section hilbert
  4737. Generate odd-tap Hilbert transform FIR coefficients.
  4738. The resulting stream can be used with @ref{afir} filter for phase-shifting
  4739. the signal by 90 degrees.
  4740. This is used in many matrix coding schemes and for analytic signal generation.
  4741. The process is often written as a multiplication by i (or j), the imaginary unit.
  4742. The filter accepts the following options:
  4743. @table @option
  4744. @item sample_rate, s
  4745. Set sample rate, default is 44100.
  4746. @item taps, t
  4747. Set length of FIR filter, default is 22051.
  4748. @item nb_samples, n
  4749. Set number of samples per each frame.
  4750. @item win_func, w
  4751. Set window function to be used when generating FIR coefficients.
  4752. @end table
  4753. @section sinc
  4754. Generate a sinc kaiser-windowed low-pass, high-pass, band-pass, or band-reject FIR coefficients.
  4755. The resulting stream can be used with @ref{afir} filter for filtering the audio signal.
  4756. The filter accepts the following options:
  4757. @table @option
  4758. @item sample_rate, r
  4759. Set sample rate, default is 44100.
  4760. @item nb_samples, n
  4761. Set number of samples per each frame. Default is 1024.
  4762. @item hp
  4763. Set high-pass frequency. Default is 0.
  4764. @item lp
  4765. Set low-pass frequency. Default is 0.
  4766. If high-pass frequency is lower than low-pass frequency and low-pass frequency
  4767. is higher than 0 then filter will create band-pass filter coefficients,
  4768. otherwise band-reject filter coefficients.
  4769. @item phase
  4770. Set filter phase response. Default is 50. Allowed range is from 0 to 100.
  4771. @item beta
  4772. Set Kaiser window beta.
  4773. @item att
  4774. Set stop-band attenuation. Default is 120dB, allowed range is from 40 to 180 dB.
  4775. @item round
  4776. Enable rounding, by default is disabled.
  4777. @item hptaps
  4778. Set number of taps for high-pass filter.
  4779. @item lptaps
  4780. Set number of taps for low-pass filter.
  4781. @end table
  4782. @section sine
  4783. Generate an audio signal made of a sine wave with amplitude 1/8.
  4784. The audio signal is bit-exact.
  4785. The filter accepts the following options:
  4786. @table @option
  4787. @item frequency, f
  4788. Set the carrier frequency. Default is 440 Hz.
  4789. @item beep_factor, b
  4790. Enable a periodic beep every second with frequency @var{beep_factor} times
  4791. the carrier frequency. Default is 0, meaning the beep is disabled.
  4792. @item sample_rate, r
  4793. Specify the sample rate, default is 44100.
  4794. @item duration, d
  4795. Specify the duration of the generated audio stream.
  4796. @item samples_per_frame
  4797. Set the number of samples per output frame.
  4798. The expression can contain the following constants:
  4799. @table @option
  4800. @item n
  4801. The (sequential) number of the output audio frame, starting from 0.
  4802. @item pts
  4803. The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the output audio frame,
  4804. expressed in @var{TB} units.
  4805. @item t
  4806. The PTS of the output audio frame, expressed in seconds.
  4807. @item TB
  4808. The timebase of the output audio frames.
  4809. @end table
  4810. Default is @code{1024}.
  4811. @end table
  4812. @subsection Examples
  4813. @itemize
  4814. @item
  4815. Generate a simple 440 Hz sine wave:
  4816. @example
  4817. sine
  4818. @end example
  4819. @item
  4820. Generate a 220 Hz sine wave with a 880 Hz beep each second, for 5 seconds:
  4821. @example
  4822. sine=220:4:d=5
  4823. sine=f=220:b=4:d=5
  4824. sine=frequency=220:beep_factor=4:duration=5
  4825. @end example
  4826. @item
  4827. Generate a 1 kHz sine wave following @code{1602,1601,1602,1601,1602} NTSC
  4828. pattern:
  4829. @example
  4830. sine=1000:samples_per_frame='st(0,mod(n,5)); 1602-not(not(eq(ld(0),1)+eq(ld(0),3)))'
  4831. @end example
  4832. @end itemize
  4833. @c man end AUDIO SOURCES
  4834. @chapter Audio Sinks
  4835. @c man begin AUDIO SINKS
  4836. Below is a description of the currently available audio sinks.
  4837. @section abuffersink
  4838. Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the end of filter chain.
  4839. This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
  4840. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
  4841. or the options system.
  4842. It accepts a pointer to an AVABufferSinkContext structure, which
  4843. defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
  4844. parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
  4845. @section anullsink
  4846. Null audio sink; do absolutely nothing with the input audio. It is
  4847. mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
  4848. tools.
  4849. @c man end AUDIO SINKS
  4850. @chapter Video Filters
  4851. @c man begin VIDEO FILTERS
  4852. When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
  4853. existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
  4854. The configure output will show the video filters included in your
  4855. build.
  4856. Below is a description of the currently available video filters.
  4857. @section addroi
  4858. Mark a region of interest in a video frame.
  4859. The frame data is passed through unchanged, but metadata is attached
  4860. to the frame indicating regions of interest which can affect the
  4861. behaviour of later encoding. Multiple regions can be marked by
  4862. applying the filter multiple times.
  4863. @table @option
  4864. @item x
  4865. Region distance in pixels from the left edge of the frame.
  4866. @item y
  4867. Region distance in pixels from the top edge of the frame.
  4868. @item w
  4869. Region width in pixels.
  4870. @item h
  4871. Region height in pixels.
  4872. The parameters @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} are expressions,
  4873. and may contain the following variables:
  4874. @table @option
  4875. @item iw
  4876. Width of the input frame.
  4877. @item ih
  4878. Height of the input frame.
  4879. @end table
  4880. @item qoffset
  4881. Quantisation offset to apply within the region.
  4882. This must be a real value in the range -1 to +1. A value of zero
  4883. indicates no quality change. A negative value asks for better quality
  4884. (less quantisation), while a positive value asks for worse quality
  4885. (greater quantisation).
  4886. The range is calibrated so that the extreme values indicate the
  4887. largest possible offset - if the rest of the frame is encoded with the
  4888. worst possible quality, an offset of -1 indicates that this region
  4889. should be encoded with the best possible quality anyway. Intermediate
  4890. values are then interpolated in some codec-dependent way.
  4891. For example, in 10-bit H.264 the quantisation parameter varies between
  4892. -12 and 51. A typical qoffset value of -1/10 therefore indicates that
  4893. this region should be encoded with a QP around one-tenth of the full
  4894. range better than the rest of the frame. So, if most of the frame
  4895. were to be encoded with a QP of around 30, this region would get a QP
  4896. of around 24 (an offset of approximately -1/10 * (51 - -12) = -6.3).
  4897. An extreme value of -1 would indicate that this region should be
  4898. encoded with the best possible quality regardless of the treatment of
  4899. the rest of the frame - that is, should be encoded at a QP of -12.
  4900. @item clear
  4901. If set to true, remove any existing regions of interest marked on the
  4902. frame before adding the new one.
  4903. @end table
  4904. @subsection Examples
  4905. @itemize
  4906. @item
  4907. Mark the centre quarter of the frame as interesting.
  4908. @example
  4909. addroi=iw/4:ih/4:iw/2:ih/2:-1/10
  4910. @end example
  4911. @item
  4912. Mark the 100-pixel-wide region on the left edge of the frame as very
  4913. uninteresting (to be encoded at much lower quality than the rest of
  4914. the frame).
  4915. @example
  4916. addroi=0:0:100:ih:+1/5
  4917. @end example
  4918. @end itemize
  4919. @section alphaextract
  4920. Extract the alpha component from the input as a grayscale video. This
  4921. is especially useful with the @var{alphamerge} filter.
  4922. @section alphamerge
  4923. Add or replace the alpha component of the primary input with the
  4924. grayscale value of a second input. This is intended for use with
  4925. @var{alphaextract} to allow the transmission or storage of frame
  4926. sequences that have alpha in a format that doesn't support an alpha
  4927. channel.
  4928. For example, to reconstruct full frames from a normal YUV-encoded video
  4929. and a separate video created with @var{alphaextract}, you might use:
  4930. @example
  4931. movie=in_alpha.mkv [alpha]; [in][alpha] alphamerge [out]
  4932. @end example
  4933. Since this filter is designed for reconstruction, it operates on frame
  4934. sequences without considering timestamps, and terminates when either
  4935. input reaches end of stream. This will cause problems if your encoding
  4936. pipeline drops frames. If you're trying to apply an image as an
  4937. overlay to a video stream, consider the @var{overlay} filter instead.
  4938. @section amplify
  4939. Amplify differences between current pixel and pixels of adjacent frames in
  4940. same pixel location.
  4941. This filter accepts the following options:
  4942. @table @option
  4943. @item radius
  4944. Set frame radius. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 63.
  4945. For example radius of 3 will instruct filter to calculate average of 7 frames.
  4946. @item factor
  4947. Set factor to amplify difference. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4948. @item threshold
  4949. Set threshold for difference amplification. Any difference greater or equal to
  4950. this value will not alter source pixel. Default is 10.
  4951. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4952. @item tolerance
  4953. Set tolerance for difference amplification. Any difference lower to
  4954. this value will not alter source pixel. Default is 0.
  4955. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4956. @item low
  4957. Set lower limit for changing source pixel. Default is 65535. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4958. This option controls maximum possible value that will decrease source pixel value.
  4959. @item high
  4960. Set high limit for changing source pixel. Default is 65535. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4961. This option controls maximum possible value that will increase source pixel value.
  4962. @item planes
  4963. Set which planes to filter. Default is all. Allowed range is from 0 to 15.
  4964. @end table
  4965. @subsection Commands
  4966. This filter supports the following @ref{commands} that corresponds to option of same name:
  4967. @table @option
  4968. @item factor
  4969. @item threshold
  4970. @item tolerance
  4971. @item low
  4972. @item high
  4973. @item planes
  4974. @end table
  4975. @section ass
  4976. Same as the @ref{subtitles} filter, except that it doesn't require libavcodec
  4977. and libavformat to work. On the other hand, it is limited to ASS (Advanced
  4978. Substation Alpha) subtitles files.
  4979. This filter accepts the following option in addition to the common options from
  4980. the @ref{subtitles} filter:
  4981. @table @option
  4982. @item shaping
  4983. Set the shaping engine
  4984. Available values are:
  4985. @table @samp
  4986. @item auto
  4987. The default libass shaping engine, which is the best available.
  4988. @item simple
  4989. Fast, font-agnostic shaper that can do only substitutions
  4990. @item complex
  4991. Slower shaper using OpenType for substitutions and positioning
  4992. @end table
  4993. The default is @code{auto}.
  4994. @end table
  4995. @section atadenoise
  4996. Apply an Adaptive Temporal Averaging Denoiser to the video input.
  4997. The filter accepts the following options:
  4998. @table @option
  4999. @item 0a
  5000. Set threshold A for 1st plane. Default is 0.02.
  5001. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  5002. @item 0b
  5003. Set threshold B for 1st plane. Default is 0.04.
  5004. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  5005. @item 1a
  5006. Set threshold A for 2nd plane. Default is 0.02.
  5007. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  5008. @item 1b
  5009. Set threshold B for 2nd plane. Default is 0.04.
  5010. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  5011. @item 2a
  5012. Set threshold A for 3rd plane. Default is 0.02.
  5013. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  5014. @item 2b
  5015. Set threshold B for 3rd plane. Default is 0.04.
  5016. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  5017. Threshold A is designed to react on abrupt changes in the input signal and
  5018. threshold B is designed to react on continuous changes in the input signal.
  5019. @item s
  5020. Set number of frames filter will use for averaging. Default is 9. Must be odd
  5021. number in range [5, 129].
  5022. @item p
  5023. Set what planes of frame filter will use for averaging. Default is all.
  5024. @item a
  5025. Set what variant of algorithm filter will use for averaging. Default is @code{p} parallel.
  5026. Alternatively can be set to @code{s} serial.
  5027. Parallel can be faster then serial, while other way around is never true.
  5028. Parallel will abort early on first change being greater then thresholds, while serial
  5029. will continue processing other side of frames if they are equal or bellow thresholds.
  5030. @end table
  5031. @subsection Commands
  5032. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options except option @code{s}.
  5033. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5034. @section avgblur
  5035. Apply average blur filter.
  5036. The filter accepts the following options:
  5037. @table @option
  5038. @item sizeX
  5039. Set horizontal radius size.
  5040. @item planes
  5041. Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.
  5042. @item sizeY
  5043. Set vertical radius size, if zero it will be same as @code{sizeX}.
  5044. Default is @code{0}.
  5045. @end table
  5046. @subsection Commands
  5047. This filter supports same commands as options.
  5048. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5049. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5050. value.
  5051. @section bbox
  5052. Compute the bounding box for the non-black pixels in the input frame
  5053. luminance plane.
  5054. This filter computes the bounding box containing all the pixels with a
  5055. luminance value greater than the minimum allowed value.
  5056. The parameters describing the bounding box are printed on the filter
  5057. log.
  5058. The filter accepts the following option:
  5059. @table @option
  5060. @item min_val
  5061. Set the minimal luminance value. Default is @code{16}.
  5062. @end table
  5063. @section bilateral
  5064. Apply bilateral filter, spatial smoothing while preserving edges.
  5065. The filter accepts the following options:
  5066. @table @option
  5067. @item sigmaS
  5068. Set sigma of gaussian function to calculate spatial weight.
  5069. Allowed range is 0 to 10. Default is 0.1.
  5070. @item sigmaR
  5071. Set sigma of gaussian function to calculate range weight.
  5072. Allowed range is 0 to 1. Default is 0.1.
  5073. @item planes
  5074. Set planes to filter. Default is first only.
  5075. @end table
  5076. @section bitplanenoise
  5077. Show and measure bit plane noise.
  5078. The filter accepts the following options:
  5079. @table @option
  5080. @item bitplane
  5081. Set which plane to analyze. Default is @code{1}.
  5082. @item filter
  5083. Filter out noisy pixels from @code{bitplane} set above.
  5084. Default is disabled.
  5085. @end table
  5086. @section blackdetect
  5087. Detect video intervals that are (almost) completely black. Can be
  5088. useful to detect chapter transitions, commercials, or invalid
  5089. recordings.
  5090. The filter outputs its detection analysis to both the log as well as
  5091. frame metadata. If a black segment of at least the specified minimum
  5092. duration is found, a line with the start and end timestamps as well
  5093. as duration is printed to the log with level @code{info}. In addition,
  5094. a log line with level @code{debug} is printed per frame showing the
  5095. black amount detected for that frame.
  5096. The filter also attaches metadata to the first frame of a black
  5097. segment with key @code{lavfi.black_start} and to the first frame
  5098. after the black segment ends with key @code{lavfi.black_end}. The
  5099. value is the frame's timestamp. This metadata is added regardless
  5100. of the minimum duration specified.
  5101. The filter accepts the following options:
  5102. @table @option
  5103. @item black_min_duration, d
  5104. Set the minimum detected black duration expressed in seconds. It must
  5105. be a non-negative floating point number.
  5106. Default value is 2.0.
  5107. @item picture_black_ratio_th, pic_th
  5108. Set the threshold for considering a picture "black".
  5109. Express the minimum value for the ratio:
  5110. @example
  5111. @var{nb_black_pixels} / @var{nb_pixels}
  5112. @end example
  5113. for which a picture is considered black.
  5114. Default value is 0.98.
  5115. @item pixel_black_th, pix_th
  5116. Set the threshold for considering a pixel "black".
  5117. The threshold expresses the maximum pixel luminance value for which a
  5118. pixel is considered "black". The provided value is scaled according to
  5119. the following equation:
  5120. @example
  5121. @var{absolute_threshold} = @var{luminance_minimum_value} + @var{pixel_black_th} * @var{luminance_range_size}
  5122. @end example
  5123. @var{luminance_range_size} and @var{luminance_minimum_value} depend on
  5124. the input video format, the range is [0-255] for YUV full-range
  5125. formats and [16-235] for YUV non full-range formats.
  5126. Default value is 0.10.
  5127. @end table
  5128. The following example sets the maximum pixel threshold to the minimum
  5129. value, and detects only black intervals of 2 or more seconds:
  5130. @example
  5131. blackdetect=d=2:pix_th=0.00
  5132. @end example
  5133. @section blackframe
  5134. Detect frames that are (almost) completely black. Can be useful to
  5135. detect chapter transitions or commercials. Output lines consist of
  5136. the frame number of the detected frame, the percentage of blackness,
  5137. the position in the file if known or -1 and the timestamp in seconds.
  5138. In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
  5139. least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
  5140. This filter exports frame metadata @code{lavfi.blackframe.pblack}.
  5141. The value represents the percentage of pixels in the picture that
  5142. are below the threshold value.
  5143. It accepts the following parameters:
  5144. @table @option
  5145. @item amount
  5146. The percentage of the pixels that have to be below the threshold; it defaults to
  5147. @code{98}.
  5148. @item threshold, thresh
  5149. The threshold below which a pixel value is considered black; it defaults to
  5150. @code{32}.
  5151. @end table
  5152. @anchor{blend}
  5153. @section blend
  5154. Blend two video frames into each other.
  5155. The @code{blend} filter takes two input streams and outputs one
  5156. stream, the first input is the "top" layer and second input is
  5157. "bottom" layer. By default, the output terminates when the longest input terminates.
  5158. The @code{tblend} (time blend) filter takes two consecutive frames
  5159. from one single stream, and outputs the result obtained by blending
  5160. the new frame on top of the old frame.
  5161. A description of the accepted options follows.
  5162. @table @option
  5163. @item c0_mode
  5164. @item c1_mode
  5165. @item c2_mode
  5166. @item c3_mode
  5167. @item all_mode
  5168. Set blend mode for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  5169. of @var{all_mode}. Default value is @code{normal}.
  5170. Available values for component modes are:
  5171. @table @samp
  5172. @item addition
  5173. @item grainmerge
  5174. @item and
  5175. @item average
  5176. @item burn
  5177. @item darken
  5178. @item difference
  5179. @item grainextract
  5180. @item divide
  5181. @item dodge
  5182. @item freeze
  5183. @item exclusion
  5184. @item extremity
  5185. @item glow
  5186. @item hardlight
  5187. @item hardmix
  5188. @item heat
  5189. @item lighten
  5190. @item linearlight
  5191. @item multiply
  5192. @item multiply128
  5193. @item negation
  5194. @item normal
  5195. @item or
  5196. @item overlay
  5197. @item phoenix
  5198. @item pinlight
  5199. @item reflect
  5200. @item screen
  5201. @item softlight
  5202. @item subtract
  5203. @item vividlight
  5204. @item xor
  5205. @end table
  5206. @item c0_opacity
  5207. @item c1_opacity
  5208. @item c2_opacity
  5209. @item c3_opacity
  5210. @item all_opacity
  5211. Set blend opacity for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  5212. of @var{all_opacity}. Only used in combination with pixel component blend modes.
  5213. @item c0_expr
  5214. @item c1_expr
  5215. @item c2_expr
  5216. @item c3_expr
  5217. @item all_expr
  5218. Set blend expression for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  5219. of @var{all_expr}. Note that related mode options will be ignored if those are set.
  5220. The expressions can use the following variables:
  5221. @table @option
  5222. @item N
  5223. The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
  5224. @item X
  5225. @item Y
  5226. the coordinates of the current sample
  5227. @item W
  5228. @item H
  5229. the width and height of currently filtered plane
  5230. @item SW
  5231. @item SH
  5232. Width and height scale for the plane being filtered. It is the
  5233. ratio between the dimensions of the current plane to the luma plane,
  5234. e.g. for a @code{yuv420p} frame, the values are @code{1,1} for
  5235. the luma plane and @code{0.5,0.5} for the chroma planes.
  5236. @item T
  5237. Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
  5238. @item TOP, A
  5239. Value of pixel component at current location for first video frame (top layer).
  5240. @item BOTTOM, B
  5241. Value of pixel component at current location for second video frame (bottom layer).
  5242. @end table
  5243. @end table
  5244. The @code{blend} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  5245. @subsection Examples
  5246. @itemize
  5247. @item
  5248. Apply transition from bottom layer to top layer in first 10 seconds:
  5249. @example
  5250. blend=all_expr='A*(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10))+B*(1-(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10)))'
  5251. @end example
  5252. @item
  5253. Apply linear horizontal transition from top layer to bottom layer:
  5254. @example
  5255. blend=all_expr='A*(X/W)+B*(1-X/W)'
  5256. @end example
  5257. @item
  5258. Apply 1x1 checkerboard effect:
  5259. @example
  5260. blend=all_expr='if(eq(mod(X,2),mod(Y,2)),A,B)'
  5261. @end example
  5262. @item
  5263. Apply uncover left effect:
  5264. @example
  5265. blend=all_expr='if(gte(N*SW+X,W),A,B)'
  5266. @end example
  5267. @item
  5268. Apply uncover down effect:
  5269. @example
  5270. blend=all_expr='if(gte(Y-N*SH,0),A,B)'
  5271. @end example
  5272. @item
  5273. Apply uncover up-left effect:
  5274. @example
  5275. blend=all_expr='if(gte(T*SH*40+Y,H)*gte((T*40*SW+X)*W/H,W),A,B)'
  5276. @end example
  5277. @item
  5278. Split diagonally video and shows top and bottom layer on each side:
  5279. @example
  5280. blend=all_expr='if(gt(X,Y*(W/H)),A,B)'
  5281. @end example
  5282. @item
  5283. Display differences between the current and the previous frame:
  5284. @example
  5285. tblend=all_mode=grainextract
  5286. @end example
  5287. @end itemize
  5288. @section bm3d
  5289. Denoise frames using Block-Matching 3D algorithm.
  5290. The filter accepts the following options.
  5291. @table @option
  5292. @item sigma
  5293. Set denoising strength. Default value is 1.
  5294. Allowed range is from 0 to 999.9.
  5295. The denoising algorithm is very sensitive to sigma, so adjust it
  5296. according to the source.
  5297. @item block
  5298. Set local patch size. This sets dimensions in 2D.
  5299. @item bstep
  5300. Set sliding step for processing blocks. Default value is 4.
  5301. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  5302. Smaller values allows processing more reference blocks and is slower.
  5303. @item group
  5304. Set maximal number of similar blocks for 3rd dimension. Default value is 1.
  5305. When set to 1, no block matching is done. Larger values allows more blocks
  5306. in single group.
  5307. Allowed range is from 1 to 256.
  5308. @item range
  5309. Set radius for search block matching. Default is 9.
  5310. Allowed range is from 1 to INT32_MAX.
  5311. @item mstep
  5312. Set step between two search locations for block matching. Default is 1.
  5313. Allowed range is from 1 to 64. Smaller is slower.
  5314. @item thmse
  5315. Set threshold of mean square error for block matching. Valid range is 0 to
  5316. INT32_MAX.
  5317. @item hdthr
  5318. Set thresholding parameter for hard thresholding in 3D transformed domain.
  5319. Larger values results in stronger hard-thresholding filtering in frequency
  5320. domain.
  5321. @item estim
  5322. Set filtering estimation mode. Can be @code{basic} or @code{final}.
  5323. Default is @code{basic}.
  5324. @item ref
  5325. If enabled, filter will use 2nd stream for block matching.
  5326. Default is disabled for @code{basic} value of @var{estim} option,
  5327. and always enabled if value of @var{estim} is @code{final}.
  5328. @item planes
  5329. Set planes to filter. Default is all available except alpha.
  5330. @end table
  5331. @subsection Examples
  5332. @itemize
  5333. @item
  5334. Basic filtering with bm3d:
  5335. @example
  5336. bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic
  5337. @end example
  5338. @item
  5339. Same as above, but filtering only luma:
  5340. @example
  5341. bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic:planes=1
  5342. @end example
  5343. @item
  5344. Same as above, but with both estimation modes:
  5345. @example
  5346. split[a][b],[a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic[a],[b][a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=16:estim=final:ref=1
  5347. @end example
  5348. @item
  5349. Same as above, but prefilter with @ref{nlmeans} filter instead:
  5350. @example
  5351. split[a][b],[a]nlmeans=s=3:r=7:p=3[a],[b][a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=16:estim=final:ref=1
  5352. @end example
  5353. @end itemize
  5354. @section boxblur
  5355. Apply a boxblur algorithm to the input video.
  5356. It accepts the following parameters:
  5357. @table @option
  5358. @item luma_radius, lr
  5359. @item luma_power, lp
  5360. @item chroma_radius, cr
  5361. @item chroma_power, cp
  5362. @item alpha_radius, ar
  5363. @item alpha_power, ap
  5364. @end table
  5365. A description of the accepted options follows.
  5366. @table @option
  5367. @item luma_radius, lr
  5368. @item chroma_radius, cr
  5369. @item alpha_radius, ar
  5370. Set an expression for the box radius in pixels used for blurring the
  5371. corresponding input plane.
  5372. The radius value must be a non-negative number, and must not be
  5373. greater than the value of the expression @code{min(w,h)/2} for the
  5374. luma and alpha planes, and of @code{min(cw,ch)/2} for the chroma
  5375. planes.
  5376. Default value for @option{luma_radius} is "2". If not specified,
  5377. @option{chroma_radius} and @option{alpha_radius} default to the
  5378. corresponding value set for @option{luma_radius}.
  5379. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  5380. @table @option
  5381. @item w
  5382. @item h
  5383. The input width and height in pixels.
  5384. @item cw
  5385. @item ch
  5386. The input chroma image width and height in pixels.
  5387. @item hsub
  5388. @item vsub
  5389. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  5390. pixel format "yuv422p", @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  5391. @end table
  5392. @item luma_power, lp
  5393. @item chroma_power, cp
  5394. @item alpha_power, ap
  5395. Specify how many times the boxblur filter is applied to the
  5396. corresponding plane.
  5397. Default value for @option{luma_power} is 2. If not specified,
  5398. @option{chroma_power} and @option{alpha_power} default to the
  5399. corresponding value set for @option{luma_power}.
  5400. A value of 0 will disable the effect.
  5401. @end table
  5402. @subsection Examples
  5403. @itemize
  5404. @item
  5405. Apply a boxblur filter with the luma, chroma, and alpha radii
  5406. set to 2:
  5407. @example
  5408. boxblur=luma_radius=2:luma_power=1
  5409. boxblur=2:1
  5410. @end example
  5411. @item
  5412. Set the luma radius to 2, and alpha and chroma radius to 0:
  5413. @example
  5414. boxblur=2:1:cr=0:ar=0
  5415. @end example
  5416. @item
  5417. Set the luma and chroma radii to a fraction of the video dimension:
  5418. @example
  5419. boxblur=luma_radius=min(h\,w)/10:luma_power=1:chroma_radius=min(cw\,ch)/10:chroma_power=1
  5420. @end example
  5421. @end itemize
  5422. @section bwdif
  5423. Deinterlace the input video ("bwdif" stands for "Bob Weaver
  5424. Deinterlacing Filter").
  5425. Motion adaptive deinterlacing based on yadif with the use of w3fdif and cubic
  5426. interpolation algorithms.
  5427. It accepts the following parameters:
  5428. @table @option
  5429. @item mode
  5430. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  5431. @table @option
  5432. @item 0, send_frame
  5433. Output one frame for each frame.
  5434. @item 1, send_field
  5435. Output one frame for each field.
  5436. @end table
  5437. The default value is @code{send_field}.
  5438. @item parity
  5439. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  5440. of the following values:
  5441. @table @option
  5442. @item 0, tff
  5443. Assume the top field is first.
  5444. @item 1, bff
  5445. Assume the bottom field is first.
  5446. @item -1, auto
  5447. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  5448. @end table
  5449. The default value is @code{auto}.
  5450. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  5451. top field first will be assumed.
  5452. @item deint
  5453. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  5454. values:
  5455. @table @option
  5456. @item 0, all
  5457. Deinterlace all frames.
  5458. @item 1, interlaced
  5459. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  5460. @end table
  5461. The default value is @code{all}.
  5462. @end table
  5463. @section cas
  5464. Apply Contrast Adaptive Sharpen filter to video stream.
  5465. The filter accepts the following options:
  5466. @table @option
  5467. @item strength
  5468. Set the sharpening strength. Default value is 0.
  5469. @item planes
  5470. Set planes to filter. Default value is to filter all
  5471. planes except alpha plane.
  5472. @end table
  5473. @section chromahold
  5474. Remove all color information for all colors except for certain one.
  5475. The filter accepts the following options:
  5476. @table @option
  5477. @item color
  5478. The color which will not be replaced with neutral chroma.
  5479. @item similarity
  5480. Similarity percentage with the above color.
  5481. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5482. @item blend
  5483. Blend percentage.
  5484. 0.0 makes pixels either fully gray, or not gray at all.
  5485. Higher values result in more preserved color.
  5486. @item yuv
  5487. Signals that the color passed is already in YUV instead of RGB.
  5488. Literal colors like "green" or "red" don't make sense with this enabled anymore.
  5489. This can be used to pass exact YUV values as hexadecimal numbers.
  5490. @end table
  5491. @subsection Commands
  5492. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  5493. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5494. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5495. value.
  5496. @section chromakey
  5497. YUV colorspace color/chroma keying.
  5498. The filter accepts the following options:
  5499. @table @option
  5500. @item color
  5501. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  5502. @item similarity
  5503. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  5504. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5505. @item blend
  5506. Blend percentage.
  5507. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  5508. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  5509. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  5510. @item yuv
  5511. Signals that the color passed is already in YUV instead of RGB.
  5512. Literal colors like "green" or "red" don't make sense with this enabled anymore.
  5513. This can be used to pass exact YUV values as hexadecimal numbers.
  5514. @end table
  5515. @subsection Commands
  5516. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  5517. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5518. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5519. value.
  5520. @subsection Examples
  5521. @itemize
  5522. @item
  5523. Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
  5524. @example
  5525. ffmpeg -i input.png -vf chromakey=green out.png
  5526. @end example
  5527. @item
  5528. Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static black background.
  5529. @example
  5530. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color=c=black:s=1280x720 -i video.mp4 -shortest -filter_complex "[1:v]chromakey=0x70de77:0.1:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.mkv
  5531. @end example
  5532. @end itemize
  5533. @section chromashift
  5534. Shift chroma pixels horizontally and/or vertically.
  5535. The filter accepts the following options:
  5536. @table @option
  5537. @item cbh
  5538. Set amount to shift chroma-blue horizontally.
  5539. @item cbv
  5540. Set amount to shift chroma-blue vertically.
  5541. @item crh
  5542. Set amount to shift chroma-red horizontally.
  5543. @item crv
  5544. Set amount to shift chroma-red vertically.
  5545. @item edge
  5546. Set edge mode, can be @var{smear}, default, or @var{warp}.
  5547. @end table
  5548. @subsection Commands
  5549. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5550. @section ciescope
  5551. Display CIE color diagram with pixels overlaid onto it.
  5552. The filter accepts the following options:
  5553. @table @option
  5554. @item system
  5555. Set color system.
  5556. @table @samp
  5557. @item ntsc, 470m
  5558. @item ebu, 470bg
  5559. @item smpte
  5560. @item 240m
  5561. @item apple
  5562. @item widergb
  5563. @item cie1931
  5564. @item rec709, hdtv
  5565. @item uhdtv, rec2020
  5566. @item dcip3
  5567. @end table
  5568. @item cie
  5569. Set CIE system.
  5570. @table @samp
  5571. @item xyy
  5572. @item ucs
  5573. @item luv
  5574. @end table
  5575. @item gamuts
  5576. Set what gamuts to draw.
  5577. See @code{system} option for available values.
  5578. @item size, s
  5579. Set ciescope size, by default set to 512.
  5580. @item intensity, i
  5581. Set intensity used to map input pixel values to CIE diagram.
  5582. @item contrast
  5583. Set contrast used to draw tongue colors that are out of active color system gamut.
  5584. @item corrgamma
  5585. Correct gamma displayed on scope, by default enabled.
  5586. @item showwhite
  5587. Show white point on CIE diagram, by default disabled.
  5588. @item gamma
  5589. Set input gamma. Used only with XYZ input color space.
  5590. @end table
  5591. @section codecview
  5592. Visualize information exported by some codecs.
  5593. Some codecs can export information through frames using side-data or other
  5594. means. For example, some MPEG based codecs export motion vectors through the
  5595. @var{export_mvs} flag in the codec @option{flags2} option.
  5596. The filter accepts the following option:
  5597. @table @option
  5598. @item mv
  5599. Set motion vectors to visualize.
  5600. Available flags for @var{mv} are:
  5601. @table @samp
  5602. @item pf
  5603. forward predicted MVs of P-frames
  5604. @item bf
  5605. forward predicted MVs of B-frames
  5606. @item bb
  5607. backward predicted MVs of B-frames
  5608. @end table
  5609. @item qp
  5610. Display quantization parameters using the chroma planes.
  5611. @item mv_type, mvt
  5612. Set motion vectors type to visualize. Includes MVs from all frames unless specified by @var{frame_type} option.
  5613. Available flags for @var{mv_type} are:
  5614. @table @samp
  5615. @item fp
  5616. forward predicted MVs
  5617. @item bp
  5618. backward predicted MVs
  5619. @end table
  5620. @item frame_type, ft
  5621. Set frame type to visualize motion vectors of.
  5622. Available flags for @var{frame_type} are:
  5623. @table @samp
  5624. @item if
  5625. intra-coded frames (I-frames)
  5626. @item pf
  5627. predicted frames (P-frames)
  5628. @item bf
  5629. bi-directionally predicted frames (B-frames)
  5630. @end table
  5631. @end table
  5632. @subsection Examples
  5633. @itemize
  5634. @item
  5635. Visualize forward predicted MVs of all frames using @command{ffplay}:
  5636. @example
  5637. ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv_type=fp
  5638. @end example
  5639. @item
  5640. Visualize multi-directionals MVs of P and B-Frames using @command{ffplay}:
  5641. @example
  5642. ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv=pf+bf+bb
  5643. @end example
  5644. @end itemize
  5645. @section colorbalance
  5646. Modify intensity of primary colors (red, green and blue) of input frames.
  5647. The filter allows an input frame to be adjusted in the shadows, midtones or highlights
  5648. regions for the red-cyan, green-magenta or blue-yellow balance.
  5649. A positive adjustment value shifts the balance towards the primary color, a negative
  5650. value towards the complementary color.
  5651. The filter accepts the following options:
  5652. @table @option
  5653. @item rs
  5654. @item gs
  5655. @item bs
  5656. Adjust red, green and blue shadows (darkest pixels).
  5657. @item rm
  5658. @item gm
  5659. @item bm
  5660. Adjust red, green and blue midtones (medium pixels).
  5661. @item rh
  5662. @item gh
  5663. @item bh
  5664. Adjust red, green and blue highlights (brightest pixels).
  5665. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5666. @item pl
  5667. Preserve lightness when changing color balance. Default is disabled.
  5668. @end table
  5669. @subsection Examples
  5670. @itemize
  5671. @item
  5672. Add red color cast to shadows:
  5673. @example
  5674. colorbalance=rs=.3
  5675. @end example
  5676. @end itemize
  5677. @subsection Commands
  5678. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5679. @section colorchannelmixer
  5680. Adjust video input frames by re-mixing color channels.
  5681. This filter modifies a color channel by adding the values associated to
  5682. the other channels of the same pixels. For example if the value to
  5683. modify is red, the output value will be:
  5684. @example
  5685. @var{red}=@var{red}*@var{rr} + @var{blue}*@var{rb} + @var{green}*@var{rg} + @var{alpha}*@var{ra}
  5686. @end example
  5687. The filter accepts the following options:
  5688. @table @option
  5689. @item rr
  5690. @item rg
  5691. @item rb
  5692. @item ra
  5693. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output red channel.
  5694. Default is @code{1} for @var{rr}, and @code{0} for @var{rg}, @var{rb} and @var{ra}.
  5695. @item gr
  5696. @item gg
  5697. @item gb
  5698. @item ga
  5699. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output green channel.
  5700. Default is @code{1} for @var{gg}, and @code{0} for @var{gr}, @var{gb} and @var{ga}.
  5701. @item br
  5702. @item bg
  5703. @item bb
  5704. @item ba
  5705. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output blue channel.
  5706. Default is @code{1} for @var{bb}, and @code{0} for @var{br}, @var{bg} and @var{ba}.
  5707. @item ar
  5708. @item ag
  5709. @item ab
  5710. @item aa
  5711. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output alpha channel.
  5712. Default is @code{1} for @var{aa}, and @code{0} for @var{ar}, @var{ag} and @var{ab}.
  5713. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-2.0, 2.0]}.
  5714. @end table
  5715. @subsection Examples
  5716. @itemize
  5717. @item
  5718. Convert source to grayscale:
  5719. @example
  5720. colorchannelmixer=.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3
  5721. @end example
  5722. @item
  5723. Simulate sepia tones:
  5724. @example
  5725. colorchannelmixer=.393:.769:.189:0:.349:.686:.168:0:.272:.534:.131
  5726. @end example
  5727. @end itemize
  5728. @subsection Commands
  5729. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5730. @section colorkey
  5731. RGB colorspace color keying.
  5732. The filter accepts the following options:
  5733. @table @option
  5734. @item color
  5735. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  5736. @item similarity
  5737. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  5738. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5739. @item blend
  5740. Blend percentage.
  5741. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  5742. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  5743. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  5744. @end table
  5745. @subsection Examples
  5746. @itemize
  5747. @item
  5748. Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
  5749. @example
  5750. ffmpeg -i input.png -vf colorkey=green out.png
  5751. @end example
  5752. @item
  5753. Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static background image.
  5754. @example
  5755. ffmpeg -i background.png -i video.mp4 -filter_complex "[1:v]colorkey=0x3BBD1E:0.3:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.flv
  5756. @end example
  5757. @end itemize
  5758. @subsection Commands
  5759. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  5760. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5761. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5762. value.
  5763. @section colorhold
  5764. Remove all color information for all RGB colors except for certain one.
  5765. The filter accepts the following options:
  5766. @table @option
  5767. @item color
  5768. The color which will not be replaced with neutral gray.
  5769. @item similarity
  5770. Similarity percentage with the above color.
  5771. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5772. @item blend
  5773. Blend percentage. 0.0 makes pixels fully gray.
  5774. Higher values result in more preserved color.
  5775. @end table
  5776. @subsection Commands
  5777. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  5778. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5779. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5780. value.
  5781. @section colorlevels
  5782. Adjust video input frames using levels.
  5783. The filter accepts the following options:
  5784. @table @option
  5785. @item rimin
  5786. @item gimin
  5787. @item bimin
  5788. @item aimin
  5789. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input black point.
  5790. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5791. @item rimax
  5792. @item gimax
  5793. @item bimax
  5794. @item aimax
  5795. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input white point.
  5796. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
  5797. Input levels are used to lighten highlights (bright tones), darken shadows
  5798. (dark tones), change the balance of bright and dark tones.
  5799. @item romin
  5800. @item gomin
  5801. @item bomin
  5802. @item aomin
  5803. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output black point.
  5804. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5805. @item romax
  5806. @item gomax
  5807. @item bomax
  5808. @item aomax
  5809. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output white point.
  5810. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
  5811. Output levels allows manual selection of a constrained output level range.
  5812. @end table
  5813. @subsection Examples
  5814. @itemize
  5815. @item
  5816. Make video output darker:
  5817. @example
  5818. colorlevels=rimin=0.058:gimin=0.058:bimin=0.058
  5819. @end example
  5820. @item
  5821. Increase contrast:
  5822. @example
  5823. colorlevels=rimin=0.039:gimin=0.039:bimin=0.039:rimax=0.96:gimax=0.96:bimax=0.96
  5824. @end example
  5825. @item
  5826. Make video output lighter:
  5827. @example
  5828. colorlevels=rimax=0.902:gimax=0.902:bimax=0.902
  5829. @end example
  5830. @item
  5831. Increase brightness:
  5832. @example
  5833. colorlevels=romin=0.5:gomin=0.5:bomin=0.5
  5834. @end example
  5835. @end itemize
  5836. @subsection Commands
  5837. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5838. @section colormatrix
  5839. Convert color matrix.
  5840. The filter accepts the following options:
  5841. @table @option
  5842. @item src
  5843. @item dst
  5844. Specify the source and destination color matrix. Both values must be
  5845. specified.
  5846. The accepted values are:
  5847. @table @samp
  5848. @item bt709
  5849. BT.709
  5850. @item fcc
  5851. FCC
  5852. @item bt601
  5853. BT.601
  5854. @item bt470
  5855. BT.470
  5856. @item bt470bg
  5857. BT.470BG
  5858. @item smpte170m
  5859. SMPTE-170M
  5860. @item smpte240m
  5861. SMPTE-240M
  5862. @item bt2020
  5863. BT.2020
  5864. @end table
  5865. @end table
  5866. For example to convert from BT.601 to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
  5867. @example
  5868. colormatrix=bt601:smpte240m
  5869. @end example
  5870. @section colorspace
  5871. Convert colorspace, transfer characteristics or color primaries.
  5872. Input video needs to have an even size.
  5873. The filter accepts the following options:
  5874. @table @option
  5875. @anchor{all}
  5876. @item all
  5877. Specify all color properties at once.
  5878. The accepted values are:
  5879. @table @samp
  5880. @item bt470m
  5881. BT.470M
  5882. @item bt470bg
  5883. BT.470BG
  5884. @item bt601-6-525
  5885. BT.601-6 525
  5886. @item bt601-6-625
  5887. BT.601-6 625
  5888. @item bt709
  5889. BT.709
  5890. @item smpte170m
  5891. SMPTE-170M
  5892. @item smpte240m
  5893. SMPTE-240M
  5894. @item bt2020
  5895. BT.2020
  5896. @end table
  5897. @anchor{space}
  5898. @item space
  5899. Specify output colorspace.
  5900. The accepted values are:
  5901. @table @samp
  5902. @item bt709
  5903. BT.709
  5904. @item fcc
  5905. FCC
  5906. @item bt470bg
  5907. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  5908. @item smpte170m
  5909. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  5910. @item smpte240m
  5911. SMPTE-240M
  5912. @item ycgco
  5913. YCgCo
  5914. @item bt2020ncl
  5915. BT.2020 with non-constant luminance
  5916. @end table
  5917. @anchor{trc}
  5918. @item trc
  5919. Specify output transfer characteristics.
  5920. The accepted values are:
  5921. @table @samp
  5922. @item bt709
  5923. BT.709
  5924. @item bt470m
  5925. BT.470M
  5926. @item bt470bg
  5927. BT.470BG
  5928. @item gamma22
  5929. Constant gamma of 2.2
  5930. @item gamma28
  5931. Constant gamma of 2.8
  5932. @item smpte170m
  5933. SMPTE-170M, BT.601-6 625 or BT.601-6 525
  5934. @item smpte240m
  5935. SMPTE-240M
  5936. @item srgb
  5937. SRGB
  5938. @item iec61966-2-1
  5939. iec61966-2-1
  5940. @item iec61966-2-4
  5941. iec61966-2-4
  5942. @item xvycc
  5943. xvycc
  5944. @item bt2020-10
  5945. BT.2020 for 10-bits content
  5946. @item bt2020-12
  5947. BT.2020 for 12-bits content
  5948. @end table
  5949. @anchor{primaries}
  5950. @item primaries
  5951. Specify output color primaries.
  5952. The accepted values are:
  5953. @table @samp
  5954. @item bt709
  5955. BT.709
  5956. @item bt470m
  5957. BT.470M
  5958. @item bt470bg
  5959. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  5960. @item smpte170m
  5961. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  5962. @item smpte240m
  5963. SMPTE-240M
  5964. @item film
  5965. film
  5966. @item smpte431
  5967. SMPTE-431
  5968. @item smpte432
  5969. SMPTE-432
  5970. @item bt2020
  5971. BT.2020
  5972. @item jedec-p22
  5973. JEDEC P22 phosphors
  5974. @end table
  5975. @anchor{range}
  5976. @item range
  5977. Specify output color range.
  5978. The accepted values are:
  5979. @table @samp
  5980. @item tv
  5981. TV (restricted) range
  5982. @item mpeg
  5983. MPEG (restricted) range
  5984. @item pc
  5985. PC (full) range
  5986. @item jpeg
  5987. JPEG (full) range
  5988. @end table
  5989. @item format
  5990. Specify output color format.
  5991. The accepted values are:
  5992. @table @samp
  5993. @item yuv420p
  5994. YUV 4:2:0 planar 8-bits
  5995. @item yuv420p10
  5996. YUV 4:2:0 planar 10-bits
  5997. @item yuv420p12
  5998. YUV 4:2:0 planar 12-bits
  5999. @item yuv422p
  6000. YUV 4:2:2 planar 8-bits
  6001. @item yuv422p10
  6002. YUV 4:2:2 planar 10-bits
  6003. @item yuv422p12
  6004. YUV 4:2:2 planar 12-bits
  6005. @item yuv444p
  6006. YUV 4:4:4 planar 8-bits
  6007. @item yuv444p10
  6008. YUV 4:4:4 planar 10-bits
  6009. @item yuv444p12
  6010. YUV 4:4:4 planar 12-bits
  6011. @end table
  6012. @item fast
  6013. Do a fast conversion, which skips gamma/primary correction. This will take
  6014. significantly less CPU, but will be mathematically incorrect. To get output
  6015. compatible with that produced by the colormatrix filter, use fast=1.
  6016. @item dither
  6017. Specify dithering mode.
  6018. The accepted values are:
  6019. @table @samp
  6020. @item none
  6021. No dithering
  6022. @item fsb
  6023. Floyd-Steinberg dithering
  6024. @end table
  6025. @item wpadapt
  6026. Whitepoint adaptation mode.
  6027. The accepted values are:
  6028. @table @samp
  6029. @item bradford
  6030. Bradford whitepoint adaptation
  6031. @item vonkries
  6032. von Kries whitepoint adaptation
  6033. @item identity
  6034. identity whitepoint adaptation (i.e. no whitepoint adaptation)
  6035. @end table
  6036. @item iall
  6037. Override all input properties at once. Same accepted values as @ref{all}.
  6038. @item ispace
  6039. Override input colorspace. Same accepted values as @ref{space}.
  6040. @item iprimaries
  6041. Override input color primaries. Same accepted values as @ref{primaries}.
  6042. @item itrc
  6043. Override input transfer characteristics. Same accepted values as @ref{trc}.
  6044. @item irange
  6045. Override input color range. Same accepted values as @ref{range}.
  6046. @end table
  6047. The filter converts the transfer characteristics, color space and color
  6048. primaries to the specified user values. The output value, if not specified,
  6049. is set to a default value based on the "all" property. If that property is
  6050. also not specified, the filter will log an error. The output color range and
  6051. format default to the same value as the input color range and format. The
  6052. input transfer characteristics, color space, color primaries and color range
  6053. should be set on the input data. If any of these are missing, the filter will
  6054. log an error and no conversion will take place.
  6055. For example to convert the input to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
  6056. @example
  6057. colorspace=smpte240m
  6058. @end example
  6059. @section convolution
  6060. Apply convolution of 3x3, 5x5, 7x7 or horizontal/vertical up to 49 elements.
  6061. The filter accepts the following options:
  6062. @table @option
  6063. @item 0m
  6064. @item 1m
  6065. @item 2m
  6066. @item 3m
  6067. Set matrix for each plane.
  6068. Matrix is sequence of 9, 25 or 49 signed integers in @var{square} mode,
  6069. and from 1 to 49 odd number of signed integers in @var{row} mode.
  6070. @item 0rdiv
  6071. @item 1rdiv
  6072. @item 2rdiv
  6073. @item 3rdiv
  6074. Set multiplier for calculated value for each plane.
  6075. If unset or 0, it will be sum of all matrix elements.
  6076. @item 0bias
  6077. @item 1bias
  6078. @item 2bias
  6079. @item 3bias
  6080. Set bias for each plane. This value is added to the result of the multiplication.
  6081. Useful for making the overall image brighter or darker. Default is 0.0.
  6082. @item 0mode
  6083. @item 1mode
  6084. @item 2mode
  6085. @item 3mode
  6086. Set matrix mode for each plane. Can be @var{square}, @var{row} or @var{column}.
  6087. Default is @var{square}.
  6088. @end table
  6089. @subsection Examples
  6090. @itemize
  6091. @item
  6092. Apply sharpen:
  6093. @example
  6094. convolution="0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0"
  6095. @end example
  6096. @item
  6097. Apply blur:
  6098. @example
  6099. convolution="1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1/9:1/9:1/9:1/9"
  6100. @end example
  6101. @item
  6102. Apply edge enhance:
  6103. @example
  6104. convolution="0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:5:1:1:1:0:128:128:128"
  6105. @end example
  6106. @item
  6107. Apply edge detect:
  6108. @example
  6109. convolution="0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:128"
  6110. @end example
  6111. @item
  6112. Apply laplacian edge detector which includes diagonals:
  6113. @example
  6114. convolution="1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:0"
  6115. @end example
  6116. @item
  6117. Apply emboss:
  6118. @example
  6119. convolution="-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2"
  6120. @end example
  6121. @end itemize
  6122. @section convolve
  6123. Apply 2D convolution of video stream in frequency domain using second stream
  6124. as impulse.
  6125. The filter accepts the following options:
  6126. @table @option
  6127. @item planes
  6128. Set which planes to process.
  6129. @item impulse
  6130. Set which impulse video frames will be processed, can be @var{first}
  6131. or @var{all}. Default is @var{all}.
  6132. @end table
  6133. The @code{convolve} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  6134. @section copy
  6135. Copy the input video source unchanged to the output. This is mainly useful for
  6136. testing purposes.
  6137. @anchor{coreimage}
  6138. @section coreimage
  6139. Video filtering on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.
  6140. Hardware acceleration is based on an OpenGL context. Usually, this means it is
  6141. processed by video hardware. However, software-based OpenGL implementations
  6142. exist which means there is no guarantee for hardware processing. It depends on
  6143. the respective OSX.
  6144. There are many filters and image generators provided by Apple that come with a
  6145. large variety of options. The filter has to be referenced by its name along
  6146. with its options.
  6147. The coreimage filter accepts the following options:
  6148. @table @option
  6149. @item list_filters
  6150. List all available filters and generators along with all their respective
  6151. options as well as possible minimum and maximum values along with the default
  6152. values.
  6153. @example
  6154. list_filters=true
  6155. @end example
  6156. @item filter
  6157. Specify all filters by their respective name and options.
  6158. Use @var{list_filters} to determine all valid filter names and options.
  6159. Numerical options are specified by a float value and are automatically clamped
  6160. to their respective value range. Vector and color options have to be specified
  6161. by a list of space separated float values. Character escaping has to be done.
  6162. A special option name @code{default} is available to use default options for a
  6163. filter.
  6164. It is required to specify either @code{default} or at least one of the filter options.
  6165. All omitted options are used with their default values.
  6166. The syntax of the filter string is as follows:
  6167. @example
  6168. filter=<NAME>@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@@...][#<NAME>@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@@...]][#...]
  6169. @end example
  6170. @item output_rect
  6171. Specify a rectangle where the output of the filter chain is copied into the
  6172. input image. It is given by a list of space separated float values:
  6173. @example
  6174. output_rect=x\ y\ width\ height
  6175. @end example
  6176. If not given, the output rectangle equals the dimensions of the input image.
  6177. The output rectangle is automatically cropped at the borders of the input
  6178. image. Negative values are valid for each component.
  6179. @example
  6180. output_rect=25\ 25\ 100\ 100
  6181. @end example
  6182. @end table
  6183. Several filters can be chained for successive processing without GPU-HOST
  6184. transfers allowing for fast processing of complex filter chains.
  6185. Currently, only filters with zero (generators) or exactly one (filters) input
  6186. image and one output image are supported. Also, transition filters are not yet
  6187. usable as intended.
  6188. Some filters generate output images with additional padding depending on the
  6189. respective filter kernel. The padding is automatically removed to ensure the
  6190. filter output has the same size as the input image.
  6191. For image generators, the size of the output image is determined by the
  6192. previous output image of the filter chain or the input image of the whole
  6193. filterchain, respectively. The generators do not use the pixel information of
  6194. this image to generate their output. However, the generated output is
  6195. blended onto this image, resulting in partial or complete coverage of the
  6196. output image.
  6197. The @ref{coreimagesrc} video source can be used for generating input images
  6198. which are directly fed into the filter chain. By using it, providing input
  6199. images by another video source or an input video is not required.
  6200. @subsection Examples
  6201. @itemize
  6202. @item
  6203. List all filters available:
  6204. @example
  6205. coreimage=list_filters=true
  6206. @end example
  6207. @item
  6208. Use the CIBoxBlur filter with default options to blur an image:
  6209. @example
  6210. coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@@default
  6211. @end example
  6212. @item
  6213. Use a filter chain with CISepiaTone at default values and CIVignetteEffect with
  6214. its center at 100x100 and a radius of 50 pixels:
  6215. @example
  6216. coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@@default#CIVignetteEffect@@inputCenter=100\ 100@@inputRadius=50
  6217. @end example
  6218. @item
  6219. Use nullsrc and CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage,
  6220. given as complete and escaped command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:
  6221. @example
  6222. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=100x100,coreimage=filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png
  6223. @end example
  6224. @end itemize
  6225. @section cover_rect
  6226. Cover a rectangular object
  6227. It accepts the following options:
  6228. @table @option
  6229. @item cover
  6230. Filepath of the optional cover image, needs to be in yuv420.
  6231. @item mode
  6232. Set covering mode.
  6233. It accepts the following values:
  6234. @table @samp
  6235. @item cover
  6236. cover it by the supplied image
  6237. @item blur
  6238. cover it by interpolating the surrounding pixels
  6239. @end table
  6240. Default value is @var{blur}.
  6241. @end table
  6242. @subsection Examples
  6243. @itemize
  6244. @item
  6245. Cover a rectangular object by the supplied image of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  6246. @example
  6247. ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
  6248. @end example
  6249. @end itemize
  6250. @section crop
  6251. Crop the input video to given dimensions.
  6252. It accepts the following parameters:
  6253. @table @option
  6254. @item w, out_w
  6255. The width of the output video. It defaults to @code{iw}.
  6256. This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
  6257. configuration, or when the @samp{w} or @samp{out_w} command is sent.
  6258. @item h, out_h
  6259. The height of the output video. It defaults to @code{ih}.
  6260. This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
  6261. configuration, or when the @samp{h} or @samp{out_h} command is sent.
  6262. @item x
  6263. The horizontal position, in the input video, of the left edge of the output
  6264. video. It defaults to @code{(in_w-out_w)/2}.
  6265. This expression is evaluated per-frame.
  6266. @item y
  6267. The vertical position, in the input video, of the top edge of the output video.
  6268. It defaults to @code{(in_h-out_h)/2}.
  6269. This expression is evaluated per-frame.
  6270. @item keep_aspect
  6271. If set to 1 will force the output display aspect ratio
  6272. to be the same of the input, by changing the output sample aspect
  6273. ratio. It defaults to 0.
  6274. @item exact
  6275. Enable exact cropping. If enabled, subsampled videos will be cropped at exact
  6276. width/height/x/y as specified and will not be rounded to nearest smaller value.
  6277. It defaults to 0.
  6278. @end table
  6279. The @var{out_w}, @var{out_h}, @var{x}, @var{y} parameters are
  6280. expressions containing the following constants:
  6281. @table @option
  6282. @item x
  6283. @item y
  6284. The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
  6285. each new frame.
  6286. @item in_w
  6287. @item in_h
  6288. The input width and height.
  6289. @item iw
  6290. @item ih
  6291. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  6292. @item out_w
  6293. @item out_h
  6294. The output (cropped) width and height.
  6295. @item ow
  6296. @item oh
  6297. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  6298. @item a
  6299. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  6300. @item sar
  6301. input sample aspect ratio
  6302. @item dar
  6303. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  6304. @item hsub
  6305. @item vsub
  6306. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  6307. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  6308. @item n
  6309. The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  6310. @item pos
  6311. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  6312. @item t
  6313. The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  6314. @end table
  6315. The expression for @var{out_w} may depend on the value of @var{out_h},
  6316. and the expression for @var{out_h} may depend on @var{out_w}, but they
  6317. cannot depend on @var{x} and @var{y}, as @var{x} and @var{y} are
  6318. evaluated after @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  6319. The @var{x} and @var{y} parameters specify the expressions for the
  6320. position of the top-left corner of the output (non-cropped) area. They
  6321. are evaluated for each frame. If the evaluated value is not valid, it
  6322. is approximated to the nearest valid value.
  6323. The expression for @var{x} may depend on @var{y}, and the expression
  6324. for @var{y} may depend on @var{x}.
  6325. @subsection Examples
  6326. @itemize
  6327. @item
  6328. Crop area with size 100x100 at position (12,34).
  6329. @example
  6330. crop=100:100:12:34
  6331. @end example
  6332. Using named options, the example above becomes:
  6333. @example
  6334. crop=w=100:h=100:x=12:y=34
  6335. @end example
  6336. @item
  6337. Crop the central input area with size 100x100:
  6338. @example
  6339. crop=100:100
  6340. @end example
  6341. @item
  6342. Crop the central input area with size 2/3 of the input video:
  6343. @example
  6344. crop=2/3*in_w:2/3*in_h
  6345. @end example
  6346. @item
  6347. Crop the input video central square:
  6348. @example
  6349. crop=out_w=in_h
  6350. crop=in_h
  6351. @end example
  6352. @item
  6353. Delimit the rectangle with the top-left corner placed at position
  6354. 100:100 and the right-bottom corner corresponding to the right-bottom
  6355. corner of the input image.
  6356. @example
  6357. crop=in_w-100:in_h-100:100:100
  6358. @end example
  6359. @item
  6360. Crop 10 pixels from the left and right borders, and 20 pixels from
  6361. the top and bottom borders
  6362. @example
  6363. crop=in_w-2*10:in_h-2*20
  6364. @end example
  6365. @item
  6366. Keep only the bottom right quarter of the input image:
  6367. @example
  6368. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:in_w/2:in_h/2
  6369. @end example
  6370. @item
  6371. Crop height for getting Greek harmony:
  6372. @example
  6373. crop=in_w:1/PHI*in_w
  6374. @end example
  6375. @item
  6376. Apply trembling effect:
  6377. @example
  6378. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(n/10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(n/7)
  6379. @end example
  6380. @item
  6381. Apply erratic camera effect depending on timestamp:
  6382. @example
  6383. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(t*10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(t*13)"
  6384. @end example
  6385. @item
  6386. Set x depending on the value of y:
  6387. @example
  6388. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:y:10+10*sin(n/10)
  6389. @end example
  6390. @end itemize
  6391. @subsection Commands
  6392. This filter supports the following commands:
  6393. @table @option
  6394. @item w, out_w
  6395. @item h, out_h
  6396. @item x
  6397. @item y
  6398. Set width/height of the output video and the horizontal/vertical position
  6399. in the input video.
  6400. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  6401. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  6402. value.
  6403. @end table
  6404. @section cropdetect
  6405. Auto-detect the crop size.
  6406. It calculates the necessary cropping parameters and prints the
  6407. recommended parameters via the logging system. The detected dimensions
  6408. correspond to the non-black area of the input video.
  6409. It accepts the following parameters:
  6410. @table @option
  6411. @item limit
  6412. Set higher black value threshold, which can be optionally specified
  6413. from nothing (0) to everything (255 for 8-bit based formats). An intensity
  6414. value greater to the set value is considered non-black. It defaults to 24.
  6415. You can also specify a value between 0.0 and 1.0 which will be scaled depending
  6416. on the bitdepth of the pixel format.
  6417. @item round
  6418. The value which the width/height should be divisible by. It defaults to
  6419. 16. The offset is automatically adjusted to center the video. Use 2 to
  6420. get only even dimensions (needed for 4:2:2 video). 16 is best when
  6421. encoding to most video codecs.
  6422. @item reset_count, reset
  6423. Set the counter that determines after how many frames cropdetect will
  6424. reset the previously detected largest video area and start over to
  6425. detect the current optimal crop area. Default value is 0.
  6426. This can be useful when channel logos distort the video area. 0
  6427. indicates 'never reset', and returns the largest area encountered during
  6428. playback.
  6429. @end table
  6430. @anchor{cue}
  6431. @section cue
  6432. Delay video filtering until a given wallclock timestamp. The filter first
  6433. passes on @option{preroll} amount of frames, then it buffers at most
  6434. @option{buffer} amount of frames and waits for the cue. After reaching the cue
  6435. it forwards the buffered frames and also any subsequent frames coming in its
  6436. input.
  6437. The filter can be used synchronize the output of multiple ffmpeg processes for
  6438. realtime output devices like decklink. By putting the delay in the filtering
  6439. chain and pre-buffering frames the process can pass on data to output almost
  6440. immediately after the target wallclock timestamp is reached.
  6441. Perfect frame accuracy cannot be guaranteed, but the result is good enough for
  6442. some use cases.
  6443. @table @option
  6444. @item cue
  6445. The cue timestamp expressed in a UNIX timestamp in microseconds. Default is 0.
  6446. @item preroll
  6447. The duration of content to pass on as preroll expressed in seconds. Default is 0.
  6448. @item buffer
  6449. The maximum duration of content to buffer before waiting for the cue expressed
  6450. in seconds. Default is 0.
  6451. @end table
  6452. @anchor{curves}
  6453. @section curves
  6454. Apply color adjustments using curves.
  6455. This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop and GIMP curves tools. Each
  6456. component (red, green and blue) has its values defined by @var{N} key points
  6457. tied from each other using a smooth curve. The x-axis represents the pixel
  6458. values from the input frame, and the y-axis the new pixel values to be set for
  6459. the output frame.
  6460. By default, a component curve is defined by the two points @var{(0;0)} and
  6461. @var{(1;1)}. This creates a straight line where each original pixel value is
  6462. "adjusted" to its own value, which means no change to the image.
  6463. The filter allows you to redefine these two points and add some more. A new
  6464. curve (using a natural cubic spline interpolation) will be define to pass
  6465. smoothly through all these new coordinates. The new defined points needs to be
  6466. strictly increasing over the x-axis, and their @var{x} and @var{y} values must
  6467. be in the @var{[0;1]} interval. If the computed curves happened to go outside
  6468. the vector spaces, the values will be clipped accordingly.
  6469. The filter accepts the following options:
  6470. @table @option
  6471. @item preset
  6472. Select one of the available color presets. This option can be used in addition
  6473. to the @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} parameters; in this case, the later
  6474. options takes priority on the preset values.
  6475. Available presets are:
  6476. @table @samp
  6477. @item none
  6478. @item color_negative
  6479. @item cross_process
  6480. @item darker
  6481. @item increase_contrast
  6482. @item lighter
  6483. @item linear_contrast
  6484. @item medium_contrast
  6485. @item negative
  6486. @item strong_contrast
  6487. @item vintage
  6488. @end table
  6489. Default is @code{none}.
  6490. @item master, m
  6491. Set the master key points. These points will define a second pass mapping. It
  6492. is sometimes called a "luminance" or "value" mapping. It can be used with
  6493. @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} or @option{all} since it acts like a
  6494. post-processing LUT.
  6495. @item red, r
  6496. Set the key points for the red component.
  6497. @item green, g
  6498. Set the key points for the green component.
  6499. @item blue, b
  6500. Set the key points for the blue component.
  6501. @item all
  6502. Set the key points for all components (not including master).
  6503. Can be used in addition to the other key points component
  6504. options. In this case, the unset component(s) will fallback on this
  6505. @option{all} setting.
  6506. @item psfile
  6507. Specify a Photoshop curves file (@code{.acv}) to import the settings from.
  6508. @item plot
  6509. Save Gnuplot script of the curves in specified file.
  6510. @end table
  6511. To avoid some filtergraph syntax conflicts, each key points list need to be
  6512. defined using the following syntax: @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ...}.
  6513. @subsection Examples
  6514. @itemize
  6515. @item
  6516. Increase slightly the middle level of blue:
  6517. @example
  6518. curves=blue='0/0 0.5/0.58 1/1'
  6519. @end example
  6520. @item
  6521. Vintage effect:
  6522. @example
  6523. curves=r='0/0.11 .42/.51 1/0.95':g='0/0 0.50/0.48 1/1':b='0/0.22 .49/.44 1/0.8'
  6524. @end example
  6525. Here we obtain the following coordinates for each components:
  6526. @table @var
  6527. @item red
  6528. @code{(0;0.11) (0.42;0.51) (1;0.95)}
  6529. @item green
  6530. @code{(0;0) (0.50;0.48) (1;1)}
  6531. @item blue
  6532. @code{(0;0.22) (0.49;0.44) (1;0.80)}
  6533. @end table
  6534. @item
  6535. The previous example can also be achieved with the associated built-in preset:
  6536. @example
  6537. curves=preset=vintage
  6538. @end example
  6539. @item
  6540. Or simply:
  6541. @example
  6542. curves=vintage
  6543. @end example
  6544. @item
  6545. Use a Photoshop preset and redefine the points of the green component:
  6546. @example
  6547. curves=psfile='MyCurvesPresets/purple.acv':green='0/0 0.45/0.53 1/1'
  6548. @end example
  6549. @item
  6550. Check out the curves of the @code{cross_process} profile using @command{ffmpeg}
  6551. and @command{gnuplot}:
  6552. @example
  6553. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color -vf curves=cross_process:plot=/tmp/curves.plt -frames:v 1 -f null -
  6554. gnuplot -p /tmp/curves.plt
  6555. @end example
  6556. @end itemize
  6557. @section datascope
  6558. Video data analysis filter.
  6559. This filter shows hexadecimal pixel values of part of video.
  6560. The filter accepts the following options:
  6561. @table @option
  6562. @item size, s
  6563. Set output video size.
  6564. @item x
  6565. Set x offset from where to pick pixels.
  6566. @item y
  6567. Set y offset from where to pick pixels.
  6568. @item mode
  6569. Set scope mode, can be one of the following:
  6570. @table @samp
  6571. @item mono
  6572. Draw hexadecimal pixel values with white color on black background.
  6573. @item color
  6574. Draw hexadecimal pixel values with input video pixel color on black
  6575. background.
  6576. @item color2
  6577. Draw hexadecimal pixel values on color background picked from input video,
  6578. the text color is picked in such way so its always visible.
  6579. @end table
  6580. @item axis
  6581. Draw rows and columns numbers on left and top of video.
  6582. @item opacity
  6583. Set background opacity.
  6584. @item format
  6585. Set display number format. Can be @code{hex}, or @code{dec}. Default is @code{hex}.
  6586. @end table
  6587. @section dblur
  6588. Apply Directional blur filter.
  6589. The filter accepts the following options:
  6590. @table @option
  6591. @item angle
  6592. Set angle of directional blur. Default is @code{45}.
  6593. @item radius
  6594. Set radius of directional blur. Default is @code{5}.
  6595. @item planes
  6596. Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.
  6597. @end table
  6598. @subsection Commands
  6599. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  6600. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  6601. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  6602. value.
  6603. @section dctdnoiz
  6604. Denoise frames using 2D DCT (frequency domain filtering).
  6605. This filter is not designed for real time.
  6606. The filter accepts the following options:
  6607. @table @option
  6608. @item sigma, s
  6609. Set the noise sigma constant.
  6610. This @var{sigma} defines a hard threshold of @code{3 * sigma}; every DCT
  6611. coefficient (absolute value) below this threshold with be dropped.
  6612. If you need a more advanced filtering, see @option{expr}.
  6613. Default is @code{0}.
  6614. @item overlap
  6615. Set number overlapping pixels for each block. Since the filter can be slow, you
  6616. may want to reduce this value, at the cost of a less effective filter and the
  6617. risk of various artefacts.
  6618. If the overlapping value doesn't permit processing the whole input width or
  6619. height, a warning will be displayed and according borders won't be denoised.
  6620. Default value is @var{blocksize}-1, which is the best possible setting.
  6621. @item expr, e
  6622. Set the coefficient factor expression.
  6623. For each coefficient of a DCT block, this expression will be evaluated as a
  6624. multiplier value for the coefficient.
  6625. If this is option is set, the @option{sigma} option will be ignored.
  6626. The absolute value of the coefficient can be accessed through the @var{c}
  6627. variable.
  6628. @item n
  6629. Set the @var{blocksize} using the number of bits. @code{1<<@var{n}} defines the
  6630. @var{blocksize}, which is the width and height of the processed blocks.
  6631. The default value is @var{3} (8x8) and can be raised to @var{4} for a
  6632. @var{blocksize} of 16x16. Note that changing this setting has huge consequences
  6633. on the speed processing. Also, a larger block size does not necessarily means a
  6634. better de-noising.
  6635. @end table
  6636. @subsection Examples
  6637. Apply a denoise with a @option{sigma} of @code{4.5}:
  6638. @example
  6639. dctdnoiz=4.5
  6640. @end example
  6641. The same operation can be achieved using the expression system:
  6642. @example
  6643. dctdnoiz=e='gte(c, 4.5*3)'
  6644. @end example
  6645. Violent denoise using a block size of @code{16x16}:
  6646. @example
  6647. dctdnoiz=15:n=4
  6648. @end example
  6649. @section deband
  6650. Remove banding artifacts from input video.
  6651. It works by replacing banded pixels with average value of referenced pixels.
  6652. The filter accepts the following options:
  6653. @table @option
  6654. @item 1thr
  6655. @item 2thr
  6656. @item 3thr
  6657. @item 4thr
  6658. Set banding detection threshold for each plane. Default is 0.02.
  6659. Valid range is 0.00003 to 0.5.
  6660. If difference between current pixel and reference pixel is less than threshold,
  6661. it will be considered as banded.
  6662. @item range, r
  6663. Banding detection range in pixels. Default is 16. If positive, random number
  6664. in range 0 to set value will be used. If negative, exact absolute value
  6665. will be used.
  6666. The range defines square of four pixels around current pixel.
  6667. @item direction, d
  6668. Set direction in radians from which four pixel will be compared. If positive,
  6669. random direction from 0 to set direction will be picked. If negative, exact of
  6670. absolute value will be picked. For example direction 0, -PI or -2*PI radians
  6671. will pick only pixels on same row and -PI/2 will pick only pixels on same
  6672. column.
  6673. @item blur, b
  6674. If enabled, current pixel is compared with average value of all four
  6675. surrounding pixels. The default is enabled. If disabled current pixel is
  6676. compared with all four surrounding pixels. The pixel is considered banded
  6677. if only all four differences with surrounding pixels are less than threshold.
  6678. @item coupling, c
  6679. If enabled, current pixel is changed if and only if all pixel components are banded,
  6680. e.g. banding detection threshold is triggered for all color components.
  6681. The default is disabled.
  6682. @end table
  6683. @section deblock
  6684. Remove blocking artifacts from input video.
  6685. The filter accepts the following options:
  6686. @table @option
  6687. @item filter
  6688. Set filter type, can be @var{weak} or @var{strong}. Default is @var{strong}.
  6689. This controls what kind of deblocking is applied.
  6690. @item block
  6691. Set size of block, allowed range is from 4 to 512. Default is @var{8}.
  6692. @item alpha
  6693. @item beta
  6694. @item gamma
  6695. @item delta
  6696. Set blocking detection thresholds. Allowed range is 0 to 1.
  6697. Defaults are: @var{0.098} for @var{alpha} and @var{0.05} for the rest.
  6698. Using higher threshold gives more deblocking strength.
  6699. Setting @var{alpha} controls threshold detection at exact edge of block.
  6700. Remaining options controls threshold detection near the edge. Each one for
  6701. below/above or left/right. Setting any of those to @var{0} disables
  6702. deblocking.
  6703. @item planes
  6704. Set planes to filter. Default is to filter all available planes.
  6705. @end table
  6706. @subsection Examples
  6707. @itemize
  6708. @item
  6709. Deblock using weak filter and block size of 4 pixels.
  6710. @example
  6711. deblock=filter=weak:block=4
  6712. @end example
  6713. @item
  6714. Deblock using strong filter, block size of 4 pixels and custom thresholds for
  6715. deblocking more edges.
  6716. @example
  6717. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05
  6718. @end example
  6719. @item
  6720. Similar as above, but filter only first plane.
  6721. @example
  6722. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05:planes=1
  6723. @end example
  6724. @item
  6725. Similar as above, but filter only second and third plane.
  6726. @example
  6727. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05:planes=6
  6728. @end example
  6729. @end itemize
  6730. @anchor{decimate}
  6731. @section decimate
  6732. Drop duplicated frames at regular intervals.
  6733. The filter accepts the following options:
  6734. @table @option
  6735. @item cycle
  6736. Set the number of frames from which one will be dropped. Setting this to
  6737. @var{N} means one frame in every batch of @var{N} frames will be dropped.
  6738. Default is @code{5}.
  6739. @item dupthresh
  6740. Set the threshold for duplicate detection. If the difference metric for a frame
  6741. is less than or equal to this value, then it is declared as duplicate. Default
  6742. is @code{1.1}
  6743. @item scthresh
  6744. Set scene change threshold. Default is @code{15}.
  6745. @item blockx
  6746. @item blocky
  6747. Set the size of the x and y-axis blocks used during metric calculations.
  6748. Larger blocks give better noise suppression, but also give worse detection of
  6749. small movements. Must be a power of two. Default is @code{32}.
  6750. @item ppsrc
  6751. Mark main input as a pre-processed input and activate clean source input
  6752. stream. This allows the input to be pre-processed with various filters to help
  6753. the metrics calculation while keeping the frame selection lossless. When set to
  6754. @code{1}, the first stream is for the pre-processed input, and the second
  6755. stream is the clean source from where the kept frames are chosen. Default is
  6756. @code{0}.
  6757. @item chroma
  6758. Set whether or not chroma is considered in the metric calculations. Default is
  6759. @code{1}.
  6760. @end table
  6761. @section deconvolve
  6762. Apply 2D deconvolution of video stream in frequency domain using second stream
  6763. as impulse.
  6764. The filter accepts the following options:
  6765. @table @option
  6766. @item planes
  6767. Set which planes to process.
  6768. @item impulse
  6769. Set which impulse video frames will be processed, can be @var{first}
  6770. or @var{all}. Default is @var{all}.
  6771. @item noise
  6772. Set noise when doing divisions. Default is @var{0.0000001}. Useful when width
  6773. and height are not same and not power of 2 or if stream prior to convolving
  6774. had noise.
  6775. @end table
  6776. The @code{deconvolve} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  6777. @section dedot
  6778. Reduce cross-luminance (dot-crawl) and cross-color (rainbows) from video.
  6779. It accepts the following options:
  6780. @table @option
  6781. @item m
  6782. Set mode of operation. Can be combination of @var{dotcrawl} for cross-luminance reduction and/or
  6783. @var{rainbows} for cross-color reduction.
  6784. @item lt
  6785. Set spatial luma threshold. Lower values increases reduction of cross-luminance.
  6786. @item tl
  6787. Set tolerance for temporal luma. Higher values increases reduction of cross-luminance.
  6788. @item tc
  6789. Set tolerance for chroma temporal variation. Higher values increases reduction of cross-color.
  6790. @item ct
  6791. Set temporal chroma threshold. Lower values increases reduction of cross-color.
  6792. @end table
  6793. @section deflate
  6794. Apply deflate effect to the video.
  6795. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
  6796. only values lower than the pixel.
  6797. It accepts the following options:
  6798. @table @option
  6799. @item threshold0
  6800. @item threshold1
  6801. @item threshold2
  6802. @item threshold3
  6803. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  6804. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  6805. @end table
  6806. @subsection Commands
  6807. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  6808. @section deflicker
  6809. Remove temporal frame luminance variations.
  6810. It accepts the following options:
  6811. @table @option
  6812. @item size, s
  6813. Set moving-average filter size in frames. Default is 5. Allowed range is 2 - 129.
  6814. @item mode, m
  6815. Set averaging mode to smooth temporal luminance variations.
  6816. Available values are:
  6817. @table @samp
  6818. @item am
  6819. Arithmetic mean
  6820. @item gm
  6821. Geometric mean
  6822. @item hm
  6823. Harmonic mean
  6824. @item qm
  6825. Quadratic mean
  6826. @item cm
  6827. Cubic mean
  6828. @item pm
  6829. Power mean
  6830. @item median
  6831. Median
  6832. @end table
  6833. @item bypass
  6834. Do not actually modify frame. Useful when one only wants metadata.
  6835. @end table
  6836. @section dejudder
  6837. Remove judder produced by partially interlaced telecined content.
  6838. Judder can be introduced, for instance, by @ref{pullup} filter. If the original
  6839. source was partially telecined content then the output of @code{pullup,dejudder}
  6840. will have a variable frame rate. May change the recorded frame rate of the
  6841. container. Aside from that change, this filter will not affect constant frame
  6842. rate video.
  6843. The option available in this filter is:
  6844. @table @option
  6845. @item cycle
  6846. Specify the length of the window over which the judder repeats.
  6847. Accepts any integer greater than 1. Useful values are:
  6848. @table @samp
  6849. @item 4
  6850. If the original was telecined from 24 to 30 fps (Film to NTSC).
  6851. @item 5
  6852. If the original was telecined from 25 to 30 fps (PAL to NTSC).
  6853. @item 20
  6854. If a mixture of the two.
  6855. @end table
  6856. The default is @samp{4}.
  6857. @end table
  6858. @section delogo
  6859. Suppress a TV station logo by a simple interpolation of the surrounding
  6860. pixels. Just set a rectangle covering the logo and watch it disappear
  6861. (and sometimes something even uglier appear - your mileage may vary).
  6862. It accepts the following parameters:
  6863. @table @option
  6864. @item x
  6865. @item y
  6866. Specify the top left corner coordinates of the logo. They must be
  6867. specified.
  6868. @item w
  6869. @item h
  6870. Specify the width and height of the logo to clear. They must be
  6871. specified.
  6872. @item band, t
  6873. Specify the thickness of the fuzzy edge of the rectangle (added to
  6874. @var{w} and @var{h}). The default value is 1. This option is
  6875. deprecated, setting higher values should no longer be necessary and
  6876. is not recommended.
  6877. @item show
  6878. When set to 1, a green rectangle is drawn on the screen to simplify
  6879. finding the right @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, and @var{h} parameters.
  6880. The default value is 0.
  6881. The rectangle is drawn on the outermost pixels which will be (partly)
  6882. replaced with interpolated values. The values of the next pixels
  6883. immediately outside this rectangle in each direction will be used to
  6884. compute the interpolated pixel values inside the rectangle.
  6885. @end table
  6886. @subsection Examples
  6887. @itemize
  6888. @item
  6889. Set a rectangle covering the area with top left corner coordinates 0,0
  6890. and size 100x77, and a band of size 10:
  6891. @example
  6892. delogo=x=0:y=0:w=100:h=77:band=10
  6893. @end example
  6894. @end itemize
  6895. @anchor{derain}
  6896. @section derain
  6897. Remove the rain in the input image/video by applying the derain methods based on
  6898. convolutional neural networks. Supported models:
  6899. @itemize
  6900. @item
  6901. Recurrent Squeeze-and-Excitation Context Aggregation Net (RESCAN).
  6902. See @url{http://openaccess.thecvf.com/content_ECCV_2018/papers/Xia_Li_Recurrent_Squeeze-and-Excitation_Context_ECCV_2018_paper.pdf}.
  6903. @end itemize
  6904. Training as well as model generation scripts are provided in
  6905. the repository at @url{https://github.com/XueweiMeng/derain_filter.git}.
  6906. Native model files (.model) can be generated from TensorFlow model
  6907. files (.pb) by using tools/python/convert.py
  6908. The filter accepts the following options:
  6909. @table @option
  6910. @item filter_type
  6911. Specify which filter to use. This option accepts the following values:
  6912. @table @samp
  6913. @item derain
  6914. Derain filter. To conduct derain filter, you need to use a derain model.
  6915. @item dehaze
  6916. Dehaze filter. To conduct dehaze filter, you need to use a dehaze model.
  6917. @end table
  6918. Default value is @samp{derain}.
  6919. @item dnn_backend
  6920. Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts
  6921. the following values:
  6922. @table @samp
  6923. @item native
  6924. Native implementation of DNN loading and execution.
  6925. @item tensorflow
  6926. TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you
  6927. need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
  6928. @url{https://www.tensorflow.org/install/install_c}) and configure FFmpeg with
  6929. @code{--enable-libtensorflow}
  6930. @end table
  6931. Default value is @samp{native}.
  6932. @item model
  6933. Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.
  6934. Note that different backends use different file formats. TensorFlow and native
  6935. backend can load files for only its format.
  6936. @end table
  6937. It can also be finished with @ref{dnn_processing} filter.
  6938. @section deshake
  6939. Attempt to fix small changes in horizontal and/or vertical shift. This
  6940. filter helps remove camera shake from hand-holding a camera, bumping a
  6941. tripod, moving on a vehicle, etc.
  6942. The filter accepts the following options:
  6943. @table @option
  6944. @item x
  6945. @item y
  6946. @item w
  6947. @item h
  6948. Specify a rectangular area where to limit the search for motion
  6949. vectors.
  6950. If desired the search for motion vectors can be limited to a
  6951. rectangular area of the frame defined by its top left corner, width
  6952. and height. These parameters have the same meaning as the drawbox
  6953. filter which can be used to visualise the position of the bounding
  6954. box.
  6955. This is useful when simultaneous movement of subjects within the frame
  6956. might be confused for camera motion by the motion vector search.
  6957. If any or all of @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} are set to -1
  6958. then the full frame is used. This allows later options to be set
  6959. without specifying the bounding box for the motion vector search.
  6960. Default - search the whole frame.
  6961. @item rx
  6962. @item ry
  6963. Specify the maximum extent of movement in x and y directions in the
  6964. range 0-64 pixels. Default 16.
  6965. @item edge
  6966. Specify how to generate pixels to fill blanks at the edge of the
  6967. frame. Available values are:
  6968. @table @samp
  6969. @item blank, 0
  6970. Fill zeroes at blank locations
  6971. @item original, 1
  6972. Original image at blank locations
  6973. @item clamp, 2
  6974. Extruded edge value at blank locations
  6975. @item mirror, 3
  6976. Mirrored edge at blank locations
  6977. @end table
  6978. Default value is @samp{mirror}.
  6979. @item blocksize
  6980. Specify the blocksize to use for motion search. Range 4-128 pixels,
  6981. default 8.
  6982. @item contrast
  6983. Specify the contrast threshold for blocks. Only blocks with more than
  6984. the specified contrast (difference between darkest and lightest
  6985. pixels) will be considered. Range 1-255, default 125.
  6986. @item search
  6987. Specify the search strategy. Available values are:
  6988. @table @samp
  6989. @item exhaustive, 0
  6990. Set exhaustive search
  6991. @item less, 1
  6992. Set less exhaustive search.
  6993. @end table
  6994. Default value is @samp{exhaustive}.
  6995. @item filename
  6996. If set then a detailed log of the motion search is written to the
  6997. specified file.
  6998. @end table
  6999. @section despill
  7000. Remove unwanted contamination of foreground colors, caused by reflected color of
  7001. greenscreen or bluescreen.
  7002. This filter accepts the following options:
  7003. @table @option
  7004. @item type
  7005. Set what type of despill to use.
  7006. @item mix
  7007. Set how spillmap will be generated.
  7008. @item expand
  7009. Set how much to get rid of still remaining spill.
  7010. @item red
  7011. Controls amount of red in spill area.
  7012. @item green
  7013. Controls amount of green in spill area.
  7014. Should be -1 for greenscreen.
  7015. @item blue
  7016. Controls amount of blue in spill area.
  7017. Should be -1 for bluescreen.
  7018. @item brightness
  7019. Controls brightness of spill area, preserving colors.
  7020. @item alpha
  7021. Modify alpha from generated spillmap.
  7022. @end table
  7023. @section detelecine
  7024. Apply an exact inverse of the telecine operation. It requires a predefined
  7025. pattern specified using the pattern option which must be the same as that passed
  7026. to the telecine filter.
  7027. This filter accepts the following options:
  7028. @table @option
  7029. @item first_field
  7030. @table @samp
  7031. @item top, t
  7032. top field first
  7033. @item bottom, b
  7034. bottom field first
  7035. The default value is @code{top}.
  7036. @end table
  7037. @item pattern
  7038. A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
  7039. The default value is @code{23}.
  7040. @item start_frame
  7041. A number representing position of the first frame with respect to the telecine
  7042. pattern. This is to be used if the stream is cut. The default value is @code{0}.
  7043. @end table
  7044. @section dilation
  7045. Apply dilation effect to the video.
  7046. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) maximum.
  7047. It accepts the following options:
  7048. @table @option
  7049. @item threshold0
  7050. @item threshold1
  7051. @item threshold2
  7052. @item threshold3
  7053. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  7054. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  7055. @item coordinates
  7056. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
  7057. pixels are used.
  7058. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
  7059. 1 2 3
  7060. 4 5
  7061. 6 7 8
  7062. @end table
  7063. @subsection Commands
  7064. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  7065. @section displace
  7066. Displace pixels as indicated by second and third input stream.
  7067. It takes three input streams and outputs one stream, the first input is the
  7068. source, and second and third input are displacement maps.
  7069. The second input specifies how much to displace pixels along the
  7070. x-axis, while the third input specifies how much to displace pixels
  7071. along the y-axis.
  7072. If one of displacement map streams terminates, last frame from that
  7073. displacement map will be used.
  7074. Note that once generated, displacements maps can be reused over and over again.
  7075. A description of the accepted options follows.
  7076. @table @option
  7077. @item edge
  7078. Set displace behavior for pixels that are out of range.
  7079. Available values are:
  7080. @table @samp
  7081. @item blank
  7082. Missing pixels are replaced by black pixels.
  7083. @item smear
  7084. Adjacent pixels will spread out to replace missing pixels.
  7085. @item wrap
  7086. Out of range pixels are wrapped so they point to pixels of other side.
  7087. @item mirror
  7088. Out of range pixels will be replaced with mirrored pixels.
  7089. @end table
  7090. Default is @samp{smear}.
  7091. @end table
  7092. @subsection Examples
  7093. @itemize
  7094. @item
  7095. Add ripple effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
  7096. @example
  7097. ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,lutrgb=128:128:128 -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,geq='r=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):g=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):b=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T)' -lavfi '[0][1][2]displace' OUTPUT
  7098. @end example
  7099. @item
  7100. Add wave effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
  7101. @example
  7102. ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=hd720,geq='r=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):g=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):b=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T))' -lavfi '[1]split[x][y],[0][x][y]displace' OUTPUT
  7103. @end example
  7104. @end itemize
  7105. @anchor{dnn_processing}
  7106. @section dnn_processing
  7107. Do image processing with deep neural networks. It works together with another filter
  7108. which converts the pixel format of the Frame to what the dnn network requires.
  7109. The filter accepts the following options:
  7110. @table @option
  7111. @item dnn_backend
  7112. Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts
  7113. the following values:
  7114. @table @samp
  7115. @item native
  7116. Native implementation of DNN loading and execution.
  7117. @item tensorflow
  7118. TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you
  7119. need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
  7120. @url{https://www.tensorflow.org/install/install_c}) and configure FFmpeg with
  7121. @code{--enable-libtensorflow}
  7122. @end table
  7123. Default value is @samp{native}.
  7124. @item model
  7125. Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.
  7126. Note that different backends use different file formats. TensorFlow and native
  7127. backend can load files for only its format.
  7128. Native model file (.model) can be generated from TensorFlow model file (.pb) by using tools/python/convert.py
  7129. @item input
  7130. Set the input name of the dnn network.
  7131. @item output
  7132. Set the output name of the dnn network.
  7133. @end table
  7134. @subsection Examples
  7135. @itemize
  7136. @item
  7137. Remove rain in rgb24 frame with can.pb (see @ref{derain} filter):
  7138. @example
  7139. ./ffmpeg -i rain.jpg -vf format=rgb24,dnn_processing=dnn_backend=tensorflow:model=can.pb:input=x:output=y derain.jpg
  7140. @end example
  7141. @item
  7142. Halve the pixel value of the frame with format gray32f:
  7143. @example
  7144. ffmpeg -i input.jpg -vf format=grayf32,dnn_processing=model=halve_gray_float.model:input=dnn_in:output=dnn_out:dnn_backend=native -y out.native.png
  7145. @end example
  7146. @item
  7147. Handle the Y channel with srcnn.pb (see @ref{sr} filter) for frame with yuv420p (planar YUV formats supported):
  7148. @example
  7149. ./ffmpeg -i 480p.jpg -vf format=yuv420p,scale=w=iw*2:h=ih*2,dnn_processing=dnn_backend=tensorflow:model=srcnn.pb:input=x:output=y -y srcnn.jpg
  7150. @end example
  7151. @item
  7152. Handle the Y channel with espcn.pb (see @ref{sr} filter), which changes frame size, for format yuv420p (planar YUV formats supported):
  7153. @example
  7154. ./ffmpeg -i 480p.jpg -vf format=yuv420p,dnn_processing=dnn_backend=tensorflow:model=espcn.pb:input=x:output=y -y tmp.espcn.jpg
  7155. @end example
  7156. @end itemize
  7157. @section drawbox
  7158. Draw a colored box on the input image.
  7159. It accepts the following parameters:
  7160. @table @option
  7161. @item x
  7162. @item y
  7163. The expressions which specify the top left corner coordinates of the box. It defaults to 0.
  7164. @item width, w
  7165. @item height, h
  7166. The expressions which specify the width and height of the box; if 0 they are interpreted as
  7167. the input width and height. It defaults to 0.
  7168. @item color, c
  7169. Specify the color of the box to write. For the general syntax of this option,
  7170. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. If the special
  7171. value @code{invert} is used, the box edge color is the same as the
  7172. video with inverted luma.
  7173. @item thickness, t
  7174. The expression which sets the thickness of the box edge.
  7175. A value of @code{fill} will create a filled box. Default value is @code{3}.
  7176. See below for the list of accepted constants.
  7177. @item replace
  7178. Applicable if the input has alpha. With value @code{1}, the pixels of the painted box
  7179. will overwrite the video's color and alpha pixels.
  7180. Default is @code{0}, which composites the box onto the input, leaving the video's alpha intact.
  7181. @end table
  7182. The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
  7183. following constants:
  7184. @table @option
  7185. @item dar
  7186. The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  7187. @item hsub
  7188. @item vsub
  7189. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7190. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7191. @item in_h, ih
  7192. @item in_w, iw
  7193. The input width and height.
  7194. @item sar
  7195. The input sample aspect ratio.
  7196. @item x
  7197. @item y
  7198. The x and y offset coordinates where the box is drawn.
  7199. @item w
  7200. @item h
  7201. The width and height of the drawn box.
  7202. @item t
  7203. The thickness of the drawn box.
  7204. These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
  7205. each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
  7206. @end table
  7207. @subsection Examples
  7208. @itemize
  7209. @item
  7210. Draw a black box around the edge of the input image:
  7211. @example
  7212. drawbox
  7213. @end example
  7214. @item
  7215. Draw a box with color red and an opacity of 50%:
  7216. @example
  7217. drawbox=10:20:200:60:red@@0.5
  7218. @end example
  7219. The previous example can be specified as:
  7220. @example
  7221. drawbox=x=10:y=20:w=200:h=60:color=red@@0.5
  7222. @end example
  7223. @item
  7224. Fill the box with pink color:
  7225. @example
  7226. drawbox=x=10:y=10:w=100:h=100:color=pink@@0.5:t=fill
  7227. @end example
  7228. @item
  7229. Draw a 2-pixel red 2.40:1 mask:
  7230. @example
  7231. drawbox=x=-t:y=0.5*(ih-iw/2.4)-t:w=iw+t*2:h=iw/2.4+t*2:t=2:c=red
  7232. @end example
  7233. @end itemize
  7234. @subsection Commands
  7235. This filter supports same commands as options.
  7236. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  7237. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  7238. value.
  7239. @anchor{drawgraph}
  7240. @section drawgraph
  7241. Draw a graph using input video metadata.
  7242. It accepts the following parameters:
  7243. @table @option
  7244. @item m1
  7245. Set 1st frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  7246. @item fg1
  7247. Set 1st foreground color expression.
  7248. @item m2
  7249. Set 2nd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  7250. @item fg2
  7251. Set 2nd foreground color expression.
  7252. @item m3
  7253. Set 3rd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  7254. @item fg3
  7255. Set 3rd foreground color expression.
  7256. @item m4
  7257. Set 4th frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  7258. @item fg4
  7259. Set 4th foreground color expression.
  7260. @item min
  7261. Set minimal value of metadata value.
  7262. @item max
  7263. Set maximal value of metadata value.
  7264. @item bg
  7265. Set graph background color. Default is white.
  7266. @item mode
  7267. Set graph mode.
  7268. Available values for mode is:
  7269. @table @samp
  7270. @item bar
  7271. @item dot
  7272. @item line
  7273. @end table
  7274. Default is @code{line}.
  7275. @item slide
  7276. Set slide mode.
  7277. Available values for slide is:
  7278. @table @samp
  7279. @item frame
  7280. Draw new frame when right border is reached.
  7281. @item replace
  7282. Replace old columns with new ones.
  7283. @item scroll
  7284. Scroll from right to left.
  7285. @item rscroll
  7286. Scroll from left to right.
  7287. @item picture
  7288. Draw single picture.
  7289. @end table
  7290. Default is @code{frame}.
  7291. @item size
  7292. Set size of graph video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  7293. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7294. The default value is @code{900x256}.
  7295. @item rate, r
  7296. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  7297. The foreground color expressions can use the following variables:
  7298. @table @option
  7299. @item MIN
  7300. Minimal value of metadata value.
  7301. @item MAX
  7302. Maximal value of metadata value.
  7303. @item VAL
  7304. Current metadata key value.
  7305. @end table
  7306. The color is defined as 0xAABBGGRR.
  7307. @end table
  7308. Example using metadata from @ref{signalstats} filter:
  7309. @example
  7310. signalstats,drawgraph=lavfi.signalstats.YAVG:min=0:max=255
  7311. @end example
  7312. Example using metadata from @ref{ebur128} filter:
  7313. @example
  7314. ebur128=metadata=1,adrawgraph=lavfi.r128.M:min=-120:max=5
  7315. @end example
  7316. @section drawgrid
  7317. Draw a grid on the input image.
  7318. It accepts the following parameters:
  7319. @table @option
  7320. @item x
  7321. @item y
  7322. The expressions which specify the coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset). Both default to 0.
  7323. @item width, w
  7324. @item height, h
  7325. The expressions which specify the width and height of the grid cell, if 0 they are interpreted as the
  7326. input width and height, respectively, minus @code{thickness}, so image gets
  7327. framed. Default to 0.
  7328. @item color, c
  7329. Specify the color of the grid. For the general syntax of this option,
  7330. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. If the special
  7331. value @code{invert} is used, the grid color is the same as the
  7332. video with inverted luma.
  7333. @item thickness, t
  7334. The expression which sets the thickness of the grid line. Default value is @code{1}.
  7335. See below for the list of accepted constants.
  7336. @item replace
  7337. Applicable if the input has alpha. With @code{1} the pixels of the painted grid
  7338. will overwrite the video's color and alpha pixels.
  7339. Default is @code{0}, which composites the grid onto the input, leaving the video's alpha intact.
  7340. @end table
  7341. The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
  7342. following constants:
  7343. @table @option
  7344. @item dar
  7345. The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  7346. @item hsub
  7347. @item vsub
  7348. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7349. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7350. @item in_h, ih
  7351. @item in_w, iw
  7352. The input grid cell width and height.
  7353. @item sar
  7354. The input sample aspect ratio.
  7355. @item x
  7356. @item y
  7357. The x and y coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset).
  7358. @item w
  7359. @item h
  7360. The width and height of the drawn cell.
  7361. @item t
  7362. The thickness of the drawn cell.
  7363. These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
  7364. each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
  7365. @end table
  7366. @subsection Examples
  7367. @itemize
  7368. @item
  7369. Draw a grid with cell 100x100 pixels, thickness 2 pixels, with color red and an opacity of 50%:
  7370. @example
  7371. drawgrid=width=100:height=100:thickness=2:color=red@@0.5
  7372. @end example
  7373. @item
  7374. Draw a white 3x3 grid with an opacity of 50%:
  7375. @example
  7376. drawgrid=w=iw/3:h=ih/3:t=2:c=white@@0.5
  7377. @end example
  7378. @end itemize
  7379. @subsection Commands
  7380. This filter supports same commands as options.
  7381. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  7382. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  7383. value.
  7384. @anchor{drawtext}
  7385. @section drawtext
  7386. Draw a text string or text from a specified file on top of a video, using the
  7387. libfreetype library.
  7388. To enable compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  7389. @code{--enable-libfreetype}.
  7390. To enable default font fallback and the @var{font} option you need to
  7391. configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libfontconfig}.
  7392. To enable the @var{text_shaping} option, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  7393. @code{--enable-libfribidi}.
  7394. @subsection Syntax
  7395. It accepts the following parameters:
  7396. @table @option
  7397. @item box
  7398. Used to draw a box around text using the background color.
  7399. The value must be either 1 (enable) or 0 (disable).
  7400. The default value of @var{box} is 0.
  7401. @item boxborderw
  7402. Set the width of the border to be drawn around the box using @var{boxcolor}.
  7403. The default value of @var{boxborderw} is 0.
  7404. @item boxcolor
  7405. The color to be used for drawing box around text. For the syntax of this
  7406. option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7407. The default value of @var{boxcolor} is "white".
  7408. @item line_spacing
  7409. Set the line spacing in pixels of the border to be drawn around the box using @var{box}.
  7410. The default value of @var{line_spacing} is 0.
  7411. @item borderw
  7412. Set the width of the border to be drawn around the text using @var{bordercolor}.
  7413. The default value of @var{borderw} is 0.
  7414. @item bordercolor
  7415. Set the color to be used for drawing border around text. For the syntax of this
  7416. option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7417. The default value of @var{bordercolor} is "black".
  7418. @item expansion
  7419. Select how the @var{text} is expanded. Can be either @code{none},
  7420. @code{strftime} (deprecated) or
  7421. @code{normal} (default). See the @ref{drawtext_expansion, Text expansion} section
  7422. below for details.
  7423. @item basetime
  7424. Set a start time for the count. Value is in microseconds. Only applied
  7425. in the deprecated strftime expansion mode. To emulate in normal expansion
  7426. mode use the @code{pts} function, supplying the start time (in seconds)
  7427. as the second argument.
  7428. @item fix_bounds
  7429. If true, check and fix text coords to avoid clipping.
  7430. @item fontcolor
  7431. The color to be used for drawing fonts. For the syntax of this option, check
  7432. the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7433. The default value of @var{fontcolor} is "black".
  7434. @item fontcolor_expr
  7435. String which is expanded the same way as @var{text} to obtain dynamic
  7436. @var{fontcolor} value. By default this option has empty value and is not
  7437. processed. When this option is set, it overrides @var{fontcolor} option.
  7438. @item font
  7439. The font family to be used for drawing text. By default Sans.
  7440. @item fontfile
  7441. The font file to be used for drawing text. The path must be included.
  7442. This parameter is mandatory if the fontconfig support is disabled.
  7443. @item alpha
  7444. Draw the text applying alpha blending. The value can
  7445. be a number between 0.0 and 1.0.
  7446. The expression accepts the same variables @var{x, y} as well.
  7447. The default value is 1.
  7448. Please see @var{fontcolor_expr}.
  7449. @item fontsize
  7450. The font size to be used for drawing text.
  7451. The default value of @var{fontsize} is 16.
  7452. @item text_shaping
  7453. If set to 1, attempt to shape the text (for example, reverse the order of
  7454. right-to-left text and join Arabic characters) before drawing it.
  7455. Otherwise, just draw the text exactly as given.
  7456. By default 1 (if supported).
  7457. @item ft_load_flags
  7458. The flags to be used for loading the fonts.
  7459. The flags map the corresponding flags supported by libfreetype, and are
  7460. a combination of the following values:
  7461. @table @var
  7462. @item default
  7463. @item no_scale
  7464. @item no_hinting
  7465. @item render
  7466. @item no_bitmap
  7467. @item vertical_layout
  7468. @item force_autohint
  7469. @item crop_bitmap
  7470. @item pedantic
  7471. @item ignore_global_advance_width
  7472. @item no_recurse
  7473. @item ignore_transform
  7474. @item monochrome
  7475. @item linear_design
  7476. @item no_autohint
  7477. @end table
  7478. Default value is "default".
  7479. For more information consult the documentation for the FT_LOAD_*
  7480. libfreetype flags.
  7481. @item shadowcolor
  7482. The color to be used for drawing a shadow behind the drawn text. For the
  7483. syntax of this option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the
  7484. ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7485. The default value of @var{shadowcolor} is "black".
  7486. @item shadowx
  7487. @item shadowy
  7488. The x and y offsets for the text shadow position with respect to the
  7489. position of the text. They can be either positive or negative
  7490. values. The default value for both is "0".
  7491. @item start_number
  7492. The starting frame number for the n/frame_num variable. The default value
  7493. is "0".
  7494. @item tabsize
  7495. The size in number of spaces to use for rendering the tab.
  7496. Default value is 4.
  7497. @item timecode
  7498. Set the initial timecode representation in "hh:mm:ss[:;.]ff"
  7499. format. It can be used with or without text parameter. @var{timecode_rate}
  7500. option must be specified.
  7501. @item timecode_rate, rate, r
  7502. Set the timecode frame rate (timecode only). Value will be rounded to nearest
  7503. integer. Minimum value is "1".
  7504. Drop-frame timecode is supported for frame rates 30 & 60.
  7505. @item tc24hmax
  7506. If set to 1, the output of the timecode option will wrap around at 24 hours.
  7507. Default is 0 (disabled).
  7508. @item text
  7509. The text string to be drawn. The text must be a sequence of UTF-8
  7510. encoded characters.
  7511. This parameter is mandatory if no file is specified with the parameter
  7512. @var{textfile}.
  7513. @item textfile
  7514. A text file containing text to be drawn. The text must be a sequence
  7515. of UTF-8 encoded characters.
  7516. This parameter is mandatory if no text string is specified with the
  7517. parameter @var{text}.
  7518. If both @var{text} and @var{textfile} are specified, an error is thrown.
  7519. @item reload
  7520. If set to 1, the @var{textfile} will be reloaded before each frame.
  7521. Be sure to update it atomically, or it may be read partially, or even fail.
  7522. @item x
  7523. @item y
  7524. The expressions which specify the offsets where text will be drawn
  7525. within the video frame. They are relative to the top/left border of the
  7526. output image.
  7527. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is "0".
  7528. See below for the list of accepted constants and functions.
  7529. @end table
  7530. The parameters for @var{x} and @var{y} are expressions containing the
  7531. following constants and functions:
  7532. @table @option
  7533. @item dar
  7534. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
  7535. @item hsub
  7536. @item vsub
  7537. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7538. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7539. @item line_h, lh
  7540. the height of each text line
  7541. @item main_h, h, H
  7542. the input height
  7543. @item main_w, w, W
  7544. the input width
  7545. @item max_glyph_a, ascent
  7546. the maximum distance from the baseline to the highest/upper grid
  7547. coordinate used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered
  7548. glyphs.
  7549. It is a positive value, due to the grid's orientation with the Y axis
  7550. upwards.
  7551. @item max_glyph_d, descent
  7552. the maximum distance from the baseline to the lowest grid coordinate
  7553. used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered glyphs.
  7554. This is a negative value, due to the grid's orientation, with the Y axis
  7555. upwards.
  7556. @item max_glyph_h
  7557. maximum glyph height, that is the maximum height for all the glyphs
  7558. contained in the rendered text, it is equivalent to @var{ascent} -
  7559. @var{descent}.
  7560. @item max_glyph_w
  7561. maximum glyph width, that is the maximum width for all the glyphs
  7562. contained in the rendered text
  7563. @item n
  7564. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  7565. @item rand(min, max)
  7566. return a random number included between @var{min} and @var{max}
  7567. @item sar
  7568. The input sample aspect ratio.
  7569. @item t
  7570. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  7571. @item text_h, th
  7572. the height of the rendered text
  7573. @item text_w, tw
  7574. the width of the rendered text
  7575. @item x
  7576. @item y
  7577. the x and y offset coordinates where the text is drawn.
  7578. These parameters allow the @var{x} and @var{y} expressions to refer
  7579. to each other, so you can for example specify @code{y=x/dar}.
  7580. @item pict_type
  7581. A one character description of the current frame's picture type.
  7582. @item pkt_pos
  7583. The current packet's position in the input file or stream
  7584. (in bytes, from the start of the input). A value of -1 indicates
  7585. this info is not available.
  7586. @item pkt_duration
  7587. The current packet's duration, in seconds.
  7588. @item pkt_size
  7589. The current packet's size (in bytes).
  7590. @end table
  7591. @anchor{drawtext_expansion}
  7592. @subsection Text expansion
  7593. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{strftime},
  7594. the filter recognizes strftime() sequences in the provided text and
  7595. expands them accordingly. Check the documentation of strftime(). This
  7596. feature is deprecated.
  7597. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{none}, the text is printed verbatim.
  7598. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{normal} (which is the default),
  7599. the following expansion mechanism is used.
  7600. The backslash character @samp{\}, followed by any character, always expands to
  7601. the second character.
  7602. Sequences of the form @code{%@{...@}} are expanded. The text between the
  7603. braces is a function name, possibly followed by arguments separated by ':'.
  7604. If the arguments contain special characters or delimiters (':' or '@}'),
  7605. they should be escaped.
  7606. Note that they probably must also be escaped as the value for the
  7607. @option{text} option in the filter argument string and as the filter
  7608. argument in the filtergraph description, and possibly also for the shell,
  7609. that makes up to four levels of escaping; using a text file avoids these
  7610. problems.
  7611. The following functions are available:
  7612. @table @command
  7613. @item expr, e
  7614. The expression evaluation result.
  7615. It must take one argument specifying the expression to be evaluated,
  7616. which accepts the same constants and functions as the @var{x} and
  7617. @var{y} values. Note that not all constants should be used, for
  7618. example the text size is not known when evaluating the expression, so
  7619. the constants @var{text_w} and @var{text_h} will have an undefined
  7620. value.
  7621. @item expr_int_format, eif
  7622. Evaluate the expression's value and output as formatted integer.
  7623. The first argument is the expression to be evaluated, just as for the @var{expr} function.
  7624. The second argument specifies the output format. Allowed values are @samp{x},
  7625. @samp{X}, @samp{d} and @samp{u}. They are treated exactly as in the
  7626. @code{printf} function.
  7627. The third parameter is optional and sets the number of positions taken by the output.
  7628. It can be used to add padding with zeros from the left.
  7629. @item gmtime
  7630. The time at which the filter is running, expressed in UTC.
  7631. It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
  7632. @item localtime
  7633. The time at which the filter is running, expressed in the local time zone.
  7634. It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
  7635. @item metadata
  7636. Frame metadata. Takes one or two arguments.
  7637. The first argument is mandatory and specifies the metadata key.
  7638. The second argument is optional and specifies a default value, used when the
  7639. metadata key is not found or empty.
  7640. Available metadata can be identified by inspecting entries
  7641. starting with TAG included within each frame section
  7642. printed by running @code{ffprobe -show_frames}.
  7643. String metadata generated in filters leading to
  7644. the drawtext filter are also available.
  7645. @item n, frame_num
  7646. The frame number, starting from 0.
  7647. @item pict_type
  7648. A one character description of the current picture type.
  7649. @item pts
  7650. The timestamp of the current frame.
  7651. It can take up to three arguments.
  7652. The first argument is the format of the timestamp; it defaults to @code{flt}
  7653. for seconds as a decimal number with microsecond accuracy; @code{hms} stands
  7654. for a formatted @var{[-]HH:MM:SS.mmm} timestamp with millisecond accuracy.
  7655. @code{gmtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as UTC time;
  7656. @code{localtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as
  7657. local time zone time.
  7658. The second argument is an offset added to the timestamp.
  7659. If the format is set to @code{hms}, a third argument @code{24HH} may be
  7660. supplied to present the hour part of the formatted timestamp in 24h format
  7661. (00-23).
  7662. If the format is set to @code{localtime} or @code{gmtime},
  7663. a third argument may be supplied: a strftime() format string.
  7664. By default, @var{YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS} format will be used.
  7665. @end table
  7666. @subsection Commands
  7667. This filter supports altering parameters via commands:
  7668. @table @option
  7669. @item reinit
  7670. Alter existing filter parameters.
  7671. Syntax for the argument is the same as for filter invocation, e.g.
  7672. @example
  7673. fontsize=56:fontcolor=green:text='Hello World'
  7674. @end example
  7675. Full filter invocation with sendcmd would look like this:
  7676. @example
  7677. sendcmd=c='56.0 drawtext reinit fontsize=56\:fontcolor=green\:text=Hello\\ World'
  7678. @end example
  7679. @end table
  7680. If the entire argument can't be parsed or applied as valid values then the filter will
  7681. continue with its existing parameters.
  7682. @subsection Examples
  7683. @itemize
  7684. @item
  7685. Draw "Test Text" with font FreeSerif, using the default values for the
  7686. optional parameters.
  7687. @example
  7688. drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text'"
  7689. @end example
  7690. @item
  7691. Draw 'Test Text' with font FreeSerif of size 24 at position x=100
  7692. and y=50 (counting from the top-left corner of the screen), text is
  7693. yellow with a red box around it. Both the text and the box have an
  7694. opacity of 20%.
  7695. @example
  7696. drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text':\
  7697. x=100: y=50: fontsize=24: fontcolor=yellow@@0.2: box=1: boxcolor=red@@0.2"
  7698. @end example
  7699. Note that the double quotes are not necessary if spaces are not used
  7700. within the parameter list.
  7701. @item
  7702. Show the text at the center of the video frame:
  7703. @example
  7704. drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=(w-text_w)/2:y=(h-text_h)/2"
  7705. @end example
  7706. @item
  7707. Show the text at a random position, switching to a new position every 30 seconds:
  7708. @example
  7709. drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(w-text_w))\,x):y=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(h-text_h))\,y)"
  7710. @end example
  7711. @item
  7712. Show a text line sliding from right to left in the last row of the video
  7713. frame. The file @file{LONG_LINE} is assumed to contain a single line
  7714. with no newlines.
  7715. @example
  7716. drawtext="fontsize=15:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=LONG_LINE:y=h-line_h:x=-50*t"
  7717. @end example
  7718. @item
  7719. Show the content of file @file{CREDITS} off the bottom of the frame and scroll up.
  7720. @example
  7721. drawtext="fontsize=20:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=CREDITS:y=h-20*t"
  7722. @end example
  7723. @item
  7724. Draw a single green letter "g", at the center of the input video.
  7725. The glyph baseline is placed at half screen height.
  7726. @example
  7727. drawtext="fontsize=60:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=green:text=g:x=(w-max_glyph_w)/2:y=h/2-ascent"
  7728. @end example
  7729. @item
  7730. Show text for 1 second every 3 seconds:
  7731. @example
  7732. drawtext="fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=white:x=100:y=x/dar:enable=lt(mod(t\,3)\,1):text='blink'"
  7733. @end example
  7734. @item
  7735. Use fontconfig to set the font. Note that the colons need to be escaped.
  7736. @example
  7737. drawtext='fontfile=Linux Libertine O-40\:style=Semibold:text=FFmpeg'
  7738. @end example
  7739. @item
  7740. Print the date of a real-time encoding (see strftime(3)):
  7741. @example
  7742. drawtext='fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=%@{localtime\:%a %b %d %Y@}'
  7743. @end example
  7744. @item
  7745. Show text fading in and out (appearing/disappearing):
  7746. @example
  7747. #!/bin/sh
  7748. DS=1.0 # display start
  7749. DE=10.0 # display end
  7750. FID=1.5 # fade in duration
  7751. FOD=5 # fade out duration
  7752. ffplay -f lavfi "color,drawtext=text=TEST:fontsize=50:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor_expr=ff0000%@{eif\\\\: clip(255*(1*between(t\\, $DS + $FID\\, $DE - $FOD) + ((t - $DS)/$FID)*between(t\\, $DS\\, $DS + $FID) + (-(t - $DE)/$FOD)*between(t\\, $DE - $FOD\\, $DE) )\\, 0\\, 255) \\\\: x\\\\: 2 @}"
  7753. @end example
  7754. @item
  7755. Horizontally align multiple separate texts. Note that @option{max_glyph_a}
  7756. and the @option{fontsize} value are included in the @option{y} offset.
  7757. @example
  7758. drawtext=fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=DOG:fontsize=24:x=10:y=20+24-max_glyph_a,
  7759. drawtext=fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=cow:fontsize=24:x=80:y=20+24-max_glyph_a
  7760. @end example
  7761. @item
  7762. Plot special @var{lavf.image2dec.source_basename} metadata onto each frame if
  7763. such metadata exists. Otherwise, plot the string "NA". Note that image2 demuxer
  7764. must have option @option{-export_path_metadata 1} for the special metadata fields
  7765. to be available for filters.
  7766. @example
  7767. drawtext="fontsize=20:fontcolor=white:fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text='%@{metadata\:lavf.image2dec.source_basename\:NA@}':x=10:y=10"
  7768. @end example
  7769. @end itemize
  7770. For more information about libfreetype, check:
  7771. @url{http://www.freetype.org/}.
  7772. For more information about fontconfig, check:
  7773. @url{http://freedesktop.org/software/fontconfig/fontconfig-user.html}.
  7774. For more information about libfribidi, check:
  7775. @url{http://fribidi.org/}.
  7776. @section edgedetect
  7777. Detect and draw edges. The filter uses the Canny Edge Detection algorithm.
  7778. The filter accepts the following options:
  7779. @table @option
  7780. @item low
  7781. @item high
  7782. Set low and high threshold values used by the Canny thresholding
  7783. algorithm.
  7784. The high threshold selects the "strong" edge pixels, which are then
  7785. connected through 8-connectivity with the "weak" edge pixels selected
  7786. by the low threshold.
  7787. @var{low} and @var{high} threshold values must be chosen in the range
  7788. [0,1], and @var{low} should be lesser or equal to @var{high}.
  7789. Default value for @var{low} is @code{20/255}, and default value for @var{high}
  7790. is @code{50/255}.
  7791. @item mode
  7792. Define the drawing mode.
  7793. @table @samp
  7794. @item wires
  7795. Draw white/gray wires on black background.
  7796. @item colormix
  7797. Mix the colors to create a paint/cartoon effect.
  7798. @item canny
  7799. Apply Canny edge detector on all selected planes.
  7800. @end table
  7801. Default value is @var{wires}.
  7802. @item planes
  7803. Select planes for filtering. By default all available planes are filtered.
  7804. @end table
  7805. @subsection Examples
  7806. @itemize
  7807. @item
  7808. Standard edge detection with custom values for the hysteresis thresholding:
  7809. @example
  7810. edgedetect=low=0.1:high=0.4
  7811. @end example
  7812. @item
  7813. Painting effect without thresholding:
  7814. @example
  7815. edgedetect=mode=colormix:high=0
  7816. @end example
  7817. @end itemize
  7818. @section elbg
  7819. Apply a posterize effect using the ELBG (Enhanced LBG) algorithm.
  7820. For each input image, the filter will compute the optimal mapping from
  7821. the input to the output given the codebook length, that is the number
  7822. of distinct output colors.
  7823. This filter accepts the following options.
  7824. @table @option
  7825. @item codebook_length, l
  7826. Set codebook length. The value must be a positive integer, and
  7827. represents the number of distinct output colors. Default value is 256.
  7828. @item nb_steps, n
  7829. Set the maximum number of iterations to apply for computing the optimal
  7830. mapping. The higher the value the better the result and the higher the
  7831. computation time. Default value is 1.
  7832. @item seed, s
  7833. Set a random seed, must be an integer included between 0 and
  7834. UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly set to -1, the filter
  7835. will try to use a good random seed on a best effort basis.
  7836. @item pal8
  7837. Set pal8 output pixel format. This option does not work with codebook
  7838. length greater than 256.
  7839. @end table
  7840. @section entropy
  7841. Measure graylevel entropy in histogram of color channels of video frames.
  7842. It accepts the following parameters:
  7843. @table @option
  7844. @item mode
  7845. Can be either @var{normal} or @var{diff}. Default is @var{normal}.
  7846. @var{diff} mode measures entropy of histogram delta values, absolute differences
  7847. between neighbour histogram values.
  7848. @end table
  7849. @section eq
  7850. Set brightness, contrast, saturation and approximate gamma adjustment.
  7851. The filter accepts the following options:
  7852. @table @option
  7853. @item contrast
  7854. Set the contrast expression. The value must be a float value in range
  7855. @code{-1000.0} to @code{1000.0}. The default value is "1".
  7856. @item brightness
  7857. Set the brightness expression. The value must be a float value in
  7858. range @code{-1.0} to @code{1.0}. The default value is "0".
  7859. @item saturation
  7860. Set the saturation expression. The value must be a float in
  7861. range @code{0.0} to @code{3.0}. The default value is "1".
  7862. @item gamma
  7863. Set the gamma expression. The value must be a float in range
  7864. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7865. @item gamma_r
  7866. Set the gamma expression for red. The value must be a float in
  7867. range @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7868. @item gamma_g
  7869. Set the gamma expression for green. The value must be a float in range
  7870. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7871. @item gamma_b
  7872. Set the gamma expression for blue. The value must be a float in range
  7873. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7874. @item gamma_weight
  7875. Set the gamma weight expression. It can be used to reduce the effect
  7876. of a high gamma value on bright image areas, e.g. keep them from
  7877. getting overamplified and just plain white. The value must be a float
  7878. in range @code{0.0} to @code{1.0}. A value of @code{0.0} turns the
  7879. gamma correction all the way down while @code{1.0} leaves it at its
  7880. full strength. Default is "1".
  7881. @item eval
  7882. Set when the expressions for brightness, contrast, saturation and
  7883. gamma expressions are evaluated.
  7884. It accepts the following values:
  7885. @table @samp
  7886. @item init
  7887. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  7888. when a command is processed
  7889. @item frame
  7890. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  7891. @end table
  7892. Default value is @samp{init}.
  7893. @end table
  7894. The expressions accept the following parameters:
  7895. @table @option
  7896. @item n
  7897. frame count of the input frame starting from 0
  7898. @item pos
  7899. byte position of the corresponding packet in the input file, NAN if
  7900. unspecified
  7901. @item r
  7902. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  7903. @item t
  7904. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  7905. @end table
  7906. @subsection Commands
  7907. The filter supports the following commands:
  7908. @table @option
  7909. @item contrast
  7910. Set the contrast expression.
  7911. @item brightness
  7912. Set the brightness expression.
  7913. @item saturation
  7914. Set the saturation expression.
  7915. @item gamma
  7916. Set the gamma expression.
  7917. @item gamma_r
  7918. Set the gamma_r expression.
  7919. @item gamma_g
  7920. Set gamma_g expression.
  7921. @item gamma_b
  7922. Set gamma_b expression.
  7923. @item gamma_weight
  7924. Set gamma_weight expression.
  7925. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  7926. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  7927. value.
  7928. @end table
  7929. @section erosion
  7930. Apply erosion effect to the video.
  7931. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) minimum.
  7932. It accepts the following options:
  7933. @table @option
  7934. @item threshold0
  7935. @item threshold1
  7936. @item threshold2
  7937. @item threshold3
  7938. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  7939. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  7940. @item coordinates
  7941. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
  7942. pixels are used.
  7943. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
  7944. 1 2 3
  7945. 4 5
  7946. 6 7 8
  7947. @end table
  7948. @subsection Commands
  7949. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  7950. @section extractplanes
  7951. Extract color channel components from input video stream into
  7952. separate grayscale video streams.
  7953. The filter accepts the following option:
  7954. @table @option
  7955. @item planes
  7956. Set plane(s) to extract.
  7957. Available values for planes are:
  7958. @table @samp
  7959. @item y
  7960. @item u
  7961. @item v
  7962. @item a
  7963. @item r
  7964. @item g
  7965. @item b
  7966. @end table
  7967. Choosing planes not available in the input will result in an error.
  7968. That means you cannot select @code{r}, @code{g}, @code{b} planes
  7969. with @code{y}, @code{u}, @code{v} planes at same time.
  7970. @end table
  7971. @subsection Examples
  7972. @itemize
  7973. @item
  7974. Extract luma, u and v color channel component from input video frame
  7975. into 3 grayscale outputs:
  7976. @example
  7977. ffmpeg -i video.avi -filter_complex 'extractplanes=y+u+v[y][u][v]' -map '[y]' y.avi -map '[u]' u.avi -map '[v]' v.avi
  7978. @end example
  7979. @end itemize
  7980. @section fade
  7981. Apply a fade-in/out effect to the input video.
  7982. It accepts the following parameters:
  7983. @table @option
  7984. @item type, t
  7985. The effect type can be either "in" for a fade-in, or "out" for a fade-out
  7986. effect.
  7987. Default is @code{in}.
  7988. @item start_frame, s
  7989. Specify the number of the frame to start applying the fade
  7990. effect at. Default is 0.
  7991. @item nb_frames, n
  7992. The number of frames that the fade effect lasts. At the end of the
  7993. fade-in effect, the output video will have the same intensity as the input video.
  7994. At the end of the fade-out transition, the output video will be filled with the
  7995. selected @option{color}.
  7996. Default is 25.
  7997. @item alpha
  7998. If set to 1, fade only alpha channel, if one exists on the input.
  7999. Default value is 0.
  8000. @item start_time, st
  8001. Specify the timestamp (in seconds) of the frame to start to apply the fade
  8002. effect. If both start_frame and start_time are specified, the fade will start at
  8003. whichever comes last. Default is 0.
  8004. @item duration, d
  8005. The number of seconds for which the fade effect has to last. At the end of the
  8006. fade-in effect the output video will have the same intensity as the input video,
  8007. at the end of the fade-out transition the output video will be filled with the
  8008. selected @option{color}.
  8009. If both duration and nb_frames are specified, duration is used. Default is 0
  8010. (nb_frames is used by default).
  8011. @item color, c
  8012. Specify the color of the fade. Default is "black".
  8013. @end table
  8014. @subsection Examples
  8015. @itemize
  8016. @item
  8017. Fade in the first 30 frames of video:
  8018. @example
  8019. fade=in:0:30
  8020. @end example
  8021. The command above is equivalent to:
  8022. @example
  8023. fade=t=in:s=0:n=30
  8024. @end example
  8025. @item
  8026. Fade out the last 45 frames of a 200-frame video:
  8027. @example
  8028. fade=out:155:45
  8029. fade=type=out:start_frame=155:nb_frames=45
  8030. @end example
  8031. @item
  8032. Fade in the first 25 frames and fade out the last 25 frames of a 1000-frame video:
  8033. @example
  8034. fade=in:0:25, fade=out:975:25
  8035. @end example
  8036. @item
  8037. Make the first 5 frames yellow, then fade in from frame 5-24:
  8038. @example
  8039. fade=in:5:20:color=yellow
  8040. @end example
  8041. @item
  8042. Fade in alpha over first 25 frames of video:
  8043. @example
  8044. fade=in:0:25:alpha=1
  8045. @end example
  8046. @item
  8047. Make the first 5.5 seconds black, then fade in for 0.5 seconds:
  8048. @example
  8049. fade=t=in:st=5.5:d=0.5
  8050. @end example
  8051. @end itemize
  8052. @section fftdnoiz
  8053. Denoise frames using 3D FFT (frequency domain filtering).
  8054. The filter accepts the following options:
  8055. @table @option
  8056. @item sigma
  8057. Set the noise sigma constant. This sets denoising strength.
  8058. Default value is 1. Allowed range is from 0 to 30.
  8059. Using very high sigma with low overlap may give blocking artifacts.
  8060. @item amount
  8061. Set amount of denoising. By default all detected noise is reduced.
  8062. Default value is 1. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  8063. @item block
  8064. Set size of block, Default is 4, can be 3, 4, 5 or 6.
  8065. Actual size of block in pixels is 2 to power of @var{block}, so by default
  8066. block size in pixels is 2^4 which is 16.
  8067. @item overlap
  8068. Set block overlap. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is from 0.2 to 0.8.
  8069. @item prev
  8070. Set number of previous frames to use for denoising. By default is set to 0.
  8071. @item next
  8072. Set number of next frames to to use for denoising. By default is set to 0.
  8073. @item planes
  8074. Set planes which will be filtered, by default are all available filtered
  8075. except alpha.
  8076. @end table
  8077. @section fftfilt
  8078. Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain
  8079. @table @option
  8080. @item dc_Y
  8081. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the luma plane of the image. The filter
  8082. accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The default
  8083. value is set to @code{0}.
  8084. @item dc_U
  8085. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 1st chroma plane of the image. The
  8086. filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
  8087. default value is set to @code{0}.
  8088. @item dc_V
  8089. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 2nd chroma plane of the image. The
  8090. filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
  8091. default value is set to @code{0}.
  8092. @item weight_Y
  8093. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the luma plane.
  8094. @item weight_U
  8095. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 1st chroma plane.
  8096. @item weight_V
  8097. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 2nd chroma plane.
  8098. @item eval
  8099. Set when the expressions are evaluated.
  8100. It accepts the following values:
  8101. @table @samp
  8102. @item init
  8103. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization.
  8104. @item frame
  8105. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  8106. @end table
  8107. Default value is @samp{init}.
  8108. The filter accepts the following variables:
  8109. @item X
  8110. @item Y
  8111. The coordinates of the current sample.
  8112. @item W
  8113. @item H
  8114. The width and height of the image.
  8115. @item N
  8116. The number of input frame, starting from 0.
  8117. @end table
  8118. @subsection Examples
  8119. @itemize
  8120. @item
  8121. High-pass:
  8122. @example
  8123. fftfilt=dc_Y=128:weight_Y='squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
  8124. @end example
  8125. @item
  8126. Low-pass:
  8127. @example
  8128. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='squish((Y+X)/100-1)'
  8129. @end example
  8130. @item
  8131. Sharpen:
  8132. @example
  8133. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='1+squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
  8134. @end example
  8135. @item
  8136. Blur:
  8137. @example
  8138. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='exp(-4 * ((Y+X)/(W+H)))'
  8139. @end example
  8140. @end itemize
  8141. @section field
  8142. Extract a single field from an interlaced image using stride
  8143. arithmetic to avoid wasting CPU time. The output frames are marked as
  8144. non-interlaced.
  8145. The filter accepts the following options:
  8146. @table @option
  8147. @item type
  8148. Specify whether to extract the top (if the value is @code{0} or
  8149. @code{top}) or the bottom field (if the value is @code{1} or
  8150. @code{bottom}).
  8151. @end table
  8152. @section fieldhint
  8153. Create new frames by copying the top and bottom fields from surrounding frames
  8154. supplied as numbers by the hint file.
  8155. @table @option
  8156. @item hint
  8157. Set file containing hints: absolute/relative frame numbers.
  8158. There must be one line for each frame in a clip. Each line must contain two
  8159. numbers separated by the comma, optionally followed by @code{-} or @code{+}.
  8160. Numbers supplied on each line of file can not be out of [N-1,N+1] where N
  8161. is current frame number for @code{absolute} mode or out of [-1, 1] range
  8162. for @code{relative} mode. First number tells from which frame to pick up top
  8163. field and second number tells from which frame to pick up bottom field.
  8164. If optionally followed by @code{+} output frame will be marked as interlaced,
  8165. else if followed by @code{-} output frame will be marked as progressive, else
  8166. it will be marked same as input frame.
  8167. If optionally followed by @code{t} output frame will use only top field, or in
  8168. case of @code{b} it will use only bottom field.
  8169. If line starts with @code{#} or @code{;} that line is skipped.
  8170. @item mode
  8171. Can be item @code{absolute} or @code{relative}. Default is @code{absolute}.
  8172. @end table
  8173. Example of first several lines of @code{hint} file for @code{relative} mode:
  8174. @example
  8175. 0,0 - # first frame
  8176. 1,0 - # second frame, use third's frame top field and second's frame bottom field
  8177. 1,0 - # third frame, use fourth's frame top field and third's frame bottom field
  8178. 1,0 -
  8179. 0,0 -
  8180. 0,0 -
  8181. 1,0 -
  8182. 1,0 -
  8183. 1,0 -
  8184. 0,0 -
  8185. 0,0 -
  8186. 1,0 -
  8187. 1,0 -
  8188. 1,0 -
  8189. 0,0 -
  8190. @end example
  8191. @section fieldmatch
  8192. Field matching filter for inverse telecine. It is meant to reconstruct the
  8193. progressive frames from a telecined stream. The filter does not drop duplicated
  8194. frames, so to achieve a complete inverse telecine @code{fieldmatch} needs to be
  8195. followed by a decimation filter such as @ref{decimate} in the filtergraph.
  8196. The separation of the field matching and the decimation is notably motivated by
  8197. the possibility of inserting a de-interlacing filter fallback between the two.
  8198. If the source has mixed telecined and real interlaced content,
  8199. @code{fieldmatch} will not be able to match fields for the interlaced parts.
  8200. But these remaining combed frames will be marked as interlaced, and thus can be
  8201. de-interlaced by a later filter such as @ref{yadif} before decimation.
  8202. In addition to the various configuration options, @code{fieldmatch} can take an
  8203. optional second stream, activated through the @option{ppsrc} option. If
  8204. enabled, the frames reconstruction will be based on the fields and frames from
  8205. this second stream. This allows the first input to be pre-processed in order to
  8206. help the various algorithms of the filter, while keeping the output lossless
  8207. (assuming the fields are matched properly). Typically, a field-aware denoiser,
  8208. or brightness/contrast adjustments can help.
  8209. Note that this filter uses the same algorithms as TIVTC/TFM (AviSynth project)
  8210. and VIVTC/VFM (VapourSynth project). The later is a light clone of TFM from
  8211. which @code{fieldmatch} is based on. While the semantic and usage are very
  8212. close, some behaviour and options names can differ.
  8213. The @ref{decimate} filter currently only works for constant frame rate input.
  8214. If your input has mixed telecined (30fps) and progressive content with a lower
  8215. framerate like 24fps use the following filterchain to produce the necessary cfr
  8216. stream: @code{dejudder,fps=30000/1001,fieldmatch,decimate}.
  8217. The filter accepts the following options:
  8218. @table @option
  8219. @item order
  8220. Specify the assumed field order of the input stream. Available values are:
  8221. @table @samp
  8222. @item auto
  8223. Auto detect parity (use FFmpeg's internal parity value).
  8224. @item bff
  8225. Assume bottom field first.
  8226. @item tff
  8227. Assume top field first.
  8228. @end table
  8229. Note that it is sometimes recommended not to trust the parity announced by the
  8230. stream.
  8231. Default value is @var{auto}.
  8232. @item mode
  8233. Set the matching mode or strategy to use. @option{pc} mode is the safest in the
  8234. sense that it won't risk creating jerkiness due to duplicate frames when
  8235. possible, but if there are bad edits or blended fields it will end up
  8236. outputting combed frames when a good match might actually exist. On the other
  8237. hand, @option{pcn_ub} mode is the most risky in terms of creating jerkiness,
  8238. but will almost always find a good frame if there is one. The other values are
  8239. all somewhere in between @option{pc} and @option{pcn_ub} in terms of risking
  8240. jerkiness and creating duplicate frames versus finding good matches in sections
  8241. with bad edits, orphaned fields, blended fields, etc.
  8242. More details about p/c/n/u/b are available in @ref{p/c/n/u/b meaning} section.
  8243. Available values are:
  8244. @table @samp
  8245. @item pc
  8246. 2-way matching (p/c)
  8247. @item pc_n
  8248. 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match if still combed (p/c + n)
  8249. @item pc_u
  8250. 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match (same order) if still combed (p/c + u)
  8251. @item pc_n_ub
  8252. 2-way matching, trying 3rd match if still combed, and trying 4th/5th matches if
  8253. still combed (p/c + n + u/b)
  8254. @item pcn
  8255. 3-way matching (p/c/n)
  8256. @item pcn_ub
  8257. 3-way matching, and trying 4th/5th matches if all 3 of the original matches are
  8258. detected as combed (p/c/n + u/b)
  8259. @end table
  8260. The parenthesis at the end indicate the matches that would be used for that
  8261. mode assuming @option{order}=@var{tff} (and @option{field} on @var{auto} or
  8262. @var{top}).
  8263. In terms of speed @option{pc} mode is by far the fastest and @option{pcn_ub} is
  8264. the slowest.
  8265. Default value is @var{pc_n}.
  8266. @item ppsrc
  8267. Mark the main input stream as a pre-processed input, and enable the secondary
  8268. input stream as the clean source to pick the fields from. See the filter
  8269. introduction for more details. It is similar to the @option{clip2} feature from
  8270. VFM/TFM.
  8271. Default value is @code{0} (disabled).
  8272. @item field
  8273. Set the field to match from. It is recommended to set this to the same value as
  8274. @option{order} unless you experience matching failures with that setting. In
  8275. certain circumstances changing the field that is used to match from can have a
  8276. large impact on matching performance. Available values are:
  8277. @table @samp
  8278. @item auto
  8279. Automatic (same value as @option{order}).
  8280. @item bottom
  8281. Match from the bottom field.
  8282. @item top
  8283. Match from the top field.
  8284. @end table
  8285. Default value is @var{auto}.
  8286. @item mchroma
  8287. Set whether or not chroma is included during the match comparisons. In most
  8288. cases it is recommended to leave this enabled. You should set this to @code{0}
  8289. only if your clip has bad chroma problems such as heavy rainbowing or other
  8290. artifacts. Setting this to @code{0} could also be used to speed things up at
  8291. the cost of some accuracy.
  8292. Default value is @code{1}.
  8293. @item y0
  8294. @item y1
  8295. These define an exclusion band which excludes the lines between @option{y0} and
  8296. @option{y1} from being included in the field matching decision. An exclusion
  8297. band can be used to ignore subtitles, a logo, or other things that may
  8298. interfere with the matching. @option{y0} sets the starting scan line and
  8299. @option{y1} sets the ending line; all lines in between @option{y0} and
  8300. @option{y1} (including @option{y0} and @option{y1}) will be ignored. Setting
  8301. @option{y0} and @option{y1} to the same value will disable the feature.
  8302. @option{y0} and @option{y1} defaults to @code{0}.
  8303. @item scthresh
  8304. Set the scene change detection threshold as a percentage of maximum change on
  8305. the luma plane. Good values are in the @code{[8.0, 14.0]} range. Scene change
  8306. detection is only relevant in case @option{combmatch}=@var{sc}. The range for
  8307. @option{scthresh} is @code{[0.0, 100.0]}.
  8308. Default value is @code{12.0}.
  8309. @item combmatch
  8310. When @option{combatch} is not @var{none}, @code{fieldmatch} will take into
  8311. account the combed scores of matches when deciding what match to use as the
  8312. final match. Available values are:
  8313. @table @samp
  8314. @item none
  8315. No final matching based on combed scores.
  8316. @item sc
  8317. Combed scores are only used when a scene change is detected.
  8318. @item full
  8319. Use combed scores all the time.
  8320. @end table
  8321. Default is @var{sc}.
  8322. @item combdbg
  8323. Force @code{fieldmatch} to calculate the combed metrics for certain matches and
  8324. print them. This setting is known as @option{micout} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
  8325. Available values are:
  8326. @table @samp
  8327. @item none
  8328. No forced calculation.
  8329. @item pcn
  8330. Force p/c/n calculations.
  8331. @item pcnub
  8332. Force p/c/n/u/b calculations.
  8333. @end table
  8334. Default value is @var{none}.
  8335. @item cthresh
  8336. This is the area combing threshold used for combed frame detection. This
  8337. essentially controls how "strong" or "visible" combing must be to be detected.
  8338. Larger values mean combing must be more visible and smaller values mean combing
  8339. can be less visible or strong and still be detected. Valid settings are from
  8340. @code{-1} (every pixel will be detected as combed) to @code{255} (no pixel will
  8341. be detected as combed). This is basically a pixel difference value. A good
  8342. range is @code{[8, 12]}.
  8343. Default value is @code{9}.
  8344. @item chroma
  8345. Sets whether or not chroma is considered in the combed frame decision. Only
  8346. disable this if your source has chroma problems (rainbowing, etc.) that are
  8347. causing problems for the combed frame detection with chroma enabled. Actually,
  8348. using @option{chroma}=@var{0} is usually more reliable, except for the case
  8349. where there is chroma only combing in the source.
  8350. Default value is @code{0}.
  8351. @item blockx
  8352. @item blocky
  8353. Respectively set the x-axis and y-axis size of the window used during combed
  8354. frame detection. This has to do with the size of the area in which
  8355. @option{combpel} pixels are required to be detected as combed for a frame to be
  8356. declared combed. See the @option{combpel} parameter description for more info.
  8357. Possible values are any number that is a power of 2 starting at 4 and going up
  8358. to 512.
  8359. Default value is @code{16}.
  8360. @item combpel
  8361. The number of combed pixels inside any of the @option{blocky} by
  8362. @option{blockx} size blocks on the frame for the frame to be detected as
  8363. combed. While @option{cthresh} controls how "visible" the combing must be, this
  8364. setting controls "how much" combing there must be in any localized area (a
  8365. window defined by the @option{blockx} and @option{blocky} settings) on the
  8366. frame. Minimum value is @code{0} and maximum is @code{blocky x blockx} (at
  8367. which point no frames will ever be detected as combed). This setting is known
  8368. as @option{MI} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
  8369. Default value is @code{80}.
  8370. @end table
  8371. @anchor{p/c/n/u/b meaning}
  8372. @subsection p/c/n/u/b meaning
  8373. @subsubsection p/c/n
  8374. We assume the following telecined stream:
  8375. @example
  8376. Top fields: 1 2 2 3 4
  8377. Bottom fields: 1 2 3 4 4
  8378. @end example
  8379. The numbers correspond to the progressive frame the fields relate to. Here, the
  8380. first two frames are progressive, the 3rd and 4th are combed, and so on.
  8381. When @code{fieldmatch} is configured to run a matching from bottom
  8382. (@option{field}=@var{bottom}) this is how this input stream get transformed:
  8383. @example
  8384. Input stream:
  8385. T 1 2 2 3 4
  8386. B 1 2 3 4 4 <-- matching reference
  8387. Matches: c c n n c
  8388. Output stream:
  8389. T 1 2 3 4 4
  8390. B 1 2 3 4 4
  8391. @end example
  8392. As a result of the field matching, we can see that some frames get duplicated.
  8393. To perform a complete inverse telecine, you need to rely on a decimation filter
  8394. after this operation. See for instance the @ref{decimate} filter.
  8395. The same operation now matching from top fields (@option{field}=@var{top})
  8396. looks like this:
  8397. @example
  8398. Input stream:
  8399. T 1 2 2 3 4 <-- matching reference
  8400. B 1 2 3 4 4
  8401. Matches: c c p p c
  8402. Output stream:
  8403. T 1 2 2 3 4
  8404. B 1 2 2 3 4
  8405. @end example
  8406. In these examples, we can see what @var{p}, @var{c} and @var{n} mean;
  8407. basically, they refer to the frame and field of the opposite parity:
  8408. @itemize
  8409. @item @var{p} matches the field of the opposite parity in the previous frame
  8410. @item @var{c} matches the field of the opposite parity in the current frame
  8411. @item @var{n} matches the field of the opposite parity in the next frame
  8412. @end itemize
  8413. @subsubsection u/b
  8414. The @var{u} and @var{b} matching are a bit special in the sense that they match
  8415. from the opposite parity flag. In the following examples, we assume that we are
  8416. currently matching the 2nd frame (Top:2, bottom:2). According to the match, a
  8417. 'x' is placed above and below each matched fields.
  8418. With bottom matching (@option{field}=@var{bottom}):
  8419. @example
  8420. Match: c p n b u
  8421. x x x x x
  8422. Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
  8423. Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
  8424. x x x x x
  8425. Output frames:
  8426. 2 1 2 2 2
  8427. 2 2 2 1 3
  8428. @end example
  8429. With top matching (@option{field}=@var{top}):
  8430. @example
  8431. Match: c p n b u
  8432. x x x x x
  8433. Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
  8434. Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
  8435. x x x x x
  8436. Output frames:
  8437. 2 2 2 1 2
  8438. 2 1 3 2 2
  8439. @end example
  8440. @subsection Examples
  8441. Simple IVTC of a top field first telecined stream:
  8442. @example
  8443. fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=none, decimate
  8444. @end example
  8445. Advanced IVTC, with fallback on @ref{yadif} for still combed frames:
  8446. @example
  8447. fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=full, yadif=deint=interlaced, decimate
  8448. @end example
  8449. @section fieldorder
  8450. Transform the field order of the input video.
  8451. It accepts the following parameters:
  8452. @table @option
  8453. @item order
  8454. The output field order. Valid values are @var{tff} for top field first or @var{bff}
  8455. for bottom field first.
  8456. @end table
  8457. The default value is @samp{tff}.
  8458. The transformation is done by shifting the picture content up or down
  8459. by one line, and filling the remaining line with appropriate picture content.
  8460. This method is consistent with most broadcast field order converters.
  8461. If the input video is not flagged as being interlaced, or it is already
  8462. flagged as being of the required output field order, then this filter does
  8463. not alter the incoming video.
  8464. It is very useful when converting to or from PAL DV material,
  8465. which is bottom field first.
  8466. For example:
  8467. @example
  8468. ffmpeg -i in.vob -vf "fieldorder=bff" out.dv
  8469. @end example
  8470. @section fifo, afifo
  8471. Buffer input images and send them when they are requested.
  8472. It is mainly useful when auto-inserted by the libavfilter
  8473. framework.
  8474. It does not take parameters.
  8475. @section fillborders
  8476. Fill borders of the input video, without changing video stream dimensions.
  8477. Sometimes video can have garbage at the four edges and you may not want to
  8478. crop video input to keep size multiple of some number.
  8479. This filter accepts the following options:
  8480. @table @option
  8481. @item left
  8482. Number of pixels to fill from left border.
  8483. @item right
  8484. Number of pixels to fill from right border.
  8485. @item top
  8486. Number of pixels to fill from top border.
  8487. @item bottom
  8488. Number of pixels to fill from bottom border.
  8489. @item mode
  8490. Set fill mode.
  8491. It accepts the following values:
  8492. @table @samp
  8493. @item smear
  8494. fill pixels using outermost pixels
  8495. @item mirror
  8496. fill pixels using mirroring
  8497. @item fixed
  8498. fill pixels with constant value
  8499. @end table
  8500. Default is @var{smear}.
  8501. @item color
  8502. Set color for pixels in fixed mode. Default is @var{black}.
  8503. @end table
  8504. @subsection Commands
  8505. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  8506. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  8507. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  8508. value.
  8509. @section find_rect
  8510. Find a rectangular object
  8511. It accepts the following options:
  8512. @table @option
  8513. @item object
  8514. Filepath of the object image, needs to be in gray8.
  8515. @item threshold
  8516. Detection threshold, default is 0.5.
  8517. @item mipmaps
  8518. Number of mipmaps, default is 3.
  8519. @item xmin, ymin, xmax, ymax
  8520. Specifies the rectangle in which to search.
  8521. @end table
  8522. @subsection Examples
  8523. @itemize
  8524. @item
  8525. Cover a rectangular object by the supplied image of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  8526. @example
  8527. ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
  8528. @end example
  8529. @end itemize
  8530. @section floodfill
  8531. Flood area with values of same pixel components with another values.
  8532. It accepts the following options:
  8533. @table @option
  8534. @item x
  8535. Set pixel x coordinate.
  8536. @item y
  8537. Set pixel y coordinate.
  8538. @item s0
  8539. Set source #0 component value.
  8540. @item s1
  8541. Set source #1 component value.
  8542. @item s2
  8543. Set source #2 component value.
  8544. @item s3
  8545. Set source #3 component value.
  8546. @item d0
  8547. Set destination #0 component value.
  8548. @item d1
  8549. Set destination #1 component value.
  8550. @item d2
  8551. Set destination #2 component value.
  8552. @item d3
  8553. Set destination #3 component value.
  8554. @end table
  8555. @anchor{format}
  8556. @section format
  8557. Convert the input video to one of the specified pixel formats.
  8558. Libavfilter will try to pick one that is suitable as input to
  8559. the next filter.
  8560. It accepts the following parameters:
  8561. @table @option
  8562. @item pix_fmts
  8563. A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
  8564. "pix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
  8565. @end table
  8566. @subsection Examples
  8567. @itemize
  8568. @item
  8569. Convert the input video to the @var{yuv420p} format
  8570. @example
  8571. format=pix_fmts=yuv420p
  8572. @end example
  8573. Convert the input video to any of the formats in the list
  8574. @example
  8575. format=pix_fmts=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
  8576. @end example
  8577. @end itemize
  8578. @anchor{fps}
  8579. @section fps
  8580. Convert the video to specified constant frame rate by duplicating or dropping
  8581. frames as necessary.
  8582. It accepts the following parameters:
  8583. @table @option
  8584. @item fps
  8585. The desired output frame rate. The default is @code{25}.
  8586. @item start_time
  8587. Assume the first PTS should be the given value, in seconds. This allows for
  8588. padding/trimming at the start of stream. By default, no assumption is made
  8589. about the first frame's expected PTS, so no padding or trimming is done.
  8590. For example, this could be set to 0 to pad the beginning with duplicates of
  8591. the first frame if a video stream starts after the audio stream or to trim any
  8592. frames with a negative PTS.
  8593. @item round
  8594. Timestamp (PTS) rounding method.
  8595. Possible values are:
  8596. @table @option
  8597. @item zero
  8598. round towards 0
  8599. @item inf
  8600. round away from 0
  8601. @item down
  8602. round towards -infinity
  8603. @item up
  8604. round towards +infinity
  8605. @item near
  8606. round to nearest
  8607. @end table
  8608. The default is @code{near}.
  8609. @item eof_action
  8610. Action performed when reading the last frame.
  8611. Possible values are:
  8612. @table @option
  8613. @item round
  8614. Use same timestamp rounding method as used for other frames.
  8615. @item pass
  8616. Pass through last frame if input duration has not been reached yet.
  8617. @end table
  8618. The default is @code{round}.
  8619. @end table
  8620. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
  8621. @var{fps}[:@var{start_time}[:@var{round}]].
  8622. See also the @ref{setpts} filter.
  8623. @subsection Examples
  8624. @itemize
  8625. @item
  8626. A typical usage in order to set the fps to 25:
  8627. @example
  8628. fps=fps=25
  8629. @end example
  8630. @item
  8631. Sets the fps to 24, using abbreviation and rounding method to round to nearest:
  8632. @example
  8633. fps=fps=film:round=near
  8634. @end example
  8635. @end itemize
  8636. @section framepack
  8637. Pack two different video streams into a stereoscopic video, setting proper
  8638. metadata on supported codecs. The two views should have the same size and
  8639. framerate and processing will stop when the shorter video ends. Please note
  8640. that you may conveniently adjust view properties with the @ref{scale} and
  8641. @ref{fps} filters.
  8642. It accepts the following parameters:
  8643. @table @option
  8644. @item format
  8645. The desired packing format. Supported values are:
  8646. @table @option
  8647. @item sbs
  8648. The views are next to each other (default).
  8649. @item tab
  8650. The views are on top of each other.
  8651. @item lines
  8652. The views are packed by line.
  8653. @item columns
  8654. The views are packed by column.
  8655. @item frameseq
  8656. The views are temporally interleaved.
  8657. @end table
  8658. @end table
  8659. Some examples:
  8660. @example
  8661. # Convert left and right views into a frame-sequential video
  8662. ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex framepack=frameseq OUTPUT
  8663. # Convert views into a side-by-side video with the same output resolution as the input
  8664. ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex [0:v]scale=w=iw/2[left],[1:v]scale=w=iw/2[right],[left][right]framepack=sbs OUTPUT
  8665. @end example
  8666. @section framerate
  8667. Change the frame rate by interpolating new video output frames from the source
  8668. frames.
  8669. This filter is not designed to function correctly with interlaced media. If
  8670. you wish to change the frame rate of interlaced media then you are required
  8671. to deinterlace before this filter and re-interlace after this filter.
  8672. A description of the accepted options follows.
  8673. @table @option
  8674. @item fps
  8675. Specify the output frames per second. This option can also be specified
  8676. as a value alone. The default is @code{50}.
  8677. @item interp_start
  8678. Specify the start of a range where the output frame will be created as a
  8679. linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
  8680. the default is @code{15}.
  8681. @item interp_end
  8682. Specify the end of a range where the output frame will be created as a
  8683. linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
  8684. the default is @code{240}.
  8685. @item scene
  8686. Specify the level at which a scene change is detected as a value between
  8687. 0 and 100 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
  8688. probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
  8689. value means the current frame is more likely to be one.
  8690. The default is @code{8.2}.
  8691. @item flags
  8692. Specify flags influencing the filter process.
  8693. Available value for @var{flags} is:
  8694. @table @option
  8695. @item scene_change_detect, scd
  8696. Enable scene change detection using the value of the option @var{scene}.
  8697. This flag is enabled by default.
  8698. @end table
  8699. @end table
  8700. @section framestep
  8701. Select one frame every N-th frame.
  8702. This filter accepts the following option:
  8703. @table @option
  8704. @item step
  8705. Select frame after every @code{step} frames.
  8706. Allowed values are positive integers higher than 0. Default value is @code{1}.
  8707. @end table
  8708. @section freezedetect
  8709. Detect frozen video.
  8710. This filter logs a message and sets frame metadata when it detects that the
  8711. input video has no significant change in content during a specified duration.
  8712. Video freeze detection calculates the mean average absolute difference of all
  8713. the components of video frames and compares it to a noise floor.
  8714. The printed times and duration are expressed in seconds. The
  8715. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_start} metadata key is set on the first frame
  8716. whose timestamp equals or exceeds the detection duration and it contains the
  8717. timestamp of the first frame of the freeze. The
  8718. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_duration} and
  8719. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_end} metadata keys are set on the first frame
  8720. after the freeze.
  8721. The filter accepts the following options:
  8722. @table @option
  8723. @item noise, n
  8724. Set noise tolerance. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the
  8725. specified value) or as a difference ratio between 0 and 1. Default is -60dB, or
  8726. 0.001.
  8727. @item duration, d
  8728. Set freeze duration until notification (default is 2 seconds).
  8729. @end table
  8730. @section freezeframes
  8731. Freeze video frames.
  8732. This filter freezes video frames using frame from 2nd input.
  8733. The filter accepts the following options:
  8734. @table @option
  8735. @item first
  8736. Set number of first frame from which to start freeze.
  8737. @item last
  8738. Set number of last frame from which to end freeze.
  8739. @item replace
  8740. Set number of frame from 2nd input which will be used instead of replaced frames.
  8741. @end table
  8742. @anchor{frei0r}
  8743. @section frei0r
  8744. Apply a frei0r effect to the input video.
  8745. To enable the compilation of this filter, you need to install the frei0r
  8746. header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
  8747. It accepts the following parameters:
  8748. @table @option
  8749. @item filter_name
  8750. The name of the frei0r effect to load. If the environment variable
  8751. @env{FREI0R_PATH} is defined, the frei0r effect is searched for in each of the
  8752. directories specified by the colon-separated list in @env{FREI0R_PATH}.
  8753. Otherwise, the standard frei0r paths are searched, in this order:
  8754. @file{HOME/.frei0r-1/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/frei0r-1/},
  8755. @file{/usr/lib/frei0r-1/}.
  8756. @item filter_params
  8757. A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r effect.
  8758. @end table
  8759. A frei0r effect parameter can be a boolean (its value is either
  8760. "y" or "n"), a double, a color (specified as
  8761. @var{R}/@var{G}/@var{B}, where @var{R}, @var{G}, and @var{B} are floating point
  8762. numbers between 0.0 and 1.0, inclusive) or a color description as specified in the
  8763. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils},
  8764. a position (specified as @var{X}/@var{Y}, where
  8765. @var{X} and @var{Y} are floating point numbers) and/or a string.
  8766. The number and types of parameters depend on the loaded effect. If an
  8767. effect parameter is not specified, the default value is set.
  8768. @subsection Examples
  8769. @itemize
  8770. @item
  8771. Apply the distort0r effect, setting the first two double parameters:
  8772. @example
  8773. frei0r=filter_name=distort0r:filter_params=0.5|0.01
  8774. @end example
  8775. @item
  8776. Apply the colordistance effect, taking a color as the first parameter:
  8777. @example
  8778. frei0r=colordistance:0.2/0.3/0.4
  8779. frei0r=colordistance:violet
  8780. frei0r=colordistance:0x112233
  8781. @end example
  8782. @item
  8783. Apply the perspective effect, specifying the top left and top right image
  8784. positions:
  8785. @example
  8786. frei0r=perspective:0.2/0.2|0.8/0.2
  8787. @end example
  8788. @end itemize
  8789. For more information, see
  8790. @url{http://frei0r.dyne.org}
  8791. @section fspp
  8792. Apply fast and simple postprocessing. It is a faster version of @ref{spp}.
  8793. It splits (I)DCT into horizontal/vertical passes. Unlike the simple post-
  8794. processing filter, one of them is performed once per block, not per pixel.
  8795. This allows for much higher speed.
  8796. The filter accepts the following options:
  8797. @table @option
  8798. @item quality
  8799. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  8800. an integer in the range 4-5. Default value is @code{4}.
  8801. @item qp
  8802. Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range 0-63.
  8803. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream (if available).
  8804. @item strength
  8805. Set filter strength. It accepts an integer in range -15 to 32. Lower values mean
  8806. more details but also more artifacts, while higher values make the image smoother
  8807. but also blurrier. Default value is @code{0} − PSNR optimal.
  8808. @item use_bframe_qp
  8809. Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
  8810. option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
  8811. @code{0} (not enabled).
  8812. @end table
  8813. @section gblur
  8814. Apply Gaussian blur filter.
  8815. The filter accepts the following options:
  8816. @table @option
  8817. @item sigma
  8818. Set horizontal sigma, standard deviation of Gaussian blur. Default is @code{0.5}.
  8819. @item steps
  8820. Set number of steps for Gaussian approximation. Default is @code{1}.
  8821. @item planes
  8822. Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.
  8823. @item sigmaV
  8824. Set vertical sigma, if negative it will be same as @code{sigma}.
  8825. Default is @code{-1}.
  8826. @end table
  8827. @subsection Commands
  8828. This filter supports same commands as options.
  8829. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  8830. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  8831. value.
  8832. @section geq
  8833. Apply generic equation to each pixel.
  8834. The filter accepts the following options:
  8835. @table @option
  8836. @item lum_expr, lum
  8837. Set the luminance expression.
  8838. @item cb_expr, cb
  8839. Set the chrominance blue expression.
  8840. @item cr_expr, cr
  8841. Set the chrominance red expression.
  8842. @item alpha_expr, a
  8843. Set the alpha expression.
  8844. @item red_expr, r
  8845. Set the red expression.
  8846. @item green_expr, g
  8847. Set the green expression.
  8848. @item blue_expr, b
  8849. Set the blue expression.
  8850. @end table
  8851. The colorspace is selected according to the specified options. If one
  8852. of the @option{lum_expr}, @option{cb_expr}, or @option{cr_expr}
  8853. options is specified, the filter will automatically select a YCbCr
  8854. colorspace. If one of the @option{red_expr}, @option{green_expr}, or
  8855. @option{blue_expr} options is specified, it will select an RGB
  8856. colorspace.
  8857. If one of the chrominance expression is not defined, it falls back on the other
  8858. one. If no alpha expression is specified it will evaluate to opaque value.
  8859. If none of chrominance expressions are specified, they will evaluate
  8860. to the luminance expression.
  8861. The expressions can use the following variables and functions:
  8862. @table @option
  8863. @item N
  8864. The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
  8865. @item X
  8866. @item Y
  8867. The coordinates of the current sample.
  8868. @item W
  8869. @item H
  8870. The width and height of the image.
  8871. @item SW
  8872. @item SH
  8873. Width and height scale depending on the currently filtered plane. It is the
  8874. ratio between the corresponding luma plane number of pixels and the current
  8875. plane ones. E.g. for YUV4:2:0 the values are @code{1,1} for the luma plane, and
  8876. @code{0.5,0.5} for chroma planes.
  8877. @item T
  8878. Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
  8879. @item p(x, y)
  8880. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the current
  8881. plane.
  8882. @item lum(x, y)
  8883. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the luminance
  8884. plane.
  8885. @item cb(x, y)
  8886. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8887. blue-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8888. @item cr(x, y)
  8889. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8890. red-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8891. @item r(x, y)
  8892. @item g(x, y)
  8893. @item b(x, y)
  8894. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8895. red/green/blue component. Return 0 if there is no such component.
  8896. @item alpha(x, y)
  8897. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the alpha
  8898. plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8899. @item psum(x,y), lumsum(x, y), cbsum(x,y), crsum(x,y), rsum(x,y), gsum(x,y), bsum(x,y), alphasum(x,y)
  8900. Sum of sample values in the rectangle from (0,0) to (x,y), this allows obtaining
  8901. sums of samples within a rectangle. See the functions without the sum postfix.
  8902. @item interpolation
  8903. Set one of interpolation methods:
  8904. @table @option
  8905. @item nearest, n
  8906. @item bilinear, b
  8907. @end table
  8908. Default is bilinear.
  8909. @end table
  8910. For functions, if @var{x} and @var{y} are outside the area, the value will be
  8911. automatically clipped to the closer edge.
  8912. Please note that this filter can use multiple threads in which case each slice
  8913. will have its own expression state. If you want to use only a single expression
  8914. state because your expressions depend on previous state then you should limit
  8915. the number of filter threads to 1.
  8916. @subsection Examples
  8917. @itemize
  8918. @item
  8919. Flip the image horizontally:
  8920. @example
  8921. geq=p(W-X\,Y)
  8922. @end example
  8923. @item
  8924. Generate a bidimensional sine wave, with angle @code{PI/3} and a
  8925. wavelength of 100 pixels:
  8926. @example
  8927. geq=128 + 100*sin(2*(PI/100)*(cos(PI/3)*(X-50*T) + sin(PI/3)*Y)):128:128
  8928. @end example
  8929. @item
  8930. Generate a fancy enigmatic moving light:
  8931. @example
  8932. nullsrc=s=256x256,geq=random(1)/hypot(X-cos(N*0.07)*W/2-W/2\,Y-sin(N*0.09)*H/2-H/2)^2*1000000*sin(N*0.02):128:128
  8933. @end example
  8934. @item
  8935. Generate a quick emboss effect:
  8936. @example
  8937. format=gray,geq=lum_expr='(p(X,Y)+(256-p(X-4,Y-4)))/2'
  8938. @end example
  8939. @item
  8940. Modify RGB components depending on pixel position:
  8941. @example
  8942. geq=r='X/W*r(X,Y)':g='(1-X/W)*g(X,Y)':b='(H-Y)/H*b(X,Y)'
  8943. @end example
  8944. @item
  8945. Create a radial gradient that is the same size as the input (also see
  8946. the @ref{vignette} filter):
  8947. @example
  8948. geq=lum=255*gauss((X/W-0.5)*3)*gauss((Y/H-0.5)*3)/gauss(0)/gauss(0),format=gray
  8949. @end example
  8950. @end itemize
  8951. @section gradfun
  8952. Fix the banding artifacts that are sometimes introduced into nearly flat
  8953. regions by truncation to 8-bit color depth.
  8954. Interpolate the gradients that should go where the bands are, and
  8955. dither them.
  8956. It is designed for playback only. Do not use it prior to
  8957. lossy compression, because compression tends to lose the dither and
  8958. bring back the bands.
  8959. It accepts the following parameters:
  8960. @table @option
  8961. @item strength
  8962. The maximum amount by which the filter will change any one pixel. This is also
  8963. the threshold for detecting nearly flat regions. Acceptable values range from
  8964. .51 to 64; the default value is 1.2. Out-of-range values will be clipped to the
  8965. valid range.
  8966. @item radius
  8967. The neighborhood to fit the gradient to. A larger radius makes for smoother
  8968. gradients, but also prevents the filter from modifying the pixels near detailed
  8969. regions. Acceptable values are 8-32; the default value is 16. Out-of-range
  8970. values will be clipped to the valid range.
  8971. @end table
  8972. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
  8973. @var{strength}[:@var{radius}]
  8974. @subsection Examples
  8975. @itemize
  8976. @item
  8977. Apply the filter with a @code{3.5} strength and radius of @code{8}:
  8978. @example
  8979. gradfun=3.5:8
  8980. @end example
  8981. @item
  8982. Specify radius, omitting the strength (which will fall-back to the default
  8983. value):
  8984. @example
  8985. gradfun=radius=8
  8986. @end example
  8987. @end itemize
  8988. @anchor{graphmonitor}
  8989. @section graphmonitor
  8990. Show various filtergraph stats.
  8991. With this filter one can debug complete filtergraph.
  8992. Especially issues with links filling with queued frames.
  8993. The filter accepts the following options:
  8994. @table @option
  8995. @item size, s
  8996. Set video output size. Default is @var{hd720}.
  8997. @item opacity, o
  8998. Set video opacity. Default is @var{0.9}. Allowed range is from @var{0} to @var{1}.
  8999. @item mode, m
  9000. Set output mode, can be @var{fulll} or @var{compact}.
  9001. In @var{compact} mode only filters with some queued frames have displayed stats.
  9002. @item flags, f
  9003. Set flags which enable which stats are shown in video.
  9004. Available values for flags are:
  9005. @table @samp
  9006. @item queue
  9007. Display number of queued frames in each link.
  9008. @item frame_count_in
  9009. Display number of frames taken from filter.
  9010. @item frame_count_out
  9011. Display number of frames given out from filter.
  9012. @item pts
  9013. Display current filtered frame pts.
  9014. @item time
  9015. Display current filtered frame time.
  9016. @item timebase
  9017. Display time base for filter link.
  9018. @item format
  9019. Display used format for filter link.
  9020. @item size
  9021. Display video size or number of audio channels in case of audio used by filter link.
  9022. @item rate
  9023. Display video frame rate or sample rate in case of audio used by filter link.
  9024. @end table
  9025. @item rate, r
  9026. Set upper limit for video rate of output stream, Default value is @var{25}.
  9027. This guarantee that output video frame rate will not be higher than this value.
  9028. @end table
  9029. @section greyedge
  9030. A color constancy variation filter which estimates scene illumination via grey edge algorithm
  9031. and corrects the scene colors accordingly.
  9032. See: @url{https://staff.science.uva.nl/th.gevers/pub/GeversTIP07.pdf}
  9033. The filter accepts the following options:
  9034. @table @option
  9035. @item difford
  9036. The order of differentiation to be applied on the scene. Must be chosen in the range
  9037. [0,2] and default value is 1.
  9038. @item minknorm
  9039. The Minkowski parameter to be used for calculating the Minkowski distance. Must
  9040. be chosen in the range [0,20] and default value is 1. Set to 0 for getting
  9041. max value instead of calculating Minkowski distance.
  9042. @item sigma
  9043. The standard deviation of Gaussian blur to be applied on the scene. Must be
  9044. chosen in the range [0,1024.0] and default value = 1. floor( @var{sigma} * break_off_sigma(3) )
  9045. can't be equal to 0 if @var{difford} is greater than 0.
  9046. @end table
  9047. @subsection Examples
  9048. @itemize
  9049. @item
  9050. Grey Edge:
  9051. @example
  9052. greyedge=difford=1:minknorm=5:sigma=2
  9053. @end example
  9054. @item
  9055. Max Edge:
  9056. @example
  9057. greyedge=difford=1:minknorm=0:sigma=2
  9058. @end example
  9059. @end itemize
  9060. @anchor{haldclut}
  9061. @section haldclut
  9062. Apply a Hald CLUT to a video stream.
  9063. First input is the video stream to process, and second one is the Hald CLUT.
  9064. The Hald CLUT input can be a simple picture or a complete video stream.
  9065. The filter accepts the following options:
  9066. @table @option
  9067. @item shortest
  9068. Force termination when the shortest input terminates. Default is @code{0}.
  9069. @item repeatlast
  9070. Continue applying the last CLUT after the end of the stream. A value of
  9071. @code{0} disable the filter after the last frame of the CLUT is reached.
  9072. Default is @code{1}.
  9073. @end table
  9074. @code{haldclut} also has the same interpolation options as @ref{lut3d} (both
  9075. filters share the same internals).
  9076. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  9077. More information about the Hald CLUT can be found on Eskil Steenberg's website
  9078. (Hald CLUT author) at @url{http://www.quelsolaar.com/technology/clut.html}.
  9079. @subsection Workflow examples
  9080. @subsubsection Hald CLUT video stream
  9081. Generate an identity Hald CLUT stream altered with various effects:
  9082. @example
  9083. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "hue=H=2*PI*t:s=sin(2*PI*t)+1, curves=cross_process" -t 10 -c:v ffv1 clut.nut
  9084. @end example
  9085. Note: make sure you use a lossless codec.
  9086. Then use it with @code{haldclut} to apply it on some random stream:
  9087. @example
  9088. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i mandelbrot -i clut.nut -filter_complex '[0][1] haldclut' -t 20 mandelclut.mkv
  9089. @end example
  9090. The Hald CLUT will be applied to the 10 first seconds (duration of
  9091. @file{clut.nut}), then the latest picture of that CLUT stream will be applied
  9092. to the remaining frames of the @code{mandelbrot} stream.
  9093. @subsubsection Hald CLUT with preview
  9094. A Hald CLUT is supposed to be a squared image of @code{Level*Level*Level} by
  9095. @code{Level*Level*Level} pixels. For a given Hald CLUT, FFmpeg will select the
  9096. biggest possible square starting at the top left of the picture. The remaining
  9097. padding pixels (bottom or right) will be ignored. This area can be used to add
  9098. a preview of the Hald CLUT.
  9099. Typically, the following generated Hald CLUT will be supported by the
  9100. @code{haldclut} filter:
  9101. @example
  9102. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "
  9103. pad=iw+320 [padded_clut];
  9104. smptebars=s=320x256, split [a][b];
  9105. [padded_clut][a] overlay=W-320:h, curves=color_negative [main];
  9106. [main][b] overlay=W-320" -frames:v 1 clut.png
  9107. @end example
  9108. It contains the original and a preview of the effect of the CLUT: SMPTE color
  9109. bars are displayed on the right-top, and below the same color bars processed by
  9110. the color changes.
  9111. Then, the effect of this Hald CLUT can be visualized with:
  9112. @example
  9113. ffplay input.mkv -vf "movie=clut.png, [in] haldclut"
  9114. @end example
  9115. @section hflip
  9116. Flip the input video horizontally.
  9117. For example, to horizontally flip the input video with @command{ffmpeg}:
  9118. @example
  9119. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "hflip" out.avi
  9120. @end example
  9121. @section histeq
  9122. This filter applies a global color histogram equalization on a
  9123. per-frame basis.
  9124. It can be used to correct video that has a compressed range of pixel
  9125. intensities. The filter redistributes the pixel intensities to
  9126. equalize their distribution across the intensity range. It may be
  9127. viewed as an "automatically adjusting contrast filter". This filter is
  9128. useful only for correcting degraded or poorly captured source
  9129. video.
  9130. The filter accepts the following options:
  9131. @table @option
  9132. @item strength
  9133. Determine the amount of equalization to be applied. As the strength
  9134. is reduced, the distribution of pixel intensities more-and-more
  9135. approaches that of the input frame. The value must be a float number
  9136. in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.200.
  9137. @item intensity
  9138. Set the maximum intensity that can generated and scale the output
  9139. values appropriately. The strength should be set as desired and then
  9140. the intensity can be limited if needed to avoid washing-out. The value
  9141. must be a float number in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.210.
  9142. @item antibanding
  9143. Set the antibanding level. If enabled the filter will randomly vary
  9144. the luminance of output pixels by a small amount to avoid banding of
  9145. the histogram. Possible values are @code{none}, @code{weak} or
  9146. @code{strong}. It defaults to @code{none}.
  9147. @end table
  9148. @anchor{histogram}
  9149. @section histogram
  9150. Compute and draw a color distribution histogram for the input video.
  9151. The computed histogram is a representation of the color component
  9152. distribution in an image.
  9153. Standard histogram displays the color components distribution in an image.
  9154. Displays color graph for each color component. Shows distribution of
  9155. the Y, U, V, A or R, G, B components, depending on input format, in the
  9156. current frame. Below each graph a color component scale meter is shown.
  9157. The filter accepts the following options:
  9158. @table @option
  9159. @item level_height
  9160. Set height of level. Default value is @code{200}.
  9161. Allowed range is [50, 2048].
  9162. @item scale_height
  9163. Set height of color scale. Default value is @code{12}.
  9164. Allowed range is [0, 40].
  9165. @item display_mode
  9166. Set display mode.
  9167. It accepts the following values:
  9168. @table @samp
  9169. @item stack
  9170. Per color component graphs are placed below each other.
  9171. @item parade
  9172. Per color component graphs are placed side by side.
  9173. @item overlay
  9174. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  9175. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  9176. over one another.
  9177. @end table
  9178. Default is @code{stack}.
  9179. @item levels_mode
  9180. Set mode. Can be either @code{linear}, or @code{logarithmic}.
  9181. Default is @code{linear}.
  9182. @item components
  9183. Set what color components to display.
  9184. Default is @code{7}.
  9185. @item fgopacity
  9186. Set foreground opacity. Default is @code{0.7}.
  9187. @item bgopacity
  9188. Set background opacity. Default is @code{0.5}.
  9189. @end table
  9190. @subsection Examples
  9191. @itemize
  9192. @item
  9193. Calculate and draw histogram:
  9194. @example
  9195. ffplay -i input -vf histogram
  9196. @end example
  9197. @end itemize
  9198. @anchor{hqdn3d}
  9199. @section hqdn3d
  9200. This is a high precision/quality 3d denoise filter. It aims to reduce
  9201. image noise, producing smooth images and making still images really
  9202. still. It should enhance compressibility.
  9203. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  9204. @table @option
  9205. @item luma_spatial
  9206. A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial luma strength.
  9207. It defaults to 4.0.
  9208. @item chroma_spatial
  9209. A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial chroma strength.
  9210. It defaults to 3.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
  9211. @item luma_tmp
  9212. A floating point number which specifies luma temporal strength. It defaults to
  9213. 6.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
  9214. @item chroma_tmp
  9215. A floating point number which specifies chroma temporal strength. It defaults to
  9216. @var{luma_tmp}*@var{chroma_spatial}/@var{luma_spatial}.
  9217. @end table
  9218. @subsection Commands
  9219. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  9220. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  9221. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  9222. value.
  9223. @anchor{hwdownload}
  9224. @section hwdownload
  9225. Download hardware frames to system memory.
  9226. The input must be in hardware frames, and the output a non-hardware format.
  9227. Not all formats will be supported on the output - it may be necessary to insert
  9228. an additional @option{format} filter immediately following in the graph to get
  9229. the output in a supported format.
  9230. @section hwmap
  9231. Map hardware frames to system memory or to another device.
  9232. This filter has several different modes of operation; which one is used depends
  9233. on the input and output formats:
  9234. @itemize
  9235. @item
  9236. Hardware frame input, normal frame output
  9237. Map the input frames to system memory and pass them to the output. If the
  9238. original hardware frame is later required (for example, after overlaying
  9239. something else on part of it), the @option{hwmap} filter can be used again
  9240. in the next mode to retrieve it.
  9241. @item
  9242. Normal frame input, hardware frame output
  9243. If the input is actually a software-mapped hardware frame, then unmap it -
  9244. that is, return the original hardware frame.
  9245. Otherwise, a device must be provided. Create new hardware surfaces on that
  9246. device for the output, then map them back to the software format at the input
  9247. and give those frames to the preceding filter. This will then act like the
  9248. @option{hwupload} filter, but may be able to avoid an additional copy when
  9249. the input is already in a compatible format.
  9250. @item
  9251. Hardware frame input and output
  9252. A device must be supplied for the output, either directly or with the
  9253. @option{derive_device} option. The input and output devices must be of
  9254. different types and compatible - the exact meaning of this is
  9255. system-dependent, but typically it means that they must refer to the same
  9256. underlying hardware context (for example, refer to the same graphics card).
  9257. If the input frames were originally created on the output device, then unmap
  9258. to retrieve the original frames.
  9259. Otherwise, map the frames to the output device - create new hardware frames
  9260. on the output corresponding to the frames on the input.
  9261. @end itemize
  9262. The following additional parameters are accepted:
  9263. @table @option
  9264. @item mode
  9265. Set the frame mapping mode. Some combination of:
  9266. @table @var
  9267. @item read
  9268. The mapped frame should be readable.
  9269. @item write
  9270. The mapped frame should be writeable.
  9271. @item overwrite
  9272. The mapping will always overwrite the entire frame.
  9273. This may improve performance in some cases, as the original contents of the
  9274. frame need not be loaded.
  9275. @item direct
  9276. The mapping must not involve any copying.
  9277. Indirect mappings to copies of frames are created in some cases where either
  9278. direct mapping is not possible or it would have unexpected properties.
  9279. Setting this flag ensures that the mapping is direct and will fail if that is
  9280. not possible.
  9281. @end table
  9282. Defaults to @var{read+write} if not specified.
  9283. @item derive_device @var{type}
  9284. Rather than using the device supplied at initialisation, instead derive a new
  9285. device of type @var{type} from the device the input frames exist on.
  9286. @item reverse
  9287. In a hardware to hardware mapping, map in reverse - create frames in the sink
  9288. and map them back to the source. This may be necessary in some cases where
  9289. a mapping in one direction is required but only the opposite direction is
  9290. supported by the devices being used.
  9291. This option is dangerous - it may break the preceding filter in undefined
  9292. ways if there are any additional constraints on that filter's output.
  9293. Do not use it without fully understanding the implications of its use.
  9294. @end table
  9295. @anchor{hwupload}
  9296. @section hwupload
  9297. Upload system memory frames to hardware surfaces.
  9298. The device to upload to must be supplied when the filter is initialised. If
  9299. using ffmpeg, select the appropriate device with the @option{-filter_hw_device}
  9300. option or with the @option{derive_device} option. The input and output devices
  9301. must be of different types and compatible - the exact meaning of this is
  9302. system-dependent, but typically it means that they must refer to the same
  9303. underlying hardware context (for example, refer to the same graphics card).
  9304. The following additional parameters are accepted:
  9305. @table @option
  9306. @item derive_device @var{type}
  9307. Rather than using the device supplied at initialisation, instead derive a new
  9308. device of type @var{type} from the device the input frames exist on.
  9309. @end table
  9310. @anchor{hwupload_cuda}
  9311. @section hwupload_cuda
  9312. Upload system memory frames to a CUDA device.
  9313. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  9314. @table @option
  9315. @item device
  9316. The number of the CUDA device to use
  9317. @end table
  9318. @section hqx
  9319. Apply a high-quality magnification filter designed for pixel art. This filter
  9320. was originally created by Maxim Stepin.
  9321. It accepts the following option:
  9322. @table @option
  9323. @item n
  9324. Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{hq2x}, @code{3} for
  9325. @code{hq3x} and @code{4} for @code{hq4x}.
  9326. Default is @code{3}.
  9327. @end table
  9328. @section hstack
  9329. Stack input videos horizontally.
  9330. All streams must be of same pixel format and of same height.
  9331. Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
  9332. to create same output.
  9333. The filter accepts the following option:
  9334. @table @option
  9335. @item inputs
  9336. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  9337. @item shortest
  9338. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  9339. terminates. Default value is 0.
  9340. @end table
  9341. @section hue
  9342. Modify the hue and/or the saturation of the input.
  9343. It accepts the following parameters:
  9344. @table @option
  9345. @item h
  9346. Specify the hue angle as a number of degrees. It accepts an expression,
  9347. and defaults to "0".
  9348. @item s
  9349. Specify the saturation in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
  9350. defaults to "1".
  9351. @item H
  9352. Specify the hue angle as a number of radians. It accepts an
  9353. expression, and defaults to "0".
  9354. @item b
  9355. Specify the brightness in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
  9356. defaults to "0".
  9357. @end table
  9358. @option{h} and @option{H} are mutually exclusive, and can't be
  9359. specified at the same time.
  9360. The @option{b}, @option{h}, @option{H} and @option{s} option values are
  9361. expressions containing the following constants:
  9362. @table @option
  9363. @item n
  9364. frame count of the input frame starting from 0
  9365. @item pts
  9366. presentation timestamp of the input frame expressed in time base units
  9367. @item r
  9368. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  9369. @item t
  9370. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  9371. @item tb
  9372. time base of the input video
  9373. @end table
  9374. @subsection Examples
  9375. @itemize
  9376. @item
  9377. Set the hue to 90 degrees and the saturation to 1.0:
  9378. @example
  9379. hue=h=90:s=1
  9380. @end example
  9381. @item
  9382. Same command but expressing the hue in radians:
  9383. @example
  9384. hue=H=PI/2:s=1
  9385. @end example
  9386. @item
  9387. Rotate hue and make the saturation swing between 0
  9388. and 2 over a period of 1 second:
  9389. @example
  9390. hue="H=2*PI*t: s=sin(2*PI*t)+1"
  9391. @end example
  9392. @item
  9393. Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-in effect starting at 0:
  9394. @example
  9395. hue="s=min(t/3\,1)"
  9396. @end example
  9397. The general fade-in expression can be written as:
  9398. @example
  9399. hue="s=min(0\, max((t-START)/DURATION\, 1))"
  9400. @end example
  9401. @item
  9402. Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-out effect starting at 5 seconds:
  9403. @example
  9404. hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (8-t)/3))"
  9405. @end example
  9406. The general fade-out expression can be written as:
  9407. @example
  9408. hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (START+DURATION-t)/DURATION))"
  9409. @end example
  9410. @end itemize
  9411. @subsection Commands
  9412. This filter supports the following commands:
  9413. @table @option
  9414. @item b
  9415. @item s
  9416. @item h
  9417. @item H
  9418. Modify the hue and/or the saturation and/or brightness of the input video.
  9419. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  9420. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  9421. value.
  9422. @end table
  9423. @section hysteresis
  9424. Grow first stream into second stream by connecting components.
  9425. This makes it possible to build more robust edge masks.
  9426. This filter accepts the following options:
  9427. @table @option
  9428. @item planes
  9429. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  9430. copied from first stream.
  9431. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  9432. @item threshold
  9433. Set threshold which is used in filtering. If pixel component value is higher than
  9434. this value filter algorithm for connecting components is activated.
  9435. By default value is 0.
  9436. @end table
  9437. The @code{hysteresis} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  9438. @section idet
  9439. Detect video interlacing type.
  9440. This filter tries to detect if the input frames are interlaced, progressive,
  9441. top or bottom field first. It will also try to detect fields that are
  9442. repeated between adjacent frames (a sign of telecine).
  9443. Single frame detection considers only immediately adjacent frames when classifying each frame.
  9444. Multiple frame detection incorporates the classification history of previous frames.
  9445. The filter will log these metadata values:
  9446. @table @option
  9447. @item single.current_frame
  9448. Detected type of current frame using single-frame detection. One of:
  9449. ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
  9450. ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
  9451. @item single.tff
  9452. Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using single-frame detection.
  9453. @item multiple.tff
  9454. Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using multiple-frame detection.
  9455. @item single.bff
  9456. Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using single-frame detection.
  9457. @item multiple.current_frame
  9458. Detected type of current frame using multiple-frame detection. One of:
  9459. ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
  9460. ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
  9461. @item multiple.bff
  9462. Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using multiple-frame detection.
  9463. @item single.progressive
  9464. Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using single-frame detection.
  9465. @item multiple.progressive
  9466. Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using multiple-frame detection.
  9467. @item single.undetermined
  9468. Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using single-frame detection.
  9469. @item multiple.undetermined
  9470. Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using multiple-frame detection.
  9471. @item repeated.current_frame
  9472. Which field in the current frame is repeated from the last. One of ``neither'', ``top'', or ``bottom''.
  9473. @item repeated.neither
  9474. Cumulative number of frames with no repeated field.
  9475. @item repeated.top
  9476. Cumulative number of frames with the top field repeated from the previous frame's top field.
  9477. @item repeated.bottom
  9478. Cumulative number of frames with the bottom field repeated from the previous frame's bottom field.
  9479. @end table
  9480. The filter accepts the following options:
  9481. @table @option
  9482. @item intl_thres
  9483. Set interlacing threshold.
  9484. @item prog_thres
  9485. Set progressive threshold.
  9486. @item rep_thres
  9487. Threshold for repeated field detection.
  9488. @item half_life
  9489. Number of frames after which a given frame's contribution to the
  9490. statistics is halved (i.e., it contributes only 0.5 to its
  9491. classification). The default of 0 means that all frames seen are given
  9492. full weight of 1.0 forever.
  9493. @item analyze_interlaced_flag
  9494. When this is not 0 then idet will use the specified number of frames to determine
  9495. if the interlaced flag is accurate, it will not count undetermined frames.
  9496. If the flag is found to be accurate it will be used without any further
  9497. computations, if it is found to be inaccurate it will be cleared without any
  9498. further computations. This allows inserting the idet filter as a low computational
  9499. method to clean up the interlaced flag
  9500. @end table
  9501. @section il
  9502. Deinterleave or interleave fields.
  9503. This filter allows one to process interlaced images fields without
  9504. deinterlacing them. Deinterleaving splits the input frame into 2
  9505. fields (so called half pictures). Odd lines are moved to the top
  9506. half of the output image, even lines to the bottom half.
  9507. You can process (filter) them independently and then re-interleave them.
  9508. The filter accepts the following options:
  9509. @table @option
  9510. @item luma_mode, l
  9511. @item chroma_mode, c
  9512. @item alpha_mode, a
  9513. Available values for @var{luma_mode}, @var{chroma_mode} and
  9514. @var{alpha_mode} are:
  9515. @table @samp
  9516. @item none
  9517. Do nothing.
  9518. @item deinterleave, d
  9519. Deinterleave fields, placing one above the other.
  9520. @item interleave, i
  9521. Interleave fields. Reverse the effect of deinterleaving.
  9522. @end table
  9523. Default value is @code{none}.
  9524. @item luma_swap, ls
  9525. @item chroma_swap, cs
  9526. @item alpha_swap, as
  9527. Swap luma/chroma/alpha fields. Exchange even & odd lines. Default value is @code{0}.
  9528. @end table
  9529. @subsection Commands
  9530. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  9531. @section inflate
  9532. Apply inflate effect to the video.
  9533. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
  9534. only values higher than the pixel.
  9535. It accepts the following options:
  9536. @table @option
  9537. @item threshold0
  9538. @item threshold1
  9539. @item threshold2
  9540. @item threshold3
  9541. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  9542. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  9543. @end table
  9544. @subsection Commands
  9545. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  9546. @section interlace
  9547. Simple interlacing filter from progressive contents. This interleaves upper (or
  9548. lower) lines from odd frames with lower (or upper) lines from even frames,
  9549. halving the frame rate and preserving image height.
  9550. @example
  9551. Original Original New Frame
  9552. Frame 'j' Frame 'j+1' (tff)
  9553. ========== =========== ==================
  9554. Line 0 --------------------> Frame 'j' Line 0
  9555. Line 1 Line 1 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 1
  9556. Line 2 ---------------------> Frame 'j' Line 2
  9557. Line 3 Line 3 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 3
  9558. ... ... ...
  9559. New Frame + 1 will be generated by Frame 'j+2' and Frame 'j+3' and so on
  9560. @end example
  9561. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  9562. @table @option
  9563. @item scan
  9564. This determines whether the interlaced frame is taken from the even
  9565. (tff - default) or odd (bff) lines of the progressive frame.
  9566. @item lowpass
  9567. Vertical lowpass filter to avoid twitter interlacing and
  9568. reduce moire patterns.
  9569. @table @samp
  9570. @item 0, off
  9571. Disable vertical lowpass filter
  9572. @item 1, linear
  9573. Enable linear filter (default)
  9574. @item 2, complex
  9575. Enable complex filter. This will slightly less reduce twitter and moire
  9576. but better retain detail and subjective sharpness impression.
  9577. @end table
  9578. @end table
  9579. @section kerndeint
  9580. Deinterlace input video by applying Donald Graft's adaptive kernel
  9581. deinterling. Work on interlaced parts of a video to produce
  9582. progressive frames.
  9583. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  9584. @table @option
  9585. @item thresh
  9586. Set the threshold which affects the filter's tolerance when
  9587. determining if a pixel line must be processed. It must be an integer
  9588. in the range [0,255] and defaults to 10. A value of 0 will result in
  9589. applying the process on every pixels.
  9590. @item map
  9591. Paint pixels exceeding the threshold value to white if set to 1.
  9592. Default is 0.
  9593. @item order
  9594. Set the fields order. Swap fields if set to 1, leave fields alone if
  9595. 0. Default is 0.
  9596. @item sharp
  9597. Enable additional sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
  9598. @item twoway
  9599. Enable twoway sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
  9600. @end table
  9601. @subsection Examples
  9602. @itemize
  9603. @item
  9604. Apply default values:
  9605. @example
  9606. kerndeint=thresh=10:map=0:order=0:sharp=0:twoway=0
  9607. @end example
  9608. @item
  9609. Enable additional sharpening:
  9610. @example
  9611. kerndeint=sharp=1
  9612. @end example
  9613. @item
  9614. Paint processed pixels in white:
  9615. @example
  9616. kerndeint=map=1
  9617. @end example
  9618. @end itemize
  9619. @section lagfun
  9620. Slowly update darker pixels.
  9621. This filter makes short flashes of light appear longer.
  9622. This filter accepts the following options:
  9623. @table @option
  9624. @item decay
  9625. Set factor for decaying. Default is .95. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  9626. @item planes
  9627. Set which planes to filter. Default is all. Allowed range is from 0 to 15.
  9628. @end table
  9629. @section lenscorrection
  9630. Correct radial lens distortion
  9631. This filter can be used to correct for radial distortion as can result from the use
  9632. of wide angle lenses, and thereby re-rectify the image. To find the right parameters
  9633. one can use tools available for example as part of opencv or simply trial-and-error.
  9634. To use opencv use the calibration sample (under samples/cpp) from the opencv sources
  9635. and extract the k1 and k2 coefficients from the resulting matrix.
  9636. Note that effectively the same filter is available in the open-source tools Krita and
  9637. Digikam from the KDE project.
  9638. In contrast to the @ref{vignette} filter, which can also be used to compensate lens errors,
  9639. this filter corrects the distortion of the image, whereas @ref{vignette} corrects the
  9640. brightness distribution, so you may want to use both filters together in certain
  9641. cases, though you will have to take care of ordering, i.e. whether vignetting should
  9642. be applied before or after lens correction.
  9643. @subsection Options
  9644. The filter accepts the following options:
  9645. @table @option
  9646. @item cx
  9647. Relative x-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
  9648. distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
  9649. width. Default is 0.5.
  9650. @item cy
  9651. Relative y-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
  9652. distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
  9653. height. Default is 0.5.
  9654. @item k1
  9655. Coefficient of the quadratic correction term. This value has a range [-1,1]. 0 means
  9656. no correction. Default is 0.
  9657. @item k2
  9658. Coefficient of the double quadratic correction term. This value has a range [-1,1].
  9659. 0 means no correction. Default is 0.
  9660. @end table
  9661. The formula that generates the correction is:
  9662. @var{r_src} = @var{r_tgt} * (1 + @var{k1} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^2 + @var{k2} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^4)
  9663. where @var{r_0} is halve of the image diagonal and @var{r_src} and @var{r_tgt} are the
  9664. distances from the focal point in the source and target images, respectively.
  9665. @section lensfun
  9666. Apply lens correction via the lensfun library (@url{http://lensfun.sourceforge.net/}).
  9667. The @code{lensfun} filter requires the camera make, camera model, and lens model
  9668. to apply the lens correction. The filter will load the lensfun database and
  9669. query it to find the corresponding camera and lens entries in the database. As
  9670. long as these entries can be found with the given options, the filter can
  9671. perform corrections on frames. Note that incomplete strings will result in the
  9672. filter choosing the best match with the given options, and the filter will
  9673. output the chosen camera and lens models (logged with level "info"). You must
  9674. provide the make, camera model, and lens model as they are required.
  9675. The filter accepts the following options:
  9676. @table @option
  9677. @item make
  9678. The make of the camera (for example, "Canon"). This option is required.
  9679. @item model
  9680. The model of the camera (for example, "Canon EOS 100D"). This option is
  9681. required.
  9682. @item lens_model
  9683. The model of the lens (for example, "Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM"). This
  9684. option is required.
  9685. @item mode
  9686. The type of correction to apply. The following values are valid options:
  9687. @table @samp
  9688. @item vignetting
  9689. Enables fixing lens vignetting.
  9690. @item geometry
  9691. Enables fixing lens geometry. This is the default.
  9692. @item subpixel
  9693. Enables fixing chromatic aberrations.
  9694. @item vig_geo
  9695. Enables fixing lens vignetting and lens geometry.
  9696. @item vig_subpixel
  9697. Enables fixing lens vignetting and chromatic aberrations.
  9698. @item distortion
  9699. Enables fixing both lens geometry and chromatic aberrations.
  9700. @item all
  9701. Enables all possible corrections.
  9702. @end table
  9703. @item focal_length
  9704. The focal length of the image/video (zoom; expected constant for video). For
  9705. example, a 18--55mm lens has focal length range of [18--55], so a value in that
  9706. range should be chosen when using that lens. Default 18.
  9707. @item aperture
  9708. The aperture of the image/video (expected constant for video). Note that
  9709. aperture is only used for vignetting correction. Default 3.5.
  9710. @item focus_distance
  9711. The focus distance of the image/video (expected constant for video). Note that
  9712. focus distance is only used for vignetting and only slightly affects the
  9713. vignetting correction process. If unknown, leave it at the default value (which
  9714. is 1000).
  9715. @item scale
  9716. The scale factor which is applied after transformation. After correction the
  9717. video is no longer necessarily rectangular. This parameter controls how much of
  9718. the resulting image is visible. The value 0 means that a value will be chosen
  9719. automatically such that there is little or no unmapped area in the output
  9720. image. 1.0 means that no additional scaling is done. Lower values may result
  9721. in more of the corrected image being visible, while higher values may avoid
  9722. unmapped areas in the output.
  9723. @item target_geometry
  9724. The target geometry of the output image/video. The following values are valid
  9725. options:
  9726. @table @samp
  9727. @item rectilinear (default)
  9728. @item fisheye
  9729. @item panoramic
  9730. @item equirectangular
  9731. @item fisheye_orthographic
  9732. @item fisheye_stereographic
  9733. @item fisheye_equisolid
  9734. @item fisheye_thoby
  9735. @end table
  9736. @item reverse
  9737. Apply the reverse of image correction (instead of correcting distortion, apply
  9738. it).
  9739. @item interpolation
  9740. The type of interpolation used when correcting distortion. The following values
  9741. are valid options:
  9742. @table @samp
  9743. @item nearest
  9744. @item linear (default)
  9745. @item lanczos
  9746. @end table
  9747. @end table
  9748. @subsection Examples
  9749. @itemize
  9750. @item
  9751. Apply lens correction with make "Canon", camera model "Canon EOS 100D", and lens
  9752. model "Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM" with focal length of "18" and
  9753. aperture of "8.0".
  9754. @example
  9755. ffmpeg -i input.mov -vf lensfun=make=Canon:model="Canon EOS 100D":lens_model="Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM":focal_length=18:aperture=8 -c:v h264 -b:v 8000k output.mov
  9756. @end example
  9757. @item
  9758. Apply the same as before, but only for the first 5 seconds of video.
  9759. @example
  9760. ffmpeg -i input.mov -vf lensfun=make=Canon:model="Canon EOS 100D":lens_model="Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM":focal_length=18:aperture=8:enable='lte(t\,5)' -c:v h264 -b:v 8000k output.mov
  9761. @end example
  9762. @end itemize
  9763. @section libvmaf
  9764. Obtain the VMAF (Video Multi-Method Assessment Fusion)
  9765. score between two input videos.
  9766. The obtained VMAF score is printed through the logging system.
  9767. It requires Netflix's vmaf library (libvmaf) as a pre-requisite.
  9768. After installing the library it can be enabled using:
  9769. @code{./configure --enable-libvmaf --enable-version3}.
  9770. If no model path is specified it uses the default model: @code{vmaf_v0.6.1.pkl}.
  9771. The filter has following options:
  9772. @table @option
  9773. @item model_path
  9774. Set the model path which is to be used for SVM.
  9775. Default value: @code{"/usr/local/share/model/vmaf_v0.6.1.pkl"}
  9776. @item log_path
  9777. Set the file path to be used to store logs.
  9778. @item log_fmt
  9779. Set the format of the log file (xml or json).
  9780. @item enable_transform
  9781. This option can enable/disable the @code{score_transform} applied to the final predicted VMAF score,
  9782. if you have specified score_transform option in the input parameter file passed to @code{run_vmaf_training.py}
  9783. Default value: @code{false}
  9784. @item phone_model
  9785. Invokes the phone model which will generate VMAF scores higher than in the
  9786. regular model, which is more suitable for laptop, TV, etc. viewing conditions.
  9787. Default value: @code{false}
  9788. @item psnr
  9789. Enables computing psnr along with vmaf.
  9790. Default value: @code{false}
  9791. @item ssim
  9792. Enables computing ssim along with vmaf.
  9793. Default value: @code{false}
  9794. @item ms_ssim
  9795. Enables computing ms_ssim along with vmaf.
  9796. Default value: @code{false}
  9797. @item pool
  9798. Set the pool method to be used for computing vmaf.
  9799. Options are @code{min}, @code{harmonic_mean} or @code{mean} (default).
  9800. @item n_threads
  9801. Set number of threads to be used when computing vmaf.
  9802. Default value: @code{0}, which makes use of all available logical processors.
  9803. @item n_subsample
  9804. Set interval for frame subsampling used when computing vmaf.
  9805. Default value: @code{1}
  9806. @item enable_conf_interval
  9807. Enables confidence interval.
  9808. Default value: @code{false}
  9809. @end table
  9810. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  9811. @subsection Examples
  9812. @itemize
  9813. @item
  9814. On the below examples the input file @file{main.mpg} being processed is
  9815. compared with the reference file @file{ref.mpg}.
  9816. @example
  9817. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi libvmaf -f null -
  9818. @end example
  9819. @item
  9820. Example with options:
  9821. @example
  9822. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi libvmaf="psnr=1:log_fmt=json" -f null -
  9823. @end example
  9824. @item
  9825. Example with options and different containers:
  9826. @example
  9827. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mkv -lavfi "[0:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[main];[1:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[ref];[main][ref]libvmaf=psnr=1:log_fmt=json" -f null -
  9828. @end example
  9829. @end itemize
  9830. @section limiter
  9831. Limits the pixel components values to the specified range [min, max].
  9832. The filter accepts the following options:
  9833. @table @option
  9834. @item min
  9835. Lower bound. Defaults to the lowest allowed value for the input.
  9836. @item max
  9837. Upper bound. Defaults to the highest allowed value for the input.
  9838. @item planes
  9839. Specify which planes will be processed. Defaults to all available.
  9840. @end table
  9841. @section loop
  9842. Loop video frames.
  9843. The filter accepts the following options:
  9844. @table @option
  9845. @item loop
  9846. Set the number of loops. Setting this value to -1 will result in infinite loops.
  9847. Default is 0.
  9848. @item size
  9849. Set maximal size in number of frames. Default is 0.
  9850. @item start
  9851. Set first frame of loop. Default is 0.
  9852. @end table
  9853. @subsection Examples
  9854. @itemize
  9855. @item
  9856. Loop single first frame infinitely:
  9857. @example
  9858. loop=loop=-1:size=1:start=0
  9859. @end example
  9860. @item
  9861. Loop single first frame 10 times:
  9862. @example
  9863. loop=loop=10:size=1:start=0
  9864. @end example
  9865. @item
  9866. Loop 10 first frames 5 times:
  9867. @example
  9868. loop=loop=5:size=10:start=0
  9869. @end example
  9870. @end itemize
  9871. @section lut1d
  9872. Apply a 1D LUT to an input video.
  9873. The filter accepts the following options:
  9874. @table @option
  9875. @item file
  9876. Set the 1D LUT file name.
  9877. Currently supported formats:
  9878. @table @samp
  9879. @item cube
  9880. Iridas
  9881. @item csp
  9882. cineSpace
  9883. @end table
  9884. @item interp
  9885. Select interpolation mode.
  9886. Available values are:
  9887. @table @samp
  9888. @item nearest
  9889. Use values from the nearest defined point.
  9890. @item linear
  9891. Interpolate values using the linear interpolation.
  9892. @item cosine
  9893. Interpolate values using the cosine interpolation.
  9894. @item cubic
  9895. Interpolate values using the cubic interpolation.
  9896. @item spline
  9897. Interpolate values using the spline interpolation.
  9898. @end table
  9899. @end table
  9900. @anchor{lut3d}
  9901. @section lut3d
  9902. Apply a 3D LUT to an input video.
  9903. The filter accepts the following options:
  9904. @table @option
  9905. @item file
  9906. Set the 3D LUT file name.
  9907. Currently supported formats:
  9908. @table @samp
  9909. @item 3dl
  9910. AfterEffects
  9911. @item cube
  9912. Iridas
  9913. @item dat
  9914. DaVinci
  9915. @item m3d
  9916. Pandora
  9917. @item csp
  9918. cineSpace
  9919. @end table
  9920. @item interp
  9921. Select interpolation mode.
  9922. Available values are:
  9923. @table @samp
  9924. @item nearest
  9925. Use values from the nearest defined point.
  9926. @item trilinear
  9927. Interpolate values using the 8 points defining a cube.
  9928. @item tetrahedral
  9929. Interpolate values using a tetrahedron.
  9930. @end table
  9931. @end table
  9932. @section lumakey
  9933. Turn certain luma values into transparency.
  9934. The filter accepts the following options:
  9935. @table @option
  9936. @item threshold
  9937. Set the luma which will be used as base for transparency.
  9938. Default value is @code{0}.
  9939. @item tolerance
  9940. Set the range of luma values to be keyed out.
  9941. Default value is @code{0.01}.
  9942. @item softness
  9943. Set the range of softness. Default value is @code{0}.
  9944. Use this to control gradual transition from zero to full transparency.
  9945. @end table
  9946. @subsection Commands
  9947. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  9948. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  9949. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  9950. value.
  9951. @section lut, lutrgb, lutyuv
  9952. Compute a look-up table for binding each pixel component input value
  9953. to an output value, and apply it to the input video.
  9954. @var{lutyuv} applies a lookup table to a YUV input video, @var{lutrgb}
  9955. to an RGB input video.
  9956. These filters accept the following parameters:
  9957. @table @option
  9958. @item c0
  9959. set first pixel component expression
  9960. @item c1
  9961. set second pixel component expression
  9962. @item c2
  9963. set third pixel component expression
  9964. @item c3
  9965. set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  9966. @item r
  9967. set red component expression
  9968. @item g
  9969. set green component expression
  9970. @item b
  9971. set blue component expression
  9972. @item a
  9973. alpha component expression
  9974. @item y
  9975. set Y/luminance component expression
  9976. @item u
  9977. set U/Cb component expression
  9978. @item v
  9979. set V/Cr component expression
  9980. @end table
  9981. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  9982. the corresponding pixel component values.
  9983. The exact component associated to each of the @var{c*} options depends on the
  9984. format in input.
  9985. The @var{lut} filter requires either YUV or RGB pixel formats in input,
  9986. @var{lutrgb} requires RGB pixel formats in input, and @var{lutyuv} requires YUV.
  9987. The expressions can contain the following constants and functions:
  9988. @table @option
  9989. @item w
  9990. @item h
  9991. The input width and height.
  9992. @item val
  9993. The input value for the pixel component.
  9994. @item clipval
  9995. The input value, clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
  9996. @item maxval
  9997. The maximum value for the pixel component.
  9998. @item minval
  9999. The minimum value for the pixel component.
  10000. @item negval
  10001. The negated value for the pixel component value, clipped to the
  10002. @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range; it corresponds to the expression
  10003. "maxval-clipval+minval".
  10004. @item clip(val)
  10005. The computed value in @var{val}, clipped to the
  10006. @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
  10007. @item gammaval(gamma)
  10008. The computed gamma correction value of the pixel component value,
  10009. clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range. It corresponds to the
  10010. expression
  10011. "pow((clipval-minval)/(maxval-minval)\,@var{gamma})*(maxval-minval)+minval"
  10012. @end table
  10013. All expressions default to "val".
  10014. @subsection Examples
  10015. @itemize
  10016. @item
  10017. Negate input video:
  10018. @example
  10019. lutrgb="r=maxval+minval-val:g=maxval+minval-val:b=maxval+minval-val"
  10020. lutyuv="y=maxval+minval-val:u=maxval+minval-val:v=maxval+minval-val"
  10021. @end example
  10022. The above is the same as:
  10023. @example
  10024. lutrgb="r=negval:g=negval:b=negval"
  10025. lutyuv="y=negval:u=negval:v=negval"
  10026. @end example
  10027. @item
  10028. Negate luminance:
  10029. @example
  10030. lutyuv=y=negval
  10031. @end example
  10032. @item
  10033. Remove chroma components, turning the video into a graytone image:
  10034. @example
  10035. lutyuv="u=128:v=128"
  10036. @end example
  10037. @item
  10038. Apply a luma burning effect:
  10039. @example
  10040. lutyuv="y=2*val"
  10041. @end example
  10042. @item
  10043. Remove green and blue components:
  10044. @example
  10045. lutrgb="g=0:b=0"
  10046. @end example
  10047. @item
  10048. Set a constant alpha channel value on input:
  10049. @example
  10050. format=rgba,lutrgb=a="maxval-minval/2"
  10051. @end example
  10052. @item
  10053. Correct luminance gamma by a factor of 0.5:
  10054. @example
  10055. lutyuv=y=gammaval(0.5)
  10056. @end example
  10057. @item
  10058. Discard least significant bits of luma:
  10059. @example
  10060. lutyuv=y='bitand(val, 128+64+32)'
  10061. @end example
  10062. @item
  10063. Technicolor like effect:
  10064. @example
  10065. lutyuv=u='(val-maxval/2)*2+maxval/2':v='(val-maxval/2)*2+maxval/2'
  10066. @end example
  10067. @end itemize
  10068. @section lut2, tlut2
  10069. The @code{lut2} filter takes two input streams and outputs one
  10070. stream.
  10071. The @code{tlut2} (time lut2) filter takes two consecutive frames
  10072. from one single stream.
  10073. This filter accepts the following parameters:
  10074. @table @option
  10075. @item c0
  10076. set first pixel component expression
  10077. @item c1
  10078. set second pixel component expression
  10079. @item c2
  10080. set third pixel component expression
  10081. @item c3
  10082. set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  10083. @item d
  10084. set output bit depth, only available for @code{lut2} filter. By default is 0,
  10085. which means bit depth is automatically picked from first input format.
  10086. @end table
  10087. The @code{lut2} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  10088. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  10089. the corresponding pixel component values.
  10090. The exact component associated to each of the @var{c*} options depends on the
  10091. format in inputs.
  10092. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  10093. @table @option
  10094. @item w
  10095. @item h
  10096. The input width and height.
  10097. @item x
  10098. The first input value for the pixel component.
  10099. @item y
  10100. The second input value for the pixel component.
  10101. @item bdx
  10102. The first input video bit depth.
  10103. @item bdy
  10104. The second input video bit depth.
  10105. @end table
  10106. All expressions default to "x".
  10107. @subsection Examples
  10108. @itemize
  10109. @item
  10110. Highlight differences between two RGB video streams:
  10111. @example
  10112. lut2='ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1)'
  10113. @end example
  10114. @item
  10115. Highlight differences between two YUV video streams:
  10116. @example
  10117. lut2='ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,pow(2,bdx-1),pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,pow(2,bdx-1),pow(2,bdx)-1)'
  10118. @end example
  10119. @item
  10120. Show max difference between two video streams:
  10121. @example
  10122. lut2='if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1))):if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1))):if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1)))'
  10123. @end example
  10124. @end itemize
  10125. @section maskedclamp
  10126. Clamp the first input stream with the second input and third input stream.
  10127. Returns the value of first stream to be between second input
  10128. stream - @code{undershoot} and third input stream + @code{overshoot}.
  10129. This filter accepts the following options:
  10130. @table @option
  10131. @item undershoot
  10132. Default value is @code{0}.
  10133. @item overshoot
  10134. Default value is @code{0}.
  10135. @item planes
  10136. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  10137. copied from first stream.
  10138. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  10139. @end table
  10140. @section maskedmax
  10141. Merge the second and third input stream into output stream using absolute differences
  10142. between second input stream and first input stream and absolute difference between
  10143. third input stream and first input stream. The picked value will be from second input
  10144. stream if second absolute difference is greater than first one or from third input stream
  10145. otherwise.
  10146. This filter accepts the following options:
  10147. @table @option
  10148. @item planes
  10149. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  10150. copied from first stream.
  10151. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  10152. @end table
  10153. @section maskedmerge
  10154. Merge the first input stream with the second input stream using per pixel
  10155. weights in the third input stream.
  10156. A value of 0 in the third stream pixel component means that pixel component
  10157. from first stream is returned unchanged, while maximum value (eg. 255 for
  10158. 8-bit videos) means that pixel component from second stream is returned
  10159. unchanged. Intermediate values define the amount of merging between both
  10160. input stream's pixel components.
  10161. This filter accepts the following options:
  10162. @table @option
  10163. @item planes
  10164. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  10165. copied from first stream.
  10166. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  10167. @end table
  10168. @section maskedmin
  10169. Merge the second and third input stream into output stream using absolute differences
  10170. between second input stream and first input stream and absolute difference between
  10171. third input stream and first input stream. The picked value will be from second input
  10172. stream if second absolute difference is less than first one or from third input stream
  10173. otherwise.
  10174. This filter accepts the following options:
  10175. @table @option
  10176. @item planes
  10177. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  10178. copied from first stream.
  10179. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  10180. @end table
  10181. @section maskedthreshold
  10182. Pick pixels comparing absolute difference of two video streams with fixed
  10183. threshold.
  10184. If absolute difference between pixel component of first and second video
  10185. stream is equal or lower than user supplied threshold than pixel component
  10186. from first video stream is picked, otherwise pixel component from second
  10187. video stream is picked.
  10188. This filter accepts the following options:
  10189. @table @option
  10190. @item threshold
  10191. Set threshold used when picking pixels from absolute difference from two input
  10192. video streams.
  10193. @item planes
  10194. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  10195. copied from second stream.
  10196. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  10197. @end table
  10198. @section maskfun
  10199. Create mask from input video.
  10200. For example it is useful to create motion masks after @code{tblend} filter.
  10201. This filter accepts the following options:
  10202. @table @option
  10203. @item low
  10204. Set low threshold. Any pixel component lower or exact than this value will be set to 0.
  10205. @item high
  10206. Set high threshold. Any pixel component higher than this value will be set to max value
  10207. allowed for current pixel format.
  10208. @item planes
  10209. Set planes to filter, by default all available planes are filtered.
  10210. @item fill
  10211. Fill all frame pixels with this value.
  10212. @item sum
  10213. Set max average pixel value for frame. If sum of all pixel components is higher that this
  10214. average, output frame will be completely filled with value set by @var{fill} option.
  10215. Typically useful for scene changes when used in combination with @code{tblend} filter.
  10216. @end table
  10217. @section mcdeint
  10218. Apply motion-compensation deinterlacing.
  10219. It needs one field per frame as input and must thus be used together
  10220. with yadif=1/3 or equivalent.
  10221. This filter accepts the following options:
  10222. @table @option
  10223. @item mode
  10224. Set the deinterlacing mode.
  10225. It accepts one of the following values:
  10226. @table @samp
  10227. @item fast
  10228. @item medium
  10229. @item slow
  10230. use iterative motion estimation
  10231. @item extra_slow
  10232. like @samp{slow}, but use multiple reference frames.
  10233. @end table
  10234. Default value is @samp{fast}.
  10235. @item parity
  10236. Set the picture field parity assumed for the input video. It must be
  10237. one of the following values:
  10238. @table @samp
  10239. @item 0, tff
  10240. assume top field first
  10241. @item 1, bff
  10242. assume bottom field first
  10243. @end table
  10244. Default value is @samp{bff}.
  10245. @item qp
  10246. Set per-block quantization parameter (QP) used by the internal
  10247. encoder.
  10248. Higher values should result in a smoother motion vector field but less
  10249. optimal individual vectors. Default value is 1.
  10250. @end table
  10251. @section median
  10252. Pick median pixel from certain rectangle defined by radius.
  10253. This filter accepts the following options:
  10254. @table @option
  10255. @item radius
  10256. Set horizontal radius size. Default value is @code{1}.
  10257. Allowed range is integer from 1 to 127.
  10258. @item planes
  10259. Set which planes to process. Default is @code{15}, which is all available planes.
  10260. @item radiusV
  10261. Set vertical radius size. Default value is @code{0}.
  10262. Allowed range is integer from 0 to 127.
  10263. If it is 0, value will be picked from horizontal @code{radius} option.
  10264. @item percentile
  10265. Set median percentile. Default value is @code{0.5}.
  10266. Default value of @code{0.5} will pick always median values, while @code{0} will pick
  10267. minimum values, and @code{1} maximum values.
  10268. @end table
  10269. @subsection Commands
  10270. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  10271. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  10272. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  10273. value.
  10274. @section mergeplanes
  10275. Merge color channel components from several video streams.
  10276. The filter accepts up to 4 input streams, and merge selected input
  10277. planes to the output video.
  10278. This filter accepts the following options:
  10279. @table @option
  10280. @item mapping
  10281. Set input to output plane mapping. Default is @code{0}.
  10282. The mappings is specified as a bitmap. It should be specified as a
  10283. hexadecimal number in the form 0xAa[Bb[Cc[Dd]]]. 'Aa' describes the
  10284. mapping for the first plane of the output stream. 'A' sets the number of
  10285. the input stream to use (from 0 to 3), and 'a' the plane number of the
  10286. corresponding input to use (from 0 to 3). The rest of the mappings is
  10287. similar, 'Bb' describes the mapping for the output stream second
  10288. plane, 'Cc' describes the mapping for the output stream third plane and
  10289. 'Dd' describes the mapping for the output stream fourth plane.
  10290. @item format
  10291. Set output pixel format. Default is @code{yuva444p}.
  10292. @end table
  10293. @subsection Examples
  10294. @itemize
  10295. @item
  10296. Merge three gray video streams of same width and height into single video stream:
  10297. @example
  10298. [a0][a1][a2]mergeplanes=0x001020:yuv444p
  10299. @end example
  10300. @item
  10301. Merge 1st yuv444p stream and 2nd gray video stream into yuva444p video stream:
  10302. @example
  10303. [a0][a1]mergeplanes=0x00010210:yuva444p
  10304. @end example
  10305. @item
  10306. Swap Y and A plane in yuva444p stream:
  10307. @example
  10308. format=yuva444p,mergeplanes=0x03010200:yuva444p
  10309. @end example
  10310. @item
  10311. Swap U and V plane in yuv420p stream:
  10312. @example
  10313. format=yuv420p,mergeplanes=0x000201:yuv420p
  10314. @end example
  10315. @item
  10316. Cast a rgb24 clip to yuv444p:
  10317. @example
  10318. format=rgb24,mergeplanes=0x000102:yuv444p
  10319. @end example
  10320. @end itemize
  10321. @section mestimate
  10322. Estimate and export motion vectors using block matching algorithms.
  10323. Motion vectors are stored in frame side data to be used by other filters.
  10324. This filter accepts the following options:
  10325. @table @option
  10326. @item method
  10327. Specify the motion estimation method. Accepts one of the following values:
  10328. @table @samp
  10329. @item esa
  10330. Exhaustive search algorithm.
  10331. @item tss
  10332. Three step search algorithm.
  10333. @item tdls
  10334. Two dimensional logarithmic search algorithm.
  10335. @item ntss
  10336. New three step search algorithm.
  10337. @item fss
  10338. Four step search algorithm.
  10339. @item ds
  10340. Diamond search algorithm.
  10341. @item hexbs
  10342. Hexagon-based search algorithm.
  10343. @item epzs
  10344. Enhanced predictive zonal search algorithm.
  10345. @item umh
  10346. Uneven multi-hexagon search algorithm.
  10347. @end table
  10348. Default value is @samp{esa}.
  10349. @item mb_size
  10350. Macroblock size. Default @code{16}.
  10351. @item search_param
  10352. Search parameter. Default @code{7}.
  10353. @end table
  10354. @section midequalizer
  10355. Apply Midway Image Equalization effect using two video streams.
  10356. Midway Image Equalization adjusts a pair of images to have the same
  10357. histogram, while maintaining their dynamics as much as possible. It's
  10358. useful for e.g. matching exposures from a pair of stereo cameras.
  10359. This filter has two inputs and one output, which must be of same pixel format, but
  10360. may be of different sizes. The output of filter is first input adjusted with
  10361. midway histogram of both inputs.
  10362. This filter accepts the following option:
  10363. @table @option
  10364. @item planes
  10365. Set which planes to process. Default is @code{15}, which is all available planes.
  10366. @end table
  10367. @section minterpolate
  10368. Convert the video to specified frame rate using motion interpolation.
  10369. This filter accepts the following options:
  10370. @table @option
  10371. @item fps
  10372. Specify the output frame rate. This can be rational e.g. @code{60000/1001}. Frames are dropped if @var{fps} is lower than source fps. Default @code{60}.
  10373. @item mi_mode
  10374. Motion interpolation mode. Following values are accepted:
  10375. @table @samp
  10376. @item dup
  10377. Duplicate previous or next frame for interpolating new ones.
  10378. @item blend
  10379. Blend source frames. Interpolated frame is mean of previous and next frames.
  10380. @item mci
  10381. Motion compensated interpolation. Following options are effective when this mode is selected:
  10382. @table @samp
  10383. @item mc_mode
  10384. Motion compensation mode. Following values are accepted:
  10385. @table @samp
  10386. @item obmc
  10387. Overlapped block motion compensation.
  10388. @item aobmc
  10389. Adaptive overlapped block motion compensation. Window weighting coefficients are controlled adaptively according to the reliabilities of the neighboring motion vectors to reduce oversmoothing.
  10390. @end table
  10391. Default mode is @samp{obmc}.
  10392. @item me_mode
  10393. Motion estimation mode. Following values are accepted:
  10394. @table @samp
  10395. @item bidir
  10396. Bidirectional motion estimation. Motion vectors are estimated for each source frame in both forward and backward directions.
  10397. @item bilat
  10398. Bilateral motion estimation. Motion vectors are estimated directly for interpolated frame.
  10399. @end table
  10400. Default mode is @samp{bilat}.
  10401. @item me
  10402. The algorithm to be used for motion estimation. Following values are accepted:
  10403. @table @samp
  10404. @item esa
  10405. Exhaustive search algorithm.
  10406. @item tss
  10407. Three step search algorithm.
  10408. @item tdls
  10409. Two dimensional logarithmic search algorithm.
  10410. @item ntss
  10411. New three step search algorithm.
  10412. @item fss
  10413. Four step search algorithm.
  10414. @item ds
  10415. Diamond search algorithm.
  10416. @item hexbs
  10417. Hexagon-based search algorithm.
  10418. @item epzs
  10419. Enhanced predictive zonal search algorithm.
  10420. @item umh
  10421. Uneven multi-hexagon search algorithm.
  10422. @end table
  10423. Default algorithm is @samp{epzs}.
  10424. @item mb_size
  10425. Macroblock size. Default @code{16}.
  10426. @item search_param
  10427. Motion estimation search parameter. Default @code{32}.
  10428. @item vsbmc
  10429. Enable variable-size block motion compensation. Motion estimation is applied with smaller block sizes at object boundaries in order to make the them less blur. Default is @code{0} (disabled).
  10430. @end table
  10431. @end table
  10432. @item scd
  10433. Scene change detection method. Scene change leads motion vectors to be in random direction. Scene change detection replace interpolated frames by duplicate ones. May not be needed for other modes. Following values are accepted:
  10434. @table @samp
  10435. @item none
  10436. Disable scene change detection.
  10437. @item fdiff
  10438. Frame difference. Corresponding pixel values are compared and if it satisfies @var{scd_threshold} scene change is detected.
  10439. @end table
  10440. Default method is @samp{fdiff}.
  10441. @item scd_threshold
  10442. Scene change detection threshold. Default is @code{10.}.
  10443. @end table
  10444. @section mix
  10445. Mix several video input streams into one video stream.
  10446. A description of the accepted options follows.
  10447. @table @option
  10448. @item nb_inputs
  10449. The number of inputs. If unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  10450. @item weights
  10451. Specify weight of each input video stream as sequence.
  10452. Each weight is separated by space. If number of weights
  10453. is smaller than number of @var{frames} last specified
  10454. weight will be used for all remaining unset weights.
  10455. @item scale
  10456. Specify scale, if it is set it will be multiplied with sum
  10457. of each weight multiplied with pixel values to give final destination
  10458. pixel value. By default @var{scale} is auto scaled to sum of weights.
  10459. @item duration
  10460. Specify how end of stream is determined.
  10461. @table @samp
  10462. @item longest
  10463. The duration of the longest input. (default)
  10464. @item shortest
  10465. The duration of the shortest input.
  10466. @item first
  10467. The duration of the first input.
  10468. @end table
  10469. @end table
  10470. @section mpdecimate
  10471. Drop frames that do not differ greatly from the previous frame in
  10472. order to reduce frame rate.
  10473. The main use of this filter is for very-low-bitrate encoding
  10474. (e.g. streaming over dialup modem), but it could in theory be used for
  10475. fixing movies that were inverse-telecined incorrectly.
  10476. A description of the accepted options follows.
  10477. @table @option
  10478. @item max
  10479. Set the maximum number of consecutive frames which can be dropped (if
  10480. positive), or the minimum interval between dropped frames (if
  10481. negative). If the value is 0, the frame is dropped disregarding the
  10482. number of previous sequentially dropped frames.
  10483. Default value is 0.
  10484. @item hi
  10485. @item lo
  10486. @item frac
  10487. Set the dropping threshold values.
  10488. Values for @option{hi} and @option{lo} are for 8x8 pixel blocks and
  10489. represent actual pixel value differences, so a threshold of 64
  10490. corresponds to 1 unit of difference for each pixel, or the same spread
  10491. out differently over the block.
  10492. A frame is a candidate for dropping if no 8x8 blocks differ by more
  10493. than a threshold of @option{hi}, and if no more than @option{frac} blocks (1
  10494. meaning the whole image) differ by more than a threshold of @option{lo}.
  10495. Default value for @option{hi} is 64*12, default value for @option{lo} is
  10496. 64*5, and default value for @option{frac} is 0.33.
  10497. @end table
  10498. @section negate
  10499. Negate (invert) the input video.
  10500. It accepts the following option:
  10501. @table @option
  10502. @item negate_alpha
  10503. With value 1, it negates the alpha component, if present. Default value is 0.
  10504. @end table
  10505. @anchor{nlmeans}
  10506. @section nlmeans
  10507. Denoise frames using Non-Local Means algorithm.
  10508. Each pixel is adjusted by looking for other pixels with similar contexts. This
  10509. context similarity is defined by comparing their surrounding patches of size
  10510. @option{p}x@option{p}. Patches are searched in an area of @option{r}x@option{r}
  10511. around the pixel.
  10512. Note that the research area defines centers for patches, which means some
  10513. patches will be made of pixels outside that research area.
  10514. The filter accepts the following options.
  10515. @table @option
  10516. @item s
  10517. Set denoising strength. Default is 1.0. Must be in range [1.0, 30.0].
  10518. @item p
  10519. Set patch size. Default is 7. Must be odd number in range [0, 99].
  10520. @item pc
  10521. Same as @option{p} but for chroma planes.
  10522. The default value is @var{0} and means automatic.
  10523. @item r
  10524. Set research size. Default is 15. Must be odd number in range [0, 99].
  10525. @item rc
  10526. Same as @option{r} but for chroma planes.
  10527. The default value is @var{0} and means automatic.
  10528. @end table
  10529. @section nnedi
  10530. Deinterlace video using neural network edge directed interpolation.
  10531. This filter accepts the following options:
  10532. @table @option
  10533. @item weights
  10534. Mandatory option, without binary file filter can not work.
  10535. Currently file can be found here:
  10536. https://github.com/dubhater/vapoursynth-nnedi3/blob/master/src/nnedi3_weights.bin
  10537. @item deint
  10538. Set which frames to deinterlace, by default it is @code{all}.
  10539. Can be @code{all} or @code{interlaced}.
  10540. @item field
  10541. Set mode of operation.
  10542. Can be one of the following:
  10543. @table @samp
  10544. @item af
  10545. Use frame flags, both fields.
  10546. @item a
  10547. Use frame flags, single field.
  10548. @item t
  10549. Use top field only.
  10550. @item b
  10551. Use bottom field only.
  10552. @item tf
  10553. Use both fields, top first.
  10554. @item bf
  10555. Use both fields, bottom first.
  10556. @end table
  10557. @item planes
  10558. Set which planes to process, by default filter process all frames.
  10559. @item nsize
  10560. Set size of local neighborhood around each pixel, used by the predictor neural
  10561. network.
  10562. Can be one of the following:
  10563. @table @samp
  10564. @item s8x6
  10565. @item s16x6
  10566. @item s32x6
  10567. @item s48x6
  10568. @item s8x4
  10569. @item s16x4
  10570. @item s32x4
  10571. @end table
  10572. @item nns
  10573. Set the number of neurons in predictor neural network.
  10574. Can be one of the following:
  10575. @table @samp
  10576. @item n16
  10577. @item n32
  10578. @item n64
  10579. @item n128
  10580. @item n256
  10581. @end table
  10582. @item qual
  10583. Controls the number of different neural network predictions that are blended
  10584. together to compute the final output value. Can be @code{fast}, default or
  10585. @code{slow}.
  10586. @item etype
  10587. Set which set of weights to use in the predictor.
  10588. Can be one of the following:
  10589. @table @samp
  10590. @item a
  10591. weights trained to minimize absolute error
  10592. @item s
  10593. weights trained to minimize squared error
  10594. @end table
  10595. @item pscrn
  10596. Controls whether or not the prescreener neural network is used to decide
  10597. which pixels should be processed by the predictor neural network and which
  10598. can be handled by simple cubic interpolation.
  10599. The prescreener is trained to know whether cubic interpolation will be
  10600. sufficient for a pixel or whether it should be predicted by the predictor nn.
  10601. The computational complexity of the prescreener nn is much less than that of
  10602. the predictor nn. Since most pixels can be handled by cubic interpolation,
  10603. using the prescreener generally results in much faster processing.
  10604. The prescreener is pretty accurate, so the difference between using it and not
  10605. using it is almost always unnoticeable.
  10606. Can be one of the following:
  10607. @table @samp
  10608. @item none
  10609. @item original
  10610. @item new
  10611. @end table
  10612. Default is @code{new}.
  10613. @item fapprox
  10614. Set various debugging flags.
  10615. @end table
  10616. @section noformat
  10617. Force libavfilter not to use any of the specified pixel formats for the
  10618. input to the next filter.
  10619. It accepts the following parameters:
  10620. @table @option
  10621. @item pix_fmts
  10622. A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
  10623. pix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
  10624. @end table
  10625. @subsection Examples
  10626. @itemize
  10627. @item
  10628. Force libavfilter to use a format different from @var{yuv420p} for the
  10629. input to the vflip filter:
  10630. @example
  10631. noformat=pix_fmts=yuv420p,vflip
  10632. @end example
  10633. @item
  10634. Convert the input video to any of the formats not contained in the list:
  10635. @example
  10636. noformat=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
  10637. @end example
  10638. @end itemize
  10639. @section noise
  10640. Add noise on video input frame.
  10641. The filter accepts the following options:
  10642. @table @option
  10643. @item all_seed
  10644. @item c0_seed
  10645. @item c1_seed
  10646. @item c2_seed
  10647. @item c3_seed
  10648. Set noise seed for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  10649. of @var{all_seed}. Default value is @code{123457}.
  10650. @item all_strength, alls
  10651. @item c0_strength, c0s
  10652. @item c1_strength, c1s
  10653. @item c2_strength, c2s
  10654. @item c3_strength, c3s
  10655. Set noise strength for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  10656. @var{all_strength}. Default value is @code{0}. Allowed range is [0, 100].
  10657. @item all_flags, allf
  10658. @item c0_flags, c0f
  10659. @item c1_flags, c1f
  10660. @item c2_flags, c2f
  10661. @item c3_flags, c3f
  10662. Set pixel component flags or set flags for all components if @var{all_flags}.
  10663. Available values for component flags are:
  10664. @table @samp
  10665. @item a
  10666. averaged temporal noise (smoother)
  10667. @item p
  10668. mix random noise with a (semi)regular pattern
  10669. @item t
  10670. temporal noise (noise pattern changes between frames)
  10671. @item u
  10672. uniform noise (gaussian otherwise)
  10673. @end table
  10674. @end table
  10675. @subsection Examples
  10676. Add temporal and uniform noise to input video:
  10677. @example
  10678. noise=alls=20:allf=t+u
  10679. @end example
  10680. @section normalize
  10681. Normalize RGB video (aka histogram stretching, contrast stretching).
  10682. See: https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Normalization_(image_processing)
  10683. For each channel of each frame, the filter computes the input range and maps
  10684. it linearly to the user-specified output range. The output range defaults
  10685. to the full dynamic range from pure black to pure white.
  10686. Temporal smoothing can be used on the input range to reduce flickering (rapid
  10687. changes in brightness) caused when small dark or bright objects enter or leave
  10688. the scene. This is similar to the auto-exposure (automatic gain control) on a
  10689. video camera, and, like a video camera, it may cause a period of over- or
  10690. under-exposure of the video.
  10691. The R,G,B channels can be normalized independently, which may cause some
  10692. color shifting, or linked together as a single channel, which prevents
  10693. color shifting. Linked normalization preserves hue. Independent normalization
  10694. does not, so it can be used to remove some color casts. Independent and linked
  10695. normalization can be combined in any ratio.
  10696. The normalize filter accepts the following options:
  10697. @table @option
  10698. @item blackpt
  10699. @item whitept
  10700. Colors which define the output range. The minimum input value is mapped to
  10701. the @var{blackpt}. The maximum input value is mapped to the @var{whitept}.
  10702. The defaults are black and white respectively. Specifying white for
  10703. @var{blackpt} and black for @var{whitept} will give color-inverted,
  10704. normalized video. Shades of grey can be used to reduce the dynamic range
  10705. (contrast). Specifying saturated colors here can create some interesting
  10706. effects.
  10707. @item smoothing
  10708. The number of previous frames to use for temporal smoothing. The input range
  10709. of each channel is smoothed using a rolling average over the current frame
  10710. and the @var{smoothing} previous frames. The default is 0 (no temporal
  10711. smoothing).
  10712. @item independence
  10713. Controls the ratio of independent (color shifting) channel normalization to
  10714. linked (color preserving) normalization. 0.0 is fully linked, 1.0 is fully
  10715. independent. Defaults to 1.0 (fully independent).
  10716. @item strength
  10717. Overall strength of the filter. 1.0 is full strength. 0.0 is a rather
  10718. expensive no-op. Defaults to 1.0 (full strength).
  10719. @end table
  10720. @subsection Commands
  10721. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options, excluding @var{smoothing} option.
  10722. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  10723. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  10724. value.
  10725. @subsection Examples
  10726. Stretch video contrast to use the full dynamic range, with no temporal
  10727. smoothing; may flicker depending on the source content:
  10728. @example
  10729. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=0
  10730. @end example
  10731. As above, but with 50 frames of temporal smoothing; flicker should be
  10732. reduced, depending on the source content:
  10733. @example
  10734. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50
  10735. @end example
  10736. As above, but with hue-preserving linked channel normalization:
  10737. @example
  10738. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50:independence=0
  10739. @end example
  10740. As above, but with half strength:
  10741. @example
  10742. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50:independence=0:strength=0.5
  10743. @end example
  10744. Map the darkest input color to red, the brightest input color to cyan:
  10745. @example
  10746. normalize=blackpt=red:whitept=cyan
  10747. @end example
  10748. @section null
  10749. Pass the video source unchanged to the output.
  10750. @section ocr
  10751. Optical Character Recognition
  10752. This filter uses Tesseract for optical character recognition. To enable
  10753. compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  10754. @code{--enable-libtesseract}.
  10755. It accepts the following options:
  10756. @table @option
  10757. @item datapath
  10758. Set datapath to tesseract data. Default is to use whatever was
  10759. set at installation.
  10760. @item language
  10761. Set language, default is "eng".
  10762. @item whitelist
  10763. Set character whitelist.
  10764. @item blacklist
  10765. Set character blacklist.
  10766. @end table
  10767. The filter exports recognized text as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.ocr.text}.
  10768. The filter exports confidence of recognized words as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.ocr.confidence}.
  10769. @section ocv
  10770. Apply a video transform using libopencv.
  10771. To enable this filter, install the libopencv library and headers and
  10772. configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libopencv}.
  10773. It accepts the following parameters:
  10774. @table @option
  10775. @item filter_name
  10776. The name of the libopencv filter to apply.
  10777. @item filter_params
  10778. The parameters to pass to the libopencv filter. If not specified, the default
  10779. values are assumed.
  10780. @end table
  10781. Refer to the official libopencv documentation for more precise
  10782. information:
  10783. @url{http://docs.opencv.org/master/modules/imgproc/doc/filtering.html}
  10784. Several libopencv filters are supported; see the following subsections.
  10785. @anchor{dilate}
  10786. @subsection dilate
  10787. Dilate an image by using a specific structuring element.
  10788. It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvDilate}.
  10789. It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}|@var{nb_iterations}.
  10790. @var{struct_el} represents a structuring element, and has the syntax:
  10791. @var{cols}x@var{rows}+@var{anchor_x}x@var{anchor_y}/@var{shape}
  10792. @var{cols} and @var{rows} represent the number of columns and rows of
  10793. the structuring element, @var{anchor_x} and @var{anchor_y} the anchor
  10794. point, and @var{shape} the shape for the structuring element. @var{shape}
  10795. must be "rect", "cross", "ellipse", or "custom".
  10796. If the value for @var{shape} is "custom", it must be followed by a
  10797. string of the form "=@var{filename}". The file with name
  10798. @var{filename} is assumed to represent a binary image, with each
  10799. printable character corresponding to a bright pixel. When a custom
  10800. @var{shape} is used, @var{cols} and @var{rows} are ignored, the number
  10801. or columns and rows of the read file are assumed instead.
  10802. The default value for @var{struct_el} is "3x3+0x0/rect".
  10803. @var{nb_iterations} specifies the number of times the transform is
  10804. applied to the image, and defaults to 1.
  10805. Some examples:
  10806. @example
  10807. # Use the default values
  10808. ocv=dilate
  10809. # Dilate using a structuring element with a 5x5 cross, iterating two times
  10810. ocv=filter_name=dilate:filter_params=5x5+2x2/cross|2
  10811. # Read the shape from the file diamond.shape, iterating two times.
  10812. # The file diamond.shape may contain a pattern of characters like this
  10813. # *
  10814. # ***
  10815. # *****
  10816. # ***
  10817. # *
  10818. # The specified columns and rows are ignored
  10819. # but the anchor point coordinates are not
  10820. ocv=dilate:0x0+2x2/custom=diamond.shape|2
  10821. @end example
  10822. @subsection erode
  10823. Erode an image by using a specific structuring element.
  10824. It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvErode}.
  10825. It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}:@var{nb_iterations},
  10826. with the same syntax and semantics as the @ref{dilate} filter.
  10827. @subsection smooth
  10828. Smooth the input video.
  10829. The filter takes the following parameters:
  10830. @var{type}|@var{param1}|@var{param2}|@var{param3}|@var{param4}.
  10831. @var{type} is the type of smooth filter to apply, and must be one of
  10832. the following values: "blur", "blur_no_scale", "median", "gaussian",
  10833. or "bilateral". The default value is "gaussian".
  10834. The meaning of @var{param1}, @var{param2}, @var{param3}, and @var{param4}
  10835. depends on the smooth type. @var{param1} and
  10836. @var{param2} accept integer positive values or 0. @var{param3} and
  10837. @var{param4} accept floating point values.
  10838. The default value for @var{param1} is 3. The default value for the
  10839. other parameters is 0.
  10840. These parameters correspond to the parameters assigned to the
  10841. libopencv function @code{cvSmooth}.
  10842. @section oscilloscope
  10843. 2D Video Oscilloscope.
  10844. Useful to measure spatial impulse, step responses, chroma delays, etc.
  10845. It accepts the following parameters:
  10846. @table @option
  10847. @item x
  10848. Set scope center x position.
  10849. @item y
  10850. Set scope center y position.
  10851. @item s
  10852. Set scope size, relative to frame diagonal.
  10853. @item t
  10854. Set scope tilt/rotation.
  10855. @item o
  10856. Set trace opacity.
  10857. @item tx
  10858. Set trace center x position.
  10859. @item ty
  10860. Set trace center y position.
  10861. @item tw
  10862. Set trace width, relative to width of frame.
  10863. @item th
  10864. Set trace height, relative to height of frame.
  10865. @item c
  10866. Set which components to trace. By default it traces first three components.
  10867. @item g
  10868. Draw trace grid. By default is enabled.
  10869. @item st
  10870. Draw some statistics. By default is enabled.
  10871. @item sc
  10872. Draw scope. By default is enabled.
  10873. @end table
  10874. @subsection Commands
  10875. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  10876. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  10877. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  10878. value.
  10879. @subsection Examples
  10880. @itemize
  10881. @item
  10882. Inspect full first row of video frame.
  10883. @example
  10884. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=0:s=1
  10885. @end example
  10886. @item
  10887. Inspect full last row of video frame.
  10888. @example
  10889. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=1:s=1
  10890. @end example
  10891. @item
  10892. Inspect full 5th line of video frame of height 1080.
  10893. @example
  10894. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=5/1080:s=1
  10895. @end example
  10896. @item
  10897. Inspect full last column of video frame.
  10898. @example
  10899. oscilloscope=x=1:y=0.5:s=1:t=1
  10900. @end example
  10901. @end itemize
  10902. @anchor{overlay}
  10903. @section overlay
  10904. Overlay one video on top of another.
  10905. It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main"
  10906. video on which the second input is overlaid.
  10907. It accepts the following parameters:
  10908. A description of the accepted options follows.
  10909. @table @option
  10910. @item x
  10911. @item y
  10912. Set the expression for the x and y coordinates of the overlaid video
  10913. on the main video. Default value is "0" for both expressions. In case
  10914. the expression is invalid, it is set to a huge value (meaning that the
  10915. overlay will not be displayed within the output visible area).
  10916. @item eof_action
  10917. See @ref{framesync}.
  10918. @item eval
  10919. Set when the expressions for @option{x}, and @option{y} are evaluated.
  10920. It accepts the following values:
  10921. @table @samp
  10922. @item init
  10923. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  10924. when a command is processed
  10925. @item frame
  10926. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  10927. @end table
  10928. Default value is @samp{frame}.
  10929. @item shortest
  10930. See @ref{framesync}.
  10931. @item format
  10932. Set the format for the output video.
  10933. It accepts the following values:
  10934. @table @samp
  10935. @item yuv420
  10936. force YUV420 output
  10937. @item yuv420p10
  10938. force YUV420p10 output
  10939. @item yuv422
  10940. force YUV422 output
  10941. @item yuv422p10
  10942. force YUV422p10 output
  10943. @item yuv444
  10944. force YUV444 output
  10945. @item rgb
  10946. force packed RGB output
  10947. @item gbrp
  10948. force planar RGB output
  10949. @item auto
  10950. automatically pick format
  10951. @end table
  10952. Default value is @samp{yuv420}.
  10953. @item repeatlast
  10954. See @ref{framesync}.
  10955. @item alpha
  10956. Set format of alpha of the overlaid video, it can be @var{straight} or
  10957. @var{premultiplied}. Default is @var{straight}.
  10958. @end table
  10959. The @option{x}, and @option{y} expressions can contain the following
  10960. parameters.
  10961. @table @option
  10962. @item main_w, W
  10963. @item main_h, H
  10964. The main input width and height.
  10965. @item overlay_w, w
  10966. @item overlay_h, h
  10967. The overlay input width and height.
  10968. @item x
  10969. @item y
  10970. The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
  10971. each new frame.
  10972. @item hsub
  10973. @item vsub
  10974. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values of the output
  10975. format. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and
  10976. @var{vsub} is 1.
  10977. @item n
  10978. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  10979. @item pos
  10980. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  10981. @item t
  10982. The timestamp, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  10983. @end table
  10984. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  10985. Note that the @var{n}, @var{pos}, @var{t} variables are available only
  10986. when evaluation is done @emph{per frame}, and will evaluate to NAN
  10987. when @option{eval} is set to @samp{init}.
  10988. Be aware that frames are taken from each input video in timestamp
  10989. order, hence, if their initial timestamps differ, it is a good idea
  10990. to pass the two inputs through a @var{setpts=PTS-STARTPTS} filter to
  10991. have them begin in the same zero timestamp, as the example for
  10992. the @var{movie} filter does.
  10993. You can chain together more overlays but you should test the
  10994. efficiency of such approach.
  10995. @subsection Commands
  10996. This filter supports the following commands:
  10997. @table @option
  10998. @item x
  10999. @item y
  11000. Modify the x and y of the overlay input.
  11001. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  11002. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  11003. value.
  11004. @end table
  11005. @subsection Examples
  11006. @itemize
  11007. @item
  11008. Draw the overlay at 10 pixels from the bottom right corner of the main
  11009. video:
  11010. @example
  11011. overlay=main_w-overlay_w-10:main_h-overlay_h-10
  11012. @end example
  11013. Using named options the example above becomes:
  11014. @example
  11015. overlay=x=main_w-overlay_w-10:y=main_h-overlay_h-10
  11016. @end example
  11017. @item
  11018. Insert a transparent PNG logo in the bottom left corner of the input,
  11019. using the @command{ffmpeg} tool with the @code{-filter_complex} option:
  11020. @example
  11021. ffmpeg -i input -i logo -filter_complex 'overlay=10:main_h-overlay_h-10' output
  11022. @end example
  11023. @item
  11024. Insert 2 different transparent PNG logos (second logo on bottom
  11025. right corner) using the @command{ffmpeg} tool:
  11026. @example
  11027. ffmpeg -i input -i logo1 -i logo2 -filter_complex 'overlay=x=10:y=H-h-10,overlay=x=W-w-10:y=H-h-10' output
  11028. @end example
  11029. @item
  11030. Add a transparent color layer on top of the main video; @code{WxH}
  11031. must specify the size of the main input to the overlay filter:
  11032. @example
  11033. color=color=red@@.3:size=WxH [over]; [in][over] overlay [out]
  11034. @end example
  11035. @item
  11036. Play an original video and a filtered version (here with the deshake
  11037. filter) side by side using the @command{ffplay} tool:
  11038. @example
  11039. ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[a][b]; [a]pad=iw*2:ih[src]; [b]deshake[filt]; [src][filt]overlay=w'
  11040. @end example
  11041. The above command is the same as:
  11042. @example
  11043. ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[b], pad=iw*2[src], [b]deshake, [src]overlay=w'
  11044. @end example
  11045. @item
  11046. Make a sliding overlay appearing from the left to the right top part of the
  11047. screen starting since time 2:
  11048. @example
  11049. overlay=x='if(gte(t,2), -w+(t-2)*20, NAN)':y=0
  11050. @end example
  11051. @item
  11052. Compose output by putting two input videos side to side:
  11053. @example
  11054. ffmpeg -i left.avi -i right.avi -filter_complex "
  11055. nullsrc=size=200x100 [background];
  11056. [0:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [left];
  11057. [1:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [right];
  11058. [background][left] overlay=shortest=1 [background+left];
  11059. [background+left][right] overlay=shortest=1:x=100 [left+right]
  11060. "
  11061. @end example
  11062. @item
  11063. Mask 10-20 seconds of a video by applying the delogo filter to a section
  11064. @example
  11065. ffmpeg -i test.avi -codec:v:0 wmv2 -ar 11025 -b:v 9000k
  11066. -vf '[in]split[split_main][split_delogo];[split_delogo]trim=start=360:end=371,delogo=0:0:640:480[delogoed];[split_main][delogoed]overlay=eof_action=pass[out]'
  11067. masked.avi
  11068. @end example
  11069. @item
  11070. Chain several overlays in cascade:
  11071. @example
  11072. nullsrc=s=200x200 [bg];
  11073. testsrc=s=100x100, split=4 [in0][in1][in2][in3];
  11074. [in0] lutrgb=r=0, [bg] overlay=0:0 [mid0];
  11075. [in1] lutrgb=g=0, [mid0] overlay=100:0 [mid1];
  11076. [in2] lutrgb=b=0, [mid1] overlay=0:100 [mid2];
  11077. [in3] null, [mid2] overlay=100:100 [out0]
  11078. @end example
  11079. @end itemize
  11080. @anchor{overlay_cuda}
  11081. @section overlay_cuda
  11082. Overlay one video on top of another.
  11083. This is the CUDA cariant of the @ref{overlay} filter.
  11084. It only accepts CUDA frames. The underlying input pixel formats have to match.
  11085. It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main"
  11086. video on which the second input is overlaid.
  11087. It accepts the following parameters:
  11088. @table @option
  11089. @item x
  11090. @item y
  11091. Set the x and y coordinates of the overlaid video on the main video.
  11092. Default value is "0" for both expressions.
  11093. @item eof_action
  11094. See @ref{framesync}.
  11095. @item shortest
  11096. See @ref{framesync}.
  11097. @item repeatlast
  11098. See @ref{framesync}.
  11099. @end table
  11100. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  11101. @section owdenoise
  11102. Apply Overcomplete Wavelet denoiser.
  11103. The filter accepts the following options:
  11104. @table @option
  11105. @item depth
  11106. Set depth.
  11107. Larger depth values will denoise lower frequency components more, but
  11108. slow down filtering.
  11109. Must be an int in the range 8-16, default is @code{8}.
  11110. @item luma_strength, ls
  11111. Set luma strength.
  11112. Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
  11113. @item chroma_strength, cs
  11114. Set chroma strength.
  11115. Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
  11116. @end table
  11117. @anchor{pad}
  11118. @section pad
  11119. Add paddings to the input image, and place the original input at the
  11120. provided @var{x}, @var{y} coordinates.
  11121. It accepts the following parameters:
  11122. @table @option
  11123. @item width, w
  11124. @item height, h
  11125. Specify an expression for the size of the output image with the
  11126. paddings added. If the value for @var{width} or @var{height} is 0, the
  11127. corresponding input size is used for the output.
  11128. The @var{width} expression can reference the value set by the
  11129. @var{height} expression, and vice versa.
  11130. The default value of @var{width} and @var{height} is 0.
  11131. @item x
  11132. @item y
  11133. Specify the offsets to place the input image at within the padded area,
  11134. with respect to the top/left border of the output image.
  11135. The @var{x} expression can reference the value set by the @var{y}
  11136. expression, and vice versa.
  11137. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is 0.
  11138. If @var{x} or @var{y} evaluate to a negative number, they'll be changed
  11139. so the input image is centered on the padded area.
  11140. @item color
  11141. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  11142. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  11143. manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11144. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  11145. @item eval
  11146. Specify when to evaluate @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x} and @var{y} expression.
  11147. It accepts the following values:
  11148. @table @samp
  11149. @item init
  11150. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when
  11151. a command is processed.
  11152. @item frame
  11153. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  11154. @end table
  11155. Default value is @samp{init}.
  11156. @item aspect
  11157. Pad to aspect instead to a resolution.
  11158. @end table
  11159. The value for the @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x}, and @var{y}
  11160. options are expressions containing the following constants:
  11161. @table @option
  11162. @item in_w
  11163. @item in_h
  11164. The input video width and height.
  11165. @item iw
  11166. @item ih
  11167. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  11168. @item out_w
  11169. @item out_h
  11170. The output width and height (the size of the padded area), as
  11171. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions.
  11172. @item ow
  11173. @item oh
  11174. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  11175. @item x
  11176. @item y
  11177. The x and y offsets as specified by the @var{x} and @var{y}
  11178. expressions, or NAN if not yet specified.
  11179. @item a
  11180. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  11181. @item sar
  11182. input sample aspect ratio
  11183. @item dar
  11184. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  11185. @item hsub
  11186. @item vsub
  11187. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  11188. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  11189. @end table
  11190. @subsection Examples
  11191. @itemize
  11192. @item
  11193. Add paddings with the color "violet" to the input video. The output video
  11194. size is 640x480, and the top-left corner of the input video is placed at
  11195. column 0, row 40
  11196. @example
  11197. pad=640:480:0:40:violet
  11198. @end example
  11199. The example above is equivalent to the following command:
  11200. @example
  11201. pad=width=640:height=480:x=0:y=40:color=violet
  11202. @end example
  11203. @item
  11204. Pad the input to get an output with dimensions increased by 3/2,
  11205. and put the input video at the center of the padded area:
  11206. @example
  11207. pad="3/2*iw:3/2*ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  11208. @end example
  11209. @item
  11210. Pad the input to get a squared output with size equal to the maximum
  11211. value between the input width and height, and put the input video at
  11212. the center of the padded area:
  11213. @example
  11214. pad="max(iw\,ih):ow:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  11215. @end example
  11216. @item
  11217. Pad the input to get a final w/h ratio of 16:9:
  11218. @example
  11219. pad="ih*16/9:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  11220. @end example
  11221. @item
  11222. In case of anamorphic video, in order to set the output display aspect
  11223. correctly, it is necessary to use @var{sar} in the expression,
  11224. according to the relation:
  11225. @example
  11226. (ih * X / ih) * sar = output_dar
  11227. X = output_dar / sar
  11228. @end example
  11229. Thus the previous example needs to be modified to:
  11230. @example
  11231. pad="ih*16/9/sar:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  11232. @end example
  11233. @item
  11234. Double the output size and put the input video in the bottom-right
  11235. corner of the output padded area:
  11236. @example
  11237. pad="2*iw:2*ih:ow-iw:oh-ih"
  11238. @end example
  11239. @end itemize
  11240. @anchor{palettegen}
  11241. @section palettegen
  11242. Generate one palette for a whole video stream.
  11243. It accepts the following options:
  11244. @table @option
  11245. @item max_colors
  11246. Set the maximum number of colors to quantize in the palette.
  11247. Note: the palette will still contain 256 colors; the unused palette entries
  11248. will be black.
  11249. @item reserve_transparent
  11250. Create a palette of 255 colors maximum and reserve the last one for
  11251. transparency. Reserving the transparency color is useful for GIF optimization.
  11252. If not set, the maximum of colors in the palette will be 256. You probably want
  11253. to disable this option for a standalone image.
  11254. Set by default.
  11255. @item transparency_color
  11256. Set the color that will be used as background for transparency.
  11257. @item stats_mode
  11258. Set statistics mode.
  11259. It accepts the following values:
  11260. @table @samp
  11261. @item full
  11262. Compute full frame histograms.
  11263. @item diff
  11264. Compute histograms only for the part that differs from previous frame. This
  11265. might be relevant to give more importance to the moving part of your input if
  11266. the background is static.
  11267. @item single
  11268. Compute new histogram for each frame.
  11269. @end table
  11270. Default value is @var{full}.
  11271. @end table
  11272. The filter also exports the frame metadata @code{lavfi.color_quant_ratio}
  11273. (@code{nb_color_in / nb_color_out}) which you can use to evaluate the degree of
  11274. color quantization of the palette. This information is also visible at
  11275. @var{info} logging level.
  11276. @subsection Examples
  11277. @itemize
  11278. @item
  11279. Generate a representative palette of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  11280. @example
  11281. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf palettegen palette.png
  11282. @end example
  11283. @end itemize
  11284. @section paletteuse
  11285. Use a palette to downsample an input video stream.
  11286. The filter takes two inputs: one video stream and a palette. The palette must
  11287. be a 256 pixels image.
  11288. It accepts the following options:
  11289. @table @option
  11290. @item dither
  11291. Select dithering mode. Available algorithms are:
  11292. @table @samp
  11293. @item bayer
  11294. Ordered 8x8 bayer dithering (deterministic)
  11295. @item heckbert
  11296. Dithering as defined by Paul Heckbert in 1982 (simple error diffusion).
  11297. Note: this dithering is sometimes considered "wrong" and is included as a
  11298. reference.
  11299. @item floyd_steinberg
  11300. Floyd and Steingberg dithering (error diffusion)
  11301. @item sierra2
  11302. Frankie Sierra dithering v2 (error diffusion)
  11303. @item sierra2_4a
  11304. Frankie Sierra dithering v2 "Lite" (error diffusion)
  11305. @end table
  11306. Default is @var{sierra2_4a}.
  11307. @item bayer_scale
  11308. When @var{bayer} dithering is selected, this option defines the scale of the
  11309. pattern (how much the crosshatch pattern is visible). A low value means more
  11310. visible pattern for less banding, and higher value means less visible pattern
  11311. at the cost of more banding.
  11312. The option must be an integer value in the range [0,5]. Default is @var{2}.
  11313. @item diff_mode
  11314. If set, define the zone to process
  11315. @table @samp
  11316. @item rectangle
  11317. Only the changing rectangle will be reprocessed. This is similar to GIF
  11318. cropping/offsetting compression mechanism. This option can be useful for speed
  11319. if only a part of the image is changing, and has use cases such as limiting the
  11320. scope of the error diffusal @option{dither} to the rectangle that bounds the
  11321. moving scene (it leads to more deterministic output if the scene doesn't change
  11322. much, and as a result less moving noise and better GIF compression).
  11323. @end table
  11324. Default is @var{none}.
  11325. @item new
  11326. Take new palette for each output frame.
  11327. @item alpha_threshold
  11328. Sets the alpha threshold for transparency. Alpha values above this threshold
  11329. will be treated as completely opaque, and values below this threshold will be
  11330. treated as completely transparent.
  11331. The option must be an integer value in the range [0,255]. Default is @var{128}.
  11332. @end table
  11333. @subsection Examples
  11334. @itemize
  11335. @item
  11336. Use a palette (generated for example with @ref{palettegen}) to encode a GIF
  11337. using @command{ffmpeg}:
  11338. @example
  11339. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -i palette.png -lavfi paletteuse output.gif
  11340. @end example
  11341. @end itemize
  11342. @section perspective
  11343. Correct perspective of video not recorded perpendicular to the screen.
  11344. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  11345. @table @option
  11346. @item x0
  11347. @item y0
  11348. @item x1
  11349. @item y1
  11350. @item x2
  11351. @item y2
  11352. @item x3
  11353. @item y3
  11354. Set coordinates expression for top left, top right, bottom left and bottom right corners.
  11355. Default values are @code{0:0:W:0:0:H:W:H} with which perspective will remain unchanged.
  11356. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{source}, then the specified points will be sent
  11357. to the corners of the destination. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{destination},
  11358. then the corners of the source will be sent to the specified coordinates.
  11359. The expressions can use the following variables:
  11360. @table @option
  11361. @item W
  11362. @item H
  11363. the width and height of video frame.
  11364. @item in
  11365. Input frame count.
  11366. @item on
  11367. Output frame count.
  11368. @end table
  11369. @item interpolation
  11370. Set interpolation for perspective correction.
  11371. It accepts the following values:
  11372. @table @samp
  11373. @item linear
  11374. @item cubic
  11375. @end table
  11376. Default value is @samp{linear}.
  11377. @item sense
  11378. Set interpretation of coordinate options.
  11379. It accepts the following values:
  11380. @table @samp
  11381. @item 0, source
  11382. Send point in the source specified by the given coordinates to
  11383. the corners of the destination.
  11384. @item 1, destination
  11385. Send the corners of the source to the point in the destination specified
  11386. by the given coordinates.
  11387. Default value is @samp{source}.
  11388. @end table
  11389. @item eval
  11390. Set when the expressions for coordinates @option{x0,y0,...x3,y3} are evaluated.
  11391. It accepts the following values:
  11392. @table @samp
  11393. @item init
  11394. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  11395. when a command is processed
  11396. @item frame
  11397. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  11398. @end table
  11399. Default value is @samp{init}.
  11400. @end table
  11401. @section phase
  11402. Delay interlaced video by one field time so that the field order changes.
  11403. The intended use is to fix PAL movies that have been captured with the
  11404. opposite field order to the film-to-video transfer.
  11405. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  11406. @table @option
  11407. @item mode
  11408. Set phase mode.
  11409. It accepts the following values:
  11410. @table @samp
  11411. @item t
  11412. Capture field order top-first, transfer bottom-first.
  11413. Filter will delay the bottom field.
  11414. @item b
  11415. Capture field order bottom-first, transfer top-first.
  11416. Filter will delay the top field.
  11417. @item p
  11418. Capture and transfer with the same field order. This mode only exists
  11419. for the documentation of the other options to refer to, but if you
  11420. actually select it, the filter will faithfully do nothing.
  11421. @item a
  11422. Capture field order determined automatically by field flags, transfer
  11423. opposite.
  11424. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} modes on a frame by frame
  11425. basis using field flags. If no field information is available,
  11426. then this works just like @samp{u}.
  11427. @item u
  11428. Capture unknown or varying, transfer opposite.
  11429. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} on a frame by frame basis by
  11430. analyzing the images and selecting the alternative that produces best
  11431. match between the fields.
  11432. @item T
  11433. Capture top-first, transfer unknown or varying.
  11434. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
  11435. @item B
  11436. Capture bottom-first, transfer unknown or varying.
  11437. Filter selects among @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
  11438. @item A
  11439. Capture determined by field flags, transfer unknown or varying.
  11440. Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using field flags and
  11441. image analysis. If no field information is available, then this works just
  11442. like @samp{U}. This is the default mode.
  11443. @item U
  11444. Both capture and transfer unknown or varying.
  11445. Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis only.
  11446. @end table
  11447. @end table
  11448. @section photosensitivity
  11449. Reduce various flashes in video, so to help users with epilepsy.
  11450. It accepts the following options:
  11451. @table @option
  11452. @item frames, f
  11453. Set how many frames to use when filtering. Default is 30.
  11454. @item threshold, t
  11455. Set detection threshold factor. Default is 1.
  11456. Lower is stricter.
  11457. @item skip
  11458. Set how many pixels to skip when sampling frames. Default is 1.
  11459. Allowed range is from 1 to 1024.
  11460. @item bypass
  11461. Leave frames unchanged. Default is disabled.
  11462. @end table
  11463. @section pixdesctest
  11464. Pixel format descriptor test filter, mainly useful for internal
  11465. testing. The output video should be equal to the input video.
  11466. For example:
  11467. @example
  11468. format=monow, pixdesctest
  11469. @end example
  11470. can be used to test the monowhite pixel format descriptor definition.
  11471. @section pixscope
  11472. Display sample values of color channels. Mainly useful for checking color
  11473. and levels. Minimum supported resolution is 640x480.
  11474. The filters accept the following options:
  11475. @table @option
  11476. @item x
  11477. Set scope X position, relative offset on X axis.
  11478. @item y
  11479. Set scope Y position, relative offset on Y axis.
  11480. @item w
  11481. Set scope width.
  11482. @item h
  11483. Set scope height.
  11484. @item o
  11485. Set window opacity. This window also holds statistics about pixel area.
  11486. @item wx
  11487. Set window X position, relative offset on X axis.
  11488. @item wy
  11489. Set window Y position, relative offset on Y axis.
  11490. @end table
  11491. @section pp
  11492. Enable the specified chain of postprocessing subfilters using libpostproc. This
  11493. library should be automatically selected with a GPL build (@code{--enable-gpl}).
  11494. Subfilters must be separated by '/' and can be disabled by prepending a '-'.
  11495. Each subfilter and some options have a short and a long name that can be used
  11496. interchangeably, i.e. dr/dering are the same.
  11497. The filters accept the following options:
  11498. @table @option
  11499. @item subfilters
  11500. Set postprocessing subfilters string.
  11501. @end table
  11502. All subfilters share common options to determine their scope:
  11503. @table @option
  11504. @item a/autoq
  11505. Honor the quality commands for this subfilter.
  11506. @item c/chrom
  11507. Do chrominance filtering, too (default).
  11508. @item y/nochrom
  11509. Do luminance filtering only (no chrominance).
  11510. @item n/noluma
  11511. Do chrominance filtering only (no luminance).
  11512. @end table
  11513. These options can be appended after the subfilter name, separated by a '|'.
  11514. Available subfilters are:
  11515. @table @option
  11516. @item hb/hdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11517. Horizontal deblocking filter
  11518. @table @option
  11519. @item difference
  11520. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11521. @item flatness
  11522. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11523. @end table
  11524. @item vb/vdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11525. Vertical deblocking filter
  11526. @table @option
  11527. @item difference
  11528. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11529. @item flatness
  11530. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11531. @end table
  11532. @item ha/hadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11533. Accurate horizontal deblocking filter
  11534. @table @option
  11535. @item difference
  11536. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11537. @item flatness
  11538. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11539. @end table
  11540. @item va/vadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11541. Accurate vertical deblocking filter
  11542. @table @option
  11543. @item difference
  11544. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11545. @item flatness
  11546. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11547. @end table
  11548. @end table
  11549. The horizontal and vertical deblocking filters share the difference and
  11550. flatness values so you cannot set different horizontal and vertical
  11551. thresholds.
  11552. @table @option
  11553. @item h1/x1hdeblock
  11554. Experimental horizontal deblocking filter
  11555. @item v1/x1vdeblock
  11556. Experimental vertical deblocking filter
  11557. @item dr/dering
  11558. Deringing filter
  11559. @item tn/tmpnoise[|threshold1[|threshold2[|threshold3]]], temporal noise reducer
  11560. @table @option
  11561. @item threshold1
  11562. larger -> stronger filtering
  11563. @item threshold2
  11564. larger -> stronger filtering
  11565. @item threshold3
  11566. larger -> stronger filtering
  11567. @end table
  11568. @item al/autolevels[:f/fullyrange], automatic brightness / contrast correction
  11569. @table @option
  11570. @item f/fullyrange
  11571. Stretch luminance to @code{0-255}.
  11572. @end table
  11573. @item lb/linblenddeint
  11574. Linear blend deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
  11575. filtering all lines with a @code{(1 2 1)} filter.
  11576. @item li/linipoldeint
  11577. Linear interpolating deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
  11578. linearly interpolating every second line.
  11579. @item ci/cubicipoldeint
  11580. Cubic interpolating deinterlacing filter deinterlaces the given block by
  11581. cubically interpolating every second line.
  11582. @item md/mediandeint
  11583. Median deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by applying a
  11584. median filter to every second line.
  11585. @item fd/ffmpegdeint
  11586. FFmpeg deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by filtering every
  11587. second line with a @code{(-1 4 2 4 -1)} filter.
  11588. @item l5/lowpass5
  11589. Vertically applied FIR lowpass deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given
  11590. block by filtering all lines with a @code{(-1 2 6 2 -1)} filter.
  11591. @item fq/forceQuant[|quantizer]
  11592. Overrides the quantizer table from the input with the constant quantizer you
  11593. specify.
  11594. @table @option
  11595. @item quantizer
  11596. Quantizer to use
  11597. @end table
  11598. @item de/default
  11599. Default pp filter combination (@code{hb|a,vb|a,dr|a})
  11600. @item fa/fast
  11601. Fast pp filter combination (@code{h1|a,v1|a,dr|a})
  11602. @item ac
  11603. High quality pp filter combination (@code{ha|a|128|7,va|a,dr|a})
  11604. @end table
  11605. @subsection Examples
  11606. @itemize
  11607. @item
  11608. Apply horizontal and vertical deblocking, deringing and automatic
  11609. brightness/contrast:
  11610. @example
  11611. pp=hb/vb/dr/al
  11612. @end example
  11613. @item
  11614. Apply default filters without brightness/contrast correction:
  11615. @example
  11616. pp=de/-al
  11617. @end example
  11618. @item
  11619. Apply default filters and temporal denoiser:
  11620. @example
  11621. pp=default/tmpnoise|1|2|3
  11622. @end example
  11623. @item
  11624. Apply deblocking on luminance only, and switch vertical deblocking on or off
  11625. automatically depending on available CPU time:
  11626. @example
  11627. pp=hb|y/vb|a
  11628. @end example
  11629. @end itemize
  11630. @section pp7
  11631. Apply Postprocessing filter 7. It is variant of the @ref{spp} filter,
  11632. similar to spp = 6 with 7 point DCT, where only the center sample is
  11633. used after IDCT.
  11634. The filter accepts the following options:
  11635. @table @option
  11636. @item qp
  11637. Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range
  11638. 0 to 63. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream
  11639. (if available).
  11640. @item mode
  11641. Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
  11642. @table @samp
  11643. @item hard
  11644. Set hard thresholding.
  11645. @item soft
  11646. Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
  11647. @item medium
  11648. Set medium thresholding (good results, default).
  11649. @end table
  11650. @end table
  11651. @section premultiply
  11652. Apply alpha premultiply effect to input video stream using first plane
  11653. of second stream as alpha.
  11654. Both streams must have same dimensions and same pixel format.
  11655. The filter accepts the following option:
  11656. @table @option
  11657. @item planes
  11658. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  11659. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  11660. @item inplace
  11661. Do not require 2nd input for processing, instead use alpha plane from input stream.
  11662. @end table
  11663. @section prewitt
  11664. Apply prewitt operator to input video stream.
  11665. The filter accepts the following option:
  11666. @table @option
  11667. @item planes
  11668. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  11669. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  11670. @item scale
  11671. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  11672. @item delta
  11673. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  11674. @end table
  11675. @section pseudocolor
  11676. Alter frame colors in video with pseudocolors.
  11677. This filter accepts the following options:
  11678. @table @option
  11679. @item c0
  11680. set pixel first component expression
  11681. @item c1
  11682. set pixel second component expression
  11683. @item c2
  11684. set pixel third component expression
  11685. @item c3
  11686. set pixel fourth component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  11687. @item i
  11688. set component to use as base for altering colors
  11689. @end table
  11690. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  11691. the corresponding pixel component values.
  11692. The expressions can contain the following constants and functions:
  11693. @table @option
  11694. @item w
  11695. @item h
  11696. The input width and height.
  11697. @item val
  11698. The input value for the pixel component.
  11699. @item ymin, umin, vmin, amin
  11700. The minimum allowed component value.
  11701. @item ymax, umax, vmax, amax
  11702. The maximum allowed component value.
  11703. @end table
  11704. All expressions default to "val".
  11705. @subsection Examples
  11706. @itemize
  11707. @item
  11708. Change too high luma values to gradient:
  11709. @example
  11710. pseudocolor="'if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(ymin,ymax,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(umax,umin,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(vmin,vmax,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):-1'"
  11711. @end example
  11712. @end itemize
  11713. @section psnr
  11714. Obtain the average, maximum and minimum PSNR (Peak Signal to Noise
  11715. Ratio) between two input videos.
  11716. This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
  11717. considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
  11718. output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
  11719. the PSNR.
  11720. Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
  11721. this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
  11722. have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
  11723. The obtained average PSNR is printed through the logging system.
  11724. The filter stores the accumulated MSE (mean squared error) of each
  11725. frame, and at the end of the processing it is averaged across all frames
  11726. equally, and the following formula is applied to obtain the PSNR:
  11727. @example
  11728. PSNR = 10*log10(MAX^2/MSE)
  11729. @end example
  11730. Where MAX is the average of the maximum values of each component of the
  11731. image.
  11732. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  11733. @table @option
  11734. @item stats_file, f
  11735. If specified the filter will use the named file to save the PSNR of
  11736. each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
  11737. standard output.
  11738. @item stats_version
  11739. Specifies which version of the stats file format to use. Details of
  11740. each format are written below.
  11741. Default value is 1.
  11742. @item stats_add_max
  11743. Determines whether the max value is output to the stats log.
  11744. Default value is 0.
  11745. Requires stats_version >= 2. If this is set and stats_version < 2,
  11746. the filter will return an error.
  11747. @end table
  11748. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  11749. The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
  11750. key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
  11751. couple of frames.
  11752. If a @var{stats_version} greater than 1 is specified, a header line precedes
  11753. the list of per-frame-pair stats, with key value pairs following the frame
  11754. format with the following parameters:
  11755. @table @option
  11756. @item psnr_log_version
  11757. The version of the log file format. Will match @var{stats_version}.
  11758. @item fields
  11759. A comma separated list of the per-frame-pair parameters included in
  11760. the log.
  11761. @end table
  11762. A description of each shown per-frame-pair parameter follows:
  11763. @table @option
  11764. @item n
  11765. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
  11766. @item mse_avg
  11767. Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
  11768. frames, averaged over all the image components.
  11769. @item mse_y, mse_u, mse_v, mse_r, mse_g, mse_b, mse_a
  11770. Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
  11771. frames for the component specified by the suffix.
  11772. @item psnr_y, psnr_u, psnr_v, psnr_r, psnr_g, psnr_b, psnr_a
  11773. Peak Signal to Noise ratio of the compared frames for the component
  11774. specified by the suffix.
  11775. @item max_avg, max_y, max_u, max_v
  11776. Maximum allowed value for each channel, and average over all
  11777. channels.
  11778. @end table
  11779. @subsection Examples
  11780. @itemize
  11781. @item
  11782. For example:
  11783. @example
  11784. movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  11785. [main][ref] psnr="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
  11786. @end example
  11787. On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
  11788. reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The PSNR of each individual frame
  11789. is stored in @file{stats.log}.
  11790. @item
  11791. Another example with different containers:
  11792. @example
  11793. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mkv -lavfi "[0:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[main];[1:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[ref];[main][ref]psnr" -f null -
  11794. @end example
  11795. @end itemize
  11796. @anchor{pullup}
  11797. @section pullup
  11798. Pulldown reversal (inverse telecine) filter, capable of handling mixed
  11799. hard-telecine, 24000/1001 fps progressive, and 30000/1001 fps progressive
  11800. content.
  11801. The pullup filter is designed to take advantage of future context in making
  11802. its decisions. This filter is stateless in the sense that it does not lock
  11803. onto a pattern to follow, but it instead looks forward to the following
  11804. fields in order to identify matches and rebuild progressive frames.
  11805. To produce content with an even framerate, insert the fps filter after
  11806. pullup, use @code{fps=24000/1001} if the input frame rate is 29.97fps,
  11807. @code{fps=24} for 30fps and the (rare) telecined 25fps input.
  11808. The filter accepts the following options:
  11809. @table @option
  11810. @item jl
  11811. @item jr
  11812. @item jt
  11813. @item jb
  11814. These options set the amount of "junk" to ignore at the left, right, top, and
  11815. bottom of the image, respectively. Left and right are in units of 8 pixels,
  11816. while top and bottom are in units of 2 lines.
  11817. The default is 8 pixels on each side.
  11818. @item sb
  11819. Set the strict breaks. Setting this option to 1 will reduce the chances of
  11820. filter generating an occasional mismatched frame, but it may also cause an
  11821. excessive number of frames to be dropped during high motion sequences.
  11822. Conversely, setting it to -1 will make filter match fields more easily.
  11823. This may help processing of video where there is slight blurring between
  11824. the fields, but may also cause there to be interlaced frames in the output.
  11825. Default value is @code{0}.
  11826. @item mp
  11827. Set the metric plane to use. It accepts the following values:
  11828. @table @samp
  11829. @item l
  11830. Use luma plane.
  11831. @item u
  11832. Use chroma blue plane.
  11833. @item v
  11834. Use chroma red plane.
  11835. @end table
  11836. This option may be set to use chroma plane instead of the default luma plane
  11837. for doing filter's computations. This may improve accuracy on very clean
  11838. source material, but more likely will decrease accuracy, especially if there
  11839. is chroma noise (rainbow effect) or any grayscale video.
  11840. The main purpose of setting @option{mp} to a chroma plane is to reduce CPU
  11841. load and make pullup usable in realtime on slow machines.
  11842. @end table
  11843. For best results (without duplicated frames in the output file) it is
  11844. necessary to change the output frame rate. For example, to inverse
  11845. telecine NTSC input:
  11846. @example
  11847. ffmpeg -i input -vf pullup -r 24000/1001 ...
  11848. @end example
  11849. @section qp
  11850. Change video quantization parameters (QP).
  11851. The filter accepts the following option:
  11852. @table @option
  11853. @item qp
  11854. Set expression for quantization parameter.
  11855. @end table
  11856. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain, among others,
  11857. the following constants:
  11858. @table @var
  11859. @item known
  11860. 1 if index is not 129, 0 otherwise.
  11861. @item qp
  11862. Sequential index starting from -129 to 128.
  11863. @end table
  11864. @subsection Examples
  11865. @itemize
  11866. @item
  11867. Some equation like:
  11868. @example
  11869. qp=2+2*sin(PI*qp)
  11870. @end example
  11871. @end itemize
  11872. @section random
  11873. Flush video frames from internal cache of frames into a random order.
  11874. No frame is discarded.
  11875. Inspired by @ref{frei0r} nervous filter.
  11876. @table @option
  11877. @item frames
  11878. Set size in number of frames of internal cache, in range from @code{2} to
  11879. @code{512}. Default is @code{30}.
  11880. @item seed
  11881. Set seed for random number generator, must be an integer included between
  11882. @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
  11883. less than @code{0}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a
  11884. best effort basis.
  11885. @end table
  11886. @section readeia608
  11887. Read closed captioning (EIA-608) information from the top lines of a video frame.
  11888. This filter adds frame metadata for @code{lavfi.readeia608.X.cc} and
  11889. @code{lavfi.readeia608.X.line}, where @code{X} is the number of the identified line
  11890. with EIA-608 data (starting from 0). A description of each metadata value follows:
  11891. @table @option
  11892. @item lavfi.readeia608.X.cc
  11893. The two bytes stored as EIA-608 data (printed in hexadecimal).
  11894. @item lavfi.readeia608.X.line
  11895. The number of the line on which the EIA-608 data was identified and read.
  11896. @end table
  11897. This filter accepts the following options:
  11898. @table @option
  11899. @item scan_min
  11900. Set the line to start scanning for EIA-608 data. Default is @code{0}.
  11901. @item scan_max
  11902. Set the line to end scanning for EIA-608 data. Default is @code{29}.
  11903. @item spw
  11904. Set the ratio of width reserved for sync code detection.
  11905. Default is @code{0.27}. Allowed range is @code{[0.1 - 0.7]}.
  11906. @item chp
  11907. Enable checking the parity bit. In the event of a parity error, the filter will output
  11908. @code{0x00} for that character. Default is false.
  11909. @item lp
  11910. Lowpass lines prior to further processing. Default is enabled.
  11911. @end table
  11912. @subsection Examples
  11913. @itemize
  11914. @item
  11915. Output a csv with presentation time and the first two lines of identified EIA-608 captioning data.
  11916. @example
  11917. ffprobe -f lavfi -i movie=captioned_video.mov,readeia608 -show_entries frame=pkt_pts_time:frame_tags=lavfi.readeia608.0.cc,lavfi.readeia608.1.cc -of csv
  11918. @end example
  11919. @end itemize
  11920. @section readvitc
  11921. Read vertical interval timecode (VITC) information from the top lines of a
  11922. video frame.
  11923. The filter adds frame metadata key @code{lavfi.readvitc.tc_str} with the
  11924. timecode value, if a valid timecode has been detected. Further metadata key
  11925. @code{lavfi.readvitc.found} is set to 0/1 depending on whether
  11926. timecode data has been found or not.
  11927. This filter accepts the following options:
  11928. @table @option
  11929. @item scan_max
  11930. Set the maximum number of lines to scan for VITC data. If the value is set to
  11931. @code{-1} the full video frame is scanned. Default is @code{45}.
  11932. @item thr_b
  11933. Set the luma threshold for black. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0],
  11934. default value is @code{0.2}. The value must be equal or less than @code{thr_w}.
  11935. @item thr_w
  11936. Set the luma threshold for white. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0],
  11937. default value is @code{0.6}. The value must be equal or greater than @code{thr_b}.
  11938. @end table
  11939. @subsection Examples
  11940. @itemize
  11941. @item
  11942. Detect and draw VITC data onto the video frame; if no valid VITC is detected,
  11943. draw @code{--:--:--:--} as a placeholder:
  11944. @example
  11945. ffmpeg -i input.avi -filter:v 'readvitc,drawtext=fontfile=FreeMono.ttf:text=%@{metadata\\:lavfi.readvitc.tc_str\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--@}:x=(w-tw)/2:y=400-ascent'
  11946. @end example
  11947. @end itemize
  11948. @section remap
  11949. Remap pixels using 2nd: Xmap and 3rd: Ymap input video stream.
  11950. Destination pixel at position (X, Y) will be picked from source (x, y) position
  11951. where x = Xmap(X, Y) and y = Ymap(X, Y). If mapping values are out of range, zero
  11952. value for pixel will be used for destination pixel.
  11953. Xmap and Ymap input video streams must be of same dimensions. Output video stream
  11954. will have Xmap/Ymap video stream dimensions.
  11955. Xmap and Ymap input video streams are 16bit depth, single channel.
  11956. @table @option
  11957. @item format
  11958. Specify pixel format of output from this filter. Can be @code{color} or @code{gray}.
  11959. Default is @code{color}.
  11960. @item fill
  11961. Specify the color of the unmapped pixels. For the syntax of this option,
  11962. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  11963. manual,ffmpeg-utils}. Default color is @code{black}.
  11964. @end table
  11965. @section removegrain
  11966. The removegrain filter is a spatial denoiser for progressive video.
  11967. @table @option
  11968. @item m0
  11969. Set mode for the first plane.
  11970. @item m1
  11971. Set mode for the second plane.
  11972. @item m2
  11973. Set mode for the third plane.
  11974. @item m3
  11975. Set mode for the fourth plane.
  11976. @end table
  11977. Range of mode is from 0 to 24. Description of each mode follows:
  11978. @table @var
  11979. @item 0
  11980. Leave input plane unchanged. Default.
  11981. @item 1
  11982. Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11983. @item 2
  11984. Clips the pixel with the second minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11985. @item 3
  11986. Clips the pixel with the third minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11987. @item 4
  11988. Clips the pixel with the fourth minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11989. This is equivalent to a median filter.
  11990. @item 5
  11991. Line-sensitive clipping giving the minimal change.
  11992. @item 6
  11993. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  11994. @item 7
  11995. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  11996. @item 8
  11997. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  11998. @item 9
  11999. Line-sensitive clipping on a line where the neighbours pixels are the closest.
  12000. @item 10
  12001. Replaces the target pixel with the closest neighbour.
  12002. @item 11
  12003. [1 2 1] horizontal and vertical kernel blur.
  12004. @item 12
  12005. Same as mode 11.
  12006. @item 13
  12007. Bob mode, interpolates top field from the line where the neighbours
  12008. pixels are the closest.
  12009. @item 14
  12010. Bob mode, interpolates bottom field from the line where the neighbours
  12011. pixels are the closest.
  12012. @item 15
  12013. Bob mode, interpolates top field. Same as 13 but with a more complicated
  12014. interpolation formula.
  12015. @item 16
  12016. Bob mode, interpolates bottom field. Same as 14 but with a more complicated
  12017. interpolation formula.
  12018. @item 17
  12019. Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of respectively the maximum and
  12020. minimum of each pair of opposite neighbour pixels.
  12021. @item 18
  12022. Line-sensitive clipping using opposite neighbours whose greatest distance from
  12023. the current pixel is minimal.
  12024. @item 19
  12025. Replaces the pixel with the average of its 8 neighbours.
  12026. @item 20
  12027. Averages the 9 pixels ([1 1 1] horizontal and vertical blur).
  12028. @item 21
  12029. Clips pixels using the averages of opposite neighbour.
  12030. @item 22
  12031. Same as mode 21 but simpler and faster.
  12032. @item 23
  12033. Small edge and halo removal, but reputed useless.
  12034. @item 24
  12035. Similar as 23.
  12036. @end table
  12037. @section removelogo
  12038. Suppress a TV station logo, using an image file to determine which
  12039. pixels comprise the logo. It works by filling in the pixels that
  12040. comprise the logo with neighboring pixels.
  12041. The filter accepts the following options:
  12042. @table @option
  12043. @item filename, f
  12044. Set the filter bitmap file, which can be any image format supported by
  12045. libavformat. The width and height of the image file must match those of the
  12046. video stream being processed.
  12047. @end table
  12048. Pixels in the provided bitmap image with a value of zero are not
  12049. considered part of the logo, non-zero pixels are considered part of
  12050. the logo. If you use white (255) for the logo and black (0) for the
  12051. rest, you will be safe. For making the filter bitmap, it is
  12052. recommended to take a screen capture of a black frame with the logo
  12053. visible, and then using a threshold filter followed by the erode
  12054. filter once or twice.
  12055. If needed, little splotches can be fixed manually. Remember that if
  12056. logo pixels are not covered, the filter quality will be much
  12057. reduced. Marking too many pixels as part of the logo does not hurt as
  12058. much, but it will increase the amount of blurring needed to cover over
  12059. the image and will destroy more information than necessary, and extra
  12060. pixels will slow things down on a large logo.
  12061. @section repeatfields
  12062. This filter uses the repeat_field flag from the Video ES headers and hard repeats
  12063. fields based on its value.
  12064. @section reverse
  12065. Reverse a video clip.
  12066. Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming
  12067. is suggested.
  12068. @subsection Examples
  12069. @itemize
  12070. @item
  12071. Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.
  12072. @example
  12073. trim=end=5,reverse
  12074. @end example
  12075. @end itemize
  12076. @section rgbashift
  12077. Shift R/G/B/A pixels horizontally and/or vertically.
  12078. The filter accepts the following options:
  12079. @table @option
  12080. @item rh
  12081. Set amount to shift red horizontally.
  12082. @item rv
  12083. Set amount to shift red vertically.
  12084. @item gh
  12085. Set amount to shift green horizontally.
  12086. @item gv
  12087. Set amount to shift green vertically.
  12088. @item bh
  12089. Set amount to shift blue horizontally.
  12090. @item bv
  12091. Set amount to shift blue vertically.
  12092. @item ah
  12093. Set amount to shift alpha horizontally.
  12094. @item av
  12095. Set amount to shift alpha vertically.
  12096. @item edge
  12097. Set edge mode, can be @var{smear}, default, or @var{warp}.
  12098. @end table
  12099. @subsection Commands
  12100. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  12101. @section roberts
  12102. Apply roberts cross operator to input video stream.
  12103. The filter accepts the following option:
  12104. @table @option
  12105. @item planes
  12106. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  12107. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  12108. @item scale
  12109. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  12110. @item delta
  12111. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  12112. @end table
  12113. @section rotate
  12114. Rotate video by an arbitrary angle expressed in radians.
  12115. The filter accepts the following options:
  12116. A description of the optional parameters follows.
  12117. @table @option
  12118. @item angle, a
  12119. Set an expression for the angle by which to rotate the input video
  12120. clockwise, expressed as a number of radians. A negative value will
  12121. result in a counter-clockwise rotation. By default it is set to "0".
  12122. This expression is evaluated for each frame.
  12123. @item out_w, ow
  12124. Set the output width expression, default value is "iw".
  12125. This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
  12126. @item out_h, oh
  12127. Set the output height expression, default value is "ih".
  12128. This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
  12129. @item bilinear
  12130. Enable bilinear interpolation if set to 1, a value of 0 disables
  12131. it. Default value is 1.
  12132. @item fillcolor, c
  12133. Set the color used to fill the output area not covered by the rotated
  12134. image. For the general syntax of this option, check the
  12135. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12136. If the special value "none" is selected then no
  12137. background is printed (useful for example if the background is never shown).
  12138. Default value is "black".
  12139. @end table
  12140. The expressions for the angle and the output size can contain the
  12141. following constants and functions:
  12142. @table @option
  12143. @item n
  12144. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0. It is always NAN
  12145. before the first frame is filtered.
  12146. @item t
  12147. time in seconds of the input frame, it is set to 0 when the filter is
  12148. configured. It is always NAN before the first frame is filtered.
  12149. @item hsub
  12150. @item vsub
  12151. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  12152. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12153. @item in_w, iw
  12154. @item in_h, ih
  12155. the input video width and height
  12156. @item out_w, ow
  12157. @item out_h, oh
  12158. the output width and height, that is the size of the padded area as
  12159. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions
  12160. @item rotw(a)
  12161. @item roth(a)
  12162. the minimal width/height required for completely containing the input
  12163. video rotated by @var{a} radians.
  12164. These are only available when computing the @option{out_w} and
  12165. @option{out_h} expressions.
  12166. @end table
  12167. @subsection Examples
  12168. @itemize
  12169. @item
  12170. Rotate the input by PI/6 radians clockwise:
  12171. @example
  12172. rotate=PI/6
  12173. @end example
  12174. @item
  12175. Rotate the input by PI/6 radians counter-clockwise:
  12176. @example
  12177. rotate=-PI/6
  12178. @end example
  12179. @item
  12180. Rotate the input by 45 degrees clockwise:
  12181. @example
  12182. rotate=45*PI/180
  12183. @end example
  12184. @item
  12185. Apply a constant rotation with period T, starting from an angle of PI/3:
  12186. @example
  12187. rotate=PI/3+2*PI*t/T
  12188. @end example
  12189. @item
  12190. Make the input video rotation oscillating with a period of T
  12191. seconds and an amplitude of A radians:
  12192. @example
  12193. rotate=A*sin(2*PI/T*t)
  12194. @end example
  12195. @item
  12196. Rotate the video, output size is chosen so that the whole rotating
  12197. input video is always completely contained in the output:
  12198. @example
  12199. rotate='2*PI*t:ow=hypot(iw,ih):oh=ow'
  12200. @end example
  12201. @item
  12202. Rotate the video, reduce the output size so that no background is ever
  12203. shown:
  12204. @example
  12205. rotate=2*PI*t:ow='min(iw,ih)/sqrt(2)':oh=ow:c=none
  12206. @end example
  12207. @end itemize
  12208. @subsection Commands
  12209. The filter supports the following commands:
  12210. @table @option
  12211. @item a, angle
  12212. Set the angle expression.
  12213. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  12214. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  12215. value.
  12216. @end table
  12217. @section sab
  12218. Apply Shape Adaptive Blur.
  12219. The filter accepts the following options:
  12220. @table @option
  12221. @item luma_radius, lr
  12222. Set luma blur filter strength, must be a value in range 0.1-4.0, default
  12223. value is 1.0. A greater value will result in a more blurred image, and
  12224. in slower processing.
  12225. @item luma_pre_filter_radius, lpfr
  12226. Set luma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the 0.1-2.0 range, default
  12227. value is 1.0.
  12228. @item luma_strength, ls
  12229. Set luma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered, must
  12230. be a value in the 0.1-100.0 range, default value is 1.0.
  12231. @item chroma_radius, cr
  12232. Set chroma blur filter strength, must be a value in range -0.9-4.0. A
  12233. greater value will result in a more blurred image, and in slower
  12234. processing.
  12235. @item chroma_pre_filter_radius, cpfr
  12236. Set chroma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the -0.9-2.0 range.
  12237. @item chroma_strength, cs
  12238. Set chroma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered,
  12239. must be a value in the -0.9-100.0 range.
  12240. @end table
  12241. Each chroma option value, if not explicitly specified, is set to the
  12242. corresponding luma option value.
  12243. @anchor{scale}
  12244. @section scale
  12245. Scale (resize) the input video, using the libswscale library.
  12246. The scale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
  12247. of the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
  12248. If the input image format is different from the format requested by
  12249. the next filter, the scale filter will convert the input to the
  12250. requested format.
  12251. @subsection Options
  12252. The filter accepts the following options, or any of the options
  12253. supported by the libswscale scaler.
  12254. See @ref{scaler_options,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for
  12255. the complete list of scaler options.
  12256. @table @option
  12257. @item width, w
  12258. @item height, h
  12259. Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
  12260. dimension.
  12261. If the @var{width} or @var{w} value is 0, the input width is used for
  12262. the output. If the @var{height} or @var{h} value is 0, the input height
  12263. is used for the output.
  12264. If one and only one of the values is -n with n >= 1, the scale filter
  12265. will use a value that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image,
  12266. calculated from the other specified dimension. After that it will,
  12267. however, make sure that the calculated dimension is divisible by n and
  12268. adjust the value if necessary.
  12269. If both values are -n with n >= 1, the behavior will be identical to
  12270. both values being set to 0 as previously detailed.
  12271. See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
  12272. expression.
  12273. @item eval
  12274. Specify when to evaluate @var{width} and @var{height} expression. It accepts the following values:
  12275. @table @samp
  12276. @item init
  12277. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when a command is processed.
  12278. @item frame
  12279. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  12280. @end table
  12281. Default value is @samp{init}.
  12282. @item interl
  12283. Set the interlacing mode. It accepts the following values:
  12284. @table @samp
  12285. @item 1
  12286. Force interlaced aware scaling.
  12287. @item 0
  12288. Do not apply interlaced scaling.
  12289. @item -1
  12290. Select interlaced aware scaling depending on whether the source frames
  12291. are flagged as interlaced or not.
  12292. @end table
  12293. Default value is @samp{0}.
  12294. @item flags
  12295. Set libswscale scaling flags. See
  12296. @ref{sws_flags,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
  12297. complete list of values. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
  12298. the default flags.
  12299. @item param0, param1
  12300. Set libswscale input parameters for scaling algorithms that need them. See
  12301. @ref{sws_params,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
  12302. complete documentation. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
  12303. empty parameters.
  12304. @item size, s
  12305. Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
  12306. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12307. @item in_color_matrix
  12308. @item out_color_matrix
  12309. Set in/output YCbCr color space type.
  12310. This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
  12311. a specific value used for the output and encoder.
  12312. If not specified, the color space type depends on the pixel format.
  12313. Possible values:
  12314. @table @samp
  12315. @item auto
  12316. Choose automatically.
  12317. @item bt709
  12318. Format conforming to International Telecommunication Union (ITU)
  12319. Recommendation BT.709.
  12320. @item fcc
  12321. Set color space conforming to the United States Federal Communications
  12322. Commission (FCC) Code of Federal Regulations (CFR) Title 47 (2003) 73.682 (a).
  12323. @item bt601
  12324. @item bt470
  12325. @item smpte170m
  12326. Set color space conforming to:
  12327. @itemize
  12328. @item
  12329. ITU Radiocommunication Sector (ITU-R) Recommendation BT.601
  12330. @item
  12331. ITU-R Rec. BT.470-6 (1998) Systems B, B1, and G
  12332. @item
  12333. Society of Motion Picture and Television Engineers (SMPTE) ST 170:2004
  12334. @end itemize
  12335. @item smpte240m
  12336. Set color space conforming to SMPTE ST 240:1999.
  12337. @item bt2020
  12338. Set color space conforming to ITU-R BT.2020 non-constant luminance system.
  12339. @end table
  12340. @item in_range
  12341. @item out_range
  12342. Set in/output YCbCr sample range.
  12343. This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
  12344. a specific value used for the output and encoder. If not specified, the
  12345. range depends on the pixel format. Possible values:
  12346. @table @samp
  12347. @item auto/unknown
  12348. Choose automatically.
  12349. @item jpeg/full/pc
  12350. Set full range (0-255 in case of 8-bit luma).
  12351. @item mpeg/limited/tv
  12352. Set "MPEG" range (16-235 in case of 8-bit luma).
  12353. @end table
  12354. @item force_original_aspect_ratio
  12355. Enable decreasing or increasing output video width or height if necessary to
  12356. keep the original aspect ratio. Possible values:
  12357. @table @samp
  12358. @item disable
  12359. Scale the video as specified and disable this feature.
  12360. @item decrease
  12361. The output video dimensions will automatically be decreased if needed.
  12362. @item increase
  12363. The output video dimensions will automatically be increased if needed.
  12364. @end table
  12365. One useful instance of this option is that when you know a specific device's
  12366. maximum allowed resolution, you can use this to limit the output video to
  12367. that, while retaining the aspect ratio. For example, device A allows
  12368. 1280x720 playback, and your video is 1920x800. Using this option (set it to
  12369. decrease) and specifying 1280x720 to the command line makes the output
  12370. 1280x533.
  12371. Please note that this is a different thing than specifying -1 for @option{w}
  12372. or @option{h}, you still need to specify the output resolution for this option
  12373. to work.
  12374. @item force_divisible_by
  12375. Ensures that both the output dimensions, width and height, are divisible by the
  12376. given integer when used together with @option{force_original_aspect_ratio}. This
  12377. works similar to using @code{-n} in the @option{w} and @option{h} options.
  12378. This option respects the value set for @option{force_original_aspect_ratio},
  12379. increasing or decreasing the resolution accordingly. The video's aspect ratio
  12380. may be slightly modified.
  12381. This option can be handy if you need to have a video fit within or exceed
  12382. a defined resolution using @option{force_original_aspect_ratio} but also have
  12383. encoder restrictions on width or height divisibility.
  12384. @end table
  12385. The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
  12386. containing the following constants:
  12387. @table @var
  12388. @item in_w
  12389. @item in_h
  12390. The input width and height
  12391. @item iw
  12392. @item ih
  12393. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  12394. @item out_w
  12395. @item out_h
  12396. The output (scaled) width and height
  12397. @item ow
  12398. @item oh
  12399. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
  12400. @item a
  12401. The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  12402. @item sar
  12403. input sample aspect ratio
  12404. @item dar
  12405. The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
  12406. @item hsub
  12407. @item vsub
  12408. horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
  12409. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12410. @item ohsub
  12411. @item ovsub
  12412. horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
  12413. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12414. @item n
  12415. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  12416. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12417. @item t
  12418. The presentation timestamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  12419. seconds. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12420. @item pos
  12421. The position (byte offset) of the frame in the input stream, or NaN if
  12422. this information is unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).
  12423. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12424. @end table
  12425. @subsection Examples
  12426. @itemize
  12427. @item
  12428. Scale the input video to a size of 200x100
  12429. @example
  12430. scale=w=200:h=100
  12431. @end example
  12432. This is equivalent to:
  12433. @example
  12434. scale=200:100
  12435. @end example
  12436. or:
  12437. @example
  12438. scale=200x100
  12439. @end example
  12440. @item
  12441. Specify a size abbreviation for the output size:
  12442. @example
  12443. scale=qcif
  12444. @end example
  12445. which can also be written as:
  12446. @example
  12447. scale=size=qcif
  12448. @end example
  12449. @item
  12450. Scale the input to 2x:
  12451. @example
  12452. scale=w=2*iw:h=2*ih
  12453. @end example
  12454. @item
  12455. The above is the same as:
  12456. @example
  12457. scale=2*in_w:2*in_h
  12458. @end example
  12459. @item
  12460. Scale the input to 2x with forced interlaced scaling:
  12461. @example
  12462. scale=2*iw:2*ih:interl=1
  12463. @end example
  12464. @item
  12465. Scale the input to half size:
  12466. @example
  12467. scale=w=iw/2:h=ih/2
  12468. @end example
  12469. @item
  12470. Increase the width, and set the height to the same size:
  12471. @example
  12472. scale=3/2*iw:ow
  12473. @end example
  12474. @item
  12475. Seek Greek harmony:
  12476. @example
  12477. scale=iw:1/PHI*iw
  12478. scale=ih*PHI:ih
  12479. @end example
  12480. @item
  12481. Increase the height, and set the width to 3/2 of the height:
  12482. @example
  12483. scale=w=3/2*oh:h=3/5*ih
  12484. @end example
  12485. @item
  12486. Increase the size, making the size a multiple of the chroma
  12487. subsample values:
  12488. @example
  12489. scale="trunc(3/2*iw/hsub)*hsub:trunc(3/2*ih/vsub)*vsub"
  12490. @end example
  12491. @item
  12492. Increase the width to a maximum of 500 pixels,
  12493. keeping the same aspect ratio as the input:
  12494. @example
  12495. scale=w='min(500\, iw*3/2):h=-1'
  12496. @end example
  12497. @item
  12498. Make pixels square by combining scale and setsar:
  12499. @example
  12500. scale='trunc(ih*dar):ih',setsar=1/1
  12501. @end example
  12502. @item
  12503. Make pixels square by combining scale and setsar,
  12504. making sure the resulting resolution is even (required by some codecs):
  12505. @example
  12506. scale='trunc(ih*dar/2)*2:trunc(ih/2)*2',setsar=1/1
  12507. @end example
  12508. @end itemize
  12509. @subsection Commands
  12510. This filter supports the following commands:
  12511. @table @option
  12512. @item width, w
  12513. @item height, h
  12514. Set the output video dimension expression.
  12515. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  12516. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  12517. value.
  12518. @end table
  12519. @section scale_npp
  12520. Use the NVIDIA Performance Primitives (libnpp) to perform scaling and/or pixel
  12521. format conversion on CUDA video frames. Setting the output width and height
  12522. works in the same way as for the @var{scale} filter.
  12523. The following additional options are accepted:
  12524. @table @option
  12525. @item format
  12526. The pixel format of the output CUDA frames. If set to the string "same" (the
  12527. default), the input format will be kept. Note that automatic format negotiation
  12528. and conversion is not yet supported for hardware frames
  12529. @item interp_algo
  12530. The interpolation algorithm used for resizing. One of the following:
  12531. @table @option
  12532. @item nn
  12533. Nearest neighbour.
  12534. @item linear
  12535. @item cubic
  12536. @item cubic2p_bspline
  12537. 2-parameter cubic (B=1, C=0)
  12538. @item cubic2p_catmullrom
  12539. 2-parameter cubic (B=0, C=1/2)
  12540. @item cubic2p_b05c03
  12541. 2-parameter cubic (B=1/2, C=3/10)
  12542. @item super
  12543. Supersampling
  12544. @item lanczos
  12545. @end table
  12546. @item force_original_aspect_ratio
  12547. Enable decreasing or increasing output video width or height if necessary to
  12548. keep the original aspect ratio. Possible values:
  12549. @table @samp
  12550. @item disable
  12551. Scale the video as specified and disable this feature.
  12552. @item decrease
  12553. The output video dimensions will automatically be decreased if needed.
  12554. @item increase
  12555. The output video dimensions will automatically be increased if needed.
  12556. @end table
  12557. One useful instance of this option is that when you know a specific device's
  12558. maximum allowed resolution, you can use this to limit the output video to
  12559. that, while retaining the aspect ratio. For example, device A allows
  12560. 1280x720 playback, and your video is 1920x800. Using this option (set it to
  12561. decrease) and specifying 1280x720 to the command line makes the output
  12562. 1280x533.
  12563. Please note that this is a different thing than specifying -1 for @option{w}
  12564. or @option{h}, you still need to specify the output resolution for this option
  12565. to work.
  12566. @item force_divisible_by
  12567. Ensures that both the output dimensions, width and height, are divisible by the
  12568. given integer when used together with @option{force_original_aspect_ratio}. This
  12569. works similar to using @code{-n} in the @option{w} and @option{h} options.
  12570. This option respects the value set for @option{force_original_aspect_ratio},
  12571. increasing or decreasing the resolution accordingly. The video's aspect ratio
  12572. may be slightly modified.
  12573. This option can be handy if you need to have a video fit within or exceed
  12574. a defined resolution using @option{force_original_aspect_ratio} but also have
  12575. encoder restrictions on width or height divisibility.
  12576. @end table
  12577. @section scale2ref
  12578. Scale (resize) the input video, based on a reference video.
  12579. See the scale filter for available options, scale2ref supports the same but
  12580. uses the reference video instead of the main input as basis. scale2ref also
  12581. supports the following additional constants for the @option{w} and
  12582. @option{h} options:
  12583. @table @var
  12584. @item main_w
  12585. @item main_h
  12586. The main input video's width and height
  12587. @item main_a
  12588. The same as @var{main_w} / @var{main_h}
  12589. @item main_sar
  12590. The main input video's sample aspect ratio
  12591. @item main_dar, mdar
  12592. The main input video's display aspect ratio. Calculated from
  12593. @code{(main_w / main_h) * main_sar}.
  12594. @item main_hsub
  12595. @item main_vsub
  12596. The main input video's horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values.
  12597. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub}
  12598. is 1.
  12599. @item main_n
  12600. The (sequential) number of the main input frame, starting from 0.
  12601. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12602. @item main_t
  12603. The presentation timestamp of the main input frame, expressed as a number of
  12604. seconds. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12605. @item main_pos
  12606. The position (byte offset) of the frame in the main input stream, or NaN if
  12607. this information is unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).
  12608. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12609. @end table
  12610. @subsection Examples
  12611. @itemize
  12612. @item
  12613. Scale a subtitle stream (b) to match the main video (a) in size before overlaying
  12614. @example
  12615. 'scale2ref[b][a];[a][b]overlay'
  12616. @end example
  12617. @item
  12618. Scale a logo to 1/10th the height of a video, while preserving its display aspect ratio.
  12619. @example
  12620. [logo-in][video-in]scale2ref=w=oh*mdar:h=ih/10[logo-out][video-out]
  12621. @end example
  12622. @end itemize
  12623. @subsection Commands
  12624. This filter supports the following commands:
  12625. @table @option
  12626. @item width, w
  12627. @item height, h
  12628. Set the output video dimension expression.
  12629. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  12630. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  12631. value.
  12632. @end table
  12633. @section scroll
  12634. Scroll input video horizontally and/or vertically by constant speed.
  12635. The filter accepts the following options:
  12636. @table @option
  12637. @item horizontal, h
  12638. Set the horizontal scrolling speed. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  12639. Negative values changes scrolling direction.
  12640. @item vertical, v
  12641. Set the vertical scrolling speed. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  12642. Negative values changes scrolling direction.
  12643. @item hpos
  12644. Set the initial horizontal scrolling position. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  12645. @item vpos
  12646. Set the initial vertical scrolling position. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  12647. @end table
  12648. @subsection Commands
  12649. This filter supports the following @ref{commands}:
  12650. @table @option
  12651. @item horizontal, h
  12652. Set the horizontal scrolling speed.
  12653. @item vertical, v
  12654. Set the vertical scrolling speed.
  12655. @end table
  12656. @anchor{scdet}
  12657. @section scdet
  12658. Detect video scene change.
  12659. This filter sets frame metadata with mafd between frame, the scene score, and
  12660. forward the frame to the next filter, so they can use these metadata to detect
  12661. scene change or others.
  12662. In addition, this filter logs a message and sets frame metadata when it detects
  12663. a scene change by @option{threshold}.
  12664. @code{lavfi.scd.mafd} metadata keys are set with mafd for every frame.
  12665. @code{lavfi.scd.score} metadata keys are set with scene change score for every frame
  12666. to detect scene change.
  12667. @code{lavfi.scd.time} metadata keys are set with current filtered frame time which
  12668. detect scene change with @option{threshold}.
  12669. The filter accepts the following options:
  12670. @table @option
  12671. @item threshold, t
  12672. Set the scene change detection threshold as a percentage of maximum change. Good
  12673. values are in the @code{[8.0, 14.0]} range. The range for @option{threshold} is
  12674. @code{[0., 100.]}.
  12675. Default value is @code{10.}.
  12676. @item sc_pass, s
  12677. Set the flag to pass scene change frames to the next filter. Default value is @code{0}
  12678. You can enable it if you want to get snapshot of scene change frames only.
  12679. @end table
  12680. @anchor{selectivecolor}
  12681. @section selectivecolor
  12682. Adjust cyan, magenta, yellow and black (CMYK) to certain ranges of colors (such
  12683. as "reds", "yellows", "greens", "cyans", ...). The adjustment range is defined
  12684. by the "purity" of the color (that is, how saturated it already is).
  12685. This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop Selective Color tool.
  12686. The filter accepts the following options:
  12687. @table @option
  12688. @item correction_method
  12689. Select color correction method.
  12690. Available values are:
  12691. @table @samp
  12692. @item absolute
  12693. Specified adjustments are applied "as-is" (added/subtracted to original pixel
  12694. component value).
  12695. @item relative
  12696. Specified adjustments are relative to the original component value.
  12697. @end table
  12698. Default is @code{absolute}.
  12699. @item reds
  12700. Adjustments for red pixels (pixels where the red component is the maximum)
  12701. @item yellows
  12702. Adjustments for yellow pixels (pixels where the blue component is the minimum)
  12703. @item greens
  12704. Adjustments for green pixels (pixels where the green component is the maximum)
  12705. @item cyans
  12706. Adjustments for cyan pixels (pixels where the red component is the minimum)
  12707. @item blues
  12708. Adjustments for blue pixels (pixels where the blue component is the maximum)
  12709. @item magentas
  12710. Adjustments for magenta pixels (pixels where the green component is the minimum)
  12711. @item whites
  12712. Adjustments for white pixels (pixels where all components are greater than 128)
  12713. @item neutrals
  12714. Adjustments for all pixels except pure black and pure white
  12715. @item blacks
  12716. Adjustments for black pixels (pixels where all components are lesser than 128)
  12717. @item psfile
  12718. Specify a Photoshop selective color file (@code{.asv}) to import the settings from.
  12719. @end table
  12720. All the adjustment settings (@option{reds}, @option{yellows}, ...) accept up to
  12721. 4 space separated floating point adjustment values in the [-1,1] range,
  12722. respectively to adjust the amount of cyan, magenta, yellow and black for the
  12723. pixels of its range.
  12724. @subsection Examples
  12725. @itemize
  12726. @item
  12727. Increase cyan by 50% and reduce yellow by 33% in every green areas, and
  12728. increase magenta by 27% in blue areas:
  12729. @example
  12730. selectivecolor=greens=.5 0 -.33 0:blues=0 .27
  12731. @end example
  12732. @item
  12733. Use a Photoshop selective color preset:
  12734. @example
  12735. selectivecolor=psfile=MySelectiveColorPresets/Misty.asv
  12736. @end example
  12737. @end itemize
  12738. @anchor{separatefields}
  12739. @section separatefields
  12740. The @code{separatefields} takes a frame-based video input and splits
  12741. each frame into its components fields, producing a new half height clip
  12742. with twice the frame rate and twice the frame count.
  12743. This filter use field-dominance information in frame to decide which
  12744. of each pair of fields to place first in the output.
  12745. If it gets it wrong use @ref{setfield} filter before @code{separatefields} filter.
  12746. @section setdar, setsar
  12747. The @code{setdar} filter sets the Display Aspect Ratio for the filter
  12748. output video.
  12749. This is done by changing the specified Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect
  12750. Ratio, according to the following equation:
  12751. @example
  12752. @var{DAR} = @var{HORIZONTAL_RESOLUTION} / @var{VERTICAL_RESOLUTION} * @var{SAR}
  12753. @end example
  12754. Keep in mind that the @code{setdar} filter does not modify the pixel
  12755. dimensions of the video frame. Also, the display aspect ratio set by
  12756. this filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain,
  12757. e.g. in case of scaling or if another "setdar" or a "setsar" filter is
  12758. applied.
  12759. The @code{setsar} filter sets the Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect Ratio for
  12760. the filter output video.
  12761. Note that as a consequence of the application of this filter, the
  12762. output display aspect ratio will change according to the equation
  12763. above.
  12764. Keep in mind that the sample aspect ratio set by the @code{setsar}
  12765. filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain, e.g. if
  12766. another "setsar" or a "setdar" filter is applied.
  12767. It accepts the following parameters:
  12768. @table @option
  12769. @item r, ratio, dar (@code{setdar} only), sar (@code{setsar} only)
  12770. Set the aspect ratio used by the filter.
  12771. The parameter can be a floating point number string, an expression, or
  12772. a string of the form @var{num}:@var{den}, where @var{num} and
  12773. @var{den} are the numerator and denominator of the aspect ratio. If
  12774. the parameter is not specified, it is assumed the value "0".
  12775. In case the form "@var{num}:@var{den}" is used, the @code{:} character
  12776. should be escaped.
  12777. @item max
  12778. Set the maximum integer value to use for expressing numerator and
  12779. denominator when reducing the expressed aspect ratio to a rational.
  12780. Default value is @code{100}.
  12781. @end table
  12782. The parameter @var{sar} is an expression containing
  12783. the following constants:
  12784. @table @option
  12785. @item E, PI, PHI
  12786. These are approximated values for the mathematical constants e
  12787. (Euler's number), pi (Greek pi), and phi (the golden ratio).
  12788. @item w, h
  12789. The input width and height.
  12790. @item a
  12791. These are the same as @var{w} / @var{h}.
  12792. @item sar
  12793. The input sample aspect ratio.
  12794. @item dar
  12795. The input display aspect ratio. It is the same as
  12796. (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  12797. @item hsub, vsub
  12798. Horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  12799. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12800. @end table
  12801. @subsection Examples
  12802. @itemize
  12803. @item
  12804. To change the display aspect ratio to 16:9, specify one of the following:
  12805. @example
  12806. setdar=dar=1.77777
  12807. setdar=dar=16/9
  12808. @end example
  12809. @item
  12810. To change the sample aspect ratio to 10:11, specify:
  12811. @example
  12812. setsar=sar=10/11
  12813. @end example
  12814. @item
  12815. To set a display aspect ratio of 16:9, and specify a maximum integer value of
  12816. 1000 in the aspect ratio reduction, use the command:
  12817. @example
  12818. setdar=ratio=16/9:max=1000
  12819. @end example
  12820. @end itemize
  12821. @anchor{setfield}
  12822. @section setfield
  12823. Force field for the output video frame.
  12824. The @code{setfield} filter marks the interlace type field for the
  12825. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  12826. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  12827. following filters (e.g. @code{fieldorder} or @code{yadif}).
  12828. The filter accepts the following options:
  12829. @table @option
  12830. @item mode
  12831. Available values are:
  12832. @table @samp
  12833. @item auto
  12834. Keep the same field property.
  12835. @item bff
  12836. Mark the frame as bottom-field-first.
  12837. @item tff
  12838. Mark the frame as top-field-first.
  12839. @item prog
  12840. Mark the frame as progressive.
  12841. @end table
  12842. @end table
  12843. @anchor{setparams}
  12844. @section setparams
  12845. Force frame parameter for the output video frame.
  12846. The @code{setparams} filter marks interlace and color range for the
  12847. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  12848. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  12849. filters/encoders.
  12850. @table @option
  12851. @item field_mode
  12852. Available values are:
  12853. @table @samp
  12854. @item auto
  12855. Keep the same field property (default).
  12856. @item bff
  12857. Mark the frame as bottom-field-first.
  12858. @item tff
  12859. Mark the frame as top-field-first.
  12860. @item prog
  12861. Mark the frame as progressive.
  12862. @end table
  12863. @item range
  12864. Available values are:
  12865. @table @samp
  12866. @item auto
  12867. Keep the same color range property (default).
  12868. @item unspecified, unknown
  12869. Mark the frame as unspecified color range.
  12870. @item limited, tv, mpeg
  12871. Mark the frame as limited range.
  12872. @item full, pc, jpeg
  12873. Mark the frame as full range.
  12874. @end table
  12875. @item color_primaries
  12876. Set the color primaries.
  12877. Available values are:
  12878. @table @samp
  12879. @item auto
  12880. Keep the same color primaries property (default).
  12881. @item bt709
  12882. @item unknown
  12883. @item bt470m
  12884. @item bt470bg
  12885. @item smpte170m
  12886. @item smpte240m
  12887. @item film
  12888. @item bt2020
  12889. @item smpte428
  12890. @item smpte431
  12891. @item smpte432
  12892. @item jedec-p22
  12893. @end table
  12894. @item color_trc
  12895. Set the color transfer.
  12896. Available values are:
  12897. @table @samp
  12898. @item auto
  12899. Keep the same color trc property (default).
  12900. @item bt709
  12901. @item unknown
  12902. @item bt470m
  12903. @item bt470bg
  12904. @item smpte170m
  12905. @item smpte240m
  12906. @item linear
  12907. @item log100
  12908. @item log316
  12909. @item iec61966-2-4
  12910. @item bt1361e
  12911. @item iec61966-2-1
  12912. @item bt2020-10
  12913. @item bt2020-12
  12914. @item smpte2084
  12915. @item smpte428
  12916. @item arib-std-b67
  12917. @end table
  12918. @item colorspace
  12919. Set the colorspace.
  12920. Available values are:
  12921. @table @samp
  12922. @item auto
  12923. Keep the same colorspace property (default).
  12924. @item gbr
  12925. @item bt709
  12926. @item unknown
  12927. @item fcc
  12928. @item bt470bg
  12929. @item smpte170m
  12930. @item smpte240m
  12931. @item ycgco
  12932. @item bt2020nc
  12933. @item bt2020c
  12934. @item smpte2085
  12935. @item chroma-derived-nc
  12936. @item chroma-derived-c
  12937. @item ictcp
  12938. @end table
  12939. @end table
  12940. @section showinfo
  12941. Show a line containing various information for each input video frame.
  12942. The input video is not modified.
  12943. This filter supports the following options:
  12944. @table @option
  12945. @item checksum
  12946. Calculate checksums of each plane. By default enabled.
  12947. @end table
  12948. The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
  12949. @var{key}:@var{value}.
  12950. The following values are shown in the output:
  12951. @table @option
  12952. @item n
  12953. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  12954. @item pts
  12955. The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  12956. time base units. The time base unit depends on the filter input pad.
  12957. @item pts_time
  12958. The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  12959. seconds.
  12960. @item pos
  12961. The position of the frame in the input stream, or -1 if this information is
  12962. unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).
  12963. @item fmt
  12964. The pixel format name.
  12965. @item sar
  12966. The sample aspect ratio of the input frame, expressed in the form
  12967. @var{num}/@var{den}.
  12968. @item s
  12969. The size of the input frame. For the syntax of this option, check the
  12970. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12971. @item i
  12972. The type of interlaced mode ("P" for "progressive", "T" for top field first, "B"
  12973. for bottom field first).
  12974. @item iskey
  12975. This is 1 if the frame is a key frame, 0 otherwise.
  12976. @item type
  12977. The picture type of the input frame ("I" for an I-frame, "P" for a
  12978. P-frame, "B" for a B-frame, or "?" for an unknown type).
  12979. Also refer to the documentation of the @code{AVPictureType} enum and of
  12980. the @code{av_get_picture_type_char} function defined in
  12981. @file{libavutil/avutil.h}.
  12982. @item checksum
  12983. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of all the planes of the input frame.
  12984. @item plane_checksum
  12985. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of each plane of the input frame,
  12986. expressed in the form "[@var{c0} @var{c1} @var{c2} @var{c3}]".
  12987. @item mean
  12988. The mean value of pixels in each plane of the input frame, expressed in the form
  12989. "[@var{mean0} @var{mean1} @var{mean2} @var{mean3}]".
  12990. @item stdev
  12991. The standard deviation of pixel values in each plane of the input frame, expressed
  12992. in the form "[@var{stdev0} @var{stdev1} @var{stdev2} @var{stdev3}]".
  12993. @end table
  12994. @section showpalette
  12995. Displays the 256 colors palette of each frame. This filter is only relevant for
  12996. @var{pal8} pixel format frames.
  12997. It accepts the following option:
  12998. @table @option
  12999. @item s
  13000. Set the size of the box used to represent one palette color entry. Default is
  13001. @code{30} (for a @code{30x30} pixel box).
  13002. @end table
  13003. @section shuffleframes
  13004. Reorder and/or duplicate and/or drop video frames.
  13005. It accepts the following parameters:
  13006. @table @option
  13007. @item mapping
  13008. Set the destination indexes of input frames.
  13009. This is space or '|' separated list of indexes that maps input frames to output
  13010. frames. Number of indexes also sets maximal value that each index may have.
  13011. '-1' index have special meaning and that is to drop frame.
  13012. @end table
  13013. The first frame has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
  13014. @subsection Examples
  13015. @itemize
  13016. @item
  13017. Swap second and third frame of every three frames of the input:
  13018. @example
  13019. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=0 2 1" OUTPUT
  13020. @end example
  13021. @item
  13022. Swap 10th and 1st frame of every ten frames of the input:
  13023. @example
  13024. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=9 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 0" OUTPUT
  13025. @end example
  13026. @end itemize
  13027. @section shuffleplanes
  13028. Reorder and/or duplicate video planes.
  13029. It accepts the following parameters:
  13030. @table @option
  13031. @item map0
  13032. The index of the input plane to be used as the first output plane.
  13033. @item map1
  13034. The index of the input plane to be used as the second output plane.
  13035. @item map2
  13036. The index of the input plane to be used as the third output plane.
  13037. @item map3
  13038. The index of the input plane to be used as the fourth output plane.
  13039. @end table
  13040. The first plane has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
  13041. @subsection Examples
  13042. @itemize
  13043. @item
  13044. Swap the second and third planes of the input:
  13045. @example
  13046. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf shuffleplanes=0:2:1:3 OUTPUT
  13047. @end example
  13048. @end itemize
  13049. @anchor{signalstats}
  13050. @section signalstats
  13051. Evaluate various visual metrics that assist in determining issues associated
  13052. with the digitization of analog video media.
  13053. By default the filter will log these metadata values:
  13054. @table @option
  13055. @item YMIN
  13056. Display the minimal Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  13057. range of [0-255].
  13058. @item YLOW
  13059. Display the Y value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  13060. range of [0-255].
  13061. @item YAVG
  13062. Display the average Y value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  13063. [0-255].
  13064. @item YHIGH
  13065. Display the Y value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  13066. range of [0-255].
  13067. @item YMAX
  13068. Display the maximum Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  13069. range of [0-255].
  13070. @item UMIN
  13071. Display the minimal U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  13072. range of [0-255].
  13073. @item ULOW
  13074. Display the U value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  13075. range of [0-255].
  13076. @item UAVG
  13077. Display the average U value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  13078. [0-255].
  13079. @item UHIGH
  13080. Display the U value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  13081. range of [0-255].
  13082. @item UMAX
  13083. Display the maximum U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  13084. range of [0-255].
  13085. @item VMIN
  13086. Display the minimal V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  13087. range of [0-255].
  13088. @item VLOW
  13089. Display the V value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  13090. range of [0-255].
  13091. @item VAVG
  13092. Display the average V value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  13093. [0-255].
  13094. @item VHIGH
  13095. Display the V value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  13096. range of [0-255].
  13097. @item VMAX
  13098. Display the maximum V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  13099. range of [0-255].
  13100. @item SATMIN
  13101. Display the minimal saturation value contained within the input frame.
  13102. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  13103. @item SATLOW
  13104. Display the saturation value at the 10% percentile within the input frame.
  13105. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  13106. @item SATAVG
  13107. Display the average saturation value within the input frame. Expressed in range
  13108. of [0-~181.02].
  13109. @item SATHIGH
  13110. Display the saturation value at the 90% percentile within the input frame.
  13111. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  13112. @item SATMAX
  13113. Display the maximum saturation value contained within the input frame.
  13114. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  13115. @item HUEMED
  13116. Display the median value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  13117. [0-360].
  13118. @item HUEAVG
  13119. Display the average value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  13120. [0-360].
  13121. @item YDIF
  13122. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the Y
  13123. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  13124. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  13125. @item UDIF
  13126. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the U
  13127. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  13128. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  13129. @item VDIF
  13130. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the V
  13131. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  13132. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  13133. @item YBITDEPTH
  13134. Display bit depth of Y plane in current frame.
  13135. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  13136. @item UBITDEPTH
  13137. Display bit depth of U plane in current frame.
  13138. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  13139. @item VBITDEPTH
  13140. Display bit depth of V plane in current frame.
  13141. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  13142. @end table
  13143. The filter accepts the following options:
  13144. @table @option
  13145. @item stat
  13146. @item out
  13147. @option{stat} specify an additional form of image analysis.
  13148. @option{out} output video with the specified type of pixel highlighted.
  13149. Both options accept the following values:
  13150. @table @samp
  13151. @item tout
  13152. Identify @var{temporal outliers} pixels. A @var{temporal outlier} is a pixel
  13153. unlike the neighboring pixels of the same field. Examples of temporal outliers
  13154. include the results of video dropouts, head clogs, or tape tracking issues.
  13155. @item vrep
  13156. Identify @var{vertical line repetition}. Vertical line repetition includes
  13157. similar rows of pixels within a frame. In born-digital video vertical line
  13158. repetition is common, but this pattern is uncommon in video digitized from an
  13159. analog source. When it occurs in video that results from the digitization of an
  13160. analog source it can indicate concealment from a dropout compensator.
  13161. @item brng
  13162. Identify pixels that fall outside of legal broadcast range.
  13163. @end table
  13164. @item color, c
  13165. Set the highlight color for the @option{out} option. The default color is
  13166. yellow.
  13167. @end table
  13168. @subsection Examples
  13169. @itemize
  13170. @item
  13171. Output data of various video metrics:
  13172. @example
  13173. ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats="stat=tout+vrep+brng" -show_frames
  13174. @end example
  13175. @item
  13176. Output specific data about the minimum and maximum values of the Y plane per frame:
  13177. @example
  13178. ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats -show_entries frame_tags=lavfi.signalstats.YMAX,lavfi.signalstats.YMIN
  13179. @end example
  13180. @item
  13181. Playback video while highlighting pixels that are outside of broadcast range in red.
  13182. @example
  13183. ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats="out=brng:color=red"
  13184. @end example
  13185. @item
  13186. Playback video with signalstats metadata drawn over the frame.
  13187. @example
  13188. ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats=stat=brng+vrep+tout,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=signalstat_drawtext.txt
  13189. @end example
  13190. The contents of signalstat_drawtext.txt used in the command are:
  13191. @example
  13192. time %@{pts:hms@}
  13193. Y (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMAX@})
  13194. U (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMAX@})
  13195. V (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMAX@})
  13196. saturation maximum: %@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.SATMAX@}
  13197. @end example
  13198. @end itemize
  13199. @anchor{signature}
  13200. @section signature
  13201. Calculates the MPEG-7 Video Signature. The filter can handle more than one
  13202. input. In this case the matching between the inputs can be calculated additionally.
  13203. The filter always passes through the first input. The signature of each stream can
  13204. be written into a file.
  13205. It accepts the following options:
  13206. @table @option
  13207. @item detectmode
  13208. Enable or disable the matching process.
  13209. Available values are:
  13210. @table @samp
  13211. @item off
  13212. Disable the calculation of a matching (default).
  13213. @item full
  13214. Calculate the matching for the whole video and output whether the whole video
  13215. matches or only parts.
  13216. @item fast
  13217. Calculate only until a matching is found or the video ends. Should be faster in
  13218. some cases.
  13219. @end table
  13220. @item nb_inputs
  13221. Set the number of inputs. The option value must be a non negative integer.
  13222. Default value is 1.
  13223. @item filename
  13224. Set the path to which the output is written. If there is more than one input,
  13225. the path must be a prototype, i.e. must contain %d or %0nd (where n is a positive
  13226. integer), that will be replaced with the input number. If no filename is
  13227. specified, no output will be written. This is the default.
  13228. @item format
  13229. Choose the output format.
  13230. Available values are:
  13231. @table @samp
  13232. @item binary
  13233. Use the specified binary representation (default).
  13234. @item xml
  13235. Use the specified xml representation.
  13236. @end table
  13237. @item th_d
  13238. Set threshold to detect one word as similar. The option value must be an integer
  13239. greater than zero. The default value is 9000.
  13240. @item th_dc
  13241. Set threshold to detect all words as similar. The option value must be an integer
  13242. greater than zero. The default value is 60000.
  13243. @item th_xh
  13244. Set threshold to detect frames as similar. The option value must be an integer
  13245. greater than zero. The default value is 116.
  13246. @item th_di
  13247. Set the minimum length of a sequence in frames to recognize it as matching
  13248. sequence. The option value must be a non negative integer value.
  13249. The default value is 0.
  13250. @item th_it
  13251. Set the minimum relation, that matching frames to all frames must have.
  13252. The option value must be a double value between 0 and 1. The default value is 0.5.
  13253. @end table
  13254. @subsection Examples
  13255. @itemize
  13256. @item
  13257. To calculate the signature of an input video and store it in signature.bin:
  13258. @example
  13259. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf signature=filename=signature.bin -map 0:v -f null -
  13260. @end example
  13261. @item
  13262. To detect whether two videos match and store the signatures in XML format in
  13263. signature0.xml and signature1.xml:
  13264. @example
  13265. ffmpeg -i input1.mkv -i input2.mkv -filter_complex "[0:v][1:v] signature=nb_inputs=2:detectmode=full:format=xml:filename=signature%d.xml" -map :v -f null -
  13266. @end example
  13267. @end itemize
  13268. @anchor{smartblur}
  13269. @section smartblur
  13270. Blur the input video without impacting the outlines.
  13271. It accepts the following options:
  13272. @table @option
  13273. @item luma_radius, lr
  13274. Set the luma radius. The option value must be a float number in
  13275. the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
  13276. used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is 1.0.
  13277. @item luma_strength, ls
  13278. Set the luma strength. The option value must be a float number
  13279. in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
  13280. in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
  13281. [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is 1.0.
  13282. @item luma_threshold, lt
  13283. Set the luma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
  13284. whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
  13285. integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
  13286. a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
  13287. in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is 0.
  13288. @item chroma_radius, cr
  13289. Set the chroma radius. The option value must be a float number in
  13290. the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
  13291. used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is @option{luma_radius}.
  13292. @item chroma_strength, cs
  13293. Set the chroma strength. The option value must be a float number
  13294. in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
  13295. in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
  13296. [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is @option{luma_strength}.
  13297. @item chroma_threshold, ct
  13298. Set the chroma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
  13299. whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
  13300. integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
  13301. a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
  13302. in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is @option{luma_threshold}.
  13303. @end table
  13304. If a chroma option is not explicitly set, the corresponding luma value
  13305. is set.
  13306. @section sobel
  13307. Apply sobel operator to input video stream.
  13308. The filter accepts the following option:
  13309. @table @option
  13310. @item planes
  13311. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  13312. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  13313. @item scale
  13314. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  13315. @item delta
  13316. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  13317. @end table
  13318. @anchor{spp}
  13319. @section spp
  13320. Apply a simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses the image
  13321. at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{6} - all) shifts
  13322. and average the results.
  13323. The filter accepts the following options:
  13324. @table @option
  13325. @item quality
  13326. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  13327. an integer in the range 0-6. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
  13328. effect. A value of @code{6} means the higher quality. For each increment of
  13329. that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
  13330. @code{3}.
  13331. @item qp
  13332. Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
  13333. from the video stream (if available).
  13334. @item mode
  13335. Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
  13336. @table @samp
  13337. @item hard
  13338. Set hard thresholding (default).
  13339. @item soft
  13340. Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
  13341. @end table
  13342. @item use_bframe_qp
  13343. Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
  13344. option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
  13345. @code{0} (not enabled).
  13346. @end table
  13347. @subsection Commands
  13348. This filter supports the following commands:
  13349. @table @option
  13350. @item quality, level
  13351. Set quality level. The value @code{max} can be used to set the maximum level,
  13352. currently @code{6}.
  13353. @end table
  13354. @anchor{sr}
  13355. @section sr
  13356. Scale the input by applying one of the super-resolution methods based on
  13357. convolutional neural networks. Supported models:
  13358. @itemize
  13359. @item
  13360. Super-Resolution Convolutional Neural Network model (SRCNN).
  13361. See @url{https://arxiv.org/abs/1501.00092}.
  13362. @item
  13363. Efficient Sub-Pixel Convolutional Neural Network model (ESPCN).
  13364. See @url{https://arxiv.org/abs/1609.05158}.
  13365. @end itemize
  13366. Training scripts as well as scripts for model file (.pb) saving can be found at
  13367. @url{https://github.com/XueweiMeng/sr/tree/sr_dnn_native}. Original repository
  13368. is at @url{https://github.com/HighVoltageRocknRoll/sr.git}.
  13369. Native model files (.model) can be generated from TensorFlow model
  13370. files (.pb) by using tools/python/convert.py
  13371. The filter accepts the following options:
  13372. @table @option
  13373. @item dnn_backend
  13374. Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts
  13375. the following values:
  13376. @table @samp
  13377. @item native
  13378. Native implementation of DNN loading and execution.
  13379. @item tensorflow
  13380. TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you
  13381. need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
  13382. @url{https://www.tensorflow.org/install/install_c}) and configure FFmpeg with
  13383. @code{--enable-libtensorflow}
  13384. @end table
  13385. Default value is @samp{native}.
  13386. @item model
  13387. Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.
  13388. Note that different backends use different file formats. TensorFlow backend
  13389. can load files for both formats, while native backend can load files for only
  13390. its format.
  13391. @item scale_factor
  13392. Set scale factor for SRCNN model. Allowed values are @code{2}, @code{3} and @code{4}.
  13393. Default value is @code{2}. Scale factor is necessary for SRCNN model, because it accepts
  13394. input upscaled using bicubic upscaling with proper scale factor.
  13395. @end table
  13396. This feature can also be finished with @ref{dnn_processing} filter.
  13397. @section ssim
  13398. Obtain the SSIM (Structural SImilarity Metric) between two input videos.
  13399. This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
  13400. considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
  13401. output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
  13402. the SSIM.
  13403. Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
  13404. this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
  13405. have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
  13406. The filter stores the calculated SSIM of each frame.
  13407. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  13408. @table @option
  13409. @item stats_file, f
  13410. If specified the filter will use the named file to save the SSIM of
  13411. each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
  13412. standard output.
  13413. @end table
  13414. The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
  13415. key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
  13416. couple of frames.
  13417. A description of each shown parameter follows:
  13418. @table @option
  13419. @item n
  13420. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
  13421. @item Y, U, V, R, G, B
  13422. SSIM of the compared frames for the component specified by the suffix.
  13423. @item All
  13424. SSIM of the compared frames for the whole frame.
  13425. @item dB
  13426. Same as above but in dB representation.
  13427. @end table
  13428. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  13429. @subsection Examples
  13430. @itemize
  13431. @item
  13432. For example:
  13433. @example
  13434. movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  13435. [main][ref] ssim="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
  13436. @end example
  13437. On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
  13438. reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The SSIM of each individual frame
  13439. is stored in @file{stats.log}.
  13440. @item
  13441. Another example with both psnr and ssim at same time:
  13442. @example
  13443. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi "ssim;[0:v][1:v]psnr" -f null -
  13444. @end example
  13445. @item
  13446. Another example with different containers:
  13447. @example
  13448. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mkv -lavfi "[0:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[main];[1:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[ref];[main][ref]ssim" -f null -
  13449. @end example
  13450. @end itemize
  13451. @section stereo3d
  13452. Convert between different stereoscopic image formats.
  13453. The filters accept the following options:
  13454. @table @option
  13455. @item in
  13456. Set stereoscopic image format of input.
  13457. Available values for input image formats are:
  13458. @table @samp
  13459. @item sbsl
  13460. side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
  13461. @item sbsr
  13462. side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
  13463. @item sbs2l
  13464. side by side parallel with half width resolution
  13465. (left eye left, right eye right)
  13466. @item sbs2r
  13467. side by side crosseye with half width resolution
  13468. (right eye left, left eye right)
  13469. @item abl
  13470. @item tbl
  13471. above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
  13472. @item abr
  13473. @item tbr
  13474. above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
  13475. @item ab2l
  13476. @item tb2l
  13477. above-below with half height resolution
  13478. (left eye above, right eye below)
  13479. @item ab2r
  13480. @item tb2r
  13481. above-below with half height resolution
  13482. (right eye above, left eye below)
  13483. @item al
  13484. alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
  13485. @item ar
  13486. alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
  13487. @item irl
  13488. interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
  13489. @item irr
  13490. interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
  13491. @item icl
  13492. interleaved columns, left eye first
  13493. @item icr
  13494. interleaved columns, right eye first
  13495. Default value is @samp{sbsl}.
  13496. @end table
  13497. @item out
  13498. Set stereoscopic image format of output.
  13499. @table @samp
  13500. @item sbsl
  13501. side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
  13502. @item sbsr
  13503. side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
  13504. @item sbs2l
  13505. side by side parallel with half width resolution
  13506. (left eye left, right eye right)
  13507. @item sbs2r
  13508. side by side crosseye with half width resolution
  13509. (right eye left, left eye right)
  13510. @item abl
  13511. @item tbl
  13512. above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
  13513. @item abr
  13514. @item tbr
  13515. above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
  13516. @item ab2l
  13517. @item tb2l
  13518. above-below with half height resolution
  13519. (left eye above, right eye below)
  13520. @item ab2r
  13521. @item tb2r
  13522. above-below with half height resolution
  13523. (right eye above, left eye below)
  13524. @item al
  13525. alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
  13526. @item ar
  13527. alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
  13528. @item irl
  13529. interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
  13530. @item irr
  13531. interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
  13532. @item arbg
  13533. anaglyph red/blue gray
  13534. (red filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13535. @item argg
  13536. anaglyph red/green gray
  13537. (red filter on left eye, green filter on right eye)
  13538. @item arcg
  13539. anaglyph red/cyan gray
  13540. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13541. @item arch
  13542. anaglyph red/cyan half colored
  13543. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13544. @item arcc
  13545. anaglyph red/cyan color
  13546. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13547. @item arcd
  13548. anaglyph red/cyan color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  13549. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13550. @item agmg
  13551. anaglyph green/magenta gray
  13552. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13553. @item agmh
  13554. anaglyph green/magenta half colored
  13555. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13556. @item agmc
  13557. anaglyph green/magenta colored
  13558. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13559. @item agmd
  13560. anaglyph green/magenta color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  13561. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13562. @item aybg
  13563. anaglyph yellow/blue gray
  13564. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13565. @item aybh
  13566. anaglyph yellow/blue half colored
  13567. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13568. @item aybc
  13569. anaglyph yellow/blue colored
  13570. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13571. @item aybd
  13572. anaglyph yellow/blue color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  13573. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13574. @item ml
  13575. mono output (left eye only)
  13576. @item mr
  13577. mono output (right eye only)
  13578. @item chl
  13579. checkerboard, left eye first
  13580. @item chr
  13581. checkerboard, right eye first
  13582. @item icl
  13583. interleaved columns, left eye first
  13584. @item icr
  13585. interleaved columns, right eye first
  13586. @item hdmi
  13587. HDMI frame pack
  13588. @end table
  13589. Default value is @samp{arcd}.
  13590. @end table
  13591. @subsection Examples
  13592. @itemize
  13593. @item
  13594. Convert input video from side by side parallel to anaglyph yellow/blue dubois:
  13595. @example
  13596. stereo3d=sbsl:aybd
  13597. @end example
  13598. @item
  13599. Convert input video from above below (left eye above, right eye below) to side by side crosseye.
  13600. @example
  13601. stereo3d=abl:sbsr
  13602. @end example
  13603. @end itemize
  13604. @section streamselect, astreamselect
  13605. Select video or audio streams.
  13606. The filter accepts the following options:
  13607. @table @option
  13608. @item inputs
  13609. Set number of inputs. Default is 2.
  13610. @item map
  13611. Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
  13612. @end table
  13613. @subsection Commands
  13614. The @code{streamselect} and @code{astreamselect} filter supports the following
  13615. commands:
  13616. @table @option
  13617. @item map
  13618. Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
  13619. @end table
  13620. @subsection Examples
  13621. @itemize
  13622. @item
  13623. Select first 5 seconds 1st stream and rest of time 2nd stream:
  13624. @example
  13625. sendcmd='5.0 streamselect map 1',streamselect=inputs=2:map=0
  13626. @end example
  13627. @item
  13628. Same as above, but for audio:
  13629. @example
  13630. asendcmd='5.0 astreamselect map 1',astreamselect=inputs=2:map=0
  13631. @end example
  13632. @end itemize
  13633. @anchor{subtitles}
  13634. @section subtitles
  13635. Draw subtitles on top of input video using the libass library.
  13636. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  13637. @code{--enable-libass}. This filter also requires a build with libavcodec and
  13638. libavformat to convert the passed subtitles file to ASS (Advanced Substation
  13639. Alpha) subtitles format.
  13640. The filter accepts the following options:
  13641. @table @option
  13642. @item filename, f
  13643. Set the filename of the subtitle file to read. It must be specified.
  13644. @item original_size
  13645. Specify the size of the original video, the video for which the ASS file
  13646. was composed. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13647. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13648. Due to a misdesign in ASS aspect ratio arithmetic, this is necessary to
  13649. correctly scale the fonts if the aspect ratio has been changed.
  13650. @item fontsdir
  13651. Set a directory path containing fonts that can be used by the filter.
  13652. These fonts will be used in addition to whatever the font provider uses.
  13653. @item alpha
  13654. Process alpha channel, by default alpha channel is untouched.
  13655. @item charenc
  13656. Set subtitles input character encoding. @code{subtitles} filter only. Only
  13657. useful if not UTF-8.
  13658. @item stream_index, si
  13659. Set subtitles stream index. @code{subtitles} filter only.
  13660. @item force_style
  13661. Override default style or script info parameters of the subtitles. It accepts a
  13662. string containing ASS style format @code{KEY=VALUE} couples separated by ",".
  13663. @end table
  13664. If the first key is not specified, it is assumed that the first value
  13665. specifies the @option{filename}.
  13666. For example, to render the file @file{sub.srt} on top of the input
  13667. video, use the command:
  13668. @example
  13669. subtitles=sub.srt
  13670. @end example
  13671. which is equivalent to:
  13672. @example
  13673. subtitles=filename=sub.srt
  13674. @end example
  13675. To render the default subtitles stream from file @file{video.mkv}, use:
  13676. @example
  13677. subtitles=video.mkv
  13678. @end example
  13679. To render the second subtitles stream from that file, use:
  13680. @example
  13681. subtitles=video.mkv:si=1
  13682. @end example
  13683. To make the subtitles stream from @file{sub.srt} appear in 80% transparent blue
  13684. @code{DejaVu Serif}, use:
  13685. @example
  13686. subtitles=sub.srt:force_style='FontName=DejaVu Serif,PrimaryColour=&HCCFF0000'
  13687. @end example
  13688. @section super2xsai
  13689. Scale the input by 2x and smooth using the Super2xSaI (Scale and
  13690. Interpolate) pixel art scaling algorithm.
  13691. Useful for enlarging pixel art images without reducing sharpness.
  13692. @section swaprect
  13693. Swap two rectangular objects in video.
  13694. This filter accepts the following options:
  13695. @table @option
  13696. @item w
  13697. Set object width.
  13698. @item h
  13699. Set object height.
  13700. @item x1
  13701. Set 1st rect x coordinate.
  13702. @item y1
  13703. Set 1st rect y coordinate.
  13704. @item x2
  13705. Set 2nd rect x coordinate.
  13706. @item y2
  13707. Set 2nd rect y coordinate.
  13708. All expressions are evaluated once for each frame.
  13709. @end table
  13710. The all options are expressions containing the following constants:
  13711. @table @option
  13712. @item w
  13713. @item h
  13714. The input width and height.
  13715. @item a
  13716. same as @var{w} / @var{h}
  13717. @item sar
  13718. input sample aspect ratio
  13719. @item dar
  13720. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
  13721. @item n
  13722. The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  13723. @item t
  13724. The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  13725. @item pos
  13726. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  13727. @end table
  13728. @section swapuv
  13729. Swap U & V plane.
  13730. @section tblend
  13731. Blend successive video frames.
  13732. See @ref{blend}
  13733. @section telecine
  13734. Apply telecine process to the video.
  13735. This filter accepts the following options:
  13736. @table @option
  13737. @item first_field
  13738. @table @samp
  13739. @item top, t
  13740. top field first
  13741. @item bottom, b
  13742. bottom field first
  13743. The default value is @code{top}.
  13744. @end table
  13745. @item pattern
  13746. A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
  13747. The default value is @code{23}.
  13748. @end table
  13749. @example
  13750. Some typical patterns:
  13751. NTSC output (30i):
  13752. 27.5p: 32222
  13753. 24p: 23 (classic)
  13754. 24p: 2332 (preferred)
  13755. 20p: 33
  13756. 18p: 334
  13757. 16p: 3444
  13758. PAL output (25i):
  13759. 27.5p: 12222
  13760. 24p: 222222222223 ("Euro pulldown")
  13761. 16.67p: 33
  13762. 16p: 33333334
  13763. @end example
  13764. @section thistogram
  13765. Compute and draw a color distribution histogram for the input video across time.
  13766. Unlike @ref{histogram} video filter which only shows histogram of single input frame
  13767. at certain time, this filter shows also past histograms of number of frames defined
  13768. by @code{width} option.
  13769. The computed histogram is a representation of the color component
  13770. distribution in an image.
  13771. The filter accepts the following options:
  13772. @table @option
  13773. @item width, w
  13774. Set width of single color component output. Default value is @code{0}.
  13775. Value of @code{0} means width will be picked from input video.
  13776. This also set number of passed histograms to keep.
  13777. Allowed range is [0, 8192].
  13778. @item display_mode, d
  13779. Set display mode.
  13780. It accepts the following values:
  13781. @table @samp
  13782. @item stack
  13783. Per color component graphs are placed below each other.
  13784. @item parade
  13785. Per color component graphs are placed side by side.
  13786. @item overlay
  13787. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  13788. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  13789. over one another.
  13790. @end table
  13791. Default is @code{stack}.
  13792. @item levels_mode, m
  13793. Set mode. Can be either @code{linear}, or @code{logarithmic}.
  13794. Default is @code{linear}.
  13795. @item components, c
  13796. Set what color components to display.
  13797. Default is @code{7}.
  13798. @item bgopacity, b
  13799. Set background opacity. Default is @code{0.9}.
  13800. @item envelope, e
  13801. Show envelope. Default is disabled.
  13802. @item ecolor, ec
  13803. Set envelope color. Default is @code{gold}.
  13804. @end table
  13805. @section threshold
  13806. Apply threshold effect to video stream.
  13807. This filter needs four video streams to perform thresholding.
  13808. First stream is stream we are filtering.
  13809. Second stream is holding threshold values, third stream is holding min values,
  13810. and last, fourth stream is holding max values.
  13811. The filter accepts the following option:
  13812. @table @option
  13813. @item planes
  13814. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  13815. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  13816. @end table
  13817. For example if first stream pixel's component value is less then threshold value
  13818. of pixel component from 2nd threshold stream, third stream value will picked,
  13819. otherwise fourth stream pixel component value will be picked.
  13820. Using color source filter one can perform various types of thresholding:
  13821. @subsection Examples
  13822. @itemize
  13823. @item
  13824. Binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13825. @example
  13826. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=black -f lavfi -i color=white -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13827. @end example
  13828. @item
  13829. Inverted binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13830. @example
  13831. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=white -f lavfi -i color=black -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13832. @end example
  13833. @item
  13834. Truncate binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13835. @example
  13836. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13837. @end example
  13838. @item
  13839. Threshold to zero, using gray color as threshold:
  13840. @example
  13841. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=white -i 320x240.avi -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13842. @end example
  13843. @item
  13844. Inverted threshold to zero, using gray color as threshold:
  13845. @example
  13846. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=white -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13847. @end example
  13848. @end itemize
  13849. @section thumbnail
  13850. Select the most representative frame in a given sequence of consecutive frames.
  13851. The filter accepts the following options:
  13852. @table @option
  13853. @item n
  13854. Set the frames batch size to analyze; in a set of @var{n} frames, the filter
  13855. will pick one of them, and then handle the next batch of @var{n} frames until
  13856. the end. Default is @code{100}.
  13857. @end table
  13858. Since the filter keeps track of the whole frames sequence, a bigger @var{n}
  13859. value will result in a higher memory usage, so a high value is not recommended.
  13860. @subsection Examples
  13861. @itemize
  13862. @item
  13863. Extract one picture each 50 frames:
  13864. @example
  13865. thumbnail=50
  13866. @end example
  13867. @item
  13868. Complete example of a thumbnail creation with @command{ffmpeg}:
  13869. @example
  13870. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf thumbnail,scale=300:200 -frames:v 1 out.png
  13871. @end example
  13872. @end itemize
  13873. @anchor{tile}
  13874. @section tile
  13875. Tile several successive frames together.
  13876. The @ref{untile} filter can do the reverse.
  13877. The filter accepts the following options:
  13878. @table @option
  13879. @item layout
  13880. Set the grid size (i.e. the number of lines and columns). For the syntax of
  13881. this option, check the
  13882. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13883. @item nb_frames
  13884. Set the maximum number of frames to render in the given area. It must be less
  13885. than or equal to @var{w}x@var{h}. The default value is @code{0}, meaning all
  13886. the area will be used.
  13887. @item margin
  13888. Set the outer border margin in pixels.
  13889. @item padding
  13890. Set the inner border thickness (i.e. the number of pixels between frames). For
  13891. more advanced padding options (such as having different values for the edges),
  13892. refer to the pad video filter.
  13893. @item color
  13894. Specify the color of the unused area. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13895. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13896. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  13897. @item overlap
  13898. Set the number of frames to overlap when tiling several successive frames together.
  13899. The value must be between @code{0} and @var{nb_frames - 1}.
  13900. @item init_padding
  13901. Set the number of frames to initially be empty before displaying first output frame.
  13902. This controls how soon will one get first output frame.
  13903. The value must be between @code{0} and @var{nb_frames - 1}.
  13904. @end table
  13905. @subsection Examples
  13906. @itemize
  13907. @item
  13908. Produce 8x8 PNG tiles of all keyframes (@option{-skip_frame nokey}) in a movie:
  13909. @example
  13910. ffmpeg -skip_frame nokey -i file.avi -vf 'scale=128:72,tile=8x8' -an -vsync 0 keyframes%03d.png
  13911. @end example
  13912. The @option{-vsync 0} is necessary to prevent @command{ffmpeg} from
  13913. duplicating each output frame to accommodate the originally detected frame
  13914. rate.
  13915. @item
  13916. Display @code{5} pictures in an area of @code{3x2} frames,
  13917. with @code{7} pixels between them, and @code{2} pixels of initial margin, using
  13918. mixed flat and named options:
  13919. @example
  13920. tile=3x2:nb_frames=5:padding=7:margin=2
  13921. @end example
  13922. @end itemize
  13923. @section tinterlace
  13924. Perform various types of temporal field interlacing.
  13925. Frames are counted starting from 1, so the first input frame is
  13926. considered odd.
  13927. The filter accepts the following options:
  13928. @table @option
  13929. @item mode
  13930. Specify the mode of the interlacing. This option can also be specified
  13931. as a value alone. See below for a list of values for this option.
  13932. Available values are:
  13933. @table @samp
  13934. @item merge, 0
  13935. Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
  13936. generating a double height frame at half frame rate.
  13937. @example
  13938. ------> time
  13939. Input:
  13940. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13941. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13942. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13943. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13944. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13945. Output:
  13946. 11111 33333
  13947. 22222 44444
  13948. 11111 33333
  13949. 22222 44444
  13950. 11111 33333
  13951. 22222 44444
  13952. 11111 33333
  13953. 22222 44444
  13954. @end example
  13955. @item drop_even, 1
  13956. Only output odd frames, even frames are dropped, generating a frame with
  13957. unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13958. @example
  13959. ------> time
  13960. Input:
  13961. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13962. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13963. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13964. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13965. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13966. Output:
  13967. 11111 33333
  13968. 11111 33333
  13969. 11111 33333
  13970. 11111 33333
  13971. @end example
  13972. @item drop_odd, 2
  13973. Only output even frames, odd frames are dropped, generating a frame with
  13974. unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13975. @example
  13976. ------> time
  13977. Input:
  13978. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13979. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13980. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13981. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13982. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13983. Output:
  13984. 22222 44444
  13985. 22222 44444
  13986. 22222 44444
  13987. 22222 44444
  13988. @end example
  13989. @item pad, 3
  13990. Expand each frame to full height, but pad alternate lines with black,
  13991. generating a frame with double height at the same input frame rate.
  13992. @example
  13993. ------> time
  13994. Input:
  13995. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13996. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13997. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13998. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13999. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  14000. Output:
  14001. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  14002. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  14003. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  14004. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  14005. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  14006. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  14007. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  14008. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  14009. @end example
  14010. @item interleave_top, 4
  14011. Interleave the upper field from odd frames with the lower field from
  14012. even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
  14013. @example
  14014. ------> time
  14015. Input:
  14016. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  14017. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  14018. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  14019. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  14020. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  14021. Output:
  14022. 11111 33333
  14023. 22222 44444
  14024. 11111 33333
  14025. 22222 44444
  14026. @end example
  14027. @item interleave_bottom, 5
  14028. Interleave the lower field from odd frames with the upper field from
  14029. even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
  14030. @example
  14031. ------> time
  14032. Input:
  14033. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  14034. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  14035. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  14036. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  14037. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  14038. Output:
  14039. 22222 44444
  14040. 11111 33333
  14041. 22222 44444
  14042. 11111 33333
  14043. @end example
  14044. @item interlacex2, 6
  14045. Double frame rate with unchanged height. Frames are inserted each
  14046. containing the second temporal field from the previous input frame and
  14047. the first temporal field from the next input frame. This mode relies on
  14048. the top_field_first flag. Useful for interlaced video displays with no
  14049. field synchronisation.
  14050. @example
  14051. ------> time
  14052. Input:
  14053. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  14054. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  14055. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  14056. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  14057. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  14058. Output:
  14059. 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
  14060. 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
  14061. 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
  14062. 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
  14063. @end example
  14064. @item mergex2, 7
  14065. Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
  14066. generating a double height frame at same frame rate.
  14067. @example
  14068. ------> time
  14069. Input:
  14070. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  14071. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  14072. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  14073. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  14074. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  14075. Output:
  14076. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  14077. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  14078. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  14079. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  14080. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  14081. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  14082. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  14083. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  14084. @end example
  14085. @end table
  14086. Numeric values are deprecated but are accepted for backward
  14087. compatibility reasons.
  14088. Default mode is @code{merge}.
  14089. @item flags
  14090. Specify flags influencing the filter process.
  14091. Available value for @var{flags} is:
  14092. @table @option
  14093. @item low_pass_filter, vlpf
  14094. Enable linear vertical low-pass filtering in the filter.
  14095. Vertical low-pass filtering is required when creating an interlaced
  14096. destination from a progressive source which contains high-frequency
  14097. vertical detail. Filtering will reduce interlace 'twitter' and Moire
  14098. patterning.
  14099. @item complex_filter, cvlpf
  14100. Enable complex vertical low-pass filtering.
  14101. This will slightly less reduce interlace 'twitter' and Moire
  14102. patterning but better retain detail and subjective sharpness impression.
  14103. @item bypass_il
  14104. Bypass already interlaced frames, only adjust the frame rate.
  14105. @end table
  14106. Vertical low-pass filtering and bypassing already interlaced frames can only be
  14107. enabled for @option{mode} @var{interleave_top} and @var{interleave_bottom}.
  14108. @end table
  14109. @section tmedian
  14110. Pick median pixels from several successive input video frames.
  14111. The filter accepts the following options:
  14112. @table @option
  14113. @item radius
  14114. Set radius of median filter.
  14115. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 127.
  14116. @item planes
  14117. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{15}, by which all planes are processed.
  14118. @item percentile
  14119. Set median percentile. Default value is @code{0.5}.
  14120. Default value of @code{0.5} will pick always median values, while @code{0} will pick
  14121. minimum values, and @code{1} maximum values.
  14122. @end table
  14123. @section tmix
  14124. Mix successive video frames.
  14125. A description of the accepted options follows.
  14126. @table @option
  14127. @item frames
  14128. The number of successive frames to mix. If unspecified, it defaults to 3.
  14129. @item weights
  14130. Specify weight of each input video frame.
  14131. Each weight is separated by space. If number of weights is smaller than
  14132. number of @var{frames} last specified weight will be used for all remaining
  14133. unset weights.
  14134. @item scale
  14135. Specify scale, if it is set it will be multiplied with sum
  14136. of each weight multiplied with pixel values to give final destination
  14137. pixel value. By default @var{scale} is auto scaled to sum of weights.
  14138. @end table
  14139. @subsection Examples
  14140. @itemize
  14141. @item
  14142. Average 7 successive frames:
  14143. @example
  14144. tmix=frames=7:weights="1 1 1 1 1 1 1"
  14145. @end example
  14146. @item
  14147. Apply simple temporal convolution:
  14148. @example
  14149. tmix=frames=3:weights="-1 3 -1"
  14150. @end example
  14151. @item
  14152. Similar as above but only showing temporal differences:
  14153. @example
  14154. tmix=frames=3:weights="-1 2 -1":scale=1
  14155. @end example
  14156. @end itemize
  14157. @anchor{tonemap}
  14158. @section tonemap
  14159. Tone map colors from different dynamic ranges.
  14160. This filter expects data in single precision floating point, as it needs to
  14161. operate on (and can output) out-of-range values. Another filter, such as
  14162. @ref{zscale}, is needed to convert the resulting frame to a usable format.
  14163. The tonemapping algorithms implemented only work on linear light, so input
  14164. data should be linearized beforehand (and possibly correctly tagged).
  14165. @example
  14166. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf zscale=transfer=linear,tonemap=clip,zscale=transfer=bt709,format=yuv420p OUTPUT
  14167. @end example
  14168. @subsection Options
  14169. The filter accepts the following options.
  14170. @table @option
  14171. @item tonemap
  14172. Set the tone map algorithm to use.
  14173. Possible values are:
  14174. @table @var
  14175. @item none
  14176. Do not apply any tone map, only desaturate overbright pixels.
  14177. @item clip
  14178. Hard-clip any out-of-range values. Use it for perfect color accuracy for
  14179. in-range values, while distorting out-of-range values.
  14180. @item linear
  14181. Stretch the entire reference gamut to a linear multiple of the display.
  14182. @item gamma
  14183. Fit a logarithmic transfer between the tone curves.
  14184. @item reinhard
  14185. Preserve overall image brightness with a simple curve, using nonlinear
  14186. contrast, which results in flattening details and degrading color accuracy.
  14187. @item hable
  14188. Preserve both dark and bright details better than @var{reinhard}, at the cost
  14189. of slightly darkening everything. Use it when detail preservation is more
  14190. important than color and brightness accuracy.
  14191. @item mobius
  14192. Smoothly map out-of-range values, while retaining contrast and colors for
  14193. in-range material as much as possible. Use it when color accuracy is more
  14194. important than detail preservation.
  14195. @end table
  14196. Default is none.
  14197. @item param
  14198. Tune the tone mapping algorithm.
  14199. This affects the following algorithms:
  14200. @table @var
  14201. @item none
  14202. Ignored.
  14203. @item linear
  14204. Specifies the scale factor to use while stretching.
  14205. Default to 1.0.
  14206. @item gamma
  14207. Specifies the exponent of the function.
  14208. Default to 1.8.
  14209. @item clip
  14210. Specify an extra linear coefficient to multiply into the signal before clipping.
  14211. Default to 1.0.
  14212. @item reinhard
  14213. Specify the local contrast coefficient at the display peak.
  14214. Default to 0.5, which means that in-gamut values will be about half as bright
  14215. as when clipping.
  14216. @item hable
  14217. Ignored.
  14218. @item mobius
  14219. Specify the transition point from linear to mobius transform. Every value
  14220. below this point is guaranteed to be mapped 1:1. The higher the value, the
  14221. more accurate the result will be, at the cost of losing bright details.
  14222. Default to 0.3, which due to the steep initial slope still preserves in-range
  14223. colors fairly accurately.
  14224. @end table
  14225. @item desat
  14226. Apply desaturation for highlights that exceed this level of brightness. The
  14227. higher the parameter, the more color information will be preserved. This
  14228. setting helps prevent unnaturally blown-out colors for super-highlights, by
  14229. (smoothly) turning into white instead. This makes images feel more natural,
  14230. at the cost of reducing information about out-of-range colors.
  14231. The default of 2.0 is somewhat conservative and will mostly just apply to
  14232. skies or directly sunlit surfaces. A setting of 0.0 disables this option.
  14233. This option works only if the input frame has a supported color tag.
  14234. @item peak
  14235. Override signal/nominal/reference peak with this value. Useful when the
  14236. embedded peak information in display metadata is not reliable or when tone
  14237. mapping from a lower range to a higher range.
  14238. @end table
  14239. @section tpad
  14240. Temporarily pad video frames.
  14241. The filter accepts the following options:
  14242. @table @option
  14243. @item start
  14244. Specify number of delay frames before input video stream. Default is 0.
  14245. @item stop
  14246. Specify number of padding frames after input video stream.
  14247. Set to -1 to pad indefinitely. Default is 0.
  14248. @item start_mode
  14249. Set kind of frames added to beginning of stream.
  14250. Can be either @var{add} or @var{clone}.
  14251. With @var{add} frames of solid-color are added.
  14252. With @var{clone} frames are clones of first frame.
  14253. Default is @var{add}.
  14254. @item stop_mode
  14255. Set kind of frames added to end of stream.
  14256. Can be either @var{add} or @var{clone}.
  14257. With @var{add} frames of solid-color are added.
  14258. With @var{clone} frames are clones of last frame.
  14259. Default is @var{add}.
  14260. @item start_duration, stop_duration
  14261. Specify the duration of the start/stop delay. See
  14262. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  14263. for the accepted syntax.
  14264. These options override @var{start} and @var{stop}. Default is 0.
  14265. @item color
  14266. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  14267. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  14268. manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  14269. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  14270. @end table
  14271. @anchor{transpose}
  14272. @section transpose
  14273. Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.
  14274. It accepts the following parameters:
  14275. @table @option
  14276. @item dir
  14277. Specify the transposition direction.
  14278. Can assume the following values:
  14279. @table @samp
  14280. @item 0, 4, cclock_flip
  14281. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip (default), that is:
  14282. @example
  14283. L.R L.l
  14284. . . -> . .
  14285. l.r R.r
  14286. @end example
  14287. @item 1, 5, clock
  14288. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise, that is:
  14289. @example
  14290. L.R l.L
  14291. . . -> . .
  14292. l.r r.R
  14293. @end example
  14294. @item 2, 6, cclock
  14295. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise, that is:
  14296. @example
  14297. L.R R.r
  14298. . . -> . .
  14299. l.r L.l
  14300. @end example
  14301. @item 3, 7, clock_flip
  14302. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip, that is:
  14303. @example
  14304. L.R r.R
  14305. . . -> . .
  14306. l.r l.L
  14307. @end example
  14308. @end table
  14309. For values between 4-7, the transposition is only done if the input
  14310. video geometry is portrait and not landscape. These values are
  14311. deprecated, the @code{passthrough} option should be used instead.
  14312. Numerical values are deprecated, and should be dropped in favor of
  14313. symbolic constants.
  14314. @item passthrough
  14315. Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one
  14316. specified by the specified value. It accepts the following values:
  14317. @table @samp
  14318. @item none
  14319. Always apply transposition.
  14320. @item portrait
  14321. Preserve portrait geometry (when @var{height} >= @var{width}).
  14322. @item landscape
  14323. Preserve landscape geometry (when @var{width} >= @var{height}).
  14324. @end table
  14325. Default value is @code{none}.
  14326. @end table
  14327. For example to rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and preserve portrait
  14328. layout:
  14329. @example
  14330. transpose=dir=1:passthrough=portrait
  14331. @end example
  14332. The command above can also be specified as:
  14333. @example
  14334. transpose=1:portrait
  14335. @end example
  14336. @section transpose_npp
  14337. Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.
  14338. For more in depth examples see the @ref{transpose} video filter, which shares mostly the same options.
  14339. It accepts the following parameters:
  14340. @table @option
  14341. @item dir
  14342. Specify the transposition direction.
  14343. Can assume the following values:
  14344. @table @samp
  14345. @item cclock_flip
  14346. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip. (default)
  14347. @item clock
  14348. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise.
  14349. @item cclock
  14350. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise.
  14351. @item clock_flip
  14352. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip.
  14353. @end table
  14354. @item passthrough
  14355. Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one
  14356. specified by the specified value. It accepts the following values:
  14357. @table @samp
  14358. @item none
  14359. Always apply transposition. (default)
  14360. @item portrait
  14361. Preserve portrait geometry (when @var{height} >= @var{width}).
  14362. @item landscape
  14363. Preserve landscape geometry (when @var{width} >= @var{height}).
  14364. @end table
  14365. @end table
  14366. @section trim
  14367. Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
  14368. It accepts the following parameters:
  14369. @table @option
  14370. @item start
  14371. Specify the time of the start of the kept section, i.e. the frame with the
  14372. timestamp @var{start} will be the first frame in the output.
  14373. @item end
  14374. Specify the time of the first frame that will be dropped, i.e. the frame
  14375. immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be the last
  14376. frame in the output.
  14377. @item start_pts
  14378. This is the same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp
  14379. in timebase units instead of seconds.
  14380. @item end_pts
  14381. This is the same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp
  14382. in timebase units instead of seconds.
  14383. @item duration
  14384. The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
  14385. @item start_frame
  14386. The number of the first frame that should be passed to the output.
  14387. @item end_frame
  14388. The number of the first frame that should be dropped.
  14389. @end table
  14390. @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
  14391. duration specifications; see
  14392. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  14393. for the accepted syntax.
  14394. Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
  14395. option look at the frame timestamp, while the _frame variants simply count the
  14396. frames that pass through the filter. Also note that this filter does not modify
  14397. the timestamps. If you wish for the output timestamps to start at zero, insert a
  14398. setpts filter after the trim filter.
  14399. If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
  14400. keep all the frames that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
  14401. only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple trim
  14402. filters.
  14403. The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
  14404. just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
  14405. Examples:
  14406. @itemize
  14407. @item
  14408. Drop everything except the second minute of input:
  14409. @example
  14410. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=60:120
  14411. @end example
  14412. @item
  14413. Keep only the first second:
  14414. @example
  14415. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=duration=1
  14416. @end example
  14417. @end itemize
  14418. @section unpremultiply
  14419. Apply alpha unpremultiply effect to input video stream using first plane
  14420. of second stream as alpha.
  14421. Both streams must have same dimensions and same pixel format.
  14422. The filter accepts the following option:
  14423. @table @option
  14424. @item planes
  14425. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  14426. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  14427. If the format has 1 or 2 components, then luma is bit 0.
  14428. If the format has 3 or 4 components:
  14429. for RGB formats bit 0 is green, bit 1 is blue and bit 2 is red;
  14430. for YUV formats bit 0 is luma, bit 1 is chroma-U and bit 2 is chroma-V.
  14431. If present, the alpha channel is always the last bit.
  14432. @item inplace
  14433. Do not require 2nd input for processing, instead use alpha plane from input stream.
  14434. @end table
  14435. @anchor{unsharp}
  14436. @section unsharp
  14437. Sharpen or blur the input video.
  14438. It accepts the following parameters:
  14439. @table @option
  14440. @item luma_msize_x, lx
  14441. Set the luma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer between
  14442. 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  14443. @item luma_msize_y, ly
  14444. Set the luma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer between 3
  14445. and 23. The default value is 5.
  14446. @item luma_amount, la
  14447. Set the luma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
  14448. values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
  14449. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  14450. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  14451. Default value is 1.0.
  14452. @item chroma_msize_x, cx
  14453. Set the chroma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer
  14454. between 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  14455. @item chroma_msize_y, cy
  14456. Set the chroma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer
  14457. between 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  14458. @item chroma_amount, ca
  14459. Set the chroma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
  14460. values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
  14461. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  14462. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  14463. Default value is 0.0.
  14464. @end table
  14465. All parameters are optional and default to the equivalent of the
  14466. string '5:5:1.0:5:5:0.0'.
  14467. @subsection Examples
  14468. @itemize
  14469. @item
  14470. Apply strong luma sharpen effect:
  14471. @example
  14472. unsharp=luma_msize_x=7:luma_msize_y=7:luma_amount=2.5
  14473. @end example
  14474. @item
  14475. Apply a strong blur of both luma and chroma parameters:
  14476. @example
  14477. unsharp=7:7:-2:7:7:-2
  14478. @end example
  14479. @end itemize
  14480. @anchor{untile}
  14481. @section untile
  14482. Decompose a video made of tiled images into the individual images.
  14483. The frame rate of the output video is the frame rate of the input video
  14484. multiplied by the number of tiles.
  14485. This filter does the reverse of @ref{tile}.
  14486. The filter accepts the following options:
  14487. @table @option
  14488. @item layout
  14489. Set the grid size (i.e. the number of lines and columns). For the syntax of
  14490. this option, check the
  14491. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  14492. @end table
  14493. @subsection Examples
  14494. @itemize
  14495. @item
  14496. Produce a 1-second video from a still image file made of 25 frames stacked
  14497. vertically, like an analogic film reel:
  14498. @example
  14499. ffmpeg -r 1 -i image.jpg -vf untile=1x25 movie.mkv
  14500. @end example
  14501. @end itemize
  14502. @section uspp
  14503. Apply ultra slow/simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses
  14504. the image at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{8} - all)
  14505. shifts and average the results.
  14506. The way this differs from the behavior of spp is that uspp actually encodes &
  14507. decodes each case with libavcodec Snow, whereas spp uses a simplified intra only 8x8
  14508. DCT similar to MJPEG.
  14509. The filter accepts the following options:
  14510. @table @option
  14511. @item quality
  14512. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  14513. an integer in the range 0-8. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
  14514. effect. A value of @code{8} means the higher quality. For each increment of
  14515. that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
  14516. @code{3}.
  14517. @item qp
  14518. Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
  14519. from the video stream (if available).
  14520. @end table
  14521. @section v360
  14522. Convert 360 videos between various formats.
  14523. The filter accepts the following options:
  14524. @table @option
  14525. @item input
  14526. @item output
  14527. Set format of the input/output video.
  14528. Available formats:
  14529. @table @samp
  14530. @item e
  14531. @item equirect
  14532. Equirectangular projection.
  14533. @item c3x2
  14534. @item c6x1
  14535. @item c1x6
  14536. Cubemap with 3x2/6x1/1x6 layout.
  14537. Format specific options:
  14538. @table @option
  14539. @item in_pad
  14540. @item out_pad
  14541. Set padding proportion for the input/output cubemap. Values in decimals.
  14542. Example values:
  14543. @table @samp
  14544. @item 0
  14545. No padding.
  14546. @item 0.01
  14547. 1% of face is padding. For example, with 1920x1280 resolution face size would be 640x640 and padding would be 3 pixels from each side. (640 * 0.01 = 6 pixels)
  14548. @end table
  14549. Default value is @b{@samp{0}}.
  14550. Maximum value is @b{@samp{0.1}}.
  14551. @item fin_pad
  14552. @item fout_pad
  14553. Set fixed padding for the input/output cubemap. Values in pixels.
  14554. Default value is @b{@samp{0}}. If greater than zero it overrides other padding options.
  14555. @item in_forder
  14556. @item out_forder
  14557. Set order of faces for the input/output cubemap. Choose one direction for each position.
  14558. Designation of directions:
  14559. @table @samp
  14560. @item r
  14561. right
  14562. @item l
  14563. left
  14564. @item u
  14565. up
  14566. @item d
  14567. down
  14568. @item f
  14569. forward
  14570. @item b
  14571. back
  14572. @end table
  14573. Default value is @b{@samp{rludfb}}.
  14574. @item in_frot
  14575. @item out_frot
  14576. Set rotation of faces for the input/output cubemap. Choose one angle for each position.
  14577. Designation of angles:
  14578. @table @samp
  14579. @item 0
  14580. 0 degrees clockwise
  14581. @item 1
  14582. 90 degrees clockwise
  14583. @item 2
  14584. 180 degrees clockwise
  14585. @item 3
  14586. 270 degrees clockwise
  14587. @end table
  14588. Default value is @b{@samp{000000}}.
  14589. @end table
  14590. @item eac
  14591. Equi-Angular Cubemap.
  14592. @item flat
  14593. @item gnomonic
  14594. @item rectilinear
  14595. Regular video.
  14596. Format specific options:
  14597. @table @option
  14598. @item h_fov
  14599. @item v_fov
  14600. @item d_fov
  14601. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14602. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14603. @item ih_fov
  14604. @item iv_fov
  14605. @item id_fov
  14606. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14607. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14608. @end table
  14609. @item dfisheye
  14610. Dual fisheye.
  14611. Format specific options:
  14612. @table @option
  14613. @item h_fov
  14614. @item v_fov
  14615. @item d_fov
  14616. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14617. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14618. @item ih_fov
  14619. @item iv_fov
  14620. @item id_fov
  14621. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14622. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14623. @end table
  14624. @item barrel
  14625. @item fb
  14626. @item barrelsplit
  14627. Facebook's 360 formats.
  14628. @item sg
  14629. Stereographic format.
  14630. Format specific options:
  14631. @table @option
  14632. @item h_fov
  14633. @item v_fov
  14634. @item d_fov
  14635. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14636. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14637. @item ih_fov
  14638. @item iv_fov
  14639. @item id_fov
  14640. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14641. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14642. @end table
  14643. @item mercator
  14644. Mercator format.
  14645. @item ball
  14646. Ball format, gives significant distortion toward the back.
  14647. @item hammer
  14648. Hammer-Aitoff map projection format.
  14649. @item sinusoidal
  14650. Sinusoidal map projection format.
  14651. @item fisheye
  14652. Fisheye projection.
  14653. Format specific options:
  14654. @table @option
  14655. @item h_fov
  14656. @item v_fov
  14657. @item d_fov
  14658. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14659. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14660. @item ih_fov
  14661. @item iv_fov
  14662. @item id_fov
  14663. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14664. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14665. @end table
  14666. @item pannini
  14667. Pannini projection.
  14668. Format specific options:
  14669. @table @option
  14670. @item h_fov
  14671. Set output pannini parameter.
  14672. @item ih_fov
  14673. Set input pannini parameter.
  14674. @end table
  14675. @item cylindrical
  14676. Cylindrical projection.
  14677. Format specific options:
  14678. @table @option
  14679. @item h_fov
  14680. @item v_fov
  14681. @item d_fov
  14682. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14683. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14684. @item ih_fov
  14685. @item iv_fov
  14686. @item id_fov
  14687. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14688. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14689. @end table
  14690. @item perspective
  14691. Perspective projection. @i{(output only)}
  14692. Format specific options:
  14693. @table @option
  14694. @item v_fov
  14695. Set perspective parameter.
  14696. @end table
  14697. @item tetrahedron
  14698. Tetrahedron projection.
  14699. @item tsp
  14700. Truncated square pyramid projection.
  14701. @item he
  14702. @item hequirect
  14703. Half equirectangular projection.
  14704. @item equisolid
  14705. Equisolid format.
  14706. Format specific options:
  14707. @table @option
  14708. @item h_fov
  14709. @item v_fov
  14710. @item d_fov
  14711. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14712. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14713. @item ih_fov
  14714. @item iv_fov
  14715. @item id_fov
  14716. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14717. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14718. @end table
  14719. @item og
  14720. Orthographic format.
  14721. Format specific options:
  14722. @table @option
  14723. @item h_fov
  14724. @item v_fov
  14725. @item d_fov
  14726. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14727. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14728. @item ih_fov
  14729. @item iv_fov
  14730. @item id_fov
  14731. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14732. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14733. @end table
  14734. @end table
  14735. @item interp
  14736. Set interpolation method.@*
  14737. @i{Note: more complex interpolation methods require much more memory to run.}
  14738. Available methods:
  14739. @table @samp
  14740. @item near
  14741. @item nearest
  14742. Nearest neighbour.
  14743. @item line
  14744. @item linear
  14745. Bilinear interpolation.
  14746. @item lagrange9
  14747. Lagrange9 interpolation.
  14748. @item cube
  14749. @item cubic
  14750. Bicubic interpolation.
  14751. @item lanc
  14752. @item lanczos
  14753. Lanczos interpolation.
  14754. @item sp16
  14755. @item spline16
  14756. Spline16 interpolation.
  14757. @item gauss
  14758. @item gaussian
  14759. Gaussian interpolation.
  14760. @end table
  14761. Default value is @b{@samp{line}}.
  14762. @item w
  14763. @item h
  14764. Set the output video resolution.
  14765. Default resolution depends on formats.
  14766. @item in_stereo
  14767. @item out_stereo
  14768. Set the input/output stereo format.
  14769. @table @samp
  14770. @item 2d
  14771. 2D mono
  14772. @item sbs
  14773. Side by side
  14774. @item tb
  14775. Top bottom
  14776. @end table
  14777. Default value is @b{@samp{2d}} for input and output format.
  14778. @item yaw
  14779. @item pitch
  14780. @item roll
  14781. Set rotation for the output video. Values in degrees.
  14782. @item rorder
  14783. Set rotation order for the output video. Choose one item for each position.
  14784. @table @samp
  14785. @item y, Y
  14786. yaw
  14787. @item p, P
  14788. pitch
  14789. @item r, R
  14790. roll
  14791. @end table
  14792. Default value is @b{@samp{ypr}}.
  14793. @item h_flip
  14794. @item v_flip
  14795. @item d_flip
  14796. Flip the output video horizontally(swaps left-right)/vertically(swaps up-down)/in-depth(swaps back-forward). Boolean values.
  14797. @item ih_flip
  14798. @item iv_flip
  14799. Set if input video is flipped horizontally/vertically. Boolean values.
  14800. @item in_trans
  14801. Set if input video is transposed. Boolean value, by default disabled.
  14802. @item out_trans
  14803. Set if output video needs to be transposed. Boolean value, by default disabled.
  14804. @item alpha_mask
  14805. Build mask in alpha plane for all unmapped pixels by marking them fully transparent. Boolean value, by default disabled.
  14806. @end table
  14807. @subsection Examples
  14808. @itemize
  14809. @item
  14810. Convert equirectangular video to cubemap with 3x2 layout and 1% padding using bicubic interpolation:
  14811. @example
  14812. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf v360=e:c3x2:cubic:out_pad=0.01 output.mkv
  14813. @end example
  14814. @item
  14815. Extract back view of Equi-Angular Cubemap:
  14816. @example
  14817. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf v360=eac:flat:yaw=180 output.mkv
  14818. @end example
  14819. @item
  14820. Convert transposed and horizontally flipped Equi-Angular Cubemap in side-by-side stereo format to equirectangular top-bottom stereo format:
  14821. @example
  14822. v360=eac:equirect:in_stereo=sbs:in_trans=1:ih_flip=1:out_stereo=tb
  14823. @end example
  14824. @end itemize
  14825. @subsection Commands
  14826. This filter supports subset of above options as @ref{commands}.
  14827. @section vaguedenoiser
  14828. Apply a wavelet based denoiser.
  14829. It transforms each frame from the video input into the wavelet domain,
  14830. using Cohen-Daubechies-Feauveau 9/7. Then it applies some filtering to
  14831. the obtained coefficients. It does an inverse wavelet transform after.
  14832. Due to wavelet properties, it should give a nice smoothed result, and
  14833. reduced noise, without blurring picture features.
  14834. This filter accepts the following options:
  14835. @table @option
  14836. @item threshold
  14837. The filtering strength. The higher, the more filtered the video will be.
  14838. Hard thresholding can use a higher threshold than soft thresholding
  14839. before the video looks overfiltered. Default value is 2.
  14840. @item method
  14841. The filtering method the filter will use.
  14842. It accepts the following values:
  14843. @table @samp
  14844. @item hard
  14845. All values under the threshold will be zeroed.
  14846. @item soft
  14847. All values under the threshold will be zeroed. All values above will be
  14848. reduced by the threshold.
  14849. @item garrote
  14850. Scales or nullifies coefficients - intermediary between (more) soft and
  14851. (less) hard thresholding.
  14852. @end table
  14853. Default is garrote.
  14854. @item nsteps
  14855. Number of times, the wavelet will decompose the picture. Picture can't
  14856. be decomposed beyond a particular point (typically, 8 for a 640x480
  14857. frame - as 2^9 = 512 > 480). Valid values are integers between 1 and 32. Default value is 6.
  14858. @item percent
  14859. Partial of full denoising (limited coefficients shrinking), from 0 to 100. Default value is 85.
  14860. @item planes
  14861. A list of the planes to process. By default all planes are processed.
  14862. @item type
  14863. The threshold type the filter will use.
  14864. It accepts the following values:
  14865. @table @samp
  14866. @item universal
  14867. Threshold used is same for all decompositions.
  14868. @item bayes
  14869. Threshold used depends also on each decomposition coefficients.
  14870. @end table
  14871. Default is universal.
  14872. @end table
  14873. @section vectorscope
  14874. Display 2 color component values in the two dimensional graph (which is called
  14875. a vectorscope).
  14876. This filter accepts the following options:
  14877. @table @option
  14878. @item mode, m
  14879. Set vectorscope mode.
  14880. It accepts the following values:
  14881. @table @samp
  14882. @item gray
  14883. @item tint
  14884. Gray values are displayed on graph, higher brightness means more pixels have
  14885. same component color value on location in graph. This is the default mode.
  14886. @item color
  14887. Gray values are displayed on graph. Surrounding pixels values which are not
  14888. present in video frame are drawn in gradient of 2 color components which are
  14889. set by option @code{x} and @code{y}. The 3rd color component is static.
  14890. @item color2
  14891. Actual color components values present in video frame are displayed on graph.
  14892. @item color3
  14893. Similar as color2 but higher frequency of same values @code{x} and @code{y}
  14894. on graph increases value of another color component, which is luminance by
  14895. default values of @code{x} and @code{y}.
  14896. @item color4
  14897. Actual colors present in video frame are displayed on graph. If two different
  14898. colors map to same position on graph then color with higher value of component
  14899. not present in graph is picked.
  14900. @item color5
  14901. Gray values are displayed on graph. Similar to @code{color} but with 3rd color
  14902. component picked from radial gradient.
  14903. @end table
  14904. @item x
  14905. Set which color component will be represented on X-axis. Default is @code{1}.
  14906. @item y
  14907. Set which color component will be represented on Y-axis. Default is @code{2}.
  14908. @item intensity, i
  14909. Set intensity, used by modes: gray, color, color3 and color5 for increasing brightness
  14910. of color component which represents frequency of (X, Y) location in graph.
  14911. @item envelope, e
  14912. @table @samp
  14913. @item none
  14914. No envelope, this is default.
  14915. @item instant
  14916. Instant envelope, even darkest single pixel will be clearly highlighted.
  14917. @item peak
  14918. Hold maximum and minimum values presented in graph over time. This way you
  14919. can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at vectorscope.
  14920. @item peak+instant
  14921. Peak and instant envelope combined together.
  14922. @end table
  14923. @item graticule, g
  14924. Set what kind of graticule to draw.
  14925. @table @samp
  14926. @item none
  14927. @item green
  14928. @item color
  14929. @item invert
  14930. @end table
  14931. @item opacity, o
  14932. Set graticule opacity.
  14933. @item flags, f
  14934. Set graticule flags.
  14935. @table @samp
  14936. @item white
  14937. Draw graticule for white point.
  14938. @item black
  14939. Draw graticule for black point.
  14940. @item name
  14941. Draw color points short names.
  14942. @end table
  14943. @item bgopacity, b
  14944. Set background opacity.
  14945. @item lthreshold, l
  14946. Set low threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.
  14947. Values lower than this value will be ignored. Default is 0.
  14948. Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one pixel component
  14949. can have. So for 8-bit input and low threshold value of 0.1 actual threshold
  14950. is 0.1 * 255 = 25.
  14951. @item hthreshold, h
  14952. Set high threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.
  14953. Values higher than this value will be ignored. Default is 1.
  14954. Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one pixel component
  14955. can have. So for 8-bit input and high threshold value of 0.9 actual threshold
  14956. is 0.9 * 255 = 230.
  14957. @item colorspace, c
  14958. Set what kind of colorspace to use when drawing graticule.
  14959. @table @samp
  14960. @item auto
  14961. @item 601
  14962. @item 709
  14963. @end table
  14964. Default is auto.
  14965. @item tint0, t0
  14966. @item tint1, t1
  14967. Set color tint for gray/tint vectorscope mode. By default both options are zero.
  14968. This means no tint, and output will remain gray.
  14969. @end table
  14970. @anchor{vidstabdetect}
  14971. @section vidstabdetect
  14972. Analyze video stabilization/deshaking. Perform pass 1 of 2, see
  14973. @ref{vidstabtransform} for pass 2.
  14974. This filter generates a file with relative translation and rotation
  14975. transform information about subsequent frames, which is then used by
  14976. the @ref{vidstabtransform} filter.
  14977. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  14978. @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
  14979. This filter accepts the following options:
  14980. @table @option
  14981. @item result
  14982. Set the path to the file used to write the transforms information.
  14983. Default value is @file{transforms.trf}.
  14984. @item shakiness
  14985. Set how shaky the video is and how quick the camera is. It accepts an
  14986. integer in the range 1-10, a value of 1 means little shakiness, a
  14987. value of 10 means strong shakiness. Default value is 5.
  14988. @item accuracy
  14989. Set the accuracy of the detection process. It must be a value in the
  14990. range 1-15. A value of 1 means low accuracy, a value of 15 means high
  14991. accuracy. Default value is 15.
  14992. @item stepsize
  14993. Set stepsize of the search process. The region around minimum is
  14994. scanned with 1 pixel resolution. Default value is 6.
  14995. @item mincontrast
  14996. Set minimum contrast. Below this value a local measurement field is
  14997. discarded. Must be a floating point value in the range 0-1. Default
  14998. value is 0.3.
  14999. @item tripod
  15000. Set reference frame number for tripod mode.
  15001. If enabled, the motion of the frames is compared to a reference frame
  15002. in the filtered stream, identified by the specified number. The idea
  15003. is to compensate all movements in a more-or-less static scene and keep
  15004. the camera view absolutely still.
  15005. If set to 0, it is disabled. The frames are counted starting from 1.
  15006. @item show
  15007. Show fields and transforms in the resulting frames. It accepts an
  15008. integer in the range 0-2. Default value is 0, which disables any
  15009. visualization.
  15010. @end table
  15011. @subsection Examples
  15012. @itemize
  15013. @item
  15014. Use default values:
  15015. @example
  15016. vidstabdetect
  15017. @end example
  15018. @item
  15019. Analyze strongly shaky movie and put the results in file
  15020. @file{mytransforms.trf}:
  15021. @example
  15022. vidstabdetect=shakiness=10:accuracy=15:result="mytransforms.trf"
  15023. @end example
  15024. @item
  15025. Visualize the result of internal transformations in the resulting
  15026. video:
  15027. @example
  15028. vidstabdetect=show=1
  15029. @end example
  15030. @item
  15031. Analyze a video with medium shakiness using @command{ffmpeg}:
  15032. @example
  15033. ffmpeg -i input -vf vidstabdetect=shakiness=5:show=1 dummy.avi
  15034. @end example
  15035. @end itemize
  15036. @anchor{vidstabtransform}
  15037. @section vidstabtransform
  15038. Video stabilization/deshaking: pass 2 of 2,
  15039. see @ref{vidstabdetect} for pass 1.
  15040. Read a file with transform information for each frame and
  15041. apply/compensate them. Together with the @ref{vidstabdetect}
  15042. filter this can be used to deshake videos. See also
  15043. @url{http://public.hronopik.de/vid.stab}. It is important to also use
  15044. the @ref{unsharp} filter, see below.
  15045. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  15046. @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
  15047. @subsection Options
  15048. @table @option
  15049. @item input
  15050. Set path to the file used to read the transforms. Default value is
  15051. @file{transforms.trf}.
  15052. @item smoothing
  15053. Set the number of frames (value*2 + 1) used for lowpass filtering the
  15054. camera movements. Default value is 10.
  15055. For example a number of 10 means that 21 frames are used (10 in the
  15056. past and 10 in the future) to smoothen the motion in the video. A
  15057. larger value leads to a smoother video, but limits the acceleration of
  15058. the camera (pan/tilt movements). 0 is a special case where a static
  15059. camera is simulated.
  15060. @item optalgo
  15061. Set the camera path optimization algorithm.
  15062. Accepted values are:
  15063. @table @samp
  15064. @item gauss
  15065. gaussian kernel low-pass filter on camera motion (default)
  15066. @item avg
  15067. averaging on transformations
  15068. @end table
  15069. @item maxshift
  15070. Set maximal number of pixels to translate frames. Default value is -1,
  15071. meaning no limit.
  15072. @item maxangle
  15073. Set maximal angle in radians (degree*PI/180) to rotate frames. Default
  15074. value is -1, meaning no limit.
  15075. @item crop
  15076. Specify how to deal with borders that may be visible due to movement
  15077. compensation.
  15078. Available values are:
  15079. @table @samp
  15080. @item keep
  15081. keep image information from previous frame (default)
  15082. @item black
  15083. fill the border black
  15084. @end table
  15085. @item invert
  15086. Invert transforms if set to 1. Default value is 0.
  15087. @item relative
  15088. Consider transforms as relative to previous frame if set to 1,
  15089. absolute if set to 0. Default value is 0.
  15090. @item zoom
  15091. Set percentage to zoom. A positive value will result in a zoom-in
  15092. effect, a negative value in a zoom-out effect. Default value is 0 (no
  15093. zoom).
  15094. @item optzoom
  15095. Set optimal zooming to avoid borders.
  15096. Accepted values are:
  15097. @table @samp
  15098. @item 0
  15099. disabled
  15100. @item 1
  15101. optimal static zoom value is determined (only very strong movements
  15102. will lead to visible borders) (default)
  15103. @item 2
  15104. optimal adaptive zoom value is determined (no borders will be
  15105. visible), see @option{zoomspeed}
  15106. @end table
  15107. Note that the value given at zoom is added to the one calculated here.
  15108. @item zoomspeed
  15109. Set percent to zoom maximally each frame (enabled when
  15110. @option{optzoom} is set to 2). Range is from 0 to 5, default value is
  15111. 0.25.
  15112. @item interpol
  15113. Specify type of interpolation.
  15114. Available values are:
  15115. @table @samp
  15116. @item no
  15117. no interpolation
  15118. @item linear
  15119. linear only horizontal
  15120. @item bilinear
  15121. linear in both directions (default)
  15122. @item bicubic
  15123. cubic in both directions (slow)
  15124. @end table
  15125. @item tripod
  15126. Enable virtual tripod mode if set to 1, which is equivalent to
  15127. @code{relative=0:smoothing=0}. Default value is 0.
  15128. Use also @code{tripod} option of @ref{vidstabdetect}.
  15129. @item debug
  15130. Increase log verbosity if set to 1. Also the detected global motions
  15131. are written to the temporary file @file{global_motions.trf}. Default
  15132. value is 0.
  15133. @end table
  15134. @subsection Examples
  15135. @itemize
  15136. @item
  15137. Use @command{ffmpeg} for a typical stabilization with default values:
  15138. @example
  15139. ffmpeg -i inp.mpeg -vf vidstabtransform,unsharp=5:5:0.8:3:3:0.4 inp_stabilized.mpeg
  15140. @end example
  15141. Note the use of the @ref{unsharp} filter which is always recommended.
  15142. @item
  15143. Zoom in a bit more and load transform data from a given file:
  15144. @example
  15145. vidstabtransform=zoom=5:input="mytransforms.trf"
  15146. @end example
  15147. @item
  15148. Smoothen the video even more:
  15149. @example
  15150. vidstabtransform=smoothing=30
  15151. @end example
  15152. @end itemize
  15153. @section vflip
  15154. Flip the input video vertically.
  15155. For example, to vertically flip a video with @command{ffmpeg}:
  15156. @example
  15157. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "vflip" out.avi
  15158. @end example
  15159. @section vfrdet
  15160. Detect variable frame rate video.
  15161. This filter tries to detect if the input is variable or constant frame rate.
  15162. At end it will output number of frames detected as having variable delta pts,
  15163. and ones with constant delta pts.
  15164. If there was frames with variable delta, than it will also show min, max and
  15165. average delta encountered.
  15166. @section vibrance
  15167. Boost or alter saturation.
  15168. The filter accepts the following options:
  15169. @table @option
  15170. @item intensity
  15171. Set strength of boost if positive value or strength of alter if negative value.
  15172. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -2 to 2.
  15173. @item rbal
  15174. Set the red balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  15175. @item gbal
  15176. Set the green balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  15177. @item bbal
  15178. Set the blue balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  15179. @item rlum
  15180. Set the red luma coefficient.
  15181. @item glum
  15182. Set the green luma coefficient.
  15183. @item blum
  15184. Set the blue luma coefficient.
  15185. @item alternate
  15186. If @code{intensity} is negative and this is set to 1, colors will change,
  15187. otherwise colors will be less saturated, more towards gray.
  15188. @end table
  15189. @subsection Commands
  15190. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  15191. @anchor{vignette}
  15192. @section vignette
  15193. Make or reverse a natural vignetting effect.
  15194. The filter accepts the following options:
  15195. @table @option
  15196. @item angle, a
  15197. Set lens angle expression as a number of radians.
  15198. The value is clipped in the @code{[0,PI/2]} range.
  15199. Default value: @code{"PI/5"}
  15200. @item x0
  15201. @item y0
  15202. Set center coordinates expressions. Respectively @code{"w/2"} and @code{"h/2"}
  15203. by default.
  15204. @item mode
  15205. Set forward/backward mode.
  15206. Available modes are:
  15207. @table @samp
  15208. @item forward
  15209. The larger the distance from the central point, the darker the image becomes.
  15210. @item backward
  15211. The larger the distance from the central point, the brighter the image becomes.
  15212. This can be used to reverse a vignette effect, though there is no automatic
  15213. detection to extract the lens @option{angle} and other settings (yet). It can
  15214. also be used to create a burning effect.
  15215. @end table
  15216. Default value is @samp{forward}.
  15217. @item eval
  15218. Set evaluation mode for the expressions (@option{angle}, @option{x0}, @option{y0}).
  15219. It accepts the following values:
  15220. @table @samp
  15221. @item init
  15222. Evaluate expressions only once during the filter initialization.
  15223. @item frame
  15224. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame. This is way slower than the
  15225. @samp{init} mode since it requires all the scalers to be re-computed, but it
  15226. allows advanced dynamic expressions.
  15227. @end table
  15228. Default value is @samp{init}.
  15229. @item dither
  15230. Set dithering to reduce the circular banding effects. Default is @code{1}
  15231. (enabled).
  15232. @item aspect
  15233. Set vignette aspect. This setting allows one to adjust the shape of the vignette.
  15234. Setting this value to the SAR of the input will make a rectangular vignetting
  15235. following the dimensions of the video.
  15236. Default is @code{1/1}.
  15237. @end table
  15238. @subsection Expressions
  15239. The @option{alpha}, @option{x0} and @option{y0} expressions can contain the
  15240. following parameters.
  15241. @table @option
  15242. @item w
  15243. @item h
  15244. input width and height
  15245. @item n
  15246. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  15247. @item pts
  15248. the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) time of the filtered video frame, expressed in
  15249. @var{TB} units, NAN if undefined
  15250. @item r
  15251. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  15252. @item t
  15253. the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
  15254. expressed in seconds, NAN if undefined
  15255. @item tb
  15256. time base of the input video
  15257. @end table
  15258. @subsection Examples
  15259. @itemize
  15260. @item
  15261. Apply simple strong vignetting effect:
  15262. @example
  15263. vignette=PI/4
  15264. @end example
  15265. @item
  15266. Make a flickering vignetting:
  15267. @example
  15268. vignette='PI/4+random(1)*PI/50':eval=frame
  15269. @end example
  15270. @end itemize
  15271. @section vmafmotion
  15272. Obtain the average VMAF motion score of a video.
  15273. It is one of the component metrics of VMAF.
  15274. The obtained average motion score is printed through the logging system.
  15275. The filter accepts the following options:
  15276. @table @option
  15277. @item stats_file
  15278. If specified, the filter will use the named file to save the motion score of
  15279. each frame with respect to the previous frame.
  15280. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to standard output.
  15281. @end table
  15282. Example:
  15283. @example
  15284. ffmpeg -i ref.mpg -vf vmafmotion -f null -
  15285. @end example
  15286. @section vstack
  15287. Stack input videos vertically.
  15288. All streams must be of same pixel format and of same width.
  15289. Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
  15290. to create same output.
  15291. The filter accepts the following options:
  15292. @table @option
  15293. @item inputs
  15294. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  15295. @item shortest
  15296. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  15297. terminates. Default value is 0.
  15298. @end table
  15299. @section w3fdif
  15300. Deinterlace the input video ("w3fdif" stands for "Weston 3 Field
  15301. Deinterlacing Filter").
  15302. Based on the process described by Martin Weston for BBC R&D, and
  15303. implemented based on the de-interlace algorithm written by Jim
  15304. Easterbrook for BBC R&D, the Weston 3 field deinterlacing filter
  15305. uses filter coefficients calculated by BBC R&D.
  15306. This filter uses field-dominance information in frame to decide which
  15307. of each pair of fields to place first in the output.
  15308. If it gets it wrong use @ref{setfield} filter before @code{w3fdif} filter.
  15309. There are two sets of filter coefficients, so called "simple"
  15310. and "complex". Which set of filter coefficients is used can
  15311. be set by passing an optional parameter:
  15312. @table @option
  15313. @item filter
  15314. Set the interlacing filter coefficients. Accepts one of the following values:
  15315. @table @samp
  15316. @item simple
  15317. Simple filter coefficient set.
  15318. @item complex
  15319. More-complex filter coefficient set.
  15320. @end table
  15321. Default value is @samp{complex}.
  15322. @item deint
  15323. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following values:
  15324. @table @samp
  15325. @item all
  15326. Deinterlace all frames,
  15327. @item interlaced
  15328. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  15329. @end table
  15330. Default value is @samp{all}.
  15331. @end table
  15332. @section waveform
  15333. Video waveform monitor.
  15334. The waveform monitor plots color component intensity. By default luminance
  15335. only. Each column of the waveform corresponds to a column of pixels in the
  15336. source video.
  15337. It accepts the following options:
  15338. @table @option
  15339. @item mode, m
  15340. Can be either @code{row}, or @code{column}. Default is @code{column}.
  15341. In row mode, the graph on the left side represents color component value 0 and
  15342. the right side represents value = 255. In column mode, the top side represents
  15343. color component value = 0 and bottom side represents value = 255.
  15344. @item intensity, i
  15345. Set intensity. Smaller values are useful to find out how many values of the same
  15346. luminance are distributed across input rows/columns.
  15347. Default value is @code{0.04}. Allowed range is [0, 1].
  15348. @item mirror, r
  15349. Set mirroring mode. @code{0} means unmirrored, @code{1} means mirrored.
  15350. In mirrored mode, higher values will be represented on the left
  15351. side for @code{row} mode and at the top for @code{column} mode. Default is
  15352. @code{1} (mirrored).
  15353. @item display, d
  15354. Set display mode.
  15355. It accepts the following values:
  15356. @table @samp
  15357. @item overlay
  15358. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  15359. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  15360. over one another.
  15361. This display mode makes it easier to spot relative differences or similarities
  15362. in overlapping areas of the color components that are supposed to be identical,
  15363. such as neutral whites, grays, or blacks.
  15364. @item stack
  15365. Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
  15366. @code{row} mode or one below the other in @code{column} mode.
  15367. @item parade
  15368. Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
  15369. @code{column} mode or one below the other in @code{row} mode.
  15370. Using this display mode makes it easy to spot color casts in the highlights
  15371. and shadows of an image, by comparing the contours of the top and the bottom
  15372. graphs of each waveform. Since whites, grays, and blacks are characterized
  15373. by exactly equal amounts of red, green, and blue, neutral areas of the picture
  15374. should display three waveforms of roughly equal width/height. If not, the
  15375. correction is easy to perform by making level adjustments the three waveforms.
  15376. @end table
  15377. Default is @code{stack}.
  15378. @item components, c
  15379. Set which color components to display. Default is 1, which means only luminance
  15380. or red color component if input is in RGB colorspace. If is set for example to
  15381. 7 it will display all 3 (if) available color components.
  15382. @item envelope, e
  15383. @table @samp
  15384. @item none
  15385. No envelope, this is default.
  15386. @item instant
  15387. Instant envelope, minimum and maximum values presented in graph will be easily
  15388. visible even with small @code{step} value.
  15389. @item peak
  15390. Hold minimum and maximum values presented in graph across time. This way you
  15391. can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at waveforms.
  15392. @item peak+instant
  15393. Peak and instant envelope combined together.
  15394. @end table
  15395. @item filter, f
  15396. @table @samp
  15397. @item lowpass
  15398. No filtering, this is default.
  15399. @item flat
  15400. Luma and chroma combined together.
  15401. @item aflat
  15402. Similar as above, but shows difference between blue and red chroma.
  15403. @item xflat
  15404. Similar as above, but use different colors.
  15405. @item yflat
  15406. Similar as above, but again with different colors.
  15407. @item chroma
  15408. Displays only chroma.
  15409. @item color
  15410. Displays actual color value on waveform.
  15411. @item acolor
  15412. Similar as above, but with luma showing frequency of chroma values.
  15413. @end table
  15414. @item graticule, g
  15415. Set which graticule to display.
  15416. @table @samp
  15417. @item none
  15418. Do not display graticule.
  15419. @item green
  15420. Display green graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  15421. @item orange
  15422. Display orange graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  15423. @item invert
  15424. Display invert graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  15425. @end table
  15426. @item opacity, o
  15427. Set graticule opacity.
  15428. @item flags, fl
  15429. Set graticule flags.
  15430. @table @samp
  15431. @item numbers
  15432. Draw numbers above lines. By default enabled.
  15433. @item dots
  15434. Draw dots instead of lines.
  15435. @end table
  15436. @item scale, s
  15437. Set scale used for displaying graticule.
  15438. @table @samp
  15439. @item digital
  15440. @item millivolts
  15441. @item ire
  15442. @end table
  15443. Default is digital.
  15444. @item bgopacity, b
  15445. Set background opacity.
  15446. @item tint0, t0
  15447. @item tint1, t1
  15448. Set tint for output.
  15449. Only used with lowpass filter and when display is not overlay and input
  15450. pixel formats are not RGB.
  15451. @end table
  15452. @section weave, doubleweave
  15453. The @code{weave} takes a field-based video input and join
  15454. each two sequential fields into single frame, producing a new double
  15455. height clip with half the frame rate and half the frame count.
  15456. The @code{doubleweave} works same as @code{weave} but without
  15457. halving frame rate and frame count.
  15458. It accepts the following option:
  15459. @table @option
  15460. @item first_field
  15461. Set first field. Available values are:
  15462. @table @samp
  15463. @item top, t
  15464. Set the frame as top-field-first.
  15465. @item bottom, b
  15466. Set the frame as bottom-field-first.
  15467. @end table
  15468. @end table
  15469. @subsection Examples
  15470. @itemize
  15471. @item
  15472. Interlace video using @ref{select} and @ref{separatefields} filter:
  15473. @example
  15474. separatefields,select=eq(mod(n,4),0)+eq(mod(n,4),3),weave
  15475. @end example
  15476. @end itemize
  15477. @section xbr
  15478. Apply the xBR high-quality magnification filter which is designed for pixel
  15479. art. It follows a set of edge-detection rules, see
  15480. @url{https://forums.libretro.com/t/xbr-algorithm-tutorial/123}.
  15481. It accepts the following option:
  15482. @table @option
  15483. @item n
  15484. Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{2xBR}, @code{3} for
  15485. @code{3xBR} and @code{4} for @code{4xBR}.
  15486. Default is @code{3}.
  15487. @end table
  15488. @section xfade
  15489. Apply cross fade from one input video stream to another input video stream.
  15490. The cross fade is applied for specified duration.
  15491. The filter accepts the following options:
  15492. @table @option
  15493. @item transition
  15494. Set one of available transition effects:
  15495. @table @samp
  15496. @item custom
  15497. @item fade
  15498. @item wipeleft
  15499. @item wiperight
  15500. @item wipeup
  15501. @item wipedown
  15502. @item slideleft
  15503. @item slideright
  15504. @item slideup
  15505. @item slidedown
  15506. @item circlecrop
  15507. @item rectcrop
  15508. @item distance
  15509. @item fadeblack
  15510. @item fadewhite
  15511. @item radial
  15512. @item smoothleft
  15513. @item smoothright
  15514. @item smoothup
  15515. @item smoothdown
  15516. @item circleopen
  15517. @item circleclose
  15518. @item vertopen
  15519. @item vertclose
  15520. @item horzopen
  15521. @item horzclose
  15522. @item dissolve
  15523. @item pixelize
  15524. @item diagtl
  15525. @item diagtr
  15526. @item diagbl
  15527. @item diagbr
  15528. @item hlslice
  15529. @item hrslice
  15530. @item vuslice
  15531. @item vdslice
  15532. @end table
  15533. Default transition effect is fade.
  15534. @item duration
  15535. Set cross fade duration in seconds.
  15536. Default duration is 1 second.
  15537. @item offset
  15538. Set cross fade start relative to first input stream in seconds.
  15539. Default offset is 0.
  15540. @item expr
  15541. Set expression for custom transition effect.
  15542. The expressions can use the following variables and functions:
  15543. @table @option
  15544. @item X
  15545. @item Y
  15546. The coordinates of the current sample.
  15547. @item W
  15548. @item H
  15549. The width and height of the image.
  15550. @item P
  15551. Progress of transition effect.
  15552. @item PLANE
  15553. Currently processed plane.
  15554. @item A
  15555. Return value of first input at current location and plane.
  15556. @item B
  15557. Return value of second input at current location and plane.
  15558. @item a0(x, y)
  15559. @item a1(x, y)
  15560. @item a2(x, y)
  15561. @item a3(x, y)
  15562. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  15563. first/second/third/fourth component of first input.
  15564. @item b0(x, y)
  15565. @item b1(x, y)
  15566. @item b2(x, y)
  15567. @item b3(x, y)
  15568. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  15569. first/second/third/fourth component of second input.
  15570. @end table
  15571. @end table
  15572. @subsection Examples
  15573. @itemize
  15574. @item
  15575. Cross fade from one input video to another input video, with fade transition and duration of transition
  15576. of 2 seconds starting at offset of 5 seconds:
  15577. @example
  15578. ffmpeg -i first.mp4 -i second.mp4 -filter_complex xfade=transition=fade:duration=2:offset=5 output.mp4
  15579. @end example
  15580. @end itemize
  15581. @section xmedian
  15582. Pick median pixels from several input videos.
  15583. The filter accepts the following options:
  15584. @table @option
  15585. @item inputs
  15586. Set number of inputs.
  15587. Default is 3. Allowed range is from 3 to 255.
  15588. If number of inputs is even number, than result will be mean value between two median values.
  15589. @item planes
  15590. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{15}, by which all planes are processed.
  15591. @item percentile
  15592. Set median percentile. Default value is @code{0.5}.
  15593. Default value of @code{0.5} will pick always median values, while @code{0} will pick
  15594. minimum values, and @code{1} maximum values.
  15595. @end table
  15596. @section xstack
  15597. Stack video inputs into custom layout.
  15598. All streams must be of same pixel format.
  15599. The filter accepts the following options:
  15600. @table @option
  15601. @item inputs
  15602. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  15603. @item layout
  15604. Specify layout of inputs.
  15605. This option requires the desired layout configuration to be explicitly set by the user.
  15606. This sets position of each video input in output. Each input
  15607. is separated by '|'.
  15608. The first number represents the column, and the second number represents the row.
  15609. Numbers start at 0 and are separated by '_'. Optionally one can use wX and hX,
  15610. where X is video input from which to take width or height.
  15611. Multiple values can be used when separated by '+'. In such
  15612. case values are summed together.
  15613. Note that if inputs are of different sizes gaps may appear, as not all of
  15614. the output video frame will be filled. Similarly, videos can overlap each
  15615. other if their position doesn't leave enough space for the full frame of
  15616. adjoining videos.
  15617. For 2 inputs, a default layout of @code{0_0|w0_0} is set. In all other cases,
  15618. a layout must be set by the user.
  15619. @item shortest
  15620. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  15621. terminates. Default value is 0.
  15622. @item fill
  15623. If set to valid color, all unused pixels will be filled with that color.
  15624. By default fill is set to none, so it is disabled.
  15625. @end table
  15626. @subsection Examples
  15627. @itemize
  15628. @item
  15629. Display 4 inputs into 2x2 grid.
  15630. Layout:
  15631. @example
  15632. input1(0, 0) | input3(w0, 0)
  15633. input2(0, h0) | input4(w0, h0)
  15634. @end example
  15635. @example
  15636. xstack=inputs=4:layout=0_0|0_h0|w0_0|w0_h0
  15637. @end example
  15638. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  15639. @item
  15640. Display 4 inputs into 1x4 grid.
  15641. Layout:
  15642. @example
  15643. input1(0, 0)
  15644. input2(0, h0)
  15645. input3(0, h0+h1)
  15646. input4(0, h0+h1+h2)
  15647. @end example
  15648. @example
  15649. xstack=inputs=4:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|0_h0+h1+h2
  15650. @end example
  15651. Note that if inputs are of different widths, unused space will appear.
  15652. @item
  15653. Display 9 inputs into 3x3 grid.
  15654. Layout:
  15655. @example
  15656. input1(0, 0) | input4(w0, 0) | input7(w0+w3, 0)
  15657. input2(0, h0) | input5(w0, h0) | input8(w0+w3, h0)
  15658. input3(0, h0+h1) | input6(w0, h0+h1) | input9(w0+w3, h0+h1)
  15659. @end example
  15660. @example
  15661. xstack=inputs=9:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|w0_0|w0_h0|w0_h0+h1|w0+w3_0|w0+w3_h0|w0+w3_h0+h1
  15662. @end example
  15663. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  15664. @item
  15665. Display 16 inputs into 4x4 grid.
  15666. Layout:
  15667. @example
  15668. input1(0, 0) | input5(w0, 0) | input9 (w0+w4, 0) | input13(w0+w4+w8, 0)
  15669. input2(0, h0) | input6(w0, h0) | input10(w0+w4, h0) | input14(w0+w4+w8, h0)
  15670. input3(0, h0+h1) | input7(w0, h0+h1) | input11(w0+w4, h0+h1) | input15(w0+w4+w8, h0+h1)
  15671. input4(0, h0+h1+h2)| input8(w0, h0+h1+h2)| input12(w0+w4, h0+h1+h2)| input16(w0+w4+w8, h0+h1+h2)
  15672. @end example
  15673. @example
  15674. xstack=inputs=16:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|0_h0+h1+h2|w0_0|w0_h0|w0_h0+h1|w0_h0+h1+h2|w0+w4_0|
  15675. w0+w4_h0|w0+w4_h0+h1|w0+w4_h0+h1+h2|w0+w4+w8_0|w0+w4+w8_h0|w0+w4+w8_h0+h1|w0+w4+w8_h0+h1+h2
  15676. @end example
  15677. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  15678. @end itemize
  15679. @anchor{yadif}
  15680. @section yadif
  15681. Deinterlace the input video ("yadif" means "yet another deinterlacing
  15682. filter").
  15683. It accepts the following parameters:
  15684. @table @option
  15685. @item mode
  15686. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  15687. @table @option
  15688. @item 0, send_frame
  15689. Output one frame for each frame.
  15690. @item 1, send_field
  15691. Output one frame for each field.
  15692. @item 2, send_frame_nospatial
  15693. Like @code{send_frame}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15694. @item 3, send_field_nospatial
  15695. Like @code{send_field}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15696. @end table
  15697. The default value is @code{send_frame}.
  15698. @item parity
  15699. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  15700. of the following values:
  15701. @table @option
  15702. @item 0, tff
  15703. Assume the top field is first.
  15704. @item 1, bff
  15705. Assume the bottom field is first.
  15706. @item -1, auto
  15707. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  15708. @end table
  15709. The default value is @code{auto}.
  15710. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  15711. top field first will be assumed.
  15712. @item deint
  15713. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  15714. values:
  15715. @table @option
  15716. @item 0, all
  15717. Deinterlace all frames.
  15718. @item 1, interlaced
  15719. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  15720. @end table
  15721. The default value is @code{all}.
  15722. @end table
  15723. @section yadif_cuda
  15724. Deinterlace the input video using the @ref{yadif} algorithm, but implemented
  15725. in CUDA so that it can work as part of a GPU accelerated pipeline with nvdec
  15726. and/or nvenc.
  15727. It accepts the following parameters:
  15728. @table @option
  15729. @item mode
  15730. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  15731. @table @option
  15732. @item 0, send_frame
  15733. Output one frame for each frame.
  15734. @item 1, send_field
  15735. Output one frame for each field.
  15736. @item 2, send_frame_nospatial
  15737. Like @code{send_frame}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15738. @item 3, send_field_nospatial
  15739. Like @code{send_field}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15740. @end table
  15741. The default value is @code{send_frame}.
  15742. @item parity
  15743. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  15744. of the following values:
  15745. @table @option
  15746. @item 0, tff
  15747. Assume the top field is first.
  15748. @item 1, bff
  15749. Assume the bottom field is first.
  15750. @item -1, auto
  15751. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  15752. @end table
  15753. The default value is @code{auto}.
  15754. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  15755. top field first will be assumed.
  15756. @item deint
  15757. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  15758. values:
  15759. @table @option
  15760. @item 0, all
  15761. Deinterlace all frames.
  15762. @item 1, interlaced
  15763. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  15764. @end table
  15765. The default value is @code{all}.
  15766. @end table
  15767. @section yaepblur
  15768. Apply blur filter while preserving edges ("yaepblur" means "yet another edge preserving blur filter").
  15769. The algorithm is described in
  15770. "J. S. Lee, Digital image enhancement and noise filtering by use of local statistics, IEEE Trans. Pattern Anal. Mach. Intell. PAMI-2, 1980."
  15771. It accepts the following parameters:
  15772. @table @option
  15773. @item radius, r
  15774. Set the window radius. Default value is 3.
  15775. @item planes, p
  15776. Set which planes to filter. Default is only the first plane.
  15777. @item sigma, s
  15778. Set blur strength. Default value is 128.
  15779. @end table
  15780. @subsection Commands
  15781. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  15782. @section zoompan
  15783. Apply Zoom & Pan effect.
  15784. This filter accepts the following options:
  15785. @table @option
  15786. @item zoom, z
  15787. Set the zoom expression. Range is 1-10. Default is 1.
  15788. @item x
  15789. @item y
  15790. Set the x and y expression. Default is 0.
  15791. @item d
  15792. Set the duration expression in number of frames.
  15793. This sets for how many number of frames effect will last for
  15794. single input image.
  15795. @item s
  15796. Set the output image size, default is 'hd720'.
  15797. @item fps
  15798. Set the output frame rate, default is '25'.
  15799. @end table
  15800. Each expression can contain the following constants:
  15801. @table @option
  15802. @item in_w, iw
  15803. Input width.
  15804. @item in_h, ih
  15805. Input height.
  15806. @item out_w, ow
  15807. Output width.
  15808. @item out_h, oh
  15809. Output height.
  15810. @item in
  15811. Input frame count.
  15812. @item on
  15813. Output frame count.
  15814. @item in_time, it
  15815. The input timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  15816. @item out_time, time, ot
  15817. The output timestamp expressed in seconds.
  15818. @item x
  15819. @item y
  15820. Last calculated 'x' and 'y' position from 'x' and 'y' expression
  15821. for current input frame.
  15822. @item px
  15823. @item py
  15824. 'x' and 'y' of last output frame of previous input frame or 0 when there was
  15825. not yet such frame (first input frame).
  15826. @item zoom
  15827. Last calculated zoom from 'z' expression for current input frame.
  15828. @item pzoom
  15829. Last calculated zoom of last output frame of previous input frame.
  15830. @item duration
  15831. Number of output frames for current input frame. Calculated from 'd' expression
  15832. for each input frame.
  15833. @item pduration
  15834. number of output frames created for previous input frame
  15835. @item a
  15836. Rational number: input width / input height
  15837. @item sar
  15838. sample aspect ratio
  15839. @item dar
  15840. display aspect ratio
  15841. @end table
  15842. @subsection Examples
  15843. @itemize
  15844. @item
  15845. Zoom in up to 1.5x and pan at same time to some spot near center of picture:
  15846. @example
  15847. zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='if(gte(zoom,1.5),x,x+1/a)':y='if(gte(zoom,1.5),y,y+1)':s=640x360
  15848. @end example
  15849. @item
  15850. Zoom in up to 1.5x and pan always at center of picture:
  15851. @example
  15852. zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
  15853. @end example
  15854. @item
  15855. Same as above but without pausing:
  15856. @example
  15857. zoompan=z='min(max(zoom,pzoom)+0.0015,1.5)':d=1:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
  15858. @end example
  15859. @item
  15860. Zoom in 2x into center of picture only for the first second of the input video:
  15861. @example
  15862. zoompan=z='if(between(in_time,0,1),2,1)':d=1:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
  15863. @end example
  15864. @end itemize
  15865. @anchor{zscale}
  15866. @section zscale
  15867. Scale (resize) the input video, using the z.lib library:
  15868. @url{https://github.com/sekrit-twc/zimg}. To enable compilation of this
  15869. filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libzimg}.
  15870. The zscale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
  15871. as the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
  15872. If the input image format is different from the format requested by
  15873. the next filter, the zscale filter will convert the input to the
  15874. requested format.
  15875. @subsection Options
  15876. The filter accepts the following options.
  15877. @table @option
  15878. @item width, w
  15879. @item height, h
  15880. Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
  15881. dimension.
  15882. If the @var{width} or @var{w} value is 0, the input width is used for
  15883. the output. If the @var{height} or @var{h} value is 0, the input height
  15884. is used for the output.
  15885. If one and only one of the values is -n with n >= 1, the zscale filter
  15886. will use a value that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image,
  15887. calculated from the other specified dimension. After that it will,
  15888. however, make sure that the calculated dimension is divisible by n and
  15889. adjust the value if necessary.
  15890. If both values are -n with n >= 1, the behavior will be identical to
  15891. both values being set to 0 as previously detailed.
  15892. See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
  15893. expression.
  15894. @item size, s
  15895. Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
  15896. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  15897. @item dither, d
  15898. Set the dither type.
  15899. Possible values are:
  15900. @table @var
  15901. @item none
  15902. @item ordered
  15903. @item random
  15904. @item error_diffusion
  15905. @end table
  15906. Default is none.
  15907. @item filter, f
  15908. Set the resize filter type.
  15909. Possible values are:
  15910. @table @var
  15911. @item point
  15912. @item bilinear
  15913. @item bicubic
  15914. @item spline16
  15915. @item spline36
  15916. @item lanczos
  15917. @end table
  15918. Default is bilinear.
  15919. @item range, r
  15920. Set the color range.
  15921. Possible values are:
  15922. @table @var
  15923. @item input
  15924. @item limited
  15925. @item full
  15926. @end table
  15927. Default is same as input.
  15928. @item primaries, p
  15929. Set the color primaries.
  15930. Possible values are:
  15931. @table @var
  15932. @item input
  15933. @item 709
  15934. @item unspecified
  15935. @item 170m
  15936. @item 240m
  15937. @item 2020
  15938. @end table
  15939. Default is same as input.
  15940. @item transfer, t
  15941. Set the transfer characteristics.
  15942. Possible values are:
  15943. @table @var
  15944. @item input
  15945. @item 709
  15946. @item unspecified
  15947. @item 601
  15948. @item linear
  15949. @item 2020_10
  15950. @item 2020_12
  15951. @item smpte2084
  15952. @item iec61966-2-1
  15953. @item arib-std-b67
  15954. @end table
  15955. Default is same as input.
  15956. @item matrix, m
  15957. Set the colorspace matrix.
  15958. Possible value are:
  15959. @table @var
  15960. @item input
  15961. @item 709
  15962. @item unspecified
  15963. @item 470bg
  15964. @item 170m
  15965. @item 2020_ncl
  15966. @item 2020_cl
  15967. @end table
  15968. Default is same as input.
  15969. @item rangein, rin
  15970. Set the input color range.
  15971. Possible values are:
  15972. @table @var
  15973. @item input
  15974. @item limited
  15975. @item full
  15976. @end table
  15977. Default is same as input.
  15978. @item primariesin, pin
  15979. Set the input color primaries.
  15980. Possible values are:
  15981. @table @var
  15982. @item input
  15983. @item 709
  15984. @item unspecified
  15985. @item 170m
  15986. @item 240m
  15987. @item 2020
  15988. @end table
  15989. Default is same as input.
  15990. @item transferin, tin
  15991. Set the input transfer characteristics.
  15992. Possible values are:
  15993. @table @var
  15994. @item input
  15995. @item 709
  15996. @item unspecified
  15997. @item 601
  15998. @item linear
  15999. @item 2020_10
  16000. @item 2020_12
  16001. @end table
  16002. Default is same as input.
  16003. @item matrixin, min
  16004. Set the input colorspace matrix.
  16005. Possible value are:
  16006. @table @var
  16007. @item input
  16008. @item 709
  16009. @item unspecified
  16010. @item 470bg
  16011. @item 170m
  16012. @item 2020_ncl
  16013. @item 2020_cl
  16014. @end table
  16015. @item chromal, c
  16016. Set the output chroma location.
  16017. Possible values are:
  16018. @table @var
  16019. @item input
  16020. @item left
  16021. @item center
  16022. @item topleft
  16023. @item top
  16024. @item bottomleft
  16025. @item bottom
  16026. @end table
  16027. @item chromalin, cin
  16028. Set the input chroma location.
  16029. Possible values are:
  16030. @table @var
  16031. @item input
  16032. @item left
  16033. @item center
  16034. @item topleft
  16035. @item top
  16036. @item bottomleft
  16037. @item bottom
  16038. @end table
  16039. @item npl
  16040. Set the nominal peak luminance.
  16041. @end table
  16042. The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
  16043. containing the following constants:
  16044. @table @var
  16045. @item in_w
  16046. @item in_h
  16047. The input width and height
  16048. @item iw
  16049. @item ih
  16050. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  16051. @item out_w
  16052. @item out_h
  16053. The output (scaled) width and height
  16054. @item ow
  16055. @item oh
  16056. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
  16057. @item a
  16058. The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  16059. @item sar
  16060. input sample aspect ratio
  16061. @item dar
  16062. The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
  16063. @item hsub
  16064. @item vsub
  16065. horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
  16066. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  16067. @item ohsub
  16068. @item ovsub
  16069. horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
  16070. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  16071. @end table
  16072. @subsection Commands
  16073. This filter supports the following commands:
  16074. @table @option
  16075. @item width, w
  16076. @item height, h
  16077. Set the output video dimension expression.
  16078. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  16079. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  16080. value.
  16081. @end table
  16082. @c man end VIDEO FILTERS
  16083. @chapter OpenCL Video Filters
  16084. @c man begin OPENCL VIDEO FILTERS
  16085. Below is a description of the currently available OpenCL video filters.
  16086. To enable compilation of these filters you need to configure FFmpeg with
  16087. @code{--enable-opencl}.
  16088. Running OpenCL filters requires you to initialize a hardware device and to pass that device to all filters in any filter graph.
  16089. @table @option
  16090. @item -init_hw_device opencl[=@var{name}][:@var{device}[,@var{key=value}...]]
  16091. Initialise a new hardware device of type @var{opencl} called @var{name}, using the
  16092. given device parameters.
  16093. @item -filter_hw_device @var{name}
  16094. Pass the hardware device called @var{name} to all filters in any filter graph.
  16095. @end table
  16096. For more detailed information see @url{https://www.ffmpeg.org/ffmpeg.html#Advanced-Video-options}
  16097. @itemize
  16098. @item
  16099. Example of choosing the first device on the second platform and running avgblur_opencl filter with default parameters on it.
  16100. @example
  16101. -init_hw_device opencl=gpu:1.0 -filter_hw_device gpu -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, avgblur_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16102. @end example
  16103. @end itemize
  16104. Since OpenCL filters are not able to access frame data in normal memory, all frame data needs to be uploaded(@ref{hwupload}) to hardware surfaces connected to the appropriate device before being used and then downloaded(@ref{hwdownload}) back to normal memory. Note that @ref{hwupload} will upload to a surface with the same layout as the software frame, so it may be necessary to add a @ref{format} filter immediately before to get the input into the right format and @ref{hwdownload} does not support all formats on the output - it may be necessary to insert an additional @ref{format} filter immediately following in the graph to get the output in a supported format.
  16105. @section avgblur_opencl
  16106. Apply average blur filter.
  16107. The filter accepts the following options:
  16108. @table @option
  16109. @item sizeX
  16110. Set horizontal radius size.
  16111. Range is @code{[1, 1024]} and default value is @code{1}.
  16112. @item planes
  16113. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  16114. @item sizeY
  16115. Set vertical radius size. Range is @code{[1, 1024]} and default value is @code{0}. If zero, @code{sizeX} value will be used.
  16116. @end table
  16117. @subsection Example
  16118. @itemize
  16119. @item
  16120. Apply average blur filter with horizontal and vertical size of 3, setting each pixel of the output to the average value of the 7x7 region centered on it in the input. For pixels on the edges of the image, the region does not extend beyond the image boundaries, and so out-of-range coordinates are not used in the calculations.
  16121. @example
  16122. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, avgblur_opencl=3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16123. @end example
  16124. @end itemize
  16125. @section boxblur_opencl
  16126. Apply a boxblur algorithm to the input video.
  16127. It accepts the following parameters:
  16128. @table @option
  16129. @item luma_radius, lr
  16130. @item luma_power, lp
  16131. @item chroma_radius, cr
  16132. @item chroma_power, cp
  16133. @item alpha_radius, ar
  16134. @item alpha_power, ap
  16135. @end table
  16136. A description of the accepted options follows.
  16137. @table @option
  16138. @item luma_radius, lr
  16139. @item chroma_radius, cr
  16140. @item alpha_radius, ar
  16141. Set an expression for the box radius in pixels used for blurring the
  16142. corresponding input plane.
  16143. The radius value must be a non-negative number, and must not be
  16144. greater than the value of the expression @code{min(w,h)/2} for the
  16145. luma and alpha planes, and of @code{min(cw,ch)/2} for the chroma
  16146. planes.
  16147. Default value for @option{luma_radius} is "2". If not specified,
  16148. @option{chroma_radius} and @option{alpha_radius} default to the
  16149. corresponding value set for @option{luma_radius}.
  16150. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  16151. @table @option
  16152. @item w
  16153. @item h
  16154. The input width and height in pixels.
  16155. @item cw
  16156. @item ch
  16157. The input chroma image width and height in pixels.
  16158. @item hsub
  16159. @item vsub
  16160. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  16161. pixel format "yuv422p", @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  16162. @end table
  16163. @item luma_power, lp
  16164. @item chroma_power, cp
  16165. @item alpha_power, ap
  16166. Specify how many times the boxblur filter is applied to the
  16167. corresponding plane.
  16168. Default value for @option{luma_power} is 2. If not specified,
  16169. @option{chroma_power} and @option{alpha_power} default to the
  16170. corresponding value set for @option{luma_power}.
  16171. A value of 0 will disable the effect.
  16172. @end table
  16173. @subsection Examples
  16174. Apply boxblur filter, setting each pixel of the output to the average value of box-radiuses @var{luma_radius}, @var{chroma_radius}, @var{alpha_radius} for each plane respectively. The filter will apply @var{luma_power}, @var{chroma_power}, @var{alpha_power} times onto the corresponding plane. For pixels on the edges of the image, the radius does not extend beyond the image boundaries, and so out-of-range coordinates are not used in the calculations.
  16175. @itemize
  16176. @item
  16177. Apply a boxblur filter with the luma, chroma, and alpha radius
  16178. set to 2 and luma, chroma, and alpha power set to 3. The filter will run 3 times with box-radius set to 2 for every plane of the image.
  16179. @example
  16180. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=luma_radius=2:luma_power=3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16181. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=2:3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16182. @end example
  16183. @item
  16184. Apply a boxblur filter with luma radius set to 2, luma_power to 1, chroma_radius to 4, chroma_power to 5, alpha_radius to 3 and alpha_power to 7.
  16185. For the luma plane, a 2x2 box radius will be run once.
  16186. For the chroma plane, a 4x4 box radius will be run 5 times.
  16187. For the alpha plane, a 3x3 box radius will be run 7 times.
  16188. @example
  16189. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=2:1:4:5:3:7, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16190. @end example
  16191. @end itemize
  16192. @section colorkey_opencl
  16193. RGB colorspace color keying.
  16194. The filter accepts the following options:
  16195. @table @option
  16196. @item color
  16197. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  16198. @item similarity
  16199. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  16200. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  16201. @item blend
  16202. Blend percentage.
  16203. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  16204. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  16205. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  16206. @end table
  16207. @subsection Examples
  16208. @itemize
  16209. @item
  16210. Make every semi-green pixel in the input transparent with some slight blending:
  16211. @example
  16212. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, colorkey_opencl=green:0.3:0.1, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16213. @end example
  16214. @end itemize
  16215. @section convolution_opencl
  16216. Apply convolution of 3x3, 5x5, 7x7 matrix.
  16217. The filter accepts the following options:
  16218. @table @option
  16219. @item 0m
  16220. @item 1m
  16221. @item 2m
  16222. @item 3m
  16223. Set matrix for each plane.
  16224. Matrix is sequence of 9, 25 or 49 signed numbers.
  16225. Default value for each plane is @code{0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0}.
  16226. @item 0rdiv
  16227. @item 1rdiv
  16228. @item 2rdiv
  16229. @item 3rdiv
  16230. Set multiplier for calculated value for each plane.
  16231. If unset or 0, it will be sum of all matrix elements.
  16232. The option value must be a float number greater or equal to @code{0.0}. Default value is @code{1.0}.
  16233. @item 0bias
  16234. @item 1bias
  16235. @item 2bias
  16236. @item 3bias
  16237. Set bias for each plane. This value is added to the result of the multiplication.
  16238. Useful for making the overall image brighter or darker.
  16239. The option value must be a float number greater or equal to @code{0.0}. Default value is @code{0.0}.
  16240. @end table
  16241. @subsection Examples
  16242. @itemize
  16243. @item
  16244. Apply sharpen:
  16245. @example
  16246. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16247. @end example
  16248. @item
  16249. Apply blur:
  16250. @example
  16251. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1/9:1/9:1/9:1/9, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16252. @end example
  16253. @item
  16254. Apply edge enhance:
  16255. @example
  16256. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:5:1:1:1:0:128:128:128, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16257. @end example
  16258. @item
  16259. Apply edge detect:
  16260. @example
  16261. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:128, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16262. @end example
  16263. @item
  16264. Apply laplacian edge detector which includes diagonals:
  16265. @example
  16266. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:0, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16267. @end example
  16268. @item
  16269. Apply emboss:
  16270. @example
  16271. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16272. @end example
  16273. @end itemize
  16274. @section erosion_opencl
  16275. Apply erosion effect to the video.
  16276. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) minimum.
  16277. It accepts the following options:
  16278. @table @option
  16279. @item threshold0
  16280. @item threshold1
  16281. @item threshold2
  16282. @item threshold3
  16283. Limit the maximum change for each plane. Range is @code{[0, 65535]} and default value is @code{65535}.
  16284. If @code{0}, plane will remain unchanged.
  16285. @item coordinates
  16286. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to.
  16287. Range is @code{[0, 255]} and default value is @code{255}, i.e. all eight pixels are used.
  16288. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates region centered on @code{x}:
  16289. 1 2 3
  16290. 4 x 5
  16291. 6 7 8
  16292. @end table
  16293. @subsection Example
  16294. @itemize
  16295. @item
  16296. Apply erosion filter with threshold0 set to 30, threshold1 set 40, threshold2 set to 50 and coordinates set to 231, setting each pixel of the output to the local minimum between pixels: 1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 8 of the 3x3 region centered on it in the input. If the difference between input pixel and local minimum is more then threshold of the corresponding plane, output pixel will be set to input pixel - threshold of corresponding plane.
  16297. @example
  16298. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, erosion_opencl=30:40:50:coordinates=231, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16299. @end example
  16300. @end itemize
  16301. @section deshake_opencl
  16302. Feature-point based video stabilization filter.
  16303. The filter accepts the following options:
  16304. @table @option
  16305. @item tripod
  16306. Simulates a tripod by preventing any camera movement whatsoever from the original frame. Defaults to @code{0}.
  16307. @item debug
  16308. Whether or not additional debug info should be displayed, both in the processed output and in the console.
  16309. Note that in order to see console debug output you will also need to pass @code{-v verbose} to ffmpeg.
  16310. Viewing point matches in the output video is only supported for RGB input.
  16311. Defaults to @code{0}.
  16312. @item adaptive_crop
  16313. Whether or not to do a tiny bit of cropping at the borders to cut down on the amount of mirrored pixels.
  16314. Defaults to @code{1}.
  16315. @item refine_features
  16316. Whether or not feature points should be refined at a sub-pixel level.
  16317. This can be turned off for a slight performance gain at the cost of precision.
  16318. Defaults to @code{1}.
  16319. @item smooth_strength
  16320. The strength of the smoothing applied to the camera path from @code{0.0} to @code{1.0}.
  16321. @code{1.0} is the maximum smoothing strength while values less than that result in less smoothing.
  16322. @code{0.0} causes the filter to adaptively choose a smoothing strength on a per-frame basis.
  16323. Defaults to @code{0.0}.
  16324. @item smooth_window_multiplier
  16325. Controls the size of the smoothing window (the number of frames buffered to determine motion information from).
  16326. The size of the smoothing window is determined by multiplying the framerate of the video by this number.
  16327. Acceptable values range from @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}.
  16328. Larger values increase the amount of motion data available for determining how to smooth the camera path,
  16329. potentially improving smoothness, but also increase latency and memory usage.
  16330. Defaults to @code{2.0}.
  16331. @end table
  16332. @subsection Examples
  16333. @itemize
  16334. @item
  16335. Stabilize a video with a fixed, medium smoothing strength:
  16336. @example
  16337. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, deshake_opencl=smooth_strength=0.5, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16338. @end example
  16339. @item
  16340. Stabilize a video with debugging (both in console and in rendered video):
  16341. @example
  16342. -i INPUT -filter_complex "[0:v]format=rgba, hwupload, deshake_opencl=debug=1, hwdownload, format=rgba, format=yuv420p" -v verbose OUTPUT
  16343. @end example
  16344. @end itemize
  16345. @section dilation_opencl
  16346. Apply dilation effect to the video.
  16347. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) maximum.
  16348. It accepts the following options:
  16349. @table @option
  16350. @item threshold0
  16351. @item threshold1
  16352. @item threshold2
  16353. @item threshold3
  16354. Limit the maximum change for each plane. Range is @code{[0, 65535]} and default value is @code{65535}.
  16355. If @code{0}, plane will remain unchanged.
  16356. @item coordinates
  16357. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to.
  16358. Range is @code{[0, 255]} and default value is @code{255}, i.e. all eight pixels are used.
  16359. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates region centered on @code{x}:
  16360. 1 2 3
  16361. 4 x 5
  16362. 6 7 8
  16363. @end table
  16364. @subsection Example
  16365. @itemize
  16366. @item
  16367. Apply dilation filter with threshold0 set to 30, threshold1 set 40, threshold2 set to 50 and coordinates set to 231, setting each pixel of the output to the local maximum between pixels: 1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 8 of the 3x3 region centered on it in the input. If the difference between input pixel and local maximum is more then threshold of the corresponding plane, output pixel will be set to input pixel + threshold of corresponding plane.
  16368. @example
  16369. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, dilation_opencl=30:40:50:coordinates=231, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16370. @end example
  16371. @end itemize
  16372. @section nlmeans_opencl
  16373. Non-local Means denoise filter through OpenCL, this filter accepts same options as @ref{nlmeans}.
  16374. @section overlay_opencl
  16375. Overlay one video on top of another.
  16376. It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main" video on which the second input is overlaid.
  16377. This filter requires same memory layout for all the inputs. So, format conversion may be needed.
  16378. The filter accepts the following options:
  16379. @table @option
  16380. @item x
  16381. Set the x coordinate of the overlaid video on the main video.
  16382. Default value is @code{0}.
  16383. @item y
  16384. Set the y coordinate of the overlaid video on the main video.
  16385. Default value is @code{0}.
  16386. @end table
  16387. @subsection Examples
  16388. @itemize
  16389. @item
  16390. Overlay an image LOGO at the top-left corner of the INPUT video. Both inputs are yuv420p format.
  16391. @example
  16392. -i INPUT -i LOGO -filter_complex "[0:v]hwupload[a], [1:v]format=yuv420p, hwupload[b], [a][b]overlay_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16393. @end example
  16394. @item
  16395. The inputs have same memory layout for color channels , the overlay has additional alpha plane, like INPUT is yuv420p, and the LOGO is yuva420p.
  16396. @example
  16397. -i INPUT -i LOGO -filter_complex "[0:v]hwupload[a], [1:v]format=yuva420p, hwupload[b], [a][b]overlay_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16398. @end example
  16399. @end itemize
  16400. @section pad_opencl
  16401. Add paddings to the input image, and place the original input at the
  16402. provided @var{x}, @var{y} coordinates.
  16403. It accepts the following options:
  16404. @table @option
  16405. @item width, w
  16406. @item height, h
  16407. Specify an expression for the size of the output image with the
  16408. paddings added. If the value for @var{width} or @var{height} is 0, the
  16409. corresponding input size is used for the output.
  16410. The @var{width} expression can reference the value set by the
  16411. @var{height} expression, and vice versa.
  16412. The default value of @var{width} and @var{height} is 0.
  16413. @item x
  16414. @item y
  16415. Specify the offsets to place the input image at within the padded area,
  16416. with respect to the top/left border of the output image.
  16417. The @var{x} expression can reference the value set by the @var{y}
  16418. expression, and vice versa.
  16419. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is 0.
  16420. If @var{x} or @var{y} evaluate to a negative number, they'll be changed
  16421. so the input image is centered on the padded area.
  16422. @item color
  16423. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  16424. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  16425. manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16426. @item aspect
  16427. Pad to an aspect instead to a resolution.
  16428. @end table
  16429. The value for the @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x}, and @var{y}
  16430. options are expressions containing the following constants:
  16431. @table @option
  16432. @item in_w
  16433. @item in_h
  16434. The input video width and height.
  16435. @item iw
  16436. @item ih
  16437. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  16438. @item out_w
  16439. @item out_h
  16440. The output width and height (the size of the padded area), as
  16441. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions.
  16442. @item ow
  16443. @item oh
  16444. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  16445. @item x
  16446. @item y
  16447. The x and y offsets as specified by the @var{x} and @var{y}
  16448. expressions, or NAN if not yet specified.
  16449. @item a
  16450. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  16451. @item sar
  16452. input sample aspect ratio
  16453. @item dar
  16454. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  16455. @end table
  16456. @section prewitt_opencl
  16457. Apply the Prewitt operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Prewitt_operator}) to input video stream.
  16458. The filter accepts the following option:
  16459. @table @option
  16460. @item planes
  16461. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  16462. @item scale
  16463. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  16464. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  16465. @item delta
  16466. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  16467. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  16468. @end table
  16469. @subsection Example
  16470. @itemize
  16471. @item
  16472. Apply the Prewitt operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10.
  16473. @example
  16474. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, prewitt_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16475. @end example
  16476. @end itemize
  16477. @anchor{program_opencl}
  16478. @section program_opencl
  16479. Filter video using an OpenCL program.
  16480. @table @option
  16481. @item source
  16482. OpenCL program source file.
  16483. @item kernel
  16484. Kernel name in program.
  16485. @item inputs
  16486. Number of inputs to the filter. Defaults to 1.
  16487. @item size, s
  16488. Size of output frames. Defaults to the same as the first input.
  16489. @end table
  16490. The @code{program_opencl} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  16491. The program source file must contain a kernel function with the given name,
  16492. which will be run once for each plane of the output. Each run on a plane
  16493. gets enqueued as a separate 2D global NDRange with one work-item for each
  16494. pixel to be generated. The global ID offset for each work-item is therefore
  16495. the coordinates of a pixel in the destination image.
  16496. The kernel function needs to take the following arguments:
  16497. @itemize
  16498. @item
  16499. Destination image, @var{__write_only image2d_t}.
  16500. This image will become the output; the kernel should write all of it.
  16501. @item
  16502. Frame index, @var{unsigned int}.
  16503. This is a counter starting from zero and increasing by one for each frame.
  16504. @item
  16505. Source images, @var{__read_only image2d_t}.
  16506. These are the most recent images on each input. The kernel may read from
  16507. them to generate the output, but they can't be written to.
  16508. @end itemize
  16509. Example programs:
  16510. @itemize
  16511. @item
  16512. Copy the input to the output (output must be the same size as the input).
  16513. @verbatim
  16514. __kernel void copy(__write_only image2d_t destination,
  16515. unsigned int index,
  16516. __read_only image2d_t source)
  16517. {
  16518. const sampler_t sampler = CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE;
  16519. int2 location = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16520. float4 value = read_imagef(source, sampler, location);
  16521. write_imagef(destination, location, value);
  16522. }
  16523. @end verbatim
  16524. @item
  16525. Apply a simple transformation, rotating the input by an amount increasing
  16526. with the index counter. Pixel values are linearly interpolated by the
  16527. sampler, and the output need not have the same dimensions as the input.
  16528. @verbatim
  16529. __kernel void rotate_image(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  16530. unsigned int index,
  16531. __read_only image2d_t src)
  16532. {
  16533. const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
  16534. CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);
  16535. float angle = (float)index / 100.0f;
  16536. float2 dst_dim = convert_float2(get_image_dim(dst));
  16537. float2 src_dim = convert_float2(get_image_dim(src));
  16538. float2 dst_cen = dst_dim / 2.0f;
  16539. float2 src_cen = src_dim / 2.0f;
  16540. int2 dst_loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16541. float2 dst_pos = convert_float2(dst_loc) - dst_cen;
  16542. float2 src_pos = {
  16543. cos(angle) * dst_pos.x - sin(angle) * dst_pos.y,
  16544. sin(angle) * dst_pos.x + cos(angle) * dst_pos.y
  16545. };
  16546. src_pos = src_pos * src_dim / dst_dim;
  16547. float2 src_loc = src_pos + src_cen;
  16548. if (src_loc.x < 0.0f || src_loc.y < 0.0f ||
  16549. src_loc.x > src_dim.x || src_loc.y > src_dim.y)
  16550. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, 0.5f);
  16551. else
  16552. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, read_imagef(src, sampler, src_loc));
  16553. }
  16554. @end verbatim
  16555. @item
  16556. Blend two inputs together, with the amount of each input used varying
  16557. with the index counter.
  16558. @verbatim
  16559. __kernel void blend_images(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  16560. unsigned int index,
  16561. __read_only image2d_t src1,
  16562. __read_only image2d_t src2)
  16563. {
  16564. const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
  16565. CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);
  16566. float blend = (cos((float)index / 50.0f) + 1.0f) / 2.0f;
  16567. int2 dst_loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16568. int2 src1_loc = dst_loc * get_image_dim(src1) / get_image_dim(dst);
  16569. int2 src2_loc = dst_loc * get_image_dim(src2) / get_image_dim(dst);
  16570. float4 val1 = read_imagef(src1, sampler, src1_loc);
  16571. float4 val2 = read_imagef(src2, sampler, src2_loc);
  16572. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, val1 * blend + val2 * (1.0f - blend));
  16573. }
  16574. @end verbatim
  16575. @end itemize
  16576. @section roberts_opencl
  16577. Apply the Roberts cross operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Roberts_cross}) to input video stream.
  16578. The filter accepts the following option:
  16579. @table @option
  16580. @item planes
  16581. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  16582. @item scale
  16583. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  16584. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  16585. @item delta
  16586. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  16587. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  16588. @end table
  16589. @subsection Example
  16590. @itemize
  16591. @item
  16592. Apply the Roberts cross operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10
  16593. @example
  16594. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, roberts_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16595. @end example
  16596. @end itemize
  16597. @section sobel_opencl
  16598. Apply the Sobel operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Sobel_operator}) to input video stream.
  16599. The filter accepts the following option:
  16600. @table @option
  16601. @item planes
  16602. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  16603. @item scale
  16604. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  16605. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  16606. @item delta
  16607. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  16608. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  16609. @end table
  16610. @subsection Example
  16611. @itemize
  16612. @item
  16613. Apply sobel operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10
  16614. @example
  16615. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, sobel_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16616. @end example
  16617. @end itemize
  16618. @section tonemap_opencl
  16619. Perform HDR(PQ/HLG) to SDR conversion with tone-mapping.
  16620. It accepts the following parameters:
  16621. @table @option
  16622. @item tonemap
  16623. Specify the tone-mapping operator to be used. Same as tonemap option in @ref{tonemap}.
  16624. @item param
  16625. Tune the tone mapping algorithm. same as param option in @ref{tonemap}.
  16626. @item desat
  16627. Apply desaturation for highlights that exceed this level of brightness. The
  16628. higher the parameter, the more color information will be preserved. This
  16629. setting helps prevent unnaturally blown-out colors for super-highlights, by
  16630. (smoothly) turning into white instead. This makes images feel more natural,
  16631. at the cost of reducing information about out-of-range colors.
  16632. The default value is 0.5, and the algorithm here is a little different from
  16633. the cpu version tonemap currently. A setting of 0.0 disables this option.
  16634. @item threshold
  16635. The tonemapping algorithm parameters is fine-tuned per each scene. And a threshold
  16636. is used to detect whether the scene has changed or not. If the distance between
  16637. the current frame average brightness and the current running average exceeds
  16638. a threshold value, we would re-calculate scene average and peak brightness.
  16639. The default value is 0.2.
  16640. @item format
  16641. Specify the output pixel format.
  16642. Currently supported formats are:
  16643. @table @var
  16644. @item p010
  16645. @item nv12
  16646. @end table
  16647. @item range, r
  16648. Set the output color range.
  16649. Possible values are:
  16650. @table @var
  16651. @item tv/mpeg
  16652. @item pc/jpeg
  16653. @end table
  16654. Default is same as input.
  16655. @item primaries, p
  16656. Set the output color primaries.
  16657. Possible values are:
  16658. @table @var
  16659. @item bt709
  16660. @item bt2020
  16661. @end table
  16662. Default is same as input.
  16663. @item transfer, t
  16664. Set the output transfer characteristics.
  16665. Possible values are:
  16666. @table @var
  16667. @item bt709
  16668. @item bt2020
  16669. @end table
  16670. Default is bt709.
  16671. @item matrix, m
  16672. Set the output colorspace matrix.
  16673. Possible value are:
  16674. @table @var
  16675. @item bt709
  16676. @item bt2020
  16677. @end table
  16678. Default is same as input.
  16679. @end table
  16680. @subsection Example
  16681. @itemize
  16682. @item
  16683. Convert HDR(PQ/HLG) video to bt2020-transfer-characteristic p010 format using linear operator.
  16684. @example
  16685. -i INPUT -vf "format=p010,hwupload,tonemap_opencl=t=bt2020:tonemap=linear:format=p010,hwdownload,format=p010" OUTPUT
  16686. @end example
  16687. @end itemize
  16688. @section unsharp_opencl
  16689. Sharpen or blur the input video.
  16690. It accepts the following parameters:
  16691. @table @option
  16692. @item luma_msize_x, lx
  16693. Set the luma matrix horizontal size.
  16694. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  16695. @item luma_msize_y, ly
  16696. Set the luma matrix vertical size.
  16697. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  16698. @item luma_amount, la
  16699. Set the luma effect strength.
  16700. Range is @code{[-10, 10]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  16701. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  16702. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  16703. @item chroma_msize_x, cx
  16704. Set the chroma matrix horizontal size.
  16705. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  16706. @item chroma_msize_y, cy
  16707. Set the chroma matrix vertical size.
  16708. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  16709. @item chroma_amount, ca
  16710. Set the chroma effect strength.
  16711. Range is @code{[-10, 10]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  16712. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  16713. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  16714. @end table
  16715. All parameters are optional and default to the equivalent of the
  16716. string '5:5:1.0:5:5:0.0'.
  16717. @subsection Examples
  16718. @itemize
  16719. @item
  16720. Apply strong luma sharpen effect:
  16721. @example
  16722. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, unsharp_opencl=luma_msize_x=7:luma_msize_y=7:luma_amount=2.5, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16723. @end example
  16724. @item
  16725. Apply a strong blur of both luma and chroma parameters:
  16726. @example
  16727. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, unsharp_opencl=7:7:-2:7:7:-2, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16728. @end example
  16729. @end itemize
  16730. @section xfade_opencl
  16731. Cross fade two videos with custom transition effect by using OpenCL.
  16732. It accepts the following options:
  16733. @table @option
  16734. @item transition
  16735. Set one of possible transition effects.
  16736. @table @option
  16737. @item custom
  16738. Select custom transition effect, the actual transition description
  16739. will be picked from source and kernel options.
  16740. @item fade
  16741. @item wipeleft
  16742. @item wiperight
  16743. @item wipeup
  16744. @item wipedown
  16745. @item slideleft
  16746. @item slideright
  16747. @item slideup
  16748. @item slidedown
  16749. Default transition is fade.
  16750. @end table
  16751. @item source
  16752. OpenCL program source file for custom transition.
  16753. @item kernel
  16754. Set name of kernel to use for custom transition from program source file.
  16755. @item duration
  16756. Set duration of video transition.
  16757. @item offset
  16758. Set time of start of transition relative to first video.
  16759. @end table
  16760. The program source file must contain a kernel function with the given name,
  16761. which will be run once for each plane of the output. Each run on a plane
  16762. gets enqueued as a separate 2D global NDRange with one work-item for each
  16763. pixel to be generated. The global ID offset for each work-item is therefore
  16764. the coordinates of a pixel in the destination image.
  16765. The kernel function needs to take the following arguments:
  16766. @itemize
  16767. @item
  16768. Destination image, @var{__write_only image2d_t}.
  16769. This image will become the output; the kernel should write all of it.
  16770. @item
  16771. First Source image, @var{__read_only image2d_t}.
  16772. Second Source image, @var{__read_only image2d_t}.
  16773. These are the most recent images on each input. The kernel may read from
  16774. them to generate the output, but they can't be written to.
  16775. @item
  16776. Transition progress, @var{float}. This value is always between 0 and 1 inclusive.
  16777. @end itemize
  16778. Example programs:
  16779. @itemize
  16780. @item
  16781. Apply dots curtain transition effect:
  16782. @verbatim
  16783. __kernel void blend_images(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  16784. __read_only image2d_t src1,
  16785. __read_only image2d_t src2,
  16786. float progress)
  16787. {
  16788. const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
  16789. CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);
  16790. int2 p = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16791. float2 rp = (float2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16792. float2 dim = (float2)(get_image_dim(src1).x, get_image_dim(src1).y);
  16793. rp = rp / dim;
  16794. float2 dots = (float2)(20.0, 20.0);
  16795. float2 center = (float2)(0,0);
  16796. float2 unused;
  16797. float4 val1 = read_imagef(src1, sampler, p);
  16798. float4 val2 = read_imagef(src2, sampler, p);
  16799. bool next = distance(fract(rp * dots, &unused), (float2)(0.5, 0.5)) < (progress / distance(rp, center));
  16800. write_imagef(dst, p, next ? val1 : val2);
  16801. }
  16802. @end verbatim
  16803. @end itemize
  16804. @c man end OPENCL VIDEO FILTERS
  16805. @chapter VAAPI Video Filters
  16806. @c man begin VAAPI VIDEO FILTERS
  16807. VAAPI Video filters are usually used with VAAPI decoder and VAAPI encoder. Below is a description of VAAPI video filters.
  16808. To enable compilation of these filters you need to configure FFmpeg with
  16809. @code{--enable-vaapi}.
  16810. To use vaapi filters, you need to setup the vaapi device correctly. For more information, please read @url{https://trac.ffmpeg.org/wiki/Hardware/VAAPI}
  16811. @section tonemap_vaapi
  16812. Perform HDR(High Dynamic Range) to SDR(Standard Dynamic Range) conversion with tone-mapping.
  16813. It maps the dynamic range of HDR10 content to the SDR content.
  16814. It currently only accepts HDR10 as input.
  16815. It accepts the following parameters:
  16816. @table @option
  16817. @item format
  16818. Specify the output pixel format.
  16819. Currently supported formats are:
  16820. @table @var
  16821. @item p010
  16822. @item nv12
  16823. @end table
  16824. Default is nv12.
  16825. @item primaries, p
  16826. Set the output color primaries.
  16827. Default is same as input.
  16828. @item transfer, t
  16829. Set the output transfer characteristics.
  16830. Default is bt709.
  16831. @item matrix, m
  16832. Set the output colorspace matrix.
  16833. Default is same as input.
  16834. @end table
  16835. @subsection Example
  16836. @itemize
  16837. @item
  16838. Convert HDR(HDR10) video to bt2020-transfer-characteristic p010 format
  16839. @example
  16840. tonemap_vaapi=format=p010:t=bt2020-10
  16841. @end example
  16842. @end itemize
  16843. @c man end VAAPI VIDEO FILTERS
  16844. @chapter Video Sources
  16845. @c man begin VIDEO SOURCES
  16846. Below is a description of the currently available video sources.
  16847. @section buffer
  16848. Buffer video frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
  16849. This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
  16850. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/vsrc_buffer.h}.
  16851. It accepts the following parameters:
  16852. @table @option
  16853. @item video_size
  16854. Specify the size (width and height) of the buffered video frames. For the
  16855. syntax of this option, check the
  16856. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16857. @item width
  16858. The input video width.
  16859. @item height
  16860. The input video height.
  16861. @item pix_fmt
  16862. A string representing the pixel format of the buffered video frames.
  16863. It may be a number corresponding to a pixel format, or a pixel format
  16864. name.
  16865. @item time_base
  16866. Specify the timebase assumed by the timestamps of the buffered frames.
  16867. @item frame_rate
  16868. Specify the frame rate expected for the video stream.
  16869. @item pixel_aspect, sar
  16870. The sample (pixel) aspect ratio of the input video.
  16871. @item sws_param
  16872. This option is deprecated and ignored. Prepend @code{sws_flags=@var{flags};}
  16873. to the filtergraph description to specify swscale flags for automatically
  16874. inserted scalers. See @ref{Filtergraph syntax}.
  16875. @item hw_frames_ctx
  16876. When using a hardware pixel format, this should be a reference to an
  16877. AVHWFramesContext describing input frames.
  16878. @end table
  16879. For example:
  16880. @example
  16881. buffer=width=320:height=240:pix_fmt=yuv410p:time_base=1/24:sar=1
  16882. @end example
  16883. will instruct the source to accept video frames with size 320x240 and
  16884. with format "yuv410p", assuming 1/24 as the timestamps timebase and
  16885. square pixels (1:1 sample aspect ratio).
  16886. Since the pixel format with name "yuv410p" corresponds to the number 6
  16887. (check the enum AVPixelFormat definition in @file{libavutil/pixfmt.h}),
  16888. this example corresponds to:
  16889. @example
  16890. buffer=size=320x240:pixfmt=6:time_base=1/24:pixel_aspect=1/1
  16891. @end example
  16892. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string, but this
  16893. syntax is deprecated:
  16894. @var{width}:@var{height}:@var{pix_fmt}:@var{time_base.num}:@var{time_base.den}:@var{pixel_aspect.num}:@var{pixel_aspect.den}
  16895. @section cellauto
  16896. Create a pattern generated by an elementary cellular automaton.
  16897. The initial state of the cellular automaton can be defined through the
  16898. @option{filename} and @option{pattern} options. If such options are
  16899. not specified an initial state is created randomly.
  16900. At each new frame a new row in the video is filled with the result of
  16901. the cellular automaton next generation. The behavior when the whole
  16902. frame is filled is defined by the @option{scroll} option.
  16903. This source accepts the following options:
  16904. @table @option
  16905. @item filename, f
  16906. Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
  16907. the specified file.
  16908. In the file, each non-whitespace character is considered an alive
  16909. cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
  16910. file will be ignored.
  16911. @item pattern, p
  16912. Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
  16913. the specified string.
  16914. Each non-whitespace character in the string is considered an alive
  16915. cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
  16916. string will be ignored.
  16917. @item rate, r
  16918. Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
  16919. Default is 25.
  16920. @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
  16921. Set the random fill ratio for the initial cellular automaton row. It
  16922. is a floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to
  16923. 1/PHI.
  16924. This option is ignored when a file or a pattern is specified.
  16925. @item random_seed, seed
  16926. Set the seed for filling randomly the initial row, must be an integer
  16927. included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
  16928. set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
  16929. effort basis.
  16930. @item rule
  16931. Set the cellular automaton rule, it is a number ranging from 0 to 255.
  16932. Default value is 110.
  16933. @item size, s
  16934. Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16935. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16936. If @option{filename} or @option{pattern} is specified, the size is set
  16937. by default to the width of the specified initial state row, and the
  16938. height is set to @var{width} * PHI.
  16939. If @option{size} is set, it must contain the width of the specified
  16940. pattern string, and the specified pattern will be centered in the
  16941. larger row.
  16942. If a filename or a pattern string is not specified, the size value
  16943. defaults to "320x518" (used for a randomly generated initial state).
  16944. @item scroll
  16945. If set to 1, scroll the output upward when all the rows in the output
  16946. have been already filled. If set to 0, the new generated row will be
  16947. written over the top row just after the bottom row is filled.
  16948. Defaults to 1.
  16949. @item start_full, full
  16950. If set to 1, completely fill the output with generated rows before
  16951. outputting the first frame.
  16952. This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
  16953. @item stitch
  16954. If set to 1, stitch the left and right row edges together.
  16955. This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
  16956. @end table
  16957. @subsection Examples
  16958. @itemize
  16959. @item
  16960. Read the initial state from @file{pattern}, and specify an output of
  16961. size 200x400.
  16962. @example
  16963. cellauto=f=pattern:s=200x400
  16964. @end example
  16965. @item
  16966. Generate a random initial row with a width of 200 cells, with a fill
  16967. ratio of 2/3:
  16968. @example
  16969. cellauto=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
  16970. @end example
  16971. @item
  16972. Create a pattern generated by rule 18 starting by a single alive cell
  16973. centered on an initial row with width 100:
  16974. @example
  16975. cellauto=p=@@:s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
  16976. @end example
  16977. @item
  16978. Specify a more elaborated initial pattern:
  16979. @example
  16980. cellauto=p='@@@@ @@ @@@@':s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
  16981. @end example
  16982. @end itemize
  16983. @anchor{coreimagesrc}
  16984. @section coreimagesrc
  16985. Video source generated on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.
  16986. This video source is a specialized version of the @ref{coreimage} video filter.
  16987. Use a core image generator at the beginning of the applied filterchain to
  16988. generate the content.
  16989. The coreimagesrc video source accepts the following options:
  16990. @table @option
  16991. @item list_generators
  16992. List all available generators along with all their respective options as well as
  16993. possible minimum and maximum values along with the default values.
  16994. @example
  16995. list_generators=true
  16996. @end example
  16997. @item size, s
  16998. Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16999. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17000. The default value is @code{320x240}.
  17001. @item rate, r
  17002. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  17003. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  17004. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  17005. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  17006. "25".
  17007. @item sar
  17008. Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
  17009. @item duration, d
  17010. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  17011. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  17012. for the accepted syntax.
  17013. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  17014. supposed to be generated forever.
  17015. @end table
  17016. Additionally, all options of the @ref{coreimage} video filter are accepted.
  17017. A complete filterchain can be used for further processing of the
  17018. generated input without CPU-HOST transfer. See @ref{coreimage} documentation
  17019. and examples for details.
  17020. @subsection Examples
  17021. @itemize
  17022. @item
  17023. Use CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage,
  17024. given as complete and escaped command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:
  17025. @example
  17026. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i coreimagesrc=s=100x100:filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png
  17027. @end example
  17028. This example is equivalent to the QRCode example of @ref{coreimage} without the
  17029. need for a nullsrc video source.
  17030. @end itemize
  17031. @section gradients
  17032. Generate several gradients.
  17033. @table @option
  17034. @item size, s
  17035. Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video
  17036. size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. Default value is "640x480".
  17037. @item rate, r
  17038. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  17039. value is "25".
  17040. @item c0, c1, c2, c3, c4, c5, c6, c7
  17041. Set 8 colors. Default values for colors is to pick random one.
  17042. @item x0, y0, y0, y1
  17043. Set gradient line source and destination points. If negative or out of range, random ones
  17044. are picked.
  17045. @item nb_colors, n
  17046. Set number of colors to use at once. Allowed range is from 2 to 8. Default value is 2.
  17047. @item seed
  17048. Set seed for picking gradient line points.
  17049. @end table
  17050. @section mandelbrot
  17051. Generate a Mandelbrot set fractal, and progressively zoom towards the
  17052. point specified with @var{start_x} and @var{start_y}.
  17053. This source accepts the following options:
  17054. @table @option
  17055. @item end_pts
  17056. Set the terminal pts value. Default value is 400.
  17057. @item end_scale
  17058. Set the terminal scale value.
  17059. Must be a floating point value. Default value is 0.3.
  17060. @item inner
  17061. Set the inner coloring mode, that is the algorithm used to draw the
  17062. Mandelbrot fractal internal region.
  17063. It shall assume one of the following values:
  17064. @table @option
  17065. @item black
  17066. Set black mode.
  17067. @item convergence
  17068. Show time until convergence.
  17069. @item mincol
  17070. Set color based on point closest to the origin of the iterations.
  17071. @item period
  17072. Set period mode.
  17073. @end table
  17074. Default value is @var{mincol}.
  17075. @item bailout
  17076. Set the bailout value. Default value is 10.0.
  17077. @item maxiter
  17078. Set the maximum of iterations performed by the rendering
  17079. algorithm. Default value is 7189.
  17080. @item outer
  17081. Set outer coloring mode.
  17082. It shall assume one of following values:
  17083. @table @option
  17084. @item iteration_count
  17085. Set iteration count mode.
  17086. @item normalized_iteration_count
  17087. set normalized iteration count mode.
  17088. @end table
  17089. Default value is @var{normalized_iteration_count}.
  17090. @item rate, r
  17091. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  17092. value is "25".
  17093. @item size, s
  17094. Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video
  17095. size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. Default value is "640x480".
  17096. @item start_scale
  17097. Set the initial scale value. Default value is 3.0.
  17098. @item start_x
  17099. Set the initial x position. Must be a floating point value between
  17100. -100 and 100. Default value is -0.743643887037158704752191506114774.
  17101. @item start_y
  17102. Set the initial y position. Must be a floating point value between
  17103. -100 and 100. Default value is -0.131825904205311970493132056385139.
  17104. @end table
  17105. @section mptestsrc
  17106. Generate various test patterns, as generated by the MPlayer test filter.
  17107. The size of the generated video is fixed, and is 256x256.
  17108. This source is useful in particular for testing encoding features.
  17109. This source accepts the following options:
  17110. @table @option
  17111. @item rate, r
  17112. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  17113. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  17114. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  17115. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  17116. "25".
  17117. @item duration, d
  17118. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  17119. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  17120. for the accepted syntax.
  17121. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  17122. supposed to be generated forever.
  17123. @item test, t
  17124. Set the number or the name of the test to perform. Supported tests are:
  17125. @table @option
  17126. @item dc_luma
  17127. @item dc_chroma
  17128. @item freq_luma
  17129. @item freq_chroma
  17130. @item amp_luma
  17131. @item amp_chroma
  17132. @item cbp
  17133. @item mv
  17134. @item ring1
  17135. @item ring2
  17136. @item all
  17137. @item max_frames, m
  17138. Set the maximum number of frames generated for each test, default value is 30.
  17139. @end table
  17140. Default value is "all", which will cycle through the list of all tests.
  17141. @end table
  17142. Some examples:
  17143. @example
  17144. mptestsrc=t=dc_luma
  17145. @end example
  17146. will generate a "dc_luma" test pattern.
  17147. @section frei0r_src
  17148. Provide a frei0r source.
  17149. To enable compilation of this filter you need to install the frei0r
  17150. header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
  17151. This source accepts the following parameters:
  17152. @table @option
  17153. @item size
  17154. The size of the video to generate. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17155. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17156. @item framerate
  17157. The framerate of the generated video. It may be a string of the form
  17158. @var{num}/@var{den} or a frame rate abbreviation.
  17159. @item filter_name
  17160. The name to the frei0r source to load. For more information regarding frei0r and
  17161. how to set the parameters, read the @ref{frei0r} section in the video filters
  17162. documentation.
  17163. @item filter_params
  17164. A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r source.
  17165. @end table
  17166. For example, to generate a frei0r partik0l source with size 200x200
  17167. and frame rate 10 which is overlaid on the overlay filter main input:
  17168. @example
  17169. frei0r_src=size=200x200:framerate=10:filter_name=partik0l:filter_params=1234 [overlay]; [in][overlay] overlay
  17170. @end example
  17171. @section life
  17172. Generate a life pattern.
  17173. This source is based on a generalization of John Conway's life game.
  17174. The sourced input represents a life grid, each pixel represents a cell
  17175. which can be in one of two possible states, alive or dead. Every cell
  17176. interacts with its eight neighbours, which are the cells that are
  17177. horizontally, vertically, or diagonally adjacent.
  17178. At each interaction the grid evolves according to the adopted rule,
  17179. which specifies the number of neighbor alive cells which will make a
  17180. cell stay alive or born. The @option{rule} option allows one to specify
  17181. the rule to adopt.
  17182. This source accepts the following options:
  17183. @table @option
  17184. @item filename, f
  17185. Set the file from which to read the initial grid state. In the file,
  17186. each non-whitespace character is considered an alive cell, and newline
  17187. is used to delimit the end of each row.
  17188. If this option is not specified, the initial grid is generated
  17189. randomly.
  17190. @item rate, r
  17191. Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
  17192. Default is 25.
  17193. @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
  17194. Set the random fill ratio for the initial random grid. It is a
  17195. floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to 1/PHI.
  17196. It is ignored when a file is specified.
  17197. @item random_seed, seed
  17198. Set the seed for filling the initial random grid, must be an integer
  17199. included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
  17200. set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
  17201. effort basis.
  17202. @item rule
  17203. Set the life rule.
  17204. A rule can be specified with a code of the kind "S@var{NS}/B@var{NB}",
  17205. where @var{NS} and @var{NB} are sequences of numbers in the range 0-8,
  17206. @var{NS} specifies the number of alive neighbor cells which make a
  17207. live cell stay alive, and @var{NB} the number of alive neighbor cells
  17208. which make a dead cell to become alive (i.e. to "born").
  17209. "s" and "b" can be used in place of "S" and "B", respectively.
  17210. Alternatively a rule can be specified by an 18-bits integer. The 9
  17211. high order bits are used to encode the next cell state if it is alive
  17212. for each number of neighbor alive cells, the low order bits specify
  17213. the rule for "borning" new cells. Higher order bits encode for an
  17214. higher number of neighbor cells.
  17215. For example the number 6153 = @code{(12<<9)+9} specifies a stay alive
  17216. rule of 12 and a born rule of 9, which corresponds to "S23/B03".
  17217. Default value is "S23/B3", which is the original Conway's game of life
  17218. rule, and will keep a cell alive if it has 2 or 3 neighbor alive
  17219. cells, and will born a new cell if there are three alive cells around
  17220. a dead cell.
  17221. @item size, s
  17222. Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17223. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17224. If @option{filename} is specified, the size is set by default to the
  17225. same size of the input file. If @option{size} is set, it must contain
  17226. the size specified in the input file, and the initial grid defined in
  17227. that file is centered in the larger resulting area.
  17228. If a filename is not specified, the size value defaults to "320x240"
  17229. (used for a randomly generated initial grid).
  17230. @item stitch
  17231. If set to 1, stitch the left and right grid edges together, and the
  17232. top and bottom edges also. Defaults to 1.
  17233. @item mold
  17234. Set cell mold speed. If set, a dead cell will go from @option{death_color} to
  17235. @option{mold_color} with a step of @option{mold}. @option{mold} can have a
  17236. value from 0 to 255.
  17237. @item life_color
  17238. Set the color of living (or new born) cells.
  17239. @item death_color
  17240. Set the color of dead cells. If @option{mold} is set, this is the first color
  17241. used to represent a dead cell.
  17242. @item mold_color
  17243. Set mold color, for definitely dead and moldy cells.
  17244. For the syntax of these 3 color options, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the
  17245. ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17246. @end table
  17247. @subsection Examples
  17248. @itemize
  17249. @item
  17250. Read a grid from @file{pattern}, and center it on a grid of size
  17251. 300x300 pixels:
  17252. @example
  17253. life=f=pattern:s=300x300
  17254. @end example
  17255. @item
  17256. Generate a random grid of size 200x200, with a fill ratio of 2/3:
  17257. @example
  17258. life=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
  17259. @end example
  17260. @item
  17261. Specify a custom rule for evolving a randomly generated grid:
  17262. @example
  17263. life=rule=S14/B34
  17264. @end example
  17265. @item
  17266. Full example with slow death effect (mold) using @command{ffplay}:
  17267. @example
  17268. ffplay -f lavfi life=s=300x200:mold=10:r=60:ratio=0.1:death_color=#C83232:life_color=#00ff00,scale=1200:800:flags=16
  17269. @end example
  17270. @end itemize
  17271. @anchor{allrgb}
  17272. @anchor{allyuv}
  17273. @anchor{color}
  17274. @anchor{haldclutsrc}
  17275. @anchor{nullsrc}
  17276. @anchor{pal75bars}
  17277. @anchor{pal100bars}
  17278. @anchor{rgbtestsrc}
  17279. @anchor{smptebars}
  17280. @anchor{smptehdbars}
  17281. @anchor{testsrc}
  17282. @anchor{testsrc2}
  17283. @anchor{yuvtestsrc}
  17284. @section allrgb, allyuv, color, haldclutsrc, nullsrc, pal75bars, pal100bars, rgbtestsrc, smptebars, smptehdbars, testsrc, testsrc2, yuvtestsrc
  17285. The @code{allrgb} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all rgb colors.
  17286. The @code{allyuv} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all yuv colors.
  17287. The @code{color} source provides an uniformly colored input.
  17288. The @code{haldclutsrc} source provides an identity Hald CLUT. See also
  17289. @ref{haldclut} filter.
  17290. The @code{nullsrc} source returns unprocessed video frames. It is
  17291. mainly useful to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as the
  17292. source for filters which ignore the input data.
  17293. The @code{pal75bars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  17294. EBU PAL recommendations with 75% color levels.
  17295. The @code{pal100bars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  17296. EBU PAL recommendations with 100% color levels.
  17297. The @code{rgbtestsrc} source generates an RGB test pattern useful for
  17298. detecting RGB vs BGR issues. You should see a red, green and blue
  17299. stripe from top to bottom.
  17300. The @code{smptebars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  17301. the SMPTE Engineering Guideline EG 1-1990.
  17302. The @code{smptehdbars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  17303. the SMPTE RP 219-2002.
  17304. The @code{testsrc} source generates a test video pattern, showing a
  17305. color pattern, a scrolling gradient and a timestamp. This is mainly
  17306. intended for testing purposes.
  17307. The @code{testsrc2} source is similar to testsrc, but supports more
  17308. pixel formats instead of just @code{rgb24}. This allows using it as an
  17309. input for other tests without requiring a format conversion.
  17310. The @code{yuvtestsrc} source generates an YUV test pattern. You should
  17311. see a y, cb and cr stripe from top to bottom.
  17312. The sources accept the following parameters:
  17313. @table @option
  17314. @item level
  17315. Specify the level of the Hald CLUT, only available in the @code{haldclutsrc}
  17316. source. A level of @code{N} generates a picture of @code{N*N*N} by @code{N*N*N}
  17317. pixels to be used as identity matrix for 3D lookup tables. Each component is
  17318. coded on a @code{1/(N*N)} scale.
  17319. @item color, c
  17320. Specify the color of the source, only available in the @code{color}
  17321. source. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17322. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17323. @item size, s
  17324. Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17325. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17326. The default value is @code{320x240}.
  17327. This option is not available with the @code{allrgb}, @code{allyuv}, and
  17328. @code{haldclutsrc} filters.
  17329. @item rate, r
  17330. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  17331. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  17332. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  17333. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  17334. "25".
  17335. @item duration, d
  17336. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  17337. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  17338. for the accepted syntax.
  17339. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  17340. supposed to be generated forever.
  17341. @item sar
  17342. Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
  17343. @item alpha
  17344. Specify the alpha (opacity) of the background, only available in the
  17345. @code{testsrc2} source. The value must be between 0 (fully transparent) and
  17346. 255 (fully opaque, the default).
  17347. @item decimals, n
  17348. Set the number of decimals to show in the timestamp, only available in the
  17349. @code{testsrc} source.
  17350. The displayed timestamp value will correspond to the original
  17351. timestamp value multiplied by the power of 10 of the specified
  17352. value. Default value is 0.
  17353. @end table
  17354. @subsection Examples
  17355. @itemize
  17356. @item
  17357. Generate a video with a duration of 5.3 seconds, with size
  17358. 176x144 and a frame rate of 10 frames per second:
  17359. @example
  17360. testsrc=duration=5.3:size=qcif:rate=10
  17361. @end example
  17362. @item
  17363. The following graph description will generate a red source
  17364. with an opacity of 0.2, with size "qcif" and a frame rate of 10
  17365. frames per second:
  17366. @example
  17367. color=c=red@@0.2:s=qcif:r=10
  17368. @end example
  17369. @item
  17370. If the input content is to be ignored, @code{nullsrc} can be used. The
  17371. following command generates noise in the luminance plane by employing
  17372. the @code{geq} filter:
  17373. @example
  17374. nullsrc=s=256x256, geq=random(1)*255:128:128
  17375. @end example
  17376. @end itemize
  17377. @subsection Commands
  17378. The @code{color} source supports the following commands:
  17379. @table @option
  17380. @item c, color
  17381. Set the color of the created image. Accepts the same syntax of the
  17382. corresponding @option{color} option.
  17383. @end table
  17384. @section openclsrc
  17385. Generate video using an OpenCL program.
  17386. @table @option
  17387. @item source
  17388. OpenCL program source file.
  17389. @item kernel
  17390. Kernel name in program.
  17391. @item size, s
  17392. Size of frames to generate. This must be set.
  17393. @item format
  17394. Pixel format to use for the generated frames. This must be set.
  17395. @item rate, r
  17396. Number of frames generated every second. Default value is '25'.
  17397. @end table
  17398. For details of how the program loading works, see the @ref{program_opencl}
  17399. filter.
  17400. Example programs:
  17401. @itemize
  17402. @item
  17403. Generate a colour ramp by setting pixel values from the position of the pixel
  17404. in the output image. (Note that this will work with all pixel formats, but
  17405. the generated output will not be the same.)
  17406. @verbatim
  17407. __kernel void ramp(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  17408. unsigned int index)
  17409. {
  17410. int2 loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  17411. float4 val;
  17412. val.xy = val.zw = convert_float2(loc) / convert_float2(get_image_dim(dst));
  17413. write_imagef(dst, loc, val);
  17414. }
  17415. @end verbatim
  17416. @item
  17417. Generate a Sierpinski carpet pattern, panning by a single pixel each frame.
  17418. @verbatim
  17419. __kernel void sierpinski_carpet(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  17420. unsigned int index)
  17421. {
  17422. int2 loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  17423. float4 value = 0.0f;
  17424. int x = loc.x + index;
  17425. int y = loc.y + index;
  17426. while (x > 0 || y > 0) {
  17427. if (x % 3 == 1 && y % 3 == 1) {
  17428. value = 1.0f;
  17429. break;
  17430. }
  17431. x /= 3;
  17432. y /= 3;
  17433. }
  17434. write_imagef(dst, loc, value);
  17435. }
  17436. @end verbatim
  17437. @end itemize
  17438. @section sierpinski
  17439. Generate a Sierpinski carpet/triangle fractal, and randomly pan around.
  17440. This source accepts the following options:
  17441. @table @option
  17442. @item size, s
  17443. Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video
  17444. size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. Default value is "640x480".
  17445. @item rate, r
  17446. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  17447. value is "25".
  17448. @item seed
  17449. Set seed which is used for random panning.
  17450. @item jump
  17451. Set max jump for single pan destination. Allowed range is from 1 to 10000.
  17452. @item type
  17453. Set fractal type, can be default @code{carpet} or @code{triangle}.
  17454. @end table
  17455. @c man end VIDEO SOURCES
  17456. @chapter Video Sinks
  17457. @c man begin VIDEO SINKS
  17458. Below is a description of the currently available video sinks.
  17459. @section buffersink
  17460. Buffer video frames, and make them available to the end of the filter
  17461. graph.
  17462. This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
  17463. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
  17464. or the options system.
  17465. It accepts a pointer to an AVBufferSinkContext structure, which
  17466. defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
  17467. parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
  17468. @section nullsink
  17469. Null video sink: do absolutely nothing with the input video. It is
  17470. mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
  17471. tools.
  17472. @c man end VIDEO SINKS
  17473. @chapter Multimedia Filters
  17474. @c man begin MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
  17475. Below is a description of the currently available multimedia filters.
  17476. @section abitscope
  17477. Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the audio bit scope.
  17478. The filter accepts the following options:
  17479. @table @option
  17480. @item rate, r
  17481. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  17482. value is "25".
  17483. @item size, s
  17484. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17485. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17486. Default value is @code{1024x256}.
  17487. @item colors
  17488. Specify list of colors separated by space or by '|' which will be used to
  17489. draw channels. Unrecognized or missing colors will be replaced
  17490. by white color.
  17491. @end table
  17492. @section adrawgraph
  17493. Draw a graph using input audio metadata.
  17494. See @ref{drawgraph}
  17495. @section agraphmonitor
  17496. See @ref{graphmonitor}.
  17497. @section ahistogram
  17498. Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the volume histogram.
  17499. The filter accepts the following options:
  17500. @table @option
  17501. @item dmode
  17502. Specify how histogram is calculated.
  17503. It accepts the following values:
  17504. @table @samp
  17505. @item single
  17506. Use single histogram for all channels.
  17507. @item separate
  17508. Use separate histogram for each channel.
  17509. @end table
  17510. Default is @code{single}.
  17511. @item rate, r
  17512. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  17513. value is "25".
  17514. @item size, s
  17515. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17516. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17517. Default value is @code{hd720}.
  17518. @item scale
  17519. Set display scale.
  17520. It accepts the following values:
  17521. @table @samp
  17522. @item log
  17523. logarithmic
  17524. @item sqrt
  17525. square root
  17526. @item cbrt
  17527. cubic root
  17528. @item lin
  17529. linear
  17530. @item rlog
  17531. reverse logarithmic
  17532. @end table
  17533. Default is @code{log}.
  17534. @item ascale
  17535. Set amplitude scale.
  17536. It accepts the following values:
  17537. @table @samp
  17538. @item log
  17539. logarithmic
  17540. @item lin
  17541. linear
  17542. @end table
  17543. Default is @code{log}.
  17544. @item acount
  17545. Set how much frames to accumulate in histogram.
  17546. Default is 1. Setting this to -1 accumulates all frames.
  17547. @item rheight
  17548. Set histogram ratio of window height.
  17549. @item slide
  17550. Set sonogram sliding.
  17551. It accepts the following values:
  17552. @table @samp
  17553. @item replace
  17554. replace old rows with new ones.
  17555. @item scroll
  17556. scroll from top to bottom.
  17557. @end table
  17558. Default is @code{replace}.
  17559. @end table
  17560. @section aphasemeter
  17561. Measures phase of input audio, which is exported as metadata @code{lavfi.aphasemeter.phase},
  17562. representing mean phase of current audio frame. A video output can also be produced and is
  17563. enabled by default. The audio is passed through as first output.
  17564. Audio will be rematrixed to stereo if it has a different channel layout. Phase value is in
  17565. range @code{[-1, 1]} where @code{-1} means left and right channels are completely out of phase
  17566. and @code{1} means channels are in phase.
  17567. The filter accepts the following options, all related to its video output:
  17568. @table @option
  17569. @item rate, r
  17570. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  17571. @item size, s
  17572. Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17573. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17574. Default value is @code{800x400}.
  17575. @item rc
  17576. @item gc
  17577. @item bc
  17578. Specify the red, green, blue contrast. Default values are @code{2},
  17579. @code{7} and @code{1}.
  17580. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  17581. @item mpc
  17582. Set color which will be used for drawing median phase. If color is
  17583. @code{none} which is default, no median phase value will be drawn.
  17584. @item video
  17585. Enable video output. Default is enabled.
  17586. @end table
  17587. @section avectorscope
  17588. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio vector
  17589. scope.
  17590. The filter is used to measure the difference between channels of stereo
  17591. audio stream. A monaural signal, consisting of identical left and right
  17592. signal, results in straight vertical line. Any stereo separation is visible
  17593. as a deviation from this line, creating a Lissajous figure.
  17594. If the straight (or deviation from it) but horizontal line appears this
  17595. indicates that the left and right channels are out of phase.
  17596. The filter accepts the following options:
  17597. @table @option
  17598. @item mode, m
  17599. Set the vectorscope mode.
  17600. Available values are:
  17601. @table @samp
  17602. @item lissajous
  17603. Lissajous rotated by 45 degrees.
  17604. @item lissajous_xy
  17605. Same as above but not rotated.
  17606. @item polar
  17607. Shape resembling half of circle.
  17608. @end table
  17609. Default value is @samp{lissajous}.
  17610. @item size, s
  17611. Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17612. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17613. Default value is @code{400x400}.
  17614. @item rate, r
  17615. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  17616. @item rc
  17617. @item gc
  17618. @item bc
  17619. @item ac
  17620. Specify the red, green, blue and alpha contrast. Default values are @code{40},
  17621. @code{160}, @code{80} and @code{255}.
  17622. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  17623. @item rf
  17624. @item gf
  17625. @item bf
  17626. @item af
  17627. Specify the red, green, blue and alpha fade. Default values are @code{15},
  17628. @code{10}, @code{5} and @code{5}.
  17629. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  17630. @item zoom
  17631. Set the zoom factor. Default value is @code{1}. Allowed range is @code{[0, 10]}.
  17632. Values lower than @var{1} will auto adjust zoom factor to maximal possible value.
  17633. @item draw
  17634. Set the vectorscope drawing mode.
  17635. Available values are:
  17636. @table @samp
  17637. @item dot
  17638. Draw dot for each sample.
  17639. @item line
  17640. Draw line between previous and current sample.
  17641. @end table
  17642. Default value is @samp{dot}.
  17643. @item scale
  17644. Specify amplitude scale of audio samples.
  17645. Available values are:
  17646. @table @samp
  17647. @item lin
  17648. Linear.
  17649. @item sqrt
  17650. Square root.
  17651. @item cbrt
  17652. Cubic root.
  17653. @item log
  17654. Logarithmic.
  17655. @end table
  17656. @item swap
  17657. Swap left channel axis with right channel axis.
  17658. @item mirror
  17659. Mirror axis.
  17660. @table @samp
  17661. @item none
  17662. No mirror.
  17663. @item x
  17664. Mirror only x axis.
  17665. @item y
  17666. Mirror only y axis.
  17667. @item xy
  17668. Mirror both axis.
  17669. @end table
  17670. @end table
  17671. @subsection Examples
  17672. @itemize
  17673. @item
  17674. Complete example using @command{ffplay}:
  17675. @example
  17676. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
  17677. [a] avectorscope=zoom=1.3:rc=2:gc=200:bc=10:rf=1:gf=8:bf=7 [out0]'
  17678. @end example
  17679. @end itemize
  17680. @section bench, abench
  17681. Benchmark part of a filtergraph.
  17682. The filter accepts the following options:
  17683. @table @option
  17684. @item action
  17685. Start or stop a timer.
  17686. Available values are:
  17687. @table @samp
  17688. @item start
  17689. Get the current time, set it as frame metadata (using the key
  17690. @code{lavfi.bench.start_time}), and forward the frame to the next filter.
  17691. @item stop
  17692. Get the current time and fetch the @code{lavfi.bench.start_time} metadata from
  17693. the input frame metadata to get the time difference. Time difference, average,
  17694. maximum and minimum time (respectively @code{t}, @code{avg}, @code{max} and
  17695. @code{min}) are then printed. The timestamps are expressed in seconds.
  17696. @end table
  17697. @end table
  17698. @subsection Examples
  17699. @itemize
  17700. @item
  17701. Benchmark @ref{selectivecolor} filter:
  17702. @example
  17703. bench=start,selectivecolor=reds=-.2 .12 -.49,bench=stop
  17704. @end example
  17705. @end itemize
  17706. @section concat
  17707. Concatenate audio and video streams, joining them together one after the
  17708. other.
  17709. The filter works on segments of synchronized video and audio streams. All
  17710. segments must have the same number of streams of each type, and that will
  17711. also be the number of streams at output.
  17712. The filter accepts the following options:
  17713. @table @option
  17714. @item n
  17715. Set the number of segments. Default is 2.
  17716. @item v
  17717. Set the number of output video streams, that is also the number of video
  17718. streams in each segment. Default is 1.
  17719. @item a
  17720. Set the number of output audio streams, that is also the number of audio
  17721. streams in each segment. Default is 0.
  17722. @item unsafe
  17723. Activate unsafe mode: do not fail if segments have a different format.
  17724. @end table
  17725. The filter has @var{v}+@var{a} outputs: first @var{v} video outputs, then
  17726. @var{a} audio outputs.
  17727. There are @var{n}x(@var{v}+@var{a}) inputs: first the inputs for the first
  17728. segment, in the same order as the outputs, then the inputs for the second
  17729. segment, etc.
  17730. Related streams do not always have exactly the same duration, for various
  17731. reasons including codec frame size or sloppy authoring. For that reason,
  17732. related synchronized streams (e.g. a video and its audio track) should be
  17733. concatenated at once. The concat filter will use the duration of the longest
  17734. stream in each segment (except the last one), and if necessary pad shorter
  17735. audio streams with silence.
  17736. For this filter to work correctly, all segments must start at timestamp 0.
  17737. All corresponding streams must have the same parameters in all segments; the
  17738. filtering system will automatically select a common pixel format for video
  17739. streams, and a common sample format, sample rate and channel layout for
  17740. audio streams, but other settings, such as resolution, must be converted
  17741. explicitly by the user.
  17742. Different frame rates are acceptable but will result in variable frame rate
  17743. at output; be sure to configure the output file to handle it.
  17744. @subsection Examples
  17745. @itemize
  17746. @item
  17747. Concatenate an opening, an episode and an ending, all in bilingual version
  17748. (video in stream 0, audio in streams 1 and 2):
  17749. @example
  17750. ffmpeg -i opening.mkv -i episode.mkv -i ending.mkv -filter_complex \
  17751. '[0:0] [0:1] [0:2] [1:0] [1:1] [1:2] [2:0] [2:1] [2:2]
  17752. concat=n=3:v=1:a=2 [v] [a1] [a2]' \
  17753. -map '[v]' -map '[a1]' -map '[a2]' output.mkv
  17754. @end example
  17755. @item
  17756. Concatenate two parts, handling audio and video separately, using the
  17757. (a)movie sources, and adjusting the resolution:
  17758. @example
  17759. movie=part1.mp4, scale=512:288 [v1] ; amovie=part1.mp4 [a1] ;
  17760. movie=part2.mp4, scale=512:288 [v2] ; amovie=part2.mp4 [a2] ;
  17761. [v1] [v2] concat [outv] ; [a1] [a2] concat=v=0:a=1 [outa]
  17762. @end example
  17763. Note that a desync will happen at the stitch if the audio and video streams
  17764. do not have exactly the same duration in the first file.
  17765. @end itemize
  17766. @subsection Commands
  17767. This filter supports the following commands:
  17768. @table @option
  17769. @item next
  17770. Close the current segment and step to the next one
  17771. @end table
  17772. @anchor{ebur128}
  17773. @section ebur128
  17774. EBU R128 scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream and analyzes its loudness
  17775. level. By default, it logs a message at a frequency of 10Hz with the
  17776. Momentary loudness (identified by @code{M}), Short-term loudness (@code{S}),
  17777. Integrated loudness (@code{I}) and Loudness Range (@code{LRA}).
  17778. The filter can only analyze streams which have a sampling rate of 48000 Hz and whose
  17779. sample format is double-precision floating point. The input stream will be converted to
  17780. this specification, if needed. Users may need to insert aformat and/or aresample filters
  17781. after this filter to obtain the original parameters.
  17782. The filter also has a video output (see the @var{video} option) with a real
  17783. time graph to observe the loudness evolution. The graphic contains the logged
  17784. message mentioned above, so it is not printed anymore when this option is set,
  17785. unless the verbose logging is set. The main graphing area contains the
  17786. short-term loudness (3 seconds of analysis), and the gauge on the right is for
  17787. the momentary loudness (400 milliseconds), but can optionally be configured
  17788. to instead display short-term loudness (see @var{gauge}).
  17789. The green area marks a +/- 1LU target range around the target loudness
  17790. (-23LUFS by default, unless modified through @var{target}).
  17791. More information about the Loudness Recommendation EBU R128 on
  17792. @url{http://tech.ebu.ch/loudness}.
  17793. The filter accepts the following options:
  17794. @table @option
  17795. @item video
  17796. Activate the video output. The audio stream is passed unchanged whether this
  17797. option is set or no. The video stream will be the first output stream if
  17798. activated. Default is @code{0}.
  17799. @item size
  17800. Set the video size. This option is for video only. For the syntax of this
  17801. option, check the
  17802. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17803. Default and minimum resolution is @code{640x480}.
  17804. @item meter
  17805. Set the EBU scale meter. Default is @code{9}. Common values are @code{9} and
  17806. @code{18}, respectively for EBU scale meter +9 and EBU scale meter +18. Any
  17807. other integer value between this range is allowed.
  17808. @item metadata
  17809. Set metadata injection. If set to @code{1}, the audio input will be segmented
  17810. into 100ms output frames, each of them containing various loudness information
  17811. in metadata. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.r128.}.
  17812. Default is @code{0}.
  17813. @item framelog
  17814. Force the frame logging level.
  17815. Available values are:
  17816. @table @samp
  17817. @item info
  17818. information logging level
  17819. @item verbose
  17820. verbose logging level
  17821. @end table
  17822. By default, the logging level is set to @var{info}. If the @option{video} or
  17823. the @option{metadata} options are set, it switches to @var{verbose}.
  17824. @item peak
  17825. Set peak mode(s).
  17826. Available modes can be cumulated (the option is a @code{flag} type). Possible
  17827. values are:
  17828. @table @samp
  17829. @item none
  17830. Disable any peak mode (default).
  17831. @item sample
  17832. Enable sample-peak mode.
  17833. Simple peak mode looking for the higher sample value. It logs a message
  17834. for sample-peak (identified by @code{SPK}).
  17835. @item true
  17836. Enable true-peak mode.
  17837. If enabled, the peak lookup is done on an over-sampled version of the input
  17838. stream for better peak accuracy. It logs a message for true-peak.
  17839. (identified by @code{TPK}) and true-peak per frame (identified by @code{FTPK}).
  17840. This mode requires a build with @code{libswresample}.
  17841. @end table
  17842. @item dualmono
  17843. Treat mono input files as "dual mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
  17844. on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
  17845. If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
  17846. Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
  17847. @item panlaw
  17848. Set a specific pan law to be used for the measurement of dual mono files.
  17849. This parameter is optional, and has a default value of -3.01dB.
  17850. @item target
  17851. Set a specific target level (in LUFS) used as relative zero in the visualization.
  17852. This parameter is optional and has a default value of -23LUFS as specified
  17853. by EBU R128. However, material published online may prefer a level of -16LUFS
  17854. (e.g. for use with podcasts or video platforms).
  17855. @item gauge
  17856. Set the value displayed by the gauge. Valid values are @code{momentary} and s
  17857. @code{shortterm}. By default the momentary value will be used, but in certain
  17858. scenarios it may be more useful to observe the short term value instead (e.g.
  17859. live mixing).
  17860. @item scale
  17861. Sets the display scale for the loudness. Valid parameters are @code{absolute}
  17862. (in LUFS) or @code{relative} (LU) relative to the target. This only affects the
  17863. video output, not the summary or continuous log output.
  17864. @end table
  17865. @subsection Examples
  17866. @itemize
  17867. @item
  17868. Real-time graph using @command{ffplay}, with a EBU scale meter +18:
  17869. @example
  17870. ffplay -f lavfi -i "amovie=input.mp3,ebur128=video=1:meter=18 [out0][out1]"
  17871. @end example
  17872. @item
  17873. Run an analysis with @command{ffmpeg}:
  17874. @example
  17875. ffmpeg -nostats -i input.mp3 -filter_complex ebur128 -f null -
  17876. @end example
  17877. @end itemize
  17878. @section interleave, ainterleave
  17879. Temporally interleave frames from several inputs.
  17880. @code{interleave} works with video inputs, @code{ainterleave} with audio.
  17881. These filters read frames from several inputs and send the oldest
  17882. queued frame to the output.
  17883. Input streams must have well defined, monotonically increasing frame
  17884. timestamp values.
  17885. In order to submit one frame to output, these filters need to enqueue
  17886. at least one frame for each input, so they cannot work in case one
  17887. input is not yet terminated and will not receive incoming frames.
  17888. For example consider the case when one input is a @code{select} filter
  17889. which always drops input frames. The @code{interleave} filter will keep
  17890. reading from that input, but it will never be able to send new frames
  17891. to output until the input sends an end-of-stream signal.
  17892. Also, depending on inputs synchronization, the filters will drop
  17893. frames in case one input receives more frames than the other ones, and
  17894. the queue is already filled.
  17895. These filters accept the following options:
  17896. @table @option
  17897. @item nb_inputs, n
  17898. Set the number of different inputs, it is 2 by default.
  17899. @item duration
  17900. How to determine the end-of-stream.
  17901. @table @option
  17902. @item longest
  17903. The duration of the longest input. (default)
  17904. @item shortest
  17905. The duration of the shortest input.
  17906. @item first
  17907. The duration of the first input.
  17908. @end table
  17909. @end table
  17910. @subsection Examples
  17911. @itemize
  17912. @item
  17913. Interleave frames belonging to different streams using @command{ffmpeg}:
  17914. @example
  17915. ffmpeg -i bambi.avi -i pr0n.mkv -filter_complex "[0:v][1:v] interleave" out.avi
  17916. @end example
  17917. @item
  17918. Add flickering blur effect:
  17919. @example
  17920. select='if(gt(random(0), 0.2), 1, 2)':n=2 [tmp], boxblur=2:2, [tmp] interleave
  17921. @end example
  17922. @end itemize
  17923. @section metadata, ametadata
  17924. Manipulate frame metadata.
  17925. This filter accepts the following options:
  17926. @table @option
  17927. @item mode
  17928. Set mode of operation of the filter.
  17929. Can be one of the following:
  17930. @table @samp
  17931. @item select
  17932. If both @code{value} and @code{key} is set, select frames
  17933. which have such metadata. If only @code{key} is set, select
  17934. every frame that has such key in metadata.
  17935. @item add
  17936. Add new metadata @code{key} and @code{value}. If key is already available
  17937. do nothing.
  17938. @item modify
  17939. Modify value of already present key.
  17940. @item delete
  17941. If @code{value} is set, delete only keys that have such value.
  17942. Otherwise, delete key. If @code{key} is not set, delete all metadata values in
  17943. the frame.
  17944. @item print
  17945. Print key and its value if metadata was found. If @code{key} is not set print all
  17946. metadata values available in frame.
  17947. @end table
  17948. @item key
  17949. Set key used with all modes. Must be set for all modes except @code{print} and @code{delete}.
  17950. @item value
  17951. Set metadata value which will be used. This option is mandatory for
  17952. @code{modify} and @code{add} mode.
  17953. @item function
  17954. Which function to use when comparing metadata value and @code{value}.
  17955. Can be one of following:
  17956. @table @samp
  17957. @item same_str
  17958. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value is same as @code{value}.
  17959. @item starts_with
  17960. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value starts with
  17961. the @code{value} option string.
  17962. @item less
  17963. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is less than @code{value}.
  17964. @item equal
  17965. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if @code{value} is equal with metadata value.
  17966. @item greater
  17967. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is greater than @code{value}.
  17968. @item expr
  17969. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if expression from option @code{expr}
  17970. evaluates to true.
  17971. @item ends_with
  17972. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value ends with
  17973. the @code{value} option string.
  17974. @end table
  17975. @item expr
  17976. Set expression which is used when @code{function} is set to @code{expr}.
  17977. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  17978. constants:
  17979. @table @option
  17980. @item VALUE1
  17981. Float representation of @code{value} from metadata key.
  17982. @item VALUE2
  17983. Float representation of @code{value} as supplied by user in @code{value} option.
  17984. @end table
  17985. @item file
  17986. If specified in @code{print} mode, output is written to the named file. Instead of
  17987. plain filename any writable url can be specified. Filename ``-'' is a shorthand
  17988. for standard output. If @code{file} option is not set, output is written to the log
  17989. with AV_LOG_INFO loglevel.
  17990. @item direct
  17991. Reduces buffering in print mode when output is written to a URL set using @var{file}.
  17992. @end table
  17993. @subsection Examples
  17994. @itemize
  17995. @item
  17996. Print all metadata values for frames with key @code{lavfi.signalstats.YDIF} with values
  17997. between 0 and 1.
  17998. @example
  17999. signalstats,metadata=print:key=lavfi.signalstats.YDIF:value=0:function=expr:expr='between(VALUE1,0,1)'
  18000. @end example
  18001. @item
  18002. Print silencedetect output to file @file{metadata.txt}.
  18003. @example
  18004. silencedetect,ametadata=mode=print:file=metadata.txt
  18005. @end example
  18006. @item
  18007. Direct all metadata to a pipe with file descriptor 4.
  18008. @example
  18009. metadata=mode=print:file='pipe\:4'
  18010. @end example
  18011. @end itemize
  18012. @section perms, aperms
  18013. Set read/write permissions for the output frames.
  18014. These filters are mainly aimed at developers to test direct path in the
  18015. following filter in the filtergraph.
  18016. The filters accept the following options:
  18017. @table @option
  18018. @item mode
  18019. Select the permissions mode.
  18020. It accepts the following values:
  18021. @table @samp
  18022. @item none
  18023. Do nothing. This is the default.
  18024. @item ro
  18025. Set all the output frames read-only.
  18026. @item rw
  18027. Set all the output frames directly writable.
  18028. @item toggle
  18029. Make the frame read-only if writable, and writable if read-only.
  18030. @item random
  18031. Set each output frame read-only or writable randomly.
  18032. @end table
  18033. @item seed
  18034. Set the seed for the @var{random} mode, must be an integer included between
  18035. @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
  18036. @code{-1}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best effort
  18037. basis.
  18038. @end table
  18039. Note: in case of auto-inserted filter between the permission filter and the
  18040. following one, the permission might not be received as expected in that
  18041. following filter. Inserting a @ref{format} or @ref{aformat} filter before the
  18042. perms/aperms filter can avoid this problem.
  18043. @section realtime, arealtime
  18044. Slow down filtering to match real time approximately.
  18045. These filters will pause the filtering for a variable amount of time to
  18046. match the output rate with the input timestamps.
  18047. They are similar to the @option{re} option to @code{ffmpeg}.
  18048. They accept the following options:
  18049. @table @option
  18050. @item limit
  18051. Time limit for the pauses. Any pause longer than that will be considered
  18052. a timestamp discontinuity and reset the timer. Default is 2 seconds.
  18053. @item speed
  18054. Speed factor for processing. The value must be a float larger than zero.
  18055. Values larger than 1.0 will result in faster than realtime processing,
  18056. smaller will slow processing down. The @var{limit} is automatically adapted
  18057. accordingly. Default is 1.0.
  18058. A processing speed faster than what is possible without these filters cannot
  18059. be achieved.
  18060. @end table
  18061. @anchor{select}
  18062. @section select, aselect
  18063. Select frames to pass in output.
  18064. This filter accepts the following options:
  18065. @table @option
  18066. @item expr, e
  18067. Set expression, which is evaluated for each input frame.
  18068. If the expression is evaluated to zero, the frame is discarded.
  18069. If the evaluation result is negative or NaN, the frame is sent to the
  18070. first output; otherwise it is sent to the output with index
  18071. @code{ceil(val)-1}, assuming that the input index starts from 0.
  18072. For example a value of @code{1.2} corresponds to the output with index
  18073. @code{ceil(1.2)-1 = 2-1 = 1}, that is the second output.
  18074. @item outputs, n
  18075. Set the number of outputs. The output to which to send the selected
  18076. frame is based on the result of the evaluation. Default value is 1.
  18077. @end table
  18078. The expression can contain the following constants:
  18079. @table @option
  18080. @item n
  18081. The (sequential) number of the filtered frame, starting from 0.
  18082. @item selected_n
  18083. The (sequential) number of the selected frame, starting from 0.
  18084. @item prev_selected_n
  18085. The sequential number of the last selected frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  18086. @item TB
  18087. The timebase of the input timestamps.
  18088. @item pts
  18089. The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
  18090. expressed in @var{TB} units. It's NAN if undefined.
  18091. @item t
  18092. The PTS of the filtered video frame,
  18093. expressed in seconds. It's NAN if undefined.
  18094. @item prev_pts
  18095. The PTS of the previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  18096. @item prev_selected_pts
  18097. The PTS of the last previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  18098. @item prev_selected_t
  18099. The PTS of the last previously selected video frame, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if undefined.
  18100. @item start_pts
  18101. The PTS of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
  18102. @item start_t
  18103. The time of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
  18104. @item pict_type @emph{(video only)}
  18105. The type of the filtered frame. It can assume one of the following
  18106. values:
  18107. @table @option
  18108. @item I
  18109. @item P
  18110. @item B
  18111. @item S
  18112. @item SI
  18113. @item SP
  18114. @item BI
  18115. @end table
  18116. @item interlace_type @emph{(video only)}
  18117. The frame interlace type. It can assume one of the following values:
  18118. @table @option
  18119. @item PROGRESSIVE
  18120. The frame is progressive (not interlaced).
  18121. @item TOPFIRST
  18122. The frame is top-field-first.
  18123. @item BOTTOMFIRST
  18124. The frame is bottom-field-first.
  18125. @end table
  18126. @item consumed_sample_n @emph{(audio only)}
  18127. the number of selected samples before the current frame
  18128. @item samples_n @emph{(audio only)}
  18129. the number of samples in the current frame
  18130. @item sample_rate @emph{(audio only)}
  18131. the input sample rate
  18132. @item key
  18133. This is 1 if the filtered frame is a key-frame, 0 otherwise.
  18134. @item pos
  18135. the position in the file of the filtered frame, -1 if the information
  18136. is not available (e.g. for synthetic video)
  18137. @item scene @emph{(video only)}
  18138. value between 0 and 1 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
  18139. probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
  18140. value means the current frame is more likely to be one (see the example below)
  18141. @item concatdec_select
  18142. The concat demuxer can select only part of a concat input file by setting an
  18143. inpoint and an outpoint, but the output packets may not be entirely contained
  18144. in the selected interval. By using this variable, it is possible to skip frames
  18145. generated by the concat demuxer which are not exactly contained in the selected
  18146. interval.
  18147. This works by comparing the frame pts against the @var{lavf.concat.start_time}
  18148. and the @var{lavf.concat.duration} packet metadata values which are also
  18149. present in the decoded frames.
  18150. The @var{concatdec_select} variable is -1 if the frame pts is at least
  18151. start_time and either the duration metadata is missing or the frame pts is less
  18152. than start_time + duration, 0 otherwise, and NaN if the start_time metadata is
  18153. missing.
  18154. That basically means that an input frame is selected if its pts is within the
  18155. interval set by the concat demuxer.
  18156. @end table
  18157. The default value of the select expression is "1".
  18158. @subsection Examples
  18159. @itemize
  18160. @item
  18161. Select all frames in input:
  18162. @example
  18163. select
  18164. @end example
  18165. The example above is the same as:
  18166. @example
  18167. select=1
  18168. @end example
  18169. @item
  18170. Skip all frames:
  18171. @example
  18172. select=0
  18173. @end example
  18174. @item
  18175. Select only I-frames:
  18176. @example
  18177. select='eq(pict_type\,I)'
  18178. @end example
  18179. @item
  18180. Select one frame every 100:
  18181. @example
  18182. select='not(mod(n\,100))'
  18183. @end example
  18184. @item
  18185. Select only frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
  18186. @example
  18187. select=between(t\,10\,20)
  18188. @end example
  18189. @item
  18190. Select only I-frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
  18191. @example
  18192. select=between(t\,10\,20)*eq(pict_type\,I)
  18193. @end example
  18194. @item
  18195. Select frames with a minimum distance of 10 seconds:
  18196. @example
  18197. select='isnan(prev_selected_t)+gte(t-prev_selected_t\,10)'
  18198. @end example
  18199. @item
  18200. Use aselect to select only audio frames with samples number > 100:
  18201. @example
  18202. aselect='gt(samples_n\,100)'
  18203. @end example
  18204. @item
  18205. Create a mosaic of the first scenes:
  18206. @example
  18207. ffmpeg -i video.avi -vf select='gt(scene\,0.4)',scale=160:120,tile -frames:v 1 preview.png
  18208. @end example
  18209. Comparing @var{scene} against a value between 0.3 and 0.5 is generally a sane
  18210. choice.
  18211. @item
  18212. Send even and odd frames to separate outputs, and compose them:
  18213. @example
  18214. select=n=2:e='mod(n, 2)+1' [odd][even]; [odd] pad=h=2*ih [tmp]; [tmp][even] overlay=y=h
  18215. @end example
  18216. @item
  18217. Select useful frames from an ffconcat file which is using inpoints and
  18218. outpoints but where the source files are not intra frame only.
  18219. @example
  18220. ffmpeg -copyts -vsync 0 -segment_time_metadata 1 -i input.ffconcat -vf select=concatdec_select -af aselect=concatdec_select output.avi
  18221. @end example
  18222. @end itemize
  18223. @section sendcmd, asendcmd
  18224. Send commands to filters in the filtergraph.
  18225. These filters read commands to be sent to other filters in the
  18226. filtergraph.
  18227. @code{sendcmd} must be inserted between two video filters,
  18228. @code{asendcmd} must be inserted between two audio filters, but apart
  18229. from that they act the same way.
  18230. The specification of commands can be provided in the filter arguments
  18231. with the @var{commands} option, or in a file specified by the
  18232. @var{filename} option.
  18233. These filters accept the following options:
  18234. @table @option
  18235. @item commands, c
  18236. Set the commands to be read and sent to the other filters.
  18237. @item filename, f
  18238. Set the filename of the commands to be read and sent to the other
  18239. filters.
  18240. @end table
  18241. @subsection Commands syntax
  18242. A commands description consists of a sequence of interval
  18243. specifications, comprising a list of commands to be executed when a
  18244. particular event related to that interval occurs. The occurring event
  18245. is typically the current frame time entering or leaving a given time
  18246. interval.
  18247. An interval is specified by the following syntax:
  18248. @example
  18249. @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS};
  18250. @end example
  18251. The time interval is specified by the @var{START} and @var{END} times.
  18252. @var{END} is optional and defaults to the maximum time.
  18253. The current frame time is considered within the specified interval if
  18254. it is included in the interval [@var{START}, @var{END}), that is when
  18255. the time is greater or equal to @var{START} and is lesser than
  18256. @var{END}.
  18257. @var{COMMANDS} consists of a sequence of one or more command
  18258. specifications, separated by ",", relating to that interval. The
  18259. syntax of a command specification is given by:
  18260. @example
  18261. [@var{FLAGS}] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} @var{ARG}
  18262. @end example
  18263. @var{FLAGS} is optional and specifies the type of events relating to
  18264. the time interval which enable sending the specified command, and must
  18265. be a non-null sequence of identifier flags separated by "+" or "|" and
  18266. enclosed between "[" and "]".
  18267. The following flags are recognized:
  18268. @table @option
  18269. @item enter
  18270. The command is sent when the current frame timestamp enters the
  18271. specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
  18272. previous frame timestamp was not in the given interval, and the
  18273. current is.
  18274. @item leave
  18275. The command is sent when the current frame timestamp leaves the
  18276. specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
  18277. previous frame timestamp was in the given interval, and the
  18278. current is not.
  18279. @item expr
  18280. The command @var{ARG} is interpreted as expression and result of
  18281. expression is passed as @var{ARG}.
  18282. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  18283. constants:
  18284. @table @option
  18285. @item POS
  18286. Original position in the file of the frame, or undefined if undefined
  18287. for the current frame.
  18288. @item PTS
  18289. The presentation timestamp in input.
  18290. @item N
  18291. The count of the input frame for video or audio, starting from 0.
  18292. @item T
  18293. The time in seconds of the current frame.
  18294. @item TS
  18295. The start time in seconds of the current command interval.
  18296. @item TE
  18297. The end time in seconds of the current command interval.
  18298. @item TI
  18299. The interpolated time of the current command interval, TI = (T - TS) / (TE - TS).
  18300. @end table
  18301. @end table
  18302. If @var{FLAGS} is not specified, a default value of @code{[enter]} is
  18303. assumed.
  18304. @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
  18305. the filter class or a specific filter instance name.
  18306. @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
  18307. @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional list of argument for
  18308. the given @var{COMMAND}.
  18309. Between one interval specification and another, whitespaces, or
  18310. sequences of characters starting with @code{#} until the end of line,
  18311. are ignored and can be used to annotate comments.
  18312. A simplified BNF description of the commands specification syntax
  18313. follows:
  18314. @example
  18315. @var{COMMAND_FLAG} ::= "enter" | "leave"
  18316. @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} ::= @var{COMMAND_FLAG} [(+|"|")@var{COMMAND_FLAG}]
  18317. @var{COMMAND} ::= ["[" @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} "]"] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
  18318. @var{COMMANDS} ::= @var{COMMAND} [,@var{COMMANDS}]
  18319. @var{INTERVAL} ::= @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS}
  18320. @var{INTERVALS} ::= @var{INTERVAL}[;@var{INTERVALS}]
  18321. @end example
  18322. @subsection Examples
  18323. @itemize
  18324. @item
  18325. Specify audio tempo change at second 4:
  18326. @example
  18327. asendcmd=c='4.0 atempo tempo 1.5',atempo
  18328. @end example
  18329. @item
  18330. Target a specific filter instance:
  18331. @example
  18332. asendcmd=c='4.0 atempo@@my tempo 1.5',atempo@@my
  18333. @end example
  18334. @item
  18335. Specify a list of drawtext and hue commands in a file.
  18336. @example
  18337. # show text in the interval 5-10
  18338. 5.0-10.0 [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=hello world',
  18339. [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=';
  18340. # desaturate the image in the interval 15-20
  18341. 15.0-20.0 [enter] hue s 0,
  18342. [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=nocolor',
  18343. [leave] hue s 1,
  18344. [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=color';
  18345. # apply an exponential saturation fade-out effect, starting from time 25
  18346. 25 [enter] hue s exp(25-t)
  18347. @end example
  18348. A filtergraph allowing to read and process the above command list
  18349. stored in a file @file{test.cmd}, can be specified with:
  18350. @example
  18351. sendcmd=f=test.cmd,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='',hue
  18352. @end example
  18353. @end itemize
  18354. @anchor{setpts}
  18355. @section setpts, asetpts
  18356. Change the PTS (presentation timestamp) of the input frames.
  18357. @code{setpts} works on video frames, @code{asetpts} on audio frames.
  18358. This filter accepts the following options:
  18359. @table @option
  18360. @item expr
  18361. The expression which is evaluated for each frame to construct its timestamp.
  18362. @end table
  18363. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  18364. constants:
  18365. @table @option
  18366. @item FRAME_RATE, FR
  18367. frame rate, only defined for constant frame-rate video
  18368. @item PTS
  18369. The presentation timestamp in input
  18370. @item N
  18371. The count of the input frame for video or the number of consumed samples,
  18372. not including the current frame for audio, starting from 0.
  18373. @item NB_CONSUMED_SAMPLES
  18374. The number of consumed samples, not including the current frame (only
  18375. audio)
  18376. @item NB_SAMPLES, S
  18377. The number of samples in the current frame (only audio)
  18378. @item SAMPLE_RATE, SR
  18379. The audio sample rate.
  18380. @item STARTPTS
  18381. The PTS of the first frame.
  18382. @item STARTT
  18383. the time in seconds of the first frame
  18384. @item INTERLACED
  18385. State whether the current frame is interlaced.
  18386. @item T
  18387. the time in seconds of the current frame
  18388. @item POS
  18389. original position in the file of the frame, or undefined if undefined
  18390. for the current frame
  18391. @item PREV_INPTS
  18392. The previous input PTS.
  18393. @item PREV_INT
  18394. previous input time in seconds
  18395. @item PREV_OUTPTS
  18396. The previous output PTS.
  18397. @item PREV_OUTT
  18398. previous output time in seconds
  18399. @item RTCTIME
  18400. The wallclock (RTC) time in microseconds. This is deprecated, use time(0)
  18401. instead.
  18402. @item RTCSTART
  18403. The wallclock (RTC) time at the start of the movie in microseconds.
  18404. @item TB
  18405. The timebase of the input timestamps.
  18406. @end table
  18407. @subsection Examples
  18408. @itemize
  18409. @item
  18410. Start counting PTS from zero
  18411. @example
  18412. setpts=PTS-STARTPTS
  18413. @end example
  18414. @item
  18415. Apply fast motion effect:
  18416. @example
  18417. setpts=0.5*PTS
  18418. @end example
  18419. @item
  18420. Apply slow motion effect:
  18421. @example
  18422. setpts=2.0*PTS
  18423. @end example
  18424. @item
  18425. Set fixed rate of 25 frames per second:
  18426. @example
  18427. setpts=N/(25*TB)
  18428. @end example
  18429. @item
  18430. Set fixed rate 25 fps with some jitter:
  18431. @example
  18432. setpts='1/(25*TB) * (N + 0.05 * sin(N*2*PI/25))'
  18433. @end example
  18434. @item
  18435. Apply an offset of 10 seconds to the input PTS:
  18436. @example
  18437. setpts=PTS+10/TB
  18438. @end example
  18439. @item
  18440. Generate timestamps from a "live source" and rebase onto the current timebase:
  18441. @example
  18442. setpts='(RTCTIME - RTCSTART) / (TB * 1000000)'
  18443. @end example
  18444. @item
  18445. Generate timestamps by counting samples:
  18446. @example
  18447. asetpts=N/SR/TB
  18448. @end example
  18449. @end itemize
  18450. @section setrange
  18451. Force color range for the output video frame.
  18452. The @code{setrange} filter marks the color range property for the
  18453. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  18454. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  18455. following filters.
  18456. The filter accepts the following options:
  18457. @table @option
  18458. @item range
  18459. Available values are:
  18460. @table @samp
  18461. @item auto
  18462. Keep the same color range property.
  18463. @item unspecified, unknown
  18464. Set the color range as unspecified.
  18465. @item limited, tv, mpeg
  18466. Set the color range as limited.
  18467. @item full, pc, jpeg
  18468. Set the color range as full.
  18469. @end table
  18470. @end table
  18471. @section settb, asettb
  18472. Set the timebase to use for the output frames timestamps.
  18473. It is mainly useful for testing timebase configuration.
  18474. It accepts the following parameters:
  18475. @table @option
  18476. @item expr, tb
  18477. The expression which is evaluated into the output timebase.
  18478. @end table
  18479. The value for @option{tb} is an arithmetic expression representing a
  18480. rational. The expression can contain the constants "AVTB" (the default
  18481. timebase), "intb" (the input timebase) and "sr" (the sample rate,
  18482. audio only). Default value is "intb".
  18483. @subsection Examples
  18484. @itemize
  18485. @item
  18486. Set the timebase to 1/25:
  18487. @example
  18488. settb=expr=1/25
  18489. @end example
  18490. @item
  18491. Set the timebase to 1/10:
  18492. @example
  18493. settb=expr=0.1
  18494. @end example
  18495. @item
  18496. Set the timebase to 1001/1000:
  18497. @example
  18498. settb=1+0.001
  18499. @end example
  18500. @item
  18501. Set the timebase to 2*intb:
  18502. @example
  18503. settb=2*intb
  18504. @end example
  18505. @item
  18506. Set the default timebase value:
  18507. @example
  18508. settb=AVTB
  18509. @end example
  18510. @end itemize
  18511. @section showcqt
  18512. Convert input audio to a video output representing frequency spectrum
  18513. logarithmically using Brown-Puckette constant Q transform algorithm with
  18514. direct frequency domain coefficient calculation (but the transform itself
  18515. is not really constant Q, instead the Q factor is actually variable/clamped),
  18516. with musical tone scale, from E0 to D#10.
  18517. The filter accepts the following options:
  18518. @table @option
  18519. @item size, s
  18520. Specify the video size for the output. It must be even. For the syntax of this option,
  18521. check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18522. Default value is @code{1920x1080}.
  18523. @item fps, rate, r
  18524. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  18525. @item bar_h
  18526. Set the bargraph height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
  18527. computes the bargraph height automatically.
  18528. @item axis_h
  18529. Set the axis height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which computes
  18530. the axis height automatically.
  18531. @item sono_h
  18532. Set the sonogram height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
  18533. computes the sonogram height automatically.
  18534. @item fullhd
  18535. Set the fullhd resolution. This option is deprecated, use @var{size}, @var{s}
  18536. instead. Default value is @code{1}.
  18537. @item sono_v, volume
  18538. Specify the sonogram volume expression. It can contain variables:
  18539. @table @option
  18540. @item bar_v
  18541. the @var{bar_v} evaluated expression
  18542. @item frequency, freq, f
  18543. the frequency where it is evaluated
  18544. @item timeclamp, tc
  18545. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  18546. @end table
  18547. and functions:
  18548. @table @option
  18549. @item a_weighting(f)
  18550. A-weighting of equal loudness
  18551. @item b_weighting(f)
  18552. B-weighting of equal loudness
  18553. @item c_weighting(f)
  18554. C-weighting of equal loudness.
  18555. @end table
  18556. Default value is @code{16}.
  18557. @item bar_v, volume2
  18558. Specify the bargraph volume expression. It can contain variables:
  18559. @table @option
  18560. @item sono_v
  18561. the @var{sono_v} evaluated expression
  18562. @item frequency, freq, f
  18563. the frequency where it is evaluated
  18564. @item timeclamp, tc
  18565. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  18566. @end table
  18567. and functions:
  18568. @table @option
  18569. @item a_weighting(f)
  18570. A-weighting of equal loudness
  18571. @item b_weighting(f)
  18572. B-weighting of equal loudness
  18573. @item c_weighting(f)
  18574. C-weighting of equal loudness.
  18575. @end table
  18576. Default value is @code{sono_v}.
  18577. @item sono_g, gamma
  18578. Specify the sonogram gamma. Lower gamma makes the spectrum more contrast,
  18579. higher gamma makes the spectrum having more range. Default value is @code{3}.
  18580. Acceptable range is @code{[1, 7]}.
  18581. @item bar_g, gamma2
  18582. Specify the bargraph gamma. Default value is @code{1}. Acceptable range is
  18583. @code{[1, 7]}.
  18584. @item bar_t
  18585. Specify the bargraph transparency level. Lower value makes the bargraph sharper.
  18586. Default value is @code{1}. Acceptable range is @code{[0, 1]}.
  18587. @item timeclamp, tc
  18588. Specify the transform timeclamp. At low frequency, there is trade-off between
  18589. accuracy in time domain and frequency domain. If timeclamp is lower,
  18590. event in time domain is represented more accurately (such as fast bass drum),
  18591. otherwise event in frequency domain is represented more accurately
  18592. (such as bass guitar). Acceptable range is @code{[0.002, 1]}. Default value is @code{0.17}.
  18593. @item attack
  18594. Set attack time in seconds. The default is @code{0} (disabled). Otherwise, it
  18595. limits future samples by applying asymmetric windowing in time domain, useful
  18596. when low latency is required. Accepted range is @code{[0, 1]}.
  18597. @item basefreq
  18598. Specify the transform base frequency. Default value is @code{20.01523126408007475},
  18599. which is frequency 50 cents below E0. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
  18600. @item endfreq
  18601. Specify the transform end frequency. Default value is @code{20495.59681441799654},
  18602. which is frequency 50 cents above D#10. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
  18603. @item coeffclamp
  18604. This option is deprecated and ignored.
  18605. @item tlength
  18606. Specify the transform length in time domain. Use this option to control accuracy
  18607. trade-off between time domain and frequency domain at every frequency sample.
  18608. It can contain variables:
  18609. @table @option
  18610. @item frequency, freq, f
  18611. the frequency where it is evaluated
  18612. @item timeclamp, tc
  18613. the value of @var{timeclamp} option.
  18614. @end table
  18615. Default value is @code{384*tc/(384+tc*f)}.
  18616. @item count
  18617. Specify the transform count for every video frame. Default value is @code{6}.
  18618. Acceptable range is @code{[1, 30]}.
  18619. @item fcount
  18620. Specify the transform count for every single pixel. Default value is @code{0},
  18621. which makes it computed automatically. Acceptable range is @code{[0, 10]}.
  18622. @item fontfile
  18623. Specify font file for use with freetype to draw the axis. If not specified,
  18624. use embedded font. Note that drawing with font file or embedded font is not
  18625. implemented with custom @var{basefreq} and @var{endfreq}, use @var{axisfile}
  18626. option instead.
  18627. @item font
  18628. Specify fontconfig pattern. This has lower priority than @var{fontfile}. The
  18629. @code{:} in the pattern may be replaced by @code{|} to avoid unnecessary
  18630. escaping.
  18631. @item fontcolor
  18632. Specify font color expression. This is arithmetic expression that should return
  18633. integer value 0xRRGGBB. It can contain variables:
  18634. @table @option
  18635. @item frequency, freq, f
  18636. the frequency where it is evaluated
  18637. @item timeclamp, tc
  18638. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  18639. @end table
  18640. and functions:
  18641. @table @option
  18642. @item midi(f)
  18643. midi number of frequency f, some midi numbers: E0(16), C1(24), C2(36), A4(69)
  18644. @item r(x), g(x), b(x)
  18645. red, green, and blue value of intensity x.
  18646. @end table
  18647. Default value is @code{st(0, (midi(f)-59.5)/12);
  18648. st(1, if(between(ld(0),0,1), 0.5-0.5*cos(2*PI*ld(0)), 0));
  18649. r(1-ld(1)) + b(ld(1))}.
  18650. @item axisfile
  18651. Specify image file to draw the axis. This option override @var{fontfile} and
  18652. @var{fontcolor} option.
  18653. @item axis, text
  18654. Enable/disable drawing text to the axis. If it is set to @code{0}, drawing to
  18655. the axis is disabled, ignoring @var{fontfile} and @var{axisfile} option.
  18656. Default value is @code{1}.
  18657. @item csp
  18658. Set colorspace. The accepted values are:
  18659. @table @samp
  18660. @item unspecified
  18661. Unspecified (default)
  18662. @item bt709
  18663. BT.709
  18664. @item fcc
  18665. FCC
  18666. @item bt470bg
  18667. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  18668. @item smpte170m
  18669. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  18670. @item smpte240m
  18671. SMPTE-240M
  18672. @item bt2020ncl
  18673. BT.2020 with non-constant luminance
  18674. @end table
  18675. @item cscheme
  18676. Set spectrogram color scheme. This is list of floating point values with format
  18677. @code{left_r|left_g|left_b|right_r|right_g|right_b}.
  18678. The default is @code{1|0.5|0|0|0.5|1}.
  18679. @end table
  18680. @subsection Examples
  18681. @itemize
  18682. @item
  18683. Playing audio while showing the spectrum:
  18684. @example
  18685. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
  18686. @end example
  18687. @item
  18688. Same as above, but with frame rate 30 fps:
  18689. @example
  18690. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=fps=30:count=5 [out0]'
  18691. @end example
  18692. @item
  18693. Playing at 1280x720:
  18694. @example
  18695. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=s=1280x720:count=4 [out0]'
  18696. @end example
  18697. @item
  18698. Disable sonogram display:
  18699. @example
  18700. sono_h=0
  18701. @end example
  18702. @item
  18703. A1 and its harmonics: A1, A2, (near)E3, A3:
  18704. @example
  18705. ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
  18706. asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
  18707. @end example
  18708. @item
  18709. Same as above, but with more accuracy in frequency domain:
  18710. @example
  18711. ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
  18712. asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt=timeclamp=0.5 [out0]'
  18713. @end example
  18714. @item
  18715. Custom volume:
  18716. @example
  18717. bar_v=10:sono_v=bar_v*a_weighting(f)
  18718. @end example
  18719. @item
  18720. Custom gamma, now spectrum is linear to the amplitude.
  18721. @example
  18722. bar_g=2:sono_g=2
  18723. @end example
  18724. @item
  18725. Custom tlength equation:
  18726. @example
  18727. tc=0.33:tlength='st(0,0.17); 384*tc / (384 / ld(0) + tc*f /(1-ld(0))) + 384*tc / (tc*f / ld(0) + 384 /(1-ld(0)))'
  18728. @end example
  18729. @item
  18730. Custom fontcolor and fontfile, C-note is colored green, others are colored blue:
  18731. @example
  18732. fontcolor='if(mod(floor(midi(f)+0.5),12), 0x0000FF, g(1))':fontfile=myfont.ttf
  18733. @end example
  18734. @item
  18735. Custom font using fontconfig:
  18736. @example
  18737. font='Courier New,Monospace,mono|bold'
  18738. @end example
  18739. @item
  18740. Custom frequency range with custom axis using image file:
  18741. @example
  18742. axisfile=myaxis.png:basefreq=40:endfreq=10000
  18743. @end example
  18744. @end itemize
  18745. @section showfreqs
  18746. Convert input audio to video output representing the audio power spectrum.
  18747. Audio amplitude is on Y-axis while frequency is on X-axis.
  18748. The filter accepts the following options:
  18749. @table @option
  18750. @item size, s
  18751. Specify size of video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18752. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18753. Default is @code{1024x512}.
  18754. @item mode
  18755. Set display mode.
  18756. This set how each frequency bin will be represented.
  18757. It accepts the following values:
  18758. @table @samp
  18759. @item line
  18760. @item bar
  18761. @item dot
  18762. @end table
  18763. Default is @code{bar}.
  18764. @item ascale
  18765. Set amplitude scale.
  18766. It accepts the following values:
  18767. @table @samp
  18768. @item lin
  18769. Linear scale.
  18770. @item sqrt
  18771. Square root scale.
  18772. @item cbrt
  18773. Cubic root scale.
  18774. @item log
  18775. Logarithmic scale.
  18776. @end table
  18777. Default is @code{log}.
  18778. @item fscale
  18779. Set frequency scale.
  18780. It accepts the following values:
  18781. @table @samp
  18782. @item lin
  18783. Linear scale.
  18784. @item log
  18785. Logarithmic scale.
  18786. @item rlog
  18787. Reverse logarithmic scale.
  18788. @end table
  18789. Default is @code{lin}.
  18790. @item win_size
  18791. Set window size. Allowed range is from 16 to 65536.
  18792. Default is @code{2048}
  18793. @item win_func
  18794. Set windowing function.
  18795. It accepts the following values:
  18796. @table @samp
  18797. @item rect
  18798. @item bartlett
  18799. @item hanning
  18800. @item hamming
  18801. @item blackman
  18802. @item welch
  18803. @item flattop
  18804. @item bharris
  18805. @item bnuttall
  18806. @item bhann
  18807. @item sine
  18808. @item nuttall
  18809. @item lanczos
  18810. @item gauss
  18811. @item tukey
  18812. @item dolph
  18813. @item cauchy
  18814. @item parzen
  18815. @item poisson
  18816. @item bohman
  18817. @end table
  18818. Default is @code{hanning}.
  18819. @item overlap
  18820. Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
  18821. which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
  18822. @item averaging
  18823. Set time averaging. Setting this to 0 will display current maximal peaks.
  18824. Default is @code{1}, which means time averaging is disabled.
  18825. @item colors
  18826. Specify list of colors separated by space or by '|' which will be used to
  18827. draw channel frequencies. Unrecognized or missing colors will be replaced
  18828. by white color.
  18829. @item cmode
  18830. Set channel display mode.
  18831. It accepts the following values:
  18832. @table @samp
  18833. @item combined
  18834. @item separate
  18835. @end table
  18836. Default is @code{combined}.
  18837. @item minamp
  18838. Set minimum amplitude used in @code{log} amplitude scaler.
  18839. @end table
  18840. @section showspatial
  18841. Convert stereo input audio to a video output, representing the spatial relationship
  18842. between two channels.
  18843. The filter accepts the following options:
  18844. @table @option
  18845. @item size, s
  18846. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18847. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18848. Default value is @code{512x512}.
  18849. @item win_size
  18850. Set window size. Allowed range is from @var{1024} to @var{65536}. Default size is @var{4096}.
  18851. @item win_func
  18852. Set window function.
  18853. It accepts the following values:
  18854. @table @samp
  18855. @item rect
  18856. @item bartlett
  18857. @item hann
  18858. @item hanning
  18859. @item hamming
  18860. @item blackman
  18861. @item welch
  18862. @item flattop
  18863. @item bharris
  18864. @item bnuttall
  18865. @item bhann
  18866. @item sine
  18867. @item nuttall
  18868. @item lanczos
  18869. @item gauss
  18870. @item tukey
  18871. @item dolph
  18872. @item cauchy
  18873. @item parzen
  18874. @item poisson
  18875. @item bohman
  18876. @end table
  18877. Default value is @code{hann}.
  18878. @item overlap
  18879. Set ratio of overlap window. Default value is @code{0.5}.
  18880. When value is @code{1} overlap is set to recommended size for specific
  18881. window function currently used.
  18882. @end table
  18883. @anchor{showspectrum}
  18884. @section showspectrum
  18885. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio frequency
  18886. spectrum.
  18887. The filter accepts the following options:
  18888. @table @option
  18889. @item size, s
  18890. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18891. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18892. Default value is @code{640x512}.
  18893. @item slide
  18894. Specify how the spectrum should slide along the window.
  18895. It accepts the following values:
  18896. @table @samp
  18897. @item replace
  18898. the samples start again on the left when they reach the right
  18899. @item scroll
  18900. the samples scroll from right to left
  18901. @item fullframe
  18902. frames are only produced when the samples reach the right
  18903. @item rscroll
  18904. the samples scroll from left to right
  18905. @end table
  18906. Default value is @code{replace}.
  18907. @item mode
  18908. Specify display mode.
  18909. It accepts the following values:
  18910. @table @samp
  18911. @item combined
  18912. all channels are displayed in the same row
  18913. @item separate
  18914. all channels are displayed in separate rows
  18915. @end table
  18916. Default value is @samp{combined}.
  18917. @item color
  18918. Specify display color mode.
  18919. It accepts the following values:
  18920. @table @samp
  18921. @item channel
  18922. each channel is displayed in a separate color
  18923. @item intensity
  18924. each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
  18925. @item rainbow
  18926. each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
  18927. @item moreland
  18928. each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
  18929. @item nebulae
  18930. each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
  18931. @item fire
  18932. each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
  18933. @item fiery
  18934. each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
  18935. @item fruit
  18936. each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
  18937. @item cool
  18938. each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
  18939. @item magma
  18940. each channel is displayed using the magma color scheme
  18941. @item green
  18942. each channel is displayed using the green color scheme
  18943. @item viridis
  18944. each channel is displayed using the viridis color scheme
  18945. @item plasma
  18946. each channel is displayed using the plasma color scheme
  18947. @item cividis
  18948. each channel is displayed using the cividis color scheme
  18949. @item terrain
  18950. each channel is displayed using the terrain color scheme
  18951. @end table
  18952. Default value is @samp{channel}.
  18953. @item scale
  18954. Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
  18955. It accepts the following values:
  18956. @table @samp
  18957. @item lin
  18958. linear
  18959. @item sqrt
  18960. square root, default
  18961. @item cbrt
  18962. cubic root
  18963. @item log
  18964. logarithmic
  18965. @item 4thrt
  18966. 4th root
  18967. @item 5thrt
  18968. 5th root
  18969. @end table
  18970. Default value is @samp{sqrt}.
  18971. @item fscale
  18972. Specify frequency scale.
  18973. It accepts the following values:
  18974. @table @samp
  18975. @item lin
  18976. linear
  18977. @item log
  18978. logarithmic
  18979. @end table
  18980. Default value is @samp{lin}.
  18981. @item saturation
  18982. Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
  18983. alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
  18984. Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
  18985. Default value is @code{1}.
  18986. @item win_func
  18987. Set window function.
  18988. It accepts the following values:
  18989. @table @samp
  18990. @item rect
  18991. @item bartlett
  18992. @item hann
  18993. @item hanning
  18994. @item hamming
  18995. @item blackman
  18996. @item welch
  18997. @item flattop
  18998. @item bharris
  18999. @item bnuttall
  19000. @item bhann
  19001. @item sine
  19002. @item nuttall
  19003. @item lanczos
  19004. @item gauss
  19005. @item tukey
  19006. @item dolph
  19007. @item cauchy
  19008. @item parzen
  19009. @item poisson
  19010. @item bohman
  19011. @end table
  19012. Default value is @code{hann}.
  19013. @item orientation
  19014. Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
  19015. @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
  19016. @item overlap
  19017. Set ratio of overlap window. Default value is @code{0}.
  19018. When value is @code{1} overlap is set to recommended size for specific
  19019. window function currently used.
  19020. @item gain
  19021. Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
  19022. Default value is @code{1}.
  19023. @item data
  19024. Set which data to display. Can be @code{magnitude}, default or @code{phase}.
  19025. @item rotation
  19026. Set color rotation, must be in [-1.0, 1.0] range.
  19027. Default value is @code{0}.
  19028. @item start
  19029. Set start frequency from which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  19030. @item stop
  19031. Set stop frequency to which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  19032. @item fps
  19033. Set upper frame rate limit. Default is @code{auto}, unlimited.
  19034. @item legend
  19035. Draw time and frequency axes and legends. Default is disabled.
  19036. @end table
  19037. The usage is very similar to the showwaves filter; see the examples in that
  19038. section.
  19039. @subsection Examples
  19040. @itemize
  19041. @item
  19042. Large window with logarithmic color scaling:
  19043. @example
  19044. showspectrum=s=1280x480:scale=log
  19045. @end example
  19046. @item
  19047. Complete example for a colored and sliding spectrum per channel using @command{ffplay}:
  19048. @example
  19049. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
  19050. [a] showspectrum=mode=separate:color=intensity:slide=1:scale=cbrt [out0]'
  19051. @end example
  19052. @end itemize
  19053. @section showspectrumpic
  19054. Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the audio frequency
  19055. spectrum.
  19056. The filter accepts the following options:
  19057. @table @option
  19058. @item size, s
  19059. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  19060. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  19061. Default value is @code{4096x2048}.
  19062. @item mode
  19063. Specify display mode.
  19064. It accepts the following values:
  19065. @table @samp
  19066. @item combined
  19067. all channels are displayed in the same row
  19068. @item separate
  19069. all channels are displayed in separate rows
  19070. @end table
  19071. Default value is @samp{combined}.
  19072. @item color
  19073. Specify display color mode.
  19074. It accepts the following values:
  19075. @table @samp
  19076. @item channel
  19077. each channel is displayed in a separate color
  19078. @item intensity
  19079. each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
  19080. @item rainbow
  19081. each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
  19082. @item moreland
  19083. each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
  19084. @item nebulae
  19085. each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
  19086. @item fire
  19087. each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
  19088. @item fiery
  19089. each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
  19090. @item fruit
  19091. each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
  19092. @item cool
  19093. each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
  19094. @item magma
  19095. each channel is displayed using the magma color scheme
  19096. @item green
  19097. each channel is displayed using the green color scheme
  19098. @item viridis
  19099. each channel is displayed using the viridis color scheme
  19100. @item plasma
  19101. each channel is displayed using the plasma color scheme
  19102. @item cividis
  19103. each channel is displayed using the cividis color scheme
  19104. @item terrain
  19105. each channel is displayed using the terrain color scheme
  19106. @end table
  19107. Default value is @samp{intensity}.
  19108. @item scale
  19109. Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
  19110. It accepts the following values:
  19111. @table @samp
  19112. @item lin
  19113. linear
  19114. @item sqrt
  19115. square root, default
  19116. @item cbrt
  19117. cubic root
  19118. @item log
  19119. logarithmic
  19120. @item 4thrt
  19121. 4th root
  19122. @item 5thrt
  19123. 5th root
  19124. @end table
  19125. Default value is @samp{log}.
  19126. @item fscale
  19127. Specify frequency scale.
  19128. It accepts the following values:
  19129. @table @samp
  19130. @item lin
  19131. linear
  19132. @item log
  19133. logarithmic
  19134. @end table
  19135. Default value is @samp{lin}.
  19136. @item saturation
  19137. Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
  19138. alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
  19139. Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
  19140. Default value is @code{1}.
  19141. @item win_func
  19142. Set window function.
  19143. It accepts the following values:
  19144. @table @samp
  19145. @item rect
  19146. @item bartlett
  19147. @item hann
  19148. @item hanning
  19149. @item hamming
  19150. @item blackman
  19151. @item welch
  19152. @item flattop
  19153. @item bharris
  19154. @item bnuttall
  19155. @item bhann
  19156. @item sine
  19157. @item nuttall
  19158. @item lanczos
  19159. @item gauss
  19160. @item tukey
  19161. @item dolph
  19162. @item cauchy
  19163. @item parzen
  19164. @item poisson
  19165. @item bohman
  19166. @end table
  19167. Default value is @code{hann}.
  19168. @item orientation
  19169. Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
  19170. @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
  19171. @item gain
  19172. Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
  19173. Default value is @code{1}.
  19174. @item legend
  19175. Draw time and frequency axes and legends. Default is enabled.
  19176. @item rotation
  19177. Set color rotation, must be in [-1.0, 1.0] range.
  19178. Default value is @code{0}.
  19179. @item start
  19180. Set start frequency from which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  19181. @item stop
  19182. Set stop frequency to which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  19183. @end table
  19184. @subsection Examples
  19185. @itemize
  19186. @item
  19187. Extract an audio spectrogram of a whole audio track
  19188. in a 1024x1024 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
  19189. @example
  19190. ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showspectrumpic=s=1024x1024 spectrogram.png
  19191. @end example
  19192. @end itemize
  19193. @section showvolume
  19194. Convert input audio volume to a video output.
  19195. The filter accepts the following options:
  19196. @table @option
  19197. @item rate, r
  19198. Set video rate.
  19199. @item b
  19200. Set border width, allowed range is [0, 5]. Default is 1.
  19201. @item w
  19202. Set channel width, allowed range is [80, 8192]. Default is 400.
  19203. @item h
  19204. Set channel height, allowed range is [1, 900]. Default is 20.
  19205. @item f
  19206. Set fade, allowed range is [0, 1]. Default is 0.95.
  19207. @item c
  19208. Set volume color expression.
  19209. The expression can use the following variables:
  19210. @table @option
  19211. @item VOLUME
  19212. Current max volume of channel in dB.
  19213. @item PEAK
  19214. Current peak.
  19215. @item CHANNEL
  19216. Current channel number, starting from 0.
  19217. @end table
  19218. @item t
  19219. If set, displays channel names. Default is enabled.
  19220. @item v
  19221. If set, displays volume values. Default is enabled.
  19222. @item o
  19223. Set orientation, can be horizontal: @code{h} or vertical: @code{v},
  19224. default is @code{h}.
  19225. @item s
  19226. Set step size, allowed range is [0, 5]. Default is 0, which means
  19227. step is disabled.
  19228. @item p
  19229. Set background opacity, allowed range is [0, 1]. Default is 0.
  19230. @item m
  19231. Set metering mode, can be peak: @code{p} or rms: @code{r},
  19232. default is @code{p}.
  19233. @item ds
  19234. Set display scale, can be linear: @code{lin} or log: @code{log},
  19235. default is @code{lin}.
  19236. @item dm
  19237. In second.
  19238. If set to > 0., display a line for the max level
  19239. in the previous seconds.
  19240. default is disabled: @code{0.}
  19241. @item dmc
  19242. The color of the max line. Use when @code{dm} option is set to > 0.
  19243. default is: @code{orange}
  19244. @end table
  19245. @section showwaves
  19246. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the samples waves.
  19247. The filter accepts the following options:
  19248. @table @option
  19249. @item size, s
  19250. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  19251. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  19252. Default value is @code{600x240}.
  19253. @item mode
  19254. Set display mode.
  19255. Available values are:
  19256. @table @samp
  19257. @item point
  19258. Draw a point for each sample.
  19259. @item line
  19260. Draw a vertical line for each sample.
  19261. @item p2p
  19262. Draw a point for each sample and a line between them.
  19263. @item cline
  19264. Draw a centered vertical line for each sample.
  19265. @end table
  19266. Default value is @code{point}.
  19267. @item n
  19268. Set the number of samples which are printed on the same column. A
  19269. larger value will decrease the frame rate. Must be a positive
  19270. integer. This option can be set only if the value for @var{rate}
  19271. is not explicitly specified.
  19272. @item rate, r
  19273. Set the (approximate) output frame rate. This is done by setting the
  19274. option @var{n}. Default value is "25".
  19275. @item split_channels
  19276. Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
  19277. @item colors
  19278. Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
  19279. @item scale
  19280. Set amplitude scale.
  19281. Available values are:
  19282. @table @samp
  19283. @item lin
  19284. Linear.
  19285. @item log
  19286. Logarithmic.
  19287. @item sqrt
  19288. Square root.
  19289. @item cbrt
  19290. Cubic root.
  19291. @end table
  19292. Default is linear.
  19293. @item draw
  19294. Set the draw mode. This is mostly useful to set for high @var{n}.
  19295. Available values are:
  19296. @table @samp
  19297. @item scale
  19298. Scale pixel values for each drawn sample.
  19299. @item full
  19300. Draw every sample directly.
  19301. @end table
  19302. Default value is @code{scale}.
  19303. @end table
  19304. @subsection Examples
  19305. @itemize
  19306. @item
  19307. Output the input file audio and the corresponding video representation
  19308. at the same time:
  19309. @example
  19310. amovie=a.mp3,asplit[out0],showwaves[out1]
  19311. @end example
  19312. @item
  19313. Create a synthetic signal and show it with showwaves, forcing a
  19314. frame rate of 30 frames per second:
  19315. @example
  19316. aevalsrc=sin(1*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t):cos(2*PI*200*t),asplit[out0],showwaves=r=30[out1]
  19317. @end example
  19318. @end itemize
  19319. @section showwavespic
  19320. Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the samples waves.
  19321. The filter accepts the following options:
  19322. @table @option
  19323. @item size, s
  19324. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  19325. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  19326. Default value is @code{600x240}.
  19327. @item split_channels
  19328. Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
  19329. @item colors
  19330. Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
  19331. @item scale
  19332. Set amplitude scale.
  19333. Available values are:
  19334. @table @samp
  19335. @item lin
  19336. Linear.
  19337. @item log
  19338. Logarithmic.
  19339. @item sqrt
  19340. Square root.
  19341. @item cbrt
  19342. Cubic root.
  19343. @end table
  19344. Default is linear.
  19345. @item draw
  19346. Set the draw mode.
  19347. Available values are:
  19348. @table @samp
  19349. @item scale
  19350. Scale pixel values for each drawn sample.
  19351. @item full
  19352. Draw every sample directly.
  19353. @end table
  19354. Default value is @code{scale}.
  19355. @end table
  19356. @subsection Examples
  19357. @itemize
  19358. @item
  19359. Extract a channel split representation of the wave form of a whole audio track
  19360. in a 1024x800 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
  19361. @example
  19362. ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showwavespic=split_channels=1:s=1024x800 waveform.png
  19363. @end example
  19364. @end itemize
  19365. @section sidedata, asidedata
  19366. Delete frame side data, or select frames based on it.
  19367. This filter accepts the following options:
  19368. @table @option
  19369. @item mode
  19370. Set mode of operation of the filter.
  19371. Can be one of the following:
  19372. @table @samp
  19373. @item select
  19374. Select every frame with side data of @code{type}.
  19375. @item delete
  19376. Delete side data of @code{type}. If @code{type} is not set, delete all side
  19377. data in the frame.
  19378. @end table
  19379. @item type
  19380. Set side data type used with all modes. Must be set for @code{select} mode. For
  19381. the list of frame side data types, refer to the @code{AVFrameSideDataType} enum
  19382. in @file{libavutil/frame.h}. For example, to choose
  19383. @code{AV_FRAME_DATA_PANSCAN} side data, you must specify @code{PANSCAN}.
  19384. @end table
  19385. @section spectrumsynth
  19386. Synthesize audio from 2 input video spectrums, first input stream represents
  19387. magnitude across time and second represents phase across time.
  19388. The filter will transform from frequency domain as displayed in videos back
  19389. to time domain as presented in audio output.
  19390. This filter is primarily created for reversing processed @ref{showspectrum}
  19391. filter outputs, but can synthesize sound from other spectrograms too.
  19392. But in such case results are going to be poor if the phase data is not
  19393. available, because in such cases phase data need to be recreated, usually
  19394. it's just recreated from random noise.
  19395. For best results use gray only output (@code{channel} color mode in
  19396. @ref{showspectrum} filter) and @code{log} scale for magnitude video and
  19397. @code{lin} scale for phase video. To produce phase, for 2nd video, use
  19398. @code{data} option. Inputs videos should generally use @code{fullframe}
  19399. slide mode as that saves resources needed for decoding video.
  19400. The filter accepts the following options:
  19401. @table @option
  19402. @item sample_rate
  19403. Specify sample rate of output audio, the sample rate of audio from which
  19404. spectrum was generated may differ.
  19405. @item channels
  19406. Set number of channels represented in input video spectrums.
  19407. @item scale
  19408. Set scale which was used when generating magnitude input spectrum.
  19409. Can be @code{lin} or @code{log}. Default is @code{log}.
  19410. @item slide
  19411. Set slide which was used when generating inputs spectrums.
  19412. Can be @code{replace}, @code{scroll}, @code{fullframe} or @code{rscroll}.
  19413. Default is @code{fullframe}.
  19414. @item win_func
  19415. Set window function used for resynthesis.
  19416. @item overlap
  19417. Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
  19418. which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
  19419. @item orientation
  19420. Set orientation of input videos. Can be @code{vertical} or @code{horizontal}.
  19421. Default is @code{vertical}.
  19422. @end table
  19423. @subsection Examples
  19424. @itemize
  19425. @item
  19426. First create magnitude and phase videos from audio, assuming audio is stereo with 44100 sample rate,
  19427. then resynthesize videos back to audio with spectrumsynth:
  19428. @example
  19429. ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=log:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=magnitude -an -c:v rawvideo magnitude.nut
  19430. ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=lin:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=phase -an -c:v rawvideo phase.nut
  19431. ffmpeg -i magnitude.nut -i phase.nut -lavfi spectrumsynth=channels=2:sample_rate=44100:win_func=hann:overlap=0.875:slide=fullframe output.flac
  19432. @end example
  19433. @end itemize
  19434. @section split, asplit
  19435. Split input into several identical outputs.
  19436. @code{asplit} works with audio input, @code{split} with video.
  19437. The filter accepts a single parameter which specifies the number of outputs. If
  19438. unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  19439. @subsection Examples
  19440. @itemize
  19441. @item
  19442. Create two separate outputs from the same input:
  19443. @example
  19444. [in] split [out0][out1]
  19445. @end example
  19446. @item
  19447. To create 3 or more outputs, you need to specify the number of
  19448. outputs, like in:
  19449. @example
  19450. [in] asplit=3 [out0][out1][out2]
  19451. @end example
  19452. @item
  19453. Create two separate outputs from the same input, one cropped and
  19454. one padded:
  19455. @example
  19456. [in] split [splitout1][splitout2];
  19457. [splitout1] crop=100:100:0:0 [cropout];
  19458. [splitout2] pad=200:200:100:100 [padout];
  19459. @end example
  19460. @item
  19461. Create 5 copies of the input audio with @command{ffmpeg}:
  19462. @example
  19463. ffmpeg -i INPUT -filter_complex asplit=5 OUTPUT
  19464. @end example
  19465. @end itemize
  19466. @section zmq, azmq
  19467. Receive commands sent through a libzmq client, and forward them to
  19468. filters in the filtergraph.
  19469. @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} work as a pass-through filters. @code{zmq}
  19470. must be inserted between two video filters, @code{azmq} between two
  19471. audio filters. Both are capable to send messages to any filter type.
  19472. To enable these filters you need to install the libzmq library and
  19473. headers and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libzmq}.
  19474. For more information about libzmq see:
  19475. @url{http://www.zeromq.org/}
  19476. The @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} filters work as a libzmq server, which
  19477. receives messages sent through a network interface defined by the
  19478. @option{bind_address} (or the abbreviation "@option{b}") option.
  19479. Default value of this option is @file{tcp://localhost:5555}. You may
  19480. want to alter this value to your needs, but do not forget to escape any
  19481. ':' signs (see @ref{filtergraph escaping}).
  19482. The received message must be in the form:
  19483. @example
  19484. @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
  19485. @end example
  19486. @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
  19487. the filter class or a specific filter instance name. The default
  19488. filter instance name uses the pattern @samp{Parsed_<filter_name>_<index>},
  19489. but you can override this by using the @samp{filter_name@@id} syntax
  19490. (see @ref{Filtergraph syntax}).
  19491. @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
  19492. @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional argument list for the
  19493. given @var{COMMAND}.
  19494. Upon reception, the message is processed and the corresponding command
  19495. is injected into the filtergraph. Depending on the result, the filter
  19496. will send a reply to the client, adopting the format:
  19497. @example
  19498. @var{ERROR_CODE} @var{ERROR_REASON}
  19499. @var{MESSAGE}
  19500. @end example
  19501. @var{MESSAGE} is optional.
  19502. @subsection Examples
  19503. Look at @file{tools/zmqsend} for an example of a zmq client which can
  19504. be used to send commands processed by these filters.
  19505. Consider the following filtergraph generated by @command{ffplay}.
  19506. In this example the last overlay filter has an instance name. All other
  19507. filters will have default instance names.
  19508. @example
  19509. ffplay -dumpgraph 1 -f lavfi "
  19510. color=s=100x100:c=red [l];
  19511. color=s=100x100:c=blue [r];
  19512. nullsrc=s=200x100, zmq [bg];
  19513. [bg][l] overlay [bg+l];
  19514. [bg+l][r] overlay@@my=x=100 "
  19515. @end example
  19516. To change the color of the left side of the video, the following
  19517. command can be used:
  19518. @example
  19519. echo Parsed_color_0 c yellow | tools/zmqsend
  19520. @end example
  19521. To change the right side:
  19522. @example
  19523. echo Parsed_color_1 c pink | tools/zmqsend
  19524. @end example
  19525. To change the position of the right side:
  19526. @example
  19527. echo overlay@@my x 150 | tools/zmqsend
  19528. @end example
  19529. @c man end MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
  19530. @chapter Multimedia Sources
  19531. @c man begin MULTIMEDIA SOURCES
  19532. Below is a description of the currently available multimedia sources.
  19533. @section amovie
  19534. This is the same as @ref{movie} source, except it selects an audio
  19535. stream by default.
  19536. @anchor{movie}
  19537. @section movie
  19538. Read audio and/or video stream(s) from a movie container.
  19539. It accepts the following parameters:
  19540. @table @option
  19541. @item filename
  19542. The name of the resource to read (not necessarily a file; it can also be a
  19543. device or a stream accessed through some protocol).
  19544. @item format_name, f
  19545. Specifies the format assumed for the movie to read, and can be either
  19546. the name of a container or an input device. If not specified, the
  19547. format is guessed from @var{movie_name} or by probing.
  19548. @item seek_point, sp
  19549. Specifies the seek point in seconds. The frames will be output
  19550. starting from this seek point. The parameter is evaluated with
  19551. @code{av_strtod}, so the numerical value may be suffixed by an IS
  19552. postfix. The default value is "0".
  19553. @item streams, s
  19554. Specifies the streams to read. Several streams can be specified,
  19555. separated by "+". The source will then have as many outputs, in the
  19556. same order. The syntax is explained in the @ref{Stream specifiers,,"Stream specifiers"
  19557. section in the ffmpeg manual,ffmpeg}. Two special names, "dv" and "da" specify
  19558. respectively the default (best suited) video and audio stream. Default
  19559. is "dv", or "da" if the filter is called as "amovie".
  19560. @item stream_index, si
  19561. Specifies the index of the video stream to read. If the value is -1,
  19562. the most suitable video stream will be automatically selected. The default
  19563. value is "-1". Deprecated. If the filter is called "amovie", it will select
  19564. audio instead of video.
  19565. @item loop
  19566. Specifies how many times to read the stream in sequence.
  19567. If the value is 0, the stream will be looped infinitely.
  19568. Default value is "1".
  19569. Note that when the movie is looped the source timestamps are not
  19570. changed, so it will generate non monotonically increasing timestamps.
  19571. @item discontinuity
  19572. Specifies the time difference between frames above which the point is
  19573. considered a timestamp discontinuity which is removed by adjusting the later
  19574. timestamps.
  19575. @end table
  19576. It allows overlaying a second video on top of the main input of
  19577. a filtergraph, as shown in this graph:
  19578. @example
  19579. input -----------> deltapts0 --> overlay --> output
  19580. ^
  19581. |
  19582. movie --> scale--> deltapts1 -------+
  19583. @end example
  19584. @subsection Examples
  19585. @itemize
  19586. @item
  19587. Skip 3.2 seconds from the start of the AVI file in.avi, and overlay it
  19588. on top of the input labelled "in":
  19589. @example
  19590. movie=in.avi:seek_point=3.2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
  19591. [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  19592. [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
  19593. @end example
  19594. @item
  19595. Read from a video4linux2 device, and overlay it on top of the input
  19596. labelled "in":
  19597. @example
  19598. movie=/dev/video0:f=video4linux2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
  19599. [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  19600. [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
  19601. @end example
  19602. @item
  19603. Read the first video stream and the audio stream with id 0x81 from
  19604. dvd.vob; the video is connected to the pad named "video" and the audio is
  19605. connected to the pad named "audio":
  19606. @example
  19607. movie=dvd.vob:s=v:0+#0x81 [video] [audio]
  19608. @end example
  19609. @end itemize
  19610. @subsection Commands
  19611. Both movie and amovie support the following commands:
  19612. @table @option
  19613. @item seek
  19614. Perform seek using "av_seek_frame".
  19615. The syntax is: seek @var{stream_index}|@var{timestamp}|@var{flags}
  19616. @itemize
  19617. @item
  19618. @var{stream_index}: If stream_index is -1, a default
  19619. stream is selected, and @var{timestamp} is automatically converted
  19620. from AV_TIME_BASE units to the stream specific time_base.
  19621. @item
  19622. @var{timestamp}: Timestamp in AVStream.time_base units
  19623. or, if no stream is specified, in AV_TIME_BASE units.
  19624. @item
  19625. @var{flags}: Flags which select direction and seeking mode.
  19626. @end itemize
  19627. @item get_duration
  19628. Get movie duration in AV_TIME_BASE units.
  19629. @end table
  19630. @c man end MULTIMEDIA SOURCES